PC210 10
PC210 10
PC210 10
HYDRAULIC EXCAVATOR
PC210LC-10
Model Serial Number
PC210LC-10 00-1
00 Index and foreword
Index
Index (ALL-0310-001-A-00-A)
00 Index and foreword ....................................................................................................................... 00-1
Index ......................................................................................................................................... 00-2
Foreword, safety and general information ................................................................................... 00-14
Important safety notice ....................................................................................................... 00-14
How to read the shop manual.............................................................................................. 00-21
Explanation of terms for maintenance standard .................................................................... 00-23
Handling equipment of fuel system devices .......................................................................... 00-25
Handling of intake system parts........................................................................................... 00-26
Handling of hydraulic equipment.......................................................................................... 00-27
Method of disconnecting and connecting of push-pull type coupler ......................................... 00-29
Handling of electrical equipment.......................................................................................... 00-32
How to read electric wire code............................................................................................. 00-40
Precautions when performing operation ............................................................................... 00-43
Practical use of KOMTRAX ................................................................................................. 00-47
Standard tightening torque table.......................................................................................... 00-48
List of abbreviation ............................................................................................................. 00-52
Conversion table ................................................................................................................ 00-57
01 Specification................................................................................................................................. 01-1
Table of contents ........................................................................................................................ 01-2
Specifications............................................................................................................................. 01-3
Specification drawing ........................................................................................................... 01-3
Working range drawings ....................................................................................................... 01-4
Specifications ...................................................................................................................... 01-5
Weight table ........................................................................................................................ 01-8
Table of fuel, coolant, and lubricants ...................................................................................... 01-9
10 Structure and function ................................................................................................................... 10-1
Table of contents ........................................................................................................................ 10-2
Engine and cooling system .......................................................................................................... 10-3
Engine related parts ............................................................................................................. 10-3
KVGT.................................................................................................................................. 10-5
EGR system piping drawing ................................................................................................ 10-12
EGR system circuit diagram ................................................................................................ 10-14
EGR valve......................................................................................................................... 10-16
EGR cooler........................................................................................................................ 10-18
KCCV layout drawing ......................................................................................................... 10-19
KCCV ventilator ................................................................................................................. 10-21
KDPF................................................................................................................................ 10-23
Cooling system .................................................................................................................. 10-27
Power train............................................................................................................................... 10-29
Power train system............................................................................................................. 10-29
Swing circle ....................................................................................................................... 10-31
Swing machinery ............................................................................................................... 10-32
Final drive ......................................................................................................................... 10-34
Undercarriage and frame........................................................................................................... 10-36
Track frame and idler cushion ............................................................................................. 10-36
Hydraulic system ...................................................................................................................... 10-38
Hydraulic equipment layout drawing .................................................................................... 10-38
Valve control...................................................................................................................... 10-40
Hydraulic tank.................................................................................................................... 10-42
CLSS ................................................................................................................................ 10-44
Main pump ........................................................................................................................ 10-49
Control valve ..................................................................................................................... 10-74
Swing motor .................................................................................................................... 10-131
Travel motor .................................................................................................................... 10-143
PPC valve ....................................................................................................................... 10-156
Solenoid valve ................................................................................................................. 10-178
Attachment circuit selector valve (for high pressure circuit) .................................................. 10-181
00-2 PC210LC-10
00 Index and foreword
Index
PC210LC-10 00-3
00 Index and foreword
Index
00-4 PC210LC-10
00 Index and foreword
Index
PC210LC-10 00-5
00 Index and foreword
Index
Failure code [CA1879] KDPF Delta P Sensor High Error ..................................................... 40-252
Failure code [CA1881] KDPF Delta P Sensor Low Error ...................................................... 40-254
Failure code [CA1883] KDPF Delta P Sens In Range Error.................................................. 40-256
Failure code [CA1921] KDPF Soot Load High Error 1.......................................................... 40-259
Failure code [CA1922] KDPF Soot Load High Error 2.......................................................... 40-262
Failure code [CA1942] Crankcase Press Sens In Range Error ............................................. 40-267
Failure code [CA1993] KDPF Delta Pressure Low Error ...................................................... 40-268
Failure code [CA2185] Throt Sensor Sup Volt High Error ..................................................... 40-271
Failure code [CA2186] Throt Sensor Sup Volt Low Error...................................................... 40-273
Failure code [CA2249] Rail Press Very Low Error ............................................................... 40-275
Failure code [CA2271] EGR Valve Pos Sens High Error ...................................................... 40-276
Failure code [CA2272] EGR Valve Pos Sens Low Error ....................................................... 40-278
Failure code [CA2288] Turbo Speed High Error 1................................................................ 40-281
Failure code [CA2311] IMV Solenoid Error ......................................................................... 40-282
Failure code [CA2349] EGR Valve Solenoid Open Error ...................................................... 40-283
Failure code [CA2353] EGR Valve Solenoid Short Error ...................................................... 40-285
Failure code [CA2357] EGR Valve Servo Error ................................................................... 40-287
Failure code [CA2373] Exhaust Manifold Press Sens High error........................................... 40-288
Failure code [CA2374] Exhaust Manifold Press Sens Low error ........................................... 40-290
Failure code [CA2375] EGR Orifice Temp Sens High Error .................................................. 40-292
Failure code [CA2376] EGR Orifice Temp Sens Low Error ................................................... 40-294
Failure code [CA2381] KVGT Pos Sens High Error ............................................................. 40-296
Failure code [CA2382] KVGT Pos Sens Low Error .............................................................. 40-298
Failure code [CA2383] KVGT Solenoid Open Error ............................................................. 40-301
Failure code [CA2386] KVGT Solenoid Short Error ............................................................. 40-303
Failure code [CA2387] KVGT Servo Error .......................................................................... 40-305
Failure code [CA2554] Exh Manifold Press Sens In Range Error .......................................... 40-306
Failure code [CA2555] Grid Htr Relay Volt Low Error ........................................................... 40-307
Failure code [CA2556] Grid Htr Relay Volt High Error .......................................................... 40-309
Failure code [CA2637] KDOC Face Plugging ..................................................................... 40-311
Failure code [CA2639] Manual Stationary Regeneration Request......................................... 40-313
Failure code [CA2961] EGR Orifice Temp High Error 1 ........................................................ 40-316
Failure code [CA2973] Chg Air Press Sensor In Range Error ............................................... 40-317
Failure code [CA3133] KDPF Outlet Press Sens High Error ................................................. 40-318
Failure code [CA3134] KDPF Outlet Press Sens Low Error.................................................. 40-320
Failure code [CA3135] KDPF Outlet Press Sens In Range Error .......................................... 40-322
Failure code [CA3251] KDOC Inlet Temp High Error............................................................ 40-326
Failure code [CA3253] KDOC Temp Error - Non Regeneration............................................. 40-329
Failure code [CA3254] KDOC Outlet Temp High Error 1 ...................................................... 40-332
Failure code [CA3255] KDPF Temp Error - Non Regeneration.............................................. 40-335
Failure code [CA3256] KDPF Outlet Temp High Error 1 ....................................................... 40-338
Failure code [CA3311] KDOC Outlet Temp High Error 2....................................................... 40-341
Failure code [CA3312] KDPF Outlet Temp High Error 2 ....................................................... 40-344
Failure code [CA3313] KDOC Inlet Temp Sensor Low Error ................................................. 40-347
Failure code [CA3314] KDOC Inlet Temp Sens High Error ................................................... 40-350
Failure code [CA3315] KDOC Inlet Temp Sens In Range Error............................................. 40-353
Failure code [CA3316] KDOC Outlet Temp Sens Low Error ................................................. 40-357
Failure code [CA3317] KDOC Outlet Temp Sens High Error................................................. 40-360
Failure code [CA3318] KDOC Outlet Temp Sens In Range Error .......................................... 40-364
Failure code [CA3319] KDPF Outlet Temp Sens High Error ................................................. 40-368
Failure code [CA3321] KDPF Outlet Temp Sens Low Error .................................................. 40-372
Failure code [CA3322] KDPF Outlet Temp Sens In Range Error........................................... 40-375
Failure code [CA3419] Mass Air Flow Sensor Sup Volt High Error ........................................ 40-379
Failure code [CA3421] Mass Air Flow Sensor Sup Volt Low Error ......................................... 40-381
Failure code [CA3741] Rail Press Valve Trip Error............................................................... 40-383
Failure code [D110KB] Battery Relay Output Voltage .......................................................... 40-384
Failure code [D19JKZ] Personal Code Relay Abnormality.................................................... 40-386
Failure code [D811MC] KOMTRAX Error............................................................................ 40-389
Failure code [D862KA] GPS Antenna Open Circuit ............................................................. 40-390
00-6 PC210LC-10
00 Index and foreword
Index
PC210LC-10 00-7
00 Index and foreword
Index
00-8 PC210LC-10
00 Index and foreword
Index
PC210LC-10 00-9
00 Index and foreword
Index
H-28 Upper structure overruns excessively when it stops swinging (both right and
left).................................................................................................................... 40-692
H-29 Upper structure overruns excessively when it stops swinging (either right or left) ........... 40-693
H-30 Shock is large when upper structure stops swinging.................................................... 40-694
H-31 Large unusual noise is heard when upper structure stops swinging .............................. 40-695
H-32 Swing drift on a slope is large while swing holding brake is applied............................... 40-696
H-33 Swing drift on a slope is large while swing holding brake is released............................. 40-697
H-34 Attachment hydraulic circuit cannot be changed while attachment is installed................ 40-698
H-35 Oil flow in attachment circuit cannot be controlled ....................................................... 40-699
Troubleshooting of engine (S-mode)......................................................................................... 40-700
Information mentioned in troubleshooting table (S mode)..................................................... 40-700
S-1 When starting switch is turned to START position, engine does not crank ....................... 40-701
S-2 Engine cranks but no exhaust smoke comes out........................................................... 40-702
S-3 Fuel is being injected but engine does not start (misfiring: engine cranks but does not
start).................................................................................................................. 40-703
S-4 Engine startability is poor ............................................................................................ 40-704
S-5 Engine does not pick up smoothly ............................................................................... 40-706
S-6 Engine stops during operation ..................................................................................... 40-708
S-7 Engine runs rough or is unstable ................................................................................. 40-710
S-8 Engine lacks power .................................................................................................... 40-711
S-9 Exhaust smoke is black (KDPF clogs up early) ............................................................. 40-713
S-10 Engine oil consumption is excessive .......................................................................... 40-715
S-11 Engine oil becomes contaminated early...................................................................... 40-716
S-12 Fuel consumption is excessive .................................................................................. 40-717
S-13 Oil is in coolant (or coolant spurts or coolant level goes down)...................................... 40-718
S-14 Engine oil pressure drops ......................................................................................... 40-719
S-15 Fuel is contaminated in engine oil .............................................................................. 40-720
S-16 Coolant is contaminated in engine oil (Oil becomes cloudy white)................................. 40-721
S-17 Coolant temperature rises too high (overheating) ........................................................ 40-722
S-18 Unusual noise is heard ............................................................................................. 40-723
S-19 Vibration is excessive ............................................................................................... 40-724
S-20 Air cannot be bled from fuel circuit ............................................................................. 40-725
S-21 Active regeneration is executed frequently ................................................................. 40-726
S-22 Active regeneration takes time................................................................................... 40-727
S-23 White smoke is exhausted during active regeneration ................................................. 40-728
50 Disassembly and assembly ........................................................................................................... 50-1
Table of contents ........................................................................................................................ 50-2
General information on disassembly and assembly........................................................................ 50-4
How to read this manual ....................................................................................................... 50-4
Coating materials list ............................................................................................................ 50-6
Special tools list ................................................................................................................. 50-10
Sketches of special tools .................................................................................................... 50-15
Engine and cooling system ........................................................................................................ 50-19
Removal and installation of supply pump assembly............................................................... 50-19
Removal and installation of injector assembly....................................................................... 50-24
Removal and installation of cylinder head assembly.............................................................. 50-33
Removal and installation of radiator assembly ...................................................................... 50-53
Removal and installation of hydraulic oil cooler assembly ...................................................... 50-55
Removal and installation of aftercooler assembly .................................................................. 50-58
Removal and installation of engine and main pump assembly ................................................ 50-60
Removal and installation of engine front oil seal .................................................................... 50-72
Removal and installation of engine rear oil seal..................................................................... 50-76
Removal and installation of fuel cooler assembly .................................................................. 50-79
Removal and installation of fuel tank assembly ..................................................................... 50-80
Removal and installation of engine hood assembly ............................................................... 50-83
Removal and installation of KDPF assembly......................................................................... 50-86
Disassembly and assembly of KDPF ................................................................................... 50-94
Removal and installation of KCCV assembly ...................................................................... 50-102
Removal and installation of air cleaner assembly ................................................................ 50-106
00-10 PC210LC-10
00 Index and foreword
Index
PC210LC-10 00-11
00 Index and foreword
Index
00-12 PC210LC-10
00 Index and foreword
Index
PC210LC-10 00-13
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
(Rev. 2012/01)
• Appropriate servicing and repair are extremely important to ensure safe operation of the machine. The
shop manual describes the effective and safe servicing and repair methods recommended by Komatsu.
Some of these methods require the use of the special tools designed by Komatsu for the specific purpose.
• The symbol mark k is used for such matters that require special cautions during the work. The work
indicated by the caution mark should be performed according to the instructions with special attention to
the cautions. Should hazardous situation occur or be anticipated during such work, be sure to keep safe
first and take every necessary measure.
00-14 PC210LC-10
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
steps when getting on or off the machine. Never • When removing piping, prevent the fuel or oil
jump on or off the machine. When the scaffold is from spilling out. If any fuel or oil drips onto the
not provided, use steps or stepladder to secure floor, wipe it off immediately. Fuel or oil on the
your footing. floor can cause you to slip and can even cause
fires.
Precautions during work • As a general rule, do not use gasoline to wash
• For the machine equipped with the battery parts. Do not use gasoline to clean the electrical
disconnect switch, check that the system parts, in particular.
operating lamp is turned off before starting the • Reinstall the parts removed to their original
work. Then, turn the battery disconnect switch to places. Replace the damaged parts and the
the OFF (Q) position and remove the switch key. parts which must not be used with new ones.
For the machine not equipped with the battery When installing the hoses and wiring harnesses,
disconnect switch, remove the cable from the be careful that they are not damaged by
battery before starting the work. Be sure to contacting with other parts when the machine is
remove the negative end (-) of the battery cable operated.
first. • When connecting the high pressure hoses and
• Release the remaining pressure in the circuits tubes, make sure that they are not twisted. The
completely before the work when the parts in the damaged high pressure hoses and tubes are
circuits of oil, fuel, coolant and air are very dangerous when they are installed. So, be
disconnected or removed. When the cap of the extremely careful when connecting the high
oil filter, drain plug or oil pressure pickup plug is pressure pipings. In addition, check that their
removed, loose them slowly to prevent the oil connections are correct.
from spurting out. • When assembling or installing the parts, be sure
• When removing or installing the checking plug or to tighten the bolts to the specified torque. When
the piping in the fuel circuit, wait 30 seconds or installing the protective parts such as guards, or
longer after the engine is shut down and start the parts which vibrate violently or rotate at high
the work after the remaining pressure is speeds, be sure to check that they are installed
released from the fuel circuit. correctly.
• Immediately after the engine is shut down, the • When aligning two holes, never insert your
coolant and oil in the circuits are hot. Be careful fingers or hand into the holes. Align the holes
not to get scalded by the hot coolant and oil. with care so that your fingers are not caught in
Start the work after checking that the coolant the hole.
and oil are cooled down sufficiently. • When measuring hydraulic pressure, check that
• Start the work after the engine is shut down. Be the measuring tools are correctly installed.
sure to shut down the engine when working on • Pay attention to safety when removing and
or around the rotating parts in particular. When installing the tracks of the track type machines.
checking the machine without shutting down the When removing the track, it separates suddenly.
engine (measuring oil pressure, engine speed, The workers should not stand at either end of
oil or coolant temperature), take extreme care the track.
not to get caught in the rotating parts or the • If the engine is operated for a long time in a
working equipment. closed place which is not ventilated well, you
• The hoist or crane must be used to sling the may suffer from gas poisoning. Accordingly,
components weighing 25 kg or heavier. Check open the windows and doors to ventilate the
the slings (wire rope, nylon sling, chain and place well.
hook) for damage before the work. Use the
slings with ample capacity and install them to Precautions for slinging work and making
the proper places. Operate the hoist or crane signals
slowly to prevent the component from hitting any • Only one appointed worker must make signals
other part. Do not work with any part still raised and co-worker must communicate with each
by the hoist or crane. other frequently. The appointed signaler must
• When removing the part which is under internal make specified signals clearly at the place
pressure or reaction force of the spring, always where the signaler is well seen from the
leave two bolts in diagonal positions. Loosen operator's seat and where the signaler can see
those two bolts gradually and alternately and the working condition easily. The signaler must
release the pressure, then, remove the part. always stand in front of the load and guide the
• When removing the part, be careful not to break operator safely.
or damage the electrical wiring. The damaged 1. Do not stand under the load.
wiring may cause electrical fires. 2. Do not step on the load.
• Check the slings before starting sling work.
PC210LC-10 00-15
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
• Keep putting on the gloves during sling work. • Use the specified eye bolts and fix wire ropes,
(Put on the leather gloves, if available.) chains, etc. to them with shackles, etc.
• Measure the weight of the load by the eye and • Apply wire ropes to the middle portion of the
check its center of gravity. hook.
• Use the proper sling according to the weight of
a Slinging near the tip of the hook may cause
the load and method of slinging. If too thick wire
the rope to slip off the hook during hoisting.
ropes are used to sling a light load, the load may
The hook has the maximum strength at the
slip and fall.
middle part.
• Do not sling a load with one wire rope only. If do
so, the load may rotate or the sling gets loose
and the sling may slip off. Install two or more
wire ropes symmetrically.
00-16 PC210LC-10
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
PC210LC-10 00-17
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
00-18 PC210LC-10
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
PC210LC-10 00-19
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
00-20 PC210LC-10
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
(Rev. 2012/01)
• Some attachments and optional parts described in this shop manual may not be arranged for certain
areas. Contact your Komatsu distributor if one or some of them are required.
• Materials and specifications are subject to change without notice.
• The shop manuals are available for "Machine part" and "Engine part". For the engine, see the shop
manual for the same model of the engine as the one which is mounted on the machine.
Symbol
Important safety and quality portions are marked with the following symbols so that the shop manual is used
practically.
Symbol Item Remarks
Safety The special safety precautions required for performing work are
k described.
The special technical precautions or other precautions for preserving
a Caution standards required when performing work are described
The weight of part or component and the cautions required when
4 Weight selecting hoisting wire or when working posture is important are
described.
Tightening The tightening torques that require special attention during assembly
3 torque work are described.
PC210LC-10 00-21
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
6 Drain The places from which oil is drained and quantity of the oil are indicated.
Unit
• In this shop manual, the units are indicated with International System of units (SI).
• For reference, Gravitational System of units which is used to be used is indicated in parentheses of { }.
00-22 PC210LC-10
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
(Rev. 2012/01)
• The chapter of maintenance standard shows judgement criteria to determine the products to be replaced
or to be reused. The judgement criteria are described by using the following terms.
PC210LC-10 00-23
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
Allowable clearance
• Parts can be used until the clearance between
them is increased to a certain limit. The limit at
which those parts cannot be used is called the
"allowable clearance".
• If the clearance between the parts exceeds the
allowable clearance, they must be replaced or
repaired.
Allowable interference
• The allowable maximum interference between
the hole of a part and the shaft of another part to
be assembled is called the "allowable
interference".
• The allowable interference shows the repair limit
of the part of smaller tolerance.
• The parts whose interferences are out of the
allowable interference must be replaced or
repaired.
00-24 PC210LC-10
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
(Rev. 2012/01)
• The common rail fuel injection system (CRI)
consists of more precise parts than the parts
used in the conventional fuel injection pump and
nozzle. If foreign material enters this system, it
may cause a failure. Use special care to prevent
entry of the foreign material when servicing the
fuel system.
PC210LC-10 00-25
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
(Rev.2012/01)
• The Komatsu Variable Geometry Turbocharger
(KVGT) consists of more precise parts (variable
mechanism) than the parts used in the
conventional turbocharger. If foreign material
enters this system, it may cause a failure. Use
special care to prevent entry of the foreign
material when servicing the air intake system.
00-26 PC210LC-10
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
(Rev. 2012/01)
• With the increase in pressure and precision of the hydraulic components, the most common cause of a
failure is dirt (foreign material) in the hydraulic circuit. Therefore, the special care must be taken when
adding hydraulic oil,or when disassembling or assembling the hydraulic components.
Sealing openings
• Plug the pipes and the openings of the
components which are removed with the caps,
tapes, vinyl bags, etc. to prevent foreign material
from entering. Never leave the openings of the
pipes and hoses without being covered or Replacing hydraulic oil while its temperature is
high
plugged with cloth as foreign material may enter
• When the hydraulic oil is warm, it flows easily. In
them or environment may be polluted by the oil
addition, sludge can also be drained from the
leaked. Do not discard the waste oil somewhere
circuit together with the oil. So, it is better to
or other. Hand it over to your customer for
change the hydraulic oil while it is warm. When
disposal, or dispose it by yourself.
changing the hydraulic oil, the old oil must be
drained as much as possible. (Drain the oil not
only from the hydraulic tank, but also from the
filter housing and the drain plug hole in the
circuit.) If the old oil is left in the system, the
contaminant and sludge in the oil mix with the
new oil and shorten the life of the new hydraulic
oil.
PC210LC-10 00-27
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
Flushing operations
• After disassembling the equipment or when
changing the hydraulic oil with new one, flush
the system to remove the contaminant and
sludge left in the hydraulic circuit as well as the
oil which includes them. Normally, flushing is
performed twice. Primary flushing is performed
by use of the flushing oil and the secondary
flushing is performed by use of the specified
hydraulic oil.
Cleaning operations
• After repairing the hydraulic equipment (pump,
control valve, etc.) or when the machine is in
operation, perform oil cleaning to remove the
sludge or contaminant in the hydraulic oil circuit.
The oil cleaning equipment can remove the ultra
fine (approximately 3 μm) particles that the filter
built in the hydraulic equipment can not remove.
So, it is an extremely effective device.
00-28 PC210LC-10
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
k Loosen the oil filler cap of the hydraulic tank slowly to release the remaining pressure in the
hydraulic tank.
k Even if the remaining pressure is released from the hydraulic tank, some hydraulic oil flows out
when the hose is disconnected. Accordingly, prepare an oil container.
Type 1 (ALL-C930-925-P-01-A)
Disconnection Connection
1. Hold adapter (1) and push hose joint (2) into 1. Hold hose adapter (1) or hose (5) and insert it in
mating adapter (3). (Fig. 1) mating adapter (3) aligning them with each other.
(Fig. 4)
a It can be pushed in by approximately 3.5mm.
a Do not hold rubber cap part (4).
a Do not hold rubber cap portion (4).
2. After inserting the hose fitting in the adapter on
2. While pushing hose joint (2) into adapter (3),
the other side perfectly, pull it back to check the
push rubber cap (4) against adapter (3) until
connecting condition. (Fig. 4)
"click" is heard. (Fig. 2)
3. Hold hose adapter (1) or hose (5) and pull it out. a When the hose fitting is pulled back, the
(Fig. 3) rubber cap will move toward the hose,
however, it is not a problem.
a Since some hydraulic oil flows out, prepare
an oil container.
PC210LC-10 00-29
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
Type 2 (ALL-C930-925-P-02-A)
Disconnection Connection
1. While holding the fitting, push body (7) in straight 1. While holding the fitting, push body (7) in straight
until sliding prevention ring (6) hits contact until sliding prevention ring (6) hits contact
surface (a) at the hexagonal part on the male surface (a) at the hexagonal part on the male
side. (Fig. 6) side to connect it. (Fig. 9)
2. While keeping the condition of Step 1, turn lever
(8) to the right (clockwise). (Fig. 7)
3. While keeping the conditions of Steps 1 and 2,
pull out whole body (7) to disconnect it. (Fig. 8)
00-30 PC210LC-10
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
Type 3 (ALL-C930-925-P-03-A)
Disconnection Connection
1. While holding the fitting, push body (9) in straight 1. While holding the fitting, push body (9) in straight
until sliding prevention ring (8) hits contact until sliding prevention ring (8) hits contact
surface (b) at the hexagonal portion on the male surface (a) at the hexagonal portion on the male
side. (Fig. 10) side to connect them. (Fig. 13)
2. While keeping the condition of Step 1, push
cover (10) straight until it hits contact surface (b)
of the hexagonal portion on the male side. (Fig.
11)
3. While keeping the conditions of Steps 1 and 2,
pull out whole body (9) to disconnect it. (Fig. 12)
PC210LC-10 00-31
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
(Rev. 2012/01)
• To maintain the performance of the machine over a long period, and to prevent failures or troubles before
they occur, correct "operation", "maintenance and inspection" "troubleshooting", and "repairs" must be
performed. This section deals particularly with correct repair procedures for mechatronics components
and is aimed at improving the quality of repairs. For this purpose, it describes the working procedures in
"Handling of electrical equipment".
00-32 PC210LC-10
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
PC210LC-10 00-33
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
Connecting connectors
1. Check the connector visually.
00-34 PC210LC-10
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
• If the connector clamp is removed, be sure to • If there is any oil or dirt on the wiring harness,
return it to its original position. And check wipe it off with a dry cloth. Avoid washing by
that it is securely installed. using steam. If the wire harness must be
washed in water, do not apply high pressure
water or steam directly to the wiring harness. If
water gets directly on the connector, do as
follows.
1. Disconnect the connector and wipe off the water
with a dry cloth.
a If the connector is to be blown with dry
compressed air, there is a risk that oil in the
air may cause defective contact of the
conditioner, remove oil and water in the air
before starting air blow.
PC210LC-10 00-35
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
Connection
1. Insert the connector securely until a click is
heard. Connection
1. Insert the connector securely until a click is
Slide, lock type (Type 2) (FRAMATOME-24) heard.
Disconnection
1. Slide down lock (red) (L1). Pull lock type (PACKARD-2)
Disconnection
1. Disconnect the connector (2) by pulling lock (B)
(on the wiring harness side) of connector (2)
outward.
00-36 PC210LC-10
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
Connection Connection
1. Insert the connector securely until a click is 1. Insert the connector securely until a click is
heard. heard.
Push lock type (1) (BOSCH-3) Push lock type (2) (SUMITOMO-4)
Disconnection Disconnection
1. While pressing lock (C), pull out connector (3) in 1. While pressing lock (C), pull out connector (4) in
the direction of the arrow. the direction of the arrow.
• 114 series Connection
1. Insert the connector securely until a click is
heard.
• 107 series
PC210LC-10 00-37
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
Connection
1. Insert the connector to the end while aligning its
Example) Speed sensor of supply pump: G grove to the other.
(SUMITOMO-3) 2. Turn housing (H1) in the direction of the arrow
until it "clicks".
a Pull the connector straight up.
00-38 PC210LC-10
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
PC210LC-10 00-39
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
00-40 PC210LC-10
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
Dimension
(Table 2)
Nominal No. 0.5f (0.5) 0.75f (0.85) 1.25f (1.25) 2f 2 3f 3 5
Number of
strands/ 20/ 30/ 11/ 50/ 16/ 37/ 26/ 58/ 41/ 65/
7/0.32
Diameter of 0.18 0.18 0.32 0.18 0.32 0.26 0.32 0.26 0.32 0.32
strand
Conductor Cross-
sectional 0.51 0.56 0.76 0.88 1.27 1.29 1.96 2.09 3.08 3.30 5.23
area (mm2)
d (approx.) 1.0 1.2 1.5 1.9 1.9 2.3 2.4 3.0
AVS Standard 2.0 2.2 2.5 2.9 2.9 3.5 3.6 —
Coating D
AV Standard — — — — — — — 4.6
AEX Standard 2.0 2.2 2.7 3.0 3.1 — 3.8 4.6
AV Standard 5.5 7.0 8.2 10.8 11.4 13.0 13.6 16.0 17.6
AEX Standard 5.3 7.0 8.2 10.8 11.4 13.0 13.6 16.0 17.6
PC210LC-10 00-41
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
a Remarks: In a color code consisting of two colors, the first color is the color of the background and the
second color is the color of the marking.
Examples)
GW means that the background is "Green" and marking is "White".
00-42 PC210LC-10
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
(Rev. 2012/01)
• When performing "removal or installation" and "disassembly or assembly" of the components, observe the
following general cautions.
PC210LC-10 00-43
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
If the part is not under hydraulic pressure, the following corks can be used.
Dimensions
Nominal No. Part No.
D d L
06 07049-00608 6 5 8
08 07049-00811 8 6.5 11
10 07049-01012 10 8.5 12
12 07049-01215 12 10 15
14 07049-01418 14 11.5 18
16 07049-01620 16 13.5 20
18 07049-01822 18 15 22
20 07049-02025 20 17 25
22 07049-02228 22 18.5 28
24 07049-02430 24 20 30
27 07049-02734 27 22.5 34
00-44 PC210LC-10
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
a After the completion of repair and when operating the machine which is stored long term, perform the air
bleeding with the same procedure as the one described above.
PC210LC-10 00-45
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
00-46 PC210LC-10
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
PC210LC-10 00-47
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
(Rev. 2012/01)
a Values with ( ) in the "Width across flats" column are for (*) marked bolt (flange bolt) shown in Fig. A.
2. The following table applies to the bolts in Fig. B.
Thread Width Tightening torque
diameter across flats
(mm) (mm) (Nm) (kgm)
6 10 5.9 to 9.8 0.6 to 1.0
8 12 13.7 to 23.5 1.4 to 2.4
10 14 34.3 to 46.1 3.5 to 4.7
12 17 74.5 to 90.2 7.6 to 9.2
Fig. A Fig. B
a Values with parentheses are applied to the width across flats of (*) marked bolts (flanged bolts)
00-48 PC210LC-10
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
PC210LC-10 00-49
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
Table of tightening torque for hose (taper seal type and face seal type)
a Unless otherwise specified, tighten the hose fittings (taper seal type and face seal type) to the torque
shown in the following table.
a The table is applied to the threads coated with engine oil (wet threads)
Tightening torque (Nm {kgm}) Taper seal Face seal
Width
Nominal across Nominal No. - Thread root
No. of Thread size threads per
flats Range Target diameter
hose (mm) (mm) inch, type of (reference)
thread
34 to 54 {3.5 to 5.5} 44 {4.5} — 9/16 -18UN 14.3
02 19
34 to 63 {3.5 to 6.5} 44 {4.5} 14 — —
22 54 to 93 {5.5 to 9.5} 74 {7.5} — 11/16 -16UN 17.5
03
24 59 to 98 {6.0 to 10.0} 78 {8.0} 18 — —
04 27 84 to 132 {8.5 to 13.5} 103 {10.5} 22 13/16 -16UN 20.6
05 32 128 to 186 {13.0 to 19.0} 157 {16.0} 24 1 -14UNS 25.4
06 36 177 to 245 {18.0 to 25.0} 216 {22.0} 30 1-3/16 -12UN 30.2
(10) 41 177 to 245 {18.0 to 25.0} 216 {22.0} 33 — —
(12) 46 197 to 294 {20.0 to 30.0} 245 {25.0} 36 — —
(14) 55 246 to 343 {25.0 to 35.0} 294 {30.0} 42 — —
00-50 PC210LC-10
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
Tightening torque table for bolts and nuts on 102,107 and 114 series engines
a Unless otherwise specified, tighten the metric threads bolts and nuts used on the 102, 107 and 114 series
engines to the torques shown in the following table.
Thread diameter Tightening torque
(mm) (Nm) (kgm)
6 10 ± 2 1.02 ± 0.20
8 24 ± 4 2.45 ± 0.41
10 43 ± 6 4.38 ± 0.61
12 77 ± 12 7.85 ± 1.22
14 — —
Tightening torque table for I-joints on 102,107 and 114 series engines
a Unless otherwise specified, tighten the metric I-joints used on the 102, 107 and 114 series engines to the
torque shown in the following table.
Thread diameter Tightening torque
(mm) (Nm) (kgm)
6 8±2 0.81 ± 0.20
8 10 ± 2 1.02 ± 0.20
10 12 ± 2 1.22 ± 0.20
12 24 ± 4 2.45 ± 0.41
14 36 ± 5 3.67 ± 0.51
Tightening torque table for tapered screws on 102,107 and 114 series engines
a Unless otherwise specified, tighten the tapered inch thread screws used on the 102, 107 and 114 series
engines to the torques shown in the following table.
Material In cast iron or steel In aluminum
Tightening torque Tightening torque
Thread diameter (inch)
(Nm) (kgm) (Nm) (kgm)
1/16 15 ± 2 1.53 ± 0.20 5±1 0.51 ± 0.10
1/8 20 ± 2 2.04 ± 0.20 15 ± 2 1.53 ± 0.20
1/4 25 ± 3 2.55 ± 0.31 20 ± 2 2.04 ± 0.20
3/8 35 ± 4 3.57 ± 0.41 25 ± 3 2.55 ± 0.31
1/2 55 ± 6 5.61 ± 0.61 35 ± 4 3.57 ± 0.41
3/4 75 ± 8 7.65 ± 0.82 45 ± 5 4.59 ± 0.51
PC210LC-10 00-51
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
00-52 PC210LC-10
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
PC210LC-10 00-53
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
00-54 PC210LC-10
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
PC210LC-10 00-55
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
00-56 PC210LC-10
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
PC210LC-10 00-57
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
Millimeters to inches
1 mm = 0.03937 in
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
0 0 0.039 0.079 0.118 0.157 0.197 0.236 0.276 0.315 0.354
10 0.394 0.433 0.472 0.512 0.551 0.591 0.630 0.669 0.709 0.748
20 0.787 0.827 0.866 0.906 0.945 0.984 1.024 1.063 1.102 1.142
30 1.181 1.220 1.260 1.299 1.339 1.378 1.417 1.457 1.496 1.536
40 1.575 1.614 1.654 1.693 1.732 1.772 1.811 1.850 1.890 1.929
50 1.969 2.008 2.047 2.087 2.126 2.165 2.205 2.244 2.283 2.323
60 2.362 2.402 2.441 2.480 2.520 2.559 2.598 2.638 2.677 2.717
70 2.756 2.795 2.835 2.847 2.913 2.953 2.992 3.032 3.071 3.110
80 3.150 3.189 3.228 3.268 3.307 3.346 3.386 3.425 3.465 3.504
90 3.543 3.583 3.622 3.661 3.701 3.740 3.780 3.819 3.858 3.898
Kilograms to pounds
1 kg = 2.2046 lb
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
0 0 2.20 4.41 6.61 8.82 11.02 13.23 15.43 17.64 19.84
10 22.05 24.25 26.46 28.66 30.86 33.07 35.27 37.48 39.68 41.89
20 44.09 46.30 48.50 50.71 51.91 55.12 57.32 59.53 61.73 63.93
30 66.14 68.34 70.55 72.75 74.96 77.16 79.37 81.57 83.78 85.98
40 88.18 90.39 92.59 94.80 97.00 99.21 101.41 103.62 105.82 108.03
50 110.23 112.44 114.64 116.85 119.05 121.25 123.46 125.66 127.87 130.07
60 132.28 134.48 136.69 138.89 141.10 143.30 145.51 147.71 149.91 152.12
70 154.32 156.53 158.73 160.94 163.14 165.35 167.55 169.76 171.96 174.17
80 176.37 178.57 180.78 182.98 185.19 187.39 189.60 191.80 194.01 196.21
90 198.42 200.62 202.83 205.03 207.24 209.44 211.64 213.85 216.05 218.26
l to U.S. Gallons
1 l= 0.2642 U.S.Gal
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
0 0 0.264 0.528 0.793 1.057 1.321 1.585 1.849 2.113 2.378
10 2.642 2.906 3.170 3.434 3.698 3.963 4.227 4.491 4.755 5.019
20 5.283 5.548 5.812 6.076 6.340 6.604 6.869 7.133 7.397 7.661
30 7.925 8.189 8.454 8.718 8.982 9.246 9.510 9.774 10.039 10.303
40 10.567 10.831 11.095 11.359 11.624 11.888 12.152 12.416 12.680 12.944
50 13.209 13.473 13.737 14.001 14.265 14.529 14.795 15.058 15.322 15.586
60 15.850 16.115 16.379 16.643 16.907 17.171 17.435 17.700 17.964 18.228
70 18.492 18.756 19.020 19.285 19.549 19.813 20.077 20.341 20.605 20.870
80 21.134 21.398 21.662 21.926 22.190 22.455 22.719 22.983 23.247 23.511
90 23.775 24.040 24.304 24.568 24.832 25.096 25.361 25.625 25.889 26.153
00-58 PC210LC-10
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
l to U.K. Gallons
1 l= 0.21997 U.S.Gal
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
0 0 0.220 0.440 0.660 0.880 1.100 1.320 1.540 1.760 1.980
10 2.200 2.420 2.640 2.860 3.080 3.300 3.520 3.740 3.950 4.179
20 4.399 4.619 4.839 5.059 5.279 5.499 5.719 5.939 6.159 6.379
30 6.599 6.819 7.039 7.259 7.479 7.699 7.919 8.139 8.359 8.579
40 8.799 9.019 9.239 9.459 9.679 9.899 10.119 10.339 10.559 10.778
50 10.998 11.281 11.438 11.658 11.878 12.098 12.318 12.528 12.758 12.978
60 13.198 13.418 13.638 13.858 14.078 14.298 14.518 14.738 14.958 15.178
70 15.398 15.618 15.838 16.058 16.278 16.498 16.718 16.938 17.158 17.378
80 17.598 17.818 18.037 18.257 18.477 18.697 18.917 19.137 19.357 19.577
90 19.797 20.017 20.237 20.457 20.677 20.897 21.117 21.337 21.557 21.777
kgm to ft.lb
1 kgm = 7.233 ft.lb
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
0 0 7.2 14.5 21.7 28.9 36.2 43.4 50.6 57.9 65.1
10 72.3 79.6 86.8 94.0 101.3 108.5 115.7 123.0 130.2 137.4
20 144.7 151.9 159.1 166.4 173.6 180.8 188.1 195.3 202.5 209.8
30 217.0 224.2 231.5 238.7 245.9 253.2 260.4 267.6 274.9 282.1
40 289.3 296.6 303.8 311.0 318.3 325.5 332.7 340.0 347.2 354.4
50 361.7 368.9 376.1 383.4 390.6 397.8 405.1 412.3 419.5 426.8
60 434.0 441.2 448.5 455.7 462.9 470.2 477.4 484.6 491.8 499.1
70 506.3 513.5 520.8 528.0 535.2 542.5 549.7 556.9 564.2 571.4
80 578.6 585.9 593.1 600.3 607.6 614.8 622.0 629.3 636.5 643.7
90 651.0 658.2 665.4 672.7 679.9 687.1 694.4 701.6 708.8 716.1
100 723.3 730.5 737.8 745.0 752.2 759.5 766.7 773.9 781.2 788.4
110 795.6 802.9 810.1 817.3 824.6 831.8 839.0 846.3 853.5 860.7
120 868.0 875.2 882.4 889.7 896.9 904.1 911.4 918.6 925.8 933.1
130 940.3 947.5 954.8 962.0 969.2 976.5 983.7 990.9 998.2 1005.4
140 1012.6 1019.9 1027.1 1034.3 1041.5 1048.8 1056.0 1063.2 1070.5 1077.7
150 1084.9 1092.2 1099.4 1106.6 1113.9 1121.1 1128.3 1135.6 1142.8 1150.0
160 1157.3 1164.5 1171.7 1179.0 1186.2 1193.4 1200.7 1207.9 1215.1 1222.4
170 1129.6 1236.8 1244.1 1251.3 1258.5 1265.8 1273.0 1280.1 1287.5 1294.7
180 1301.9 1309.2 1316.4 1323.6 1330.9 1338.1 1345.3 1352.6 1359.8 1367.0
190 1374.3 1381.5 1388.7 1396.0 1403.2 1410.4 1417.7 1424.9 1432.1 1439.4
PC210LC-10 00-59
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
kg/cm2 to lb/in2
1 kg/cm2 = 14.2233 lb/in2
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
0 0 14.2 28.4 42.7 56.9 71.1 85.3 99.6 113.8 128.0
10 142.2 156.5 170.7 184.9 199.1 213.4 227.6 241.8 256.0 270.2
20 284.5 298.7 312.9 327.1 341.4 355.6 369.8 384.0 398.3 412.5
30 426.7 440.9 455.1 469.4 483.6 497.8 512.0 526.3 540.5 554.7
40 568.9 583.2 597.4 611.6 625.8 640.1 654.3 668.5 682.7 696.9
50 711.2 725.4 739.6 753.8 768.1 782.3 796.5 810.7 825.0 839.2
60 853.4 867.6 881.8 896.1 910.3 924.5 938.7 953.0 967.2 981.4
70 995.6 1,010 1,024 1,038 1,053 1,067 1,081 1,095 1,109 1,124
80 1,138 1,152 1,166 1,181 1,195 1,209 1,223 1,237 1,252 1,266
90 1,280 1,294 1,309 1,323 1,337 1,351 1,365 1,380 1,394 1,408
100 1,422 1,437 1,451 1,465 1,479 1,493 1,508 1,522 1,536 1,550
110 1,565 1,579 1,593 1,607 1,621 1,636 1,650 1,664 1,678 1,693
120 1,707 1,721 1,735 1,749 1,764 1,778 1,792 1,806 1,821 1,835
130 1,849 1,863 1,877 1,892 1,906 1,920 1,934 1,949 1,963 1,977
140 1,991 2,005 2,020 2,034 2,048 2,062 2,077 2,091 2,105 2,119
150 2,134 2,148 2,162 2,176 2,190 2,205 2,219 2,233 2,247 2,262
160 2,276 2,290 2,304 2,318 2,333 2,347 2,361 2,375 2,389 2,404
170 2,418 2,432 2,446 2,460 2,475 2,489 2,503 2,518 2,532 2,546
180 2,560 2,574 2,589 2,603 2,617 2,631 2,646 2,660 2,674 2,688
190 2,702 2,717 2,731 2,745 2,759 2,773 2,788 2,802 2,816 2,830
200 2,845 2,859 2,873 2,887 2,901 2,916 2,930 2,944 2,958 2,973
210 2,987 3,001 3,015 3,030 3,044 3,058 3,072 3,086 3,101 3,115
220 3,129 3,143 3,158 3,172 3,186 3,200 3,214 3,229 3,243 3,257
230 3,271 3,286 3,300 3,314 3,328 3,343 3,357 3,371 3,385 3,399
240 3,414 3,428 3,442 3,456 3,470 3,485 3,499 3,513 3,527 3,542
00-60 PC210LC-10
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
Temperature
Conversion of Fahrenheit to Celsius
• A simple way to convert a Fahrenheit temperature reading into a Celsius temperature reading or vice
versa is to see the number in the center column of the following table. The figures on the following table
show the temperatures in both Fahrenheit and Celsius.
• When converting from Fahrenheit to Celsius degrees, consider the center column to be a table of
Fahrenheit temperatures and read the corresponding Celsius temperature in the column at the left.
• When converting from Celsius to Fahrenheit degrees, consider the center column to be a table of Celsius
values, and read the corresponding Fahrenheit temperature on the right.
1°C = 33.8°F
°C °F °C °F °C °F °C °F
-40.4 -40 -40.0 -11.7 11 51.8 7.8 46 114.8 27.2 81 177.8
-37.2 -35 -31.0 -11.1 12 53.6 8.3 47 116.6 27.8 82 179.6
-34.4 -30 -22.0 -10.6 13 55.4 8.9 48 118.4 28.3 83 181.4
-31.7 -25 -13.0 -10.0 14 57.2 9.4 49 120.2 28.9 84 183.2
-28.9 -20 -4.0 -9.4 15 59.0 10.0 50 122.0 29.4 85 185.0
-28.3 -19 -2.2 -8.9 16 60.8 10.6 51 123.8 30.0 86 186.8
-27.8 -18 -0.4 -8.3 17 62.6 11.1 52 125.6 30.6 87 188.6
-27.2 -17 1.4 -7.8 18 64.4 11.7 53 127.4 31.1 88 190.4
-26.7 -16 3.2 -7.2 19 66.2 12.2 54 129.2 31.7 89 192.2
-26.1 -15 5.0 -6.7 20 68.0 12.8 55 131.0 32.2 90 194.0
-25.6 -14 6.8 -6.1 21 69.8 13.3 56 132.8 32.8 91 195.8
-25.0 -13 8.6 -5.6 22 71.6 13.9 57 134.6 33.3 92 197.6
-24.4 -12 10.4 -5.0 23 73.4 14.4 58 136.4 33.9 93 199.4
-23.9 -11 12.2 -4.4 24 75.2 15.0 59 138.2 34.4 94 201.2
-23.3 -10 14.0 -3.9 25 77.0 15.6 60 140.0 35.0 95 203.0
-22.8 -9 15.8 -3.3 26 78.8 16.1 61 141.8 35.6 96 204.8
-22.2 -8 17.6 -2.8 27 80.6 16.7 62 143.6 36.1 97 206.6
-21.7 -7 19.4 -2.2 28 82.4 17.2 63 145.4 36.7 98 208.4
-21.1 -6 21.2 -1.7 29 84.2 17.8 64 147.2 37.2 99 210.2
-20.6 -5 23.0 -1.1 30 86.0 18.3 65 149.0 37.8 100 212.0
-20.0 -4 24.8 -0.6 31 87.8 18.9 66 150.8 40.6 105 221.0
-19.4 -3 26.6 0 32 89.6 19.4 67 152.6 43.3 110 230.0
-18.9 -2 28.4 0.6 33 91.4 20.0 68 154.4 46.1 115 239.0
-18.3 -1 30.2 1.1 34 93.2 20.6 69 156.2 48.9 120 248.0
-17.8 0 32.0 1.7 35 95.0 21.1 70 158.0 51.7 125 257.0
-17.2 1 33.8 2.2 36 96.8 21.7 71 159.8 54.4 130 266.0
-16.7 2 35.6 2.8 37 98.6 22.2 72 161.6 57.2 135 275.0
-16.1 3 37.4 3.3 38 100.4 22.8 73 163.4 60.0 140 284.0
-15.6 4 39.2 3.9 39 102.2 23.3 74 165.2 62.7 145 293.0
-15.0 5 41.0 4.4 40 104.0 23.9 75 167.0 65.6 150 302.0
-14.4 6 42.8 5.0 41 105.8 24.4 76 168.8 68.3 155 311.0
-13.9 7 44.6 5.6 42 107.6 25.0 77 170.6 71.1 160 320.0
-13.3 8 46.4 6.1 43 109.4 25.6 78 172.4 73.9 165 329.0
-12.8 9 48.2 6.7 44 111.2 26.1 79 174.2 76.7 170 338.0
-12.2 10 50.0 7.2 45 113.0 26.7 80 176.0 79.4 175 347.0
PC210LC-10 00-61
00 Index and foreword
Foreword, safety and general information
00-62 PC210LC-10
SHOP MANUAL
HYDRAULIC EXCAVATOR
PC210LC-10
Model Serial Number
01 Specification
2 01 Specification
PC210LC-10 01-1
01 Specification
Table of contents
01-2 PC210LC-10
01 Specification
Specification drawing
Specifications (ALL-2111-001-A-00-A)
PC210LC-10 (PC200_10-2110-931-A-00-A)
a The engine flywheel horsepower is indicated in the net value and gross value. Gross value is the flywheel
horsepower measured of the bear engine. While, net value is the value measured of the engine under the
same condition essentially as the condition that it is installed on the machine.
PC210LC-10 01-3
01 Specification
Working range drawings
PC210LC-10 (PC200_10-2110-931-A-01-A)
01-4 PC210LC-10
01 Specification
Specifications
Specifications (ALL-2111-001-A-00-A)
PC210LC-10 (PC200_10-2111-931-A-00-A)
PC210LC-10 01-5
01 Specification
Specifications
Engine
Machine model PC210LC-10
Serial number 450001 and up
Model SAA6D107E–2
4-cycle, water-cooled, in-line vertical,
Type direct injection type with turbocharger
and air-cooled aftercooler
No. of cylinders - bore x stroke mm 6-107x124
Piston displacement l {cc} 6.69 {6,690}
Flywheel horsepower
• Net [ISO 9249/SAE J1349] 118 {158}/2,000 {2,000}
kW {HP}/min-1 {rpm}
• Gross [SAE J1995] 123 {165}/2,000 {2,000}
Performance
01-6 PC210LC-10
01 Specification
Specifications
Hydraulic system
Machine model PC210LC-10
Serial number 450001 and up
Variable displacement piston type (HPV
Hydraulic pump
Type x number
125 + 125) x 2
Delivery l/min 245 x 2
PC210LC-10 01-7
01 Specification
Weight table
PC210LC-10 (PC200_10-2120-931-A-00-A)
k This weight table is prepared for your reference when handling or transporting the components.
Unit:kg
Machine model PC210LC-10
Serial number 450001 and up
Engine assembly 886
• Engine 690
• Damper 6
• Main pump 190
Radiator and oil cooler assembly 150
Hydraulic tank and filter assembly (excluding hydraulic oil) 120
Fuel tank assembly (excluding fuel) 155
Revolving frame 2,115
Operator's cab (including head guard and front half guard) 430
Operator seat 35
Counterweight 3,600
Swing machinery 169
Control valve 235
Swing motor 51.5
Travel motor 93 × 2
Center swivel joint 36
Track frame assembly (excluding piping) 4,957
2,662
• Track frame
273
• Swing circle
• Idler 101 × 2
• Idler cushion 127 × 2
• Carrier roller 13 × 4
• Track roller
• Final drive (including travel motor and sprocket) 36 × 18
355 × 2
Track shoe assembly
• Triple grouser shoe (700 mm {31.50 in}) 1,530 × 2
Boom assembly 1,506
Arm assembly 795
Bucket assembly 759
Boom cylinder assembly 204 × 2
Arm cylinder assembly 224
Bucket cylinder assembly 133
Bucket link (large) assembly 83
Bucket link (small) assembly 22 × 2
Boom foot pin 42
Boom cylinder bottom pin 8×2
Boom cylinder head pin 28
Arm cylinder bottom pin 10
Arm cylinder head pin 12
Boom and arm connecting pin 26
Bucket cylinder bottom pin 8
Bucket pin 20 × 2
Bucket link pin 13 × 2
01-8 PC210LC-10
01 Specification
Table of fuel, coolant, and lubricants
a For details of the notes (Note 1, Note 2...) in the table, see Operation and Maintenance Manual.
Unit: l
PC210LC-10
Reservoir
Specified Refill
Engine oil pan 25.4 23.1
Swing machinery case 7.1 6.5
Final drive case (right and left respectively) 5.4 5.0
Damper case 0.65 0.65
Hydraulic system 236 132
Cooling system 30.7 30.7
Fuel tank 400 —
PC210LC-10 01-9
01 Specification
Table of fuel, coolant, and lubricants
01-10 PC210LC-10
SHOP MANUAL
HYDRAULIC EXCAVATOR
PC210LC-10
Model Serial Number
PC210LC-10 10-1
10 Structure and function
Table of contents
10-2 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Engine related parts
PC210LC-10 10-3
10 Structure and function
Engine related parts
10-4 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
KVGT
KVGT (WA380-AA10-041-K-00-A)
KVGT: Abbreviation for KOMATSU Variable Geometry Turbocharger and it is variable displacement
turbocharger.
a The shape is subject to machine models.
PC210LC-10 10-5
10 Structure and function
KVGT
1. Blower housing
2. KVGT speed sensor
3. Hydraulic actuator
4. Turbine housing
5. Plate
6. Vane
7. Nozzle ring
8. Push rod
9. Shaft
10. Blower impeller
11. Turbine impeller
12. Piston
A: Air intake inlet
B: Air intake outlet
C: Exhaust inlet
D: Exhaust outlet
Operation (ENG107-AA10-044-K-00-A)
1. Air cleaner
2. KVGT
3. KDPF
4. EGR cooler
5. EGR valve
C: Blower impeller
T: Turbine impeller
• The new exhaust gas regulation not only requires to control emissions at high engine speeds but also at
low engine speeds. To meet the requirements, the EGR ratio is increased. (EGR ratio = volume of EGR/
intake air flow)
• To obtain a high EGR ratio especially at low engine speeds, the turbine inlet pressure (P3) must be higher
than the boost pressure (P2). A variable displacement turbocharger (KVGT), in which the exhaust gas
pressure hitting the turbine impeller (T) can be adjusted, is introduced.
• The charged pressure rises faster, also contributing to suppress the generation of PM (particles) due to
insufficient oxygen at low engine speeds.
• The turbine impeller (T) drives the blower impeller (C) via a shaft. In turn the blower impeller (C) sends a
large amount of air to the cylinders for combustion. When the air flow from KVGT (2) increases, more fuel
can be injected, and the engine output increases.
• Since the density of the air and the amount of oxygen increases when the air is cooled, more fuel can be
injected, and the engine output increases.
10-6 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
KVGT
a Adequate amount of clean high quality oil is required to maintain the KVGT performance. Be sure to use
Komatsu genuine high quality oil. Follow the procedures in the Operation and Maintenance Manual when
replacing oil or oil filter.
• Exhaust gas enters from (C) of turbine housing (4), flows through section (P) and out from (D). Section (P)
is surrounded by plate (5) and nozzle ring (7) fixed on turbine housing (4), and vane (6).
• The passage area changes when push rod (8) slides right or left.
• The hydraulic actuator (3) moves piston (12) in the actuator up/down by using the oil pressure controlled
at the EPC valve installed to the EGR valve, and also controls the right/left slide of push rod (8).
• Exhaust gas hits vane (6), and then turbine impeller (11) drives blower impeller (10) via shaft (9). This
works as a compressor and the air entered from (A) is compressed and sent out from (B).
• When the exhaust gas pressure at the inlet (C) of turbine housing (4) is low (at low engine speeds), push
rod (8) slides to the right to narrow section (P).
• Then the exhaust gas pressure to turbine impeller (11) increases, the turbocharger speed also increases,
and more air (oxygen) is inhaled.
• The turbocharger speed is sensed by KVGT speed sensor (2).
PC210LC-10 10-7
10 Structure and function
KVGT
a Nozzle ring (7), vane (6), and push rod (8) are integrated and slide together but do not rotate.
a KVGT position sensor is installed to hydraulic actuator (3). The KVGT position sensor is calibrated
together with the variable mechanism in the KVGT, and values are stored in the memory inside the KVGT
position sensor. If any of the hydraulic actuator (3), KVGT position sensor, or KVGT body fails, replace the
whole KVGT.
10-8 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
KVGT
• Position of hydraulic actuator (6) is sensed by KVGT position sensor (5) and the signals are fed back to
engine controller (7).
PC210LC-10 10-9
10 Structure and function
KVGT
1. Air cleaner
2. Mass air flow and temperature sensor
3. KVGT
4. KVGT speed sensor
5. KVGT position sensor
6. Hydraulic actuator
7. Engine controller
8. EPC valve (for KVGT)
9. KDPF
10. EGR system (EGR cooler, EGR valve)
11. EGR orifice temperature sensor
12. Boost oil pump
C: Blower impeller
T: Turbine impeller
Lubrication
• Cooled oil from the engine oil cooler is sent through the supply pipe to the KVGT for lubrication.
• Oil is sent to the bearing housing to lubricate the shaft bearing and thrust bearing.
• Return oil is drained from the return pipe connected to the bottom of the bearing housing and falls to the oil
pan.
10-10 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
KVGT
Cooling
• Coolant from the cylinder block enters the center housing to cool the KVGT.
• Coolant return flows from the center housing and joins the flow at the EGR cooler outlet piping, then flows
through the water inlet connector to the water pump.
PC210LC-10 10-11
10 Structure and function
EGR system piping drawing
1. KVGT
2. EGR valve
3. Air intake pipe
4. Air intake connector
5. Exhaust manifold
6. EGR cooler
Function (ENG107-A9J0-042-K-00-A)
10-12 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
EGR system piping drawing
PC210LC-10 10-13
10 Structure and function
EGR system circuit diagram
1. Air cleaner
2. KDPF
3. Ambient pressure sensor
4. Aftercooler
5. EGR orifice temperature sensor
6. EGR cooler
7. EGR valve
8. Hydraulic actuator (power piston)
9. EPC valve (for EGR valve)
10. EGR valve lift sensor
11. EPC valve (for KVGT)
12. Exhaust manifold
13. Boost oil pump
14. Intake manifold
15. Charge (boost) pressure and temperature sensor
16. Engine controller
C: Blower impeller
T: Turbine impeller
Operation (ENG107-A9J0-044-K-00-A)
• The engine controller outputs signals for opening EGR valve (7) most properly according to the load on
the engine to attain both clean exhaust gas and low fuel consumption.
• When EGR valve (7) opens, a part of the exhaust gas (EGR gas) flows from exhaust manifold (12)
through EGR piping to EGR cooler (6).
10-14 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
EGR system circuit diagram
• The exhaust gas cooled by EGR cooler (6) flows through EGR valve (7) and mixes with the intake air in
the air intake connector, and then flows in the air intake manifold (14).
PC210LC-10 10-15
10 Structure and function
EGR valve
1. Valve
2. Spring
3. Power piston
4. Spool
5. Spring
6. EGR valve lift sensor
7. EPC valve (for EGR valve)
8. EPC valve (for KVGT)
A: EGR gas inlet (from EGR cooler)
B: EGR gas outlet (to intake manifold)
C: Servo drive oil inlet
D: Servo drive oil outlet
E: KVGT control oil pressure outlet
F: KVGT drive oil pressure outlet
Structure
• The EGR valve consists of the EGR gas flow control mechanism and the EPC valves
• There are two EPC valves, one for the EGR valves control and one for the KVGTcontrol.
10-16 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
EGR valve
Operation (ENG107-A9K1-044-K-00-A)
• Oil from the boost oil pump flows into the EGR valve from port (C). Control pressure from the EPC valve
flows into port (E).
• Spool (4) is pressed to the right by the force of spring (5), and EGR valve (1) is closed by the force of
spring (2) Therefore, exhaust gas from the EGR cooler does not flow to the intake side.
• To open EGR valve (1), first the control pressure from the EPC valve enters port (E). Spool (4) moves to a
position whereat this control pressure and the force of spring (5) are balanced.
• The hydraulic circuit in power piston (3) opens, and then the oil from the boost oil pump entering from port
(C) pushes power piston (3) to the left.
• Oil from the boost oil pump acts on power piston (3) and generates force (Fp).
• When force (Fp) becomes larger than force (Fs) of spring (2), EGR valve (1) opens and then exhaust gas
will flow to the intake side.
• Since the hydraulic circuit to spool (4) is closed by movement of power piston (3), power piston (3) stops at
a position determined by spool (4).
• The valve position is controlled by the engine controller by controlling the spool position with the control
pressure of the EPC valve.
• A servo mechanism prevents external force applied to valve (1) from acting on spool (4), which is in
contact with power piston (3).
• Position of spool (4) is sensed by the EGR valve lift sensor.
PC210LC-10 10-17
10 Structure and function
EGR cooler
1. Tube
A: EGR gas inlet
B: Air vent
C: Coolant outlet
D: EGR gas outlet (to EGR valve)
E: Coolant inlet
1. Flat tube
2. Inner fin
Operation (ENG107-A9L0-044-K-00-A)
• The EGR gas enters from (A) and flows through 11 flat tubes (1).
• Coolant enters from (E) and flows around flat tube (1) in shell and then goes out from (C).
• The EGR gas is effectively cooled by flat tubes (1) with inner fins (2) and flows out from EGR gas outlet
(D).
10-18 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
KCCV layout drawing
1. KCCV ventilator
2. KVGT
3. Blowby duct
4. Flywheel housing
5. Check valve
6. CDR valve
7. Crankcase pressure sensor
A: Blowby gas (from flywheel housing)
B: Engine oil-free blowby gas (to KVGT)
C: Engine oil (to oil pan)
• Formerly, blowby gas has been released to the atmosphere. However, since the tightened exhaust gas
regulation also regulates blowby gas, the blowby gas recirculation system is adopted.
• Since blowby gas (A) contains engine oil mist, which may cause the following problems when recirculated
to KVGT (2), a filter is provided at KCCV ventilator (1) to remove the oil.
1. Degraded performance of turbocharger and aftercooler due to adherence of engine oil
2. Abnormal engine combustion
3. Malfunction of sensors due to aherence of engine oil
PC210LC-10 10-19
10 Structure and function
KCCV layout drawing
Operation (ENG107-A180-044-K-00-A)
a The figure on the left shows the flow of blowby gas released to the atmosphere from conventional engines.
The figure on the right shows the flow of blowby gas recirculated to the intake system by the KCCV
ventilator.
1. Air cleaner
2. KVGT
3. Aftercooler
4. Cylinder block (crankcase)
5. Breather
6. KCCV ventilator
7. Oil pan
• Engine oil mist is removed from blowby gas (A) in cylinder block (4) by the filter in KCCV ventilator (6), and
then the cleaned gas (B) is recirculated to the intake side of the KVGT.
• Removed engine oil (C) flows through a check valve and falls to the oil pan.
10-20 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
KCCV ventilator
1. Case
2. CDR valve
3. Crankcase pressure sensor
4. Relief valve
5. Impactor
6. Filter
7. Heater tube
A: Blowby gas inlet (from flywheel housing)
B: Blowby gas outlet (to KVGT intake side)
C: Oil drain port (to oil pan)
D: Coolant inlet
E: Coolant outlet
Function (PC200_10-A18H-042-K-00-A)
• When blowby gas is recirculated to the intake side of the KVGT, the pressure inside the crankcase
becomes negative, and dust may be sucked in through the crankshaft seals. Therefore, CDR valve
(regulator valve) controls the pressure inside the crankcase.
• If the filter in the KCCV ventilator clogs, pressure inside the crankcase increases and oil may leak, so clog
of filter is detected by crankcase pressure sensor.
• There are two types of filters that differ by the filter replacement method; the top load type (removed
upward) and the bottom load type (removed downward).
• Warming KCCV ventilator with the warmed engine coolant can prevent the blowby gas passage from
being plugged by the frozen gas.
PC210LC-10 10-21
10 Structure and function
KCCV ventilator
Operation (ENG107-A18H-044-K-00-A)
• Blowby gas enters from (A). The larger drops of oil mist are removed from the blowby gas when it flows
through the impactor (5) holes in filter (6).
• Smaller drops of oil mist are removed by filter (6).
• Removed oil flows down along the case wall to oil drain port (C) and then flows to the oil pan.
• The CDR valve operates when the pressure inside the crankcase becomes negative, to prevent excessive
negative pressure in the crankcase.
• Crankcase pressure sensor (3) senses the blowby gas pressure (crankcase pressure).
• When the engine controller determines that the filter is clogged from crankcase pressure sensor (3)
signals, failure code CA555 is issued. If the pressure increases further, failure code CA556 is issued.
• Relief valve (4) is installed in case (1). It operates to protect the KCCV ventilator and engine when filter (6)
is blocked.
CDR valve (ENG107-A18A-041-K-00-A)
1. Diaphragm
2. Spring
A: Crankcase side
B: KVGT side (intake side)
• The CDR valve is a regulator valve which prevents excessive negative crankcase pressure (P1).
• Normally, diaphragm (1) is pushed up by spring (2) and blowby gas flows from crankcase side (A) to
KVGT side (intake side) (B).
• When intake air flow at KVGT side (intake side) (B) increases and crankcase pressure (P1) decreases,
force of spring (2) yields to ambient pressure (P2). The diaphragm shuts the passage and temporarily
blocks the flow.
• Then, when blowby gas accumulates in the crankcase and pressure (P1) recovers, the diaphragm is
pushed up again and blowby gas starts to flow again.
10-22 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
KDPF
KDPF (WA380-A9H0-041-K-00-A)
1. Inlet unit
2. KDOC inlet temperature sensor
3. KDOC outlet temperature sensor
4. KCSF unit
5. Connector box
6. KDPF outlet temperature sensor
7. Outlet unit
8. KDPF differential pressure sensor port
9. KDPF differential pressure sensor
10. KDPF differential pressure sensor port
11. KDOC unit
12. Hanger bracket
13. Sensor bracket
14. Sensor bracket band
15. Water drain port
A: From KVGT
B: Exhaust
C: Water drain
• The KDPF consists of the following components: inlet unit (1) to introduce exhaust gas, KDOC unit (11)
that houses an oxidation catalyst, KCSF unit (4) that houses a soot collecting filter with a catalyzer, and
outlet unit (7) that sends out exhaust gas and has a "dam" to prevent rain water from entering KCSF unit
(4).
• KDOC unit (11) consists of a ceramic honeycomb coated with oxidation calatyst material.
PC210LC-10 10-23
10 Structure and function
KDPF
• The ceramic honeycomb supports the oxidization of NO (nitrogen monoxide) into NO 2 (nitrogen dioxide),
and also contributes to burn the injected fuel during automatic regeneration and manual stationary
regeneration (*1).
• The ceramic honeycomb is guarded by a mat made of special fiber to prevent damage caused by engine
and machine vibrations.
• The mat also prevents overheating of the KDPF outer periphery by insulating the heat generated at the
ceramic honeycomb during operation.
• KCSF unit (4) also consists of a ceramic honeycomb coated with oxidation catalyst material, like the
KDOC unit (11). This ceramic honeycomb collects soot.
• Inside the KCSF, there are many cells partitioned by ceramic walls. Cells plugged at the inlet side and
cells plugged at the outlet side are alternately arranged.
• Three temperature sensors and one differential pressure sensor (an integrated KDPF differential pressure
and KDPF outlet pressure sensor) are installed to the KDPF.
• Temperature signals from the three temperature sensors are used in combination to monitor the KDOC
and KCSF operations and to perform various troubleshootings.
• The differential pressure sensor detects the amount of soot deposited in the KCSF by sensing the
pressure difference across the KCSF. Like the temperature sensors, this sensor is also used for various
troubleshootings.
*1: Soot is cleaned (oxidized) during the process.
k During engine operation and for a while after engine shutdown, the surface of the KDPF and
adjacent pipings are very hot. When working near the KDPF, be careful not to get burned.
Function (ENG107-A9H0-042-K-00-A)
10-24 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
KDPF
• The KDPF is installed to meet the very strict requirements of the latest exhaust gas regulation. The KDPF
purifies the exhaust gas by catching most of the PM (Particulate Matter such as soot) included in the
exhaust gas from the engine.
• KCSF (2) is made of ceramic. Inside the KCSF, there are many cells partitioned by ceramic walls. Cells
plugged at the inlet side and cells plugged at the outlet side are alternately arranged.
• The soot deposited in KCSF (2) is naturally oxidized and burned away by the effect of KDOC (1), in
operating conditions with relatively high exhaust gas temperatures. (This is referred to as "passive
regeneration".)
• When the exhaust temperature is relatively low, in conditions such as continued low load operations, the
deposit of soot in KCSF (2) increases.
• The engine controller continuously monitors the amount of deposited soot by estimating from the
operating conditions and calculating based on the KCSF differential pressure sensor signals.
• When the soot deposit exceeds a certain level, and the engine is operated with the exhaust gas
temperature exceeding a certain level, the engine controller executes "automatic regeneration" to burn
(oxidize) the soot.
• During automatic regeneration, the engine controller automatically controls the fuel injection timing and
the KVGT to raise the exhaust temperature. This is referred to as "exhaust temperature-raising control".
• As the exhaust temperature increases, the engine controller automatically performs calculations based on
the exhaust temperature at the KDOC inlet and flow of the exhaust gas, so that KCSF (2) can efficiently
burn (oxidize) the soot.
• KDOC (1) burns (oxidize) soot by utilizing the catalyzer.
• Automatic regeneration is not performed when regeneration is executed from the machine monitor, or
when the outside air temperature is extremely low, and when the exhaust gas temperature is not high
enough to burn soot because the engine has been operated at low loads for a while. Thus, soot deposit in
KCSF (2) will increase.
• If the soot deposit in KCSF (2) exceeds a certain level, it will be necessary to perform "manual stationary
regeneration" to burn away (oxidize) the soot.
• If the soot deposit exceeds the acceptable level, the exhaust gas flow will be restricted. This can increase
fuel consumption, degrade engine combustion, or cause other problems.
• If the soot deposit exceeds the limit to safely perform "manual stationary regeneration", the KDPF fails and
replacement becomes unavoidable. Make sure to follow the procedures in the Operation and
Maintenance Manual when performing "manual stationary regeneration".
Types of regeneration (WA380-A9H0-042-K-00-A)
a Regeneration refers to a process of purifying (oxidizing) the soot deposited in the soot collecting filter
(KCSF) inside the KDPF.
1. Passive regeneration
When the exhaust temperature is relatively high, the catalyst effect of the KDOC to oxidize soot will be
stronger and the soot deposit in the KCSF will be naturally burned away.
2. Active regeneration
1) Automatic regeneration
If the soot deposit exceeds a certain level, the engine controller switches to exhaust temperature-
raising control (*1), performs fuel dosing (*2), and automatically starts the regeneration process.
Another type of automatic regeneration is performed by the engine controller at certain intervals,
regardless of the amount of soot deposited in the KCSF.
*1: The fuel injection timing and the KVGT are controlled to raise the exhaust temperature.
*2: Fuel is injected to increase the exhaust temperature and accelerate the regeneration process. No.
1, 2, and 3 injectors are used for fuel dosing.
2) Manual stationary regeneration
When the exhaust temperature does not reach a certain level due to the machine operating condition,
or when regeneration is disabled by the operator, automatic regeneration will not be performed and the
soot deposit in the KCSF may increase. In such conditions, the machine monitor displays a manual
stationary regeneration request on the screen. The operator must perform regeneration by operating
the machine monitor on its screen. A regeneration feature is also provided for the technician who
should use this feature from the machine monitor menu after engine controller replacement, KDPF
replacement, and KCSF ash cleaning. (= Regeneration for service)
• A KDPF drying feature is provided to prevent excessive accumulation of unburned fuel in the KDPF
when the machine is operated for a long time with low exhaust temperature.
PC210LC-10 10-25
10 Structure and function
KDPF
• When certain conditions are met, the engine controller automatically switches control to increase
the exhaust temperature to dry the KCSF. If some of the conditions for automatic drying are not met,
manual stationary regeneration may be requested.
a Follow the procedures in the Operation and Maintenance Manual when starting and stopping
KDPF regeneration.
a Be sure to use ultra-low-sulfur diesel fuel. Non-specified fuels may cause KDPF failure.
a Be sure to use the specified Komatsu genuine oil for the KDPF. Non-specified oils may cause
KDPF clogging in a short time, resulting in increased fuel consumption or KDPF failure.
a Do not modify the KDPF itself or exhaust pipes. Modifications disturb normal operation of the
KDPF, leading to a failure.
a Do not apply impacts to the KDPF by stepping on, dropping, or striking it. The KDPF contains a
ceramic honeycomb, which can be damaged by strong impacts.
a The engine controller performs automatic regeneration even when the amount of soot deposit is
low. Since this is programmed to maintain the KDPF performance, this is normal.
a During automatic regeneration and manual stationary regeneration, the KVGT automatically
operates and the engine sound changes. The flow of exhaust gas through the KDPF changes
and the exhaust sound changes, but this is normal.
a During automatic regeneration and manual stationary regeneration, especially at low
temperatures, white smoke may come out from the exhaust pipe for a short time, but this is
normal. Be sure to perform regeneration at a well ventilated place since carbon monoxide can
be produced.
a During automatic regeneration and manual stationary regeneration, a strange odor may be
smelled from the exhaust pipe, but this is normal.
a During automatic regeneration and manual stationary regeneration, the exhaust temperature at
the exhaust pipe can exceed 650 °C. Make sure that there is no flammable material near the
exhaust system to prevent fire. Make sure that nobody is standing in front of the exhaust pipe,
and pay sufficient attention to safety of the environment.
a KDPF temperature values are shown below for reference.
DOC_In (KDOC inlet DOC_Out (KDOC outlet KDPF_Out (KDPF outlet
temperature sensor) temperature sensor) temperature sensor)
Not regenerating (idling) 100 to 250 °C
Regenerating (under
exhaust temperature-raising 100 to 250 °C 400 to 550 °C
control: 1,000 rpm)
10-26 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Cooling system
1. Reservoir tank
2. Oil cooler
3. Radiator cap
PC210LC-10 10-27
10 Structure and function
Cooling system
4. Radiator
5. Aftercooler
6. Fuel cooler inlet
7. Fuel cooler
8. Fuel cooler outlet
9. Condenser
10. Air conditioner condenser switching bracket
11. Oil cooler inlet
12. Aftercooler outlet hose
13. Fan guard
14. Radiator inlet hose
15. Oil cooler outlet
16. Aftercooler inlet hose
17. Shroud
18. Fan
19. Radiator outlet hose
20. Radiator drain plug
Specifications (PC200_10-B000-030-K-00-A)
10-28 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Power train system
1. Control valve
1a. Self-pressure reducing valve
1b. Merge-divider valve
1c. Travel junction valve
2. Main pump
3. Engine
4. Travel motor
5. Final drive
6. Swing motor
6a. Swing 2-stage relief valve
7. Center swivel joint
8. Idler
PC210LC-10 10-29
10 Structure and function
Power train system
10-30 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Swing circle
PC210LC-10 10-31
10 Structure and function
Swing machinery
10-32 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Swing machinery
PC210LC-10 10-33
10 Structure and function
Final drive
1. Level plug
2. No. 1 planetary gear (number of teeth: 42)
3. Drain plug
10-34 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Final drive
PC210LC-10 10-35
10 Structure and function
Track frame and idler cushion
1. Idler
2. Track frame
3. Carrier roller
4. Final drive
5. Track roller
6. Track shoe
7. Center guard
8. Idler cushion
9. Front guard
10-36 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Track frame and idler cushion
Specification (PC200_10-DT20-030-K-00-A)
PC210LC-10 10-37
10 Structure and function
Hydraulic equipment layout drawing
1. Bucket cylinder
10-38 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Hydraulic equipment layout drawing
2. Arm cylinder
3. R.H. PPC valve for work equipment
4. Swing motor
5. Hydraulic tank
6. Main pump
7. Control valve
8. Accumulator (for PPC circuit)
9. Oil cooler
10. Travel motor
11. Solenoid valve
12. L.H. PPC valve for work equipment
13. Attachment 2 PPC valve (*1)
14. Travel PPC valve
15. Attachment 1 PPC valve (*1)
16. Center swivel joint
17. Boom cylinder
*1: Machine ready for installation of attachment
PC210LC-10 10-39
10 Structure and function
Valve control
10-40 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Valve control
PC210LC-10 10-41
10 Structure and function
Hydraulic tank
1. Main pump
2. Hydraulic tank
3. Filler cap
4. Sight gauge
5. Drain plug
6. Bypass valve
7. Strainer
8. Filter element
9. Suction strainer
Specifications (PC220-PM30-030-K-00-A)
10-42 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Hydraulic tank
1. Filter element
2. Bottom plate
3. Gasket
4. Seam valve
5. Spring
PC210LC-10 10-43
10 Structure and function
CLSS
CLSS (ALL-PNJ1-001-K-00-A)
Features
• Fine control not influenced by load
• Control performance that allows digging even when fine control operation is turned on
• Ease of combined operation enabled by the flow divider function that is determined by the opening areas
of spools during combined operations
• Energy saving by variable pump control
Configuration
• CLSS consists of variable capacity piston pump, control valve, and actuators.
• The main pump consists of pump itself, PC valve and LS valve.
10-44 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
CLSS
Basic principle
• The pump swash plate angle shifts toward the maximum position if LS differential pressure (dPLS) is
lower than the set pressure of the LS valve (when the actuator load pressure is high).
• If it becomes higher than the set pressure (when the actuator load pressure is low), the pump swash plate
angle shifts toward the minimum position.
PC210LC-10 10-45
10 Structure and function
CLSS
LS differential pressure (d
d PLS) and pump swash plate angle
10-46 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
CLSS
• A pressure compensation valve is installed to the outlet port side of each control valve to balance the load
pressure.
• When actuators are operated in combination, the pressure difference (dP) between the upstream (inlet
port) and downstream (outlet port) of the spool of each valve becomes the same regardless the size of the
load (pressure).
• The flow of oil from the pump is divided (compensated) in proportion to the areas of openings (S1) and
(S2) of each valve.
System diagram
a The illustration shows the state when actuator (7) is relieved at the stroke end in the merge mode.
1. Front pump
2. Rear pump
3. Main relief valve
4. Unload valve
5. Merge-divider valve
6. Control valve
PC210LC-10 10-47
10 Structure and function
CLSS
7. Actuator
8. Pump circuit
9. LS circuit
10. Tank circuit
11. Valve
12. Spring
13. LS bypass plug
14. LS valve
15. PC valve
10-48 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Main pump
PC210LC-10 10-49
10 Structure and function
Main pump
10-50 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Main pump
1. Front shaft
2. Cradle
3. Front case
4. Rocker cam
5. Shoe
6. Piston
7. Cylinder block
8. Valve plate
9. End cap
10. Rear shaft
11. Rear case
12. PC valve
13. Servo piston
14. Slider
PC210LC-10 10-51
10 Structure and function
Main pump
15. Spline
16. Bearing
17. LS valve
Outline
• This pump consists of two variable capacity swash plate piston pumps, PC valve, LS valve, EPC valve,
and swash plate sensor.
Function
• The pump converts the engine speed and torque transmitted to its shaft (1) into oil pressure and delivers
pressurized oil corresponding to the load.
• It is possible to change the delivery by changing the swash plate angle.
Structure
• Cylinder block (7) is supported to shaft (1) by spline (15).
• Shaft (1) is supported by each bearing (16) at the front and rear.
• The tip of piston (6) is shaped as a concave sphere and is crimped together with shoe (5).
• Piston (6) and shoe (5) constitute a spherical bearing.
• Rocker cam (4) has flat surface (A), and shoe (5) is always pressed against this surface while sliding in a
circular pattern.
• Rocker cam (4) transmits high pressure oil to cylindrical surface (B) with cradle (2), which is secured to the
case, and forms a static pressure bearing when it slides.
• Piston (6) performs reciprocal motion in the axial direction inside each cylinder chamber of cylinder block
(7).
• Cylinder block (7) seals the pressurized oil to valve plate (8) and performs relative rotation.
• The oil pressure balance on the valve plate is maintained properly.
• The pressurized oil is sucked in and discharged from each cylinder chamber in cylinder block (7) through
valve plate (8).
Operation (PC220-C200-044-K-00-A)
• Cylinder block (7) rotates together with shaft (1) and shoe (5) slides on plane (A).
• Rocker cam (4) moves along cylindrical surface (B). As a result, angle (a) between center line (X) of
rocker cam (4) and the axis of cylinder block (7) changes.
• Angle (a) is called the swash plate angle.
• If swash plate angle (a) is made between center line (X) of rocker cam (4) and the axis of cylinder block (7),
plane (A) functions as a cam against shoe (5).
• Piston (6) reciprocates inside cylinder block (7) and a difference is made between volumes (E) and (F) in
cylinder block (7).
• Each piston (6) sucks and discharges oil by (F) - (E).
• Oil is discharged while cylinder block (7) rotates and the volume of chamber (E) decreases.
• The volume of chamber (F) grows larger and, in this process, the oil is sucked.
10-52 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Main pump
• As center line (X) of rocker cam (4) matches the axis of cylinder block (7) (swash plate angle = 0), the
difference between volumes (E) and (F) inside cylinder block (7) equals 0.
• Suction and delivery of pressurized oil is not carried out in this state. Namely pumping action is not
performed. (Actually, however, the swash plate angle is not set to 0 deg.)
Control of delivery
• If swash plate angle (a) increases, the difference between volumes (E) and (F) increases, and pump
delivery (Q) increases.
• Swash plate angle (a) is changed by servo piston (13).
• Servo piston (13) moves in a linear reciprocating movement according to the signal pressure from the PC
valve and LS valve.
• This linear reciprocating movement is transmitted to rocker cam (4) through slider (14).
• Being supported by cradle (2) on the cylindrical surface, rocker cam (4) slides on the surface while
continuing revolving movement.
• Output pressure (PEN) of the LS valve is transmitted to the pressure chamber of the large diameter piston
side.
• The areas receiving the pressure on the right and left sides of servo piston (13) are different from each
other, and delivery pressure (self pressure) (PP) of the main pump is constantly transmitted to the
pressure chamber of the small diameter piston side.
• The movement of servo piston (13) is controlled by the relationship of pressure between small diameter
piston side (PP) and large diameter piston side (PEN) and by the ratio of the areas receiving the pressure
of the small diameter piston and large diameter piston.
PC210LC-10 10-53
10 Structure and function
Main pump
10-54 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Main pump
LS valve (PC-C2J0-041-K-00-A)
Function (PC-C2J0-042-K-00-A)
• The LS (load sensing) valve detects the load and controls the pump delivery.
• This valve controls main pump delivery (Q) according to differential pressure (dPLS) [= PP - PLS], called
the LS differential pressure (the difference between main pump delivery pressure (PP) and control valve
outlet port pressure (PLS)).
• This valve receives main pump delivery pressure (PP), pressure (PLS) (called the LS pressure) coming
from the control valve output, and pressure (PSIG) (called the LS set selector pressure) from the
proportional solenoid valve.
• The relation between the pump delivery (Q) and the differential pressure (dPLS) [= (PP) - (PLS)] between
the main pump pressure (PP) and LS pressure (PLS) is changed by the LS set pressure selector current
(ISIG) of the LS-EPC valve as shown in the figure below.
• When the (ISIG) changes from 0 A to 1 A, the spring setting force will change accordingly, to let the center
of the standard value range of the pump delivery selector point vary within the range from 0.27 MPa {2.78
kg/cm2} to 1.7 MPa {17.75 kg/cm2}.
PC210LC-10 10-55
10 Structure and function
Main pump
Operation (PC-C2J0-044-K-00-A)
• The LS valve is a 3-way selector valve, and LS pressure (PLS) (actuator load pressure) on the outlet of
control valve is transmitted to spring chamber (B), and pump delivery pressure (PP) is transmitted to port
(H) of sleeve (8).
• Magnitude of the force resulting from this LS pressure (PLS), force of spring (4) and the pump delivery
pressure (self pressure) (PP) determine the position of spool (6).
10-56 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Main pump
• However, magnitude of the output pressure (PSIG) (called the LS set selector pressure) of the EPC valve
for the LS valve entering port (G) also changes the position of spool (6).(Setting force of the spring is
changed)
• Before the engine is started, servo piston (12) is pushed to the left. (See the following figure)
• If the control lever is at the neutral position when the engine is started, LS pressure (PLS) is set to 0 MPa
{0 kg/cm2}. (It is connected to the drain circuit through the control valve spool.)
• Spool (6) is pushed to the right, and port (C) and port (D) are connected.
• Pump delivery pressure (PP) is transmitted to the larger diameter end of the pump from the port (K).
• The same pump delivery pressure (PP) is transmitted to the smaller diameter end at the port (J).
• According to the area difference of servo piston (12), the servo piston is moved to the right, in the direction
which makes the swash plate angle minimum. (See the previous figure.)
PC210LC-10 10-57
10 Structure and function
Main pump
• When the difference between pump delivery pressure (PP) and LS pressure (PLS), in other words, LS
differential pressure (dPLS) decreases (for example, when the control valve opening area increases and
pump delivery pressure (PP) decreases), the combined force exerted by LS pressure (PLS) and spring (4)
pushes spool (6) to the left.
• As spool (6) moves, ports (D) and (E) are interconnected and also connected to the PC valve.
• Since the PC valve and drain port are connected, the pressure between ports (D) and (K) becomes drain
pressure (PT). (PC valve operation will be explained later.)
• The pressure on the large diameter piston side of servo piston (12) becomes drain pressure (PT), and
pump pressure (PP) is constantly transmitted to port (J) on the small diameter end. Accordingly, servo
piston (12) is pushed to the left and the swash plate is moved to increase the delivery.
• At this time, when the output pressure from the EPC valve for the LS valve is transmitted to port (G), a
force is applied on piston (7) to move the piston to the right.
• If piston (7) is pushed to the right, setting force of spring (4) is weakened, changing the LS differential
pressure (dPLS) [Difference between oil pressures (PLS) and (PP)] when ports (D) and (E) of spool (6)
are connected.
10-58 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Main pump
• When servo piston (12) moves to the right (the direction that reduces pump delivery) and LS differential
pressure (dPLS) increases (for example, when the control valve opening area decreases and pump
delivery pressure (PP) increases), the force exerted by pump delivery pressure (PP) pushes spool (6) to
the right.
• The movement of spool (6) transmits pump delivery pressure (PP) to the large diameter end of the piston
through port (C), port (D) and port (K).
• Pump delivery pressure (PP) is also transmitted to port (J) of the small diameter end of the piston, but
because of the difference in area between the large diameter end and the small diameter end on servo
piston (12), it is pushed to the right. As the result, the servo piston (12) moves into the direction of reducing
the swash plate angle.
• When the LS set selector pressure (PSIG) is transmitted to port (G), the spring (4) setting force is
weakened.
PC210LC-10 10-59
10 Structure and function
Main pump
• The symbols (A1), (A0) and (PEN) represent the area receiving the pressure at the large diameter end of
the piston, the area receiving the pressure at the small diameter end and the pressure transmitted to the
large diameter end of the piston, respectively.
• When the force exerted by main pump pressure (PP) of the LS valve is balanced with the combined force
exerted by LS pressure (PLS) and spring (4), and the relationship becomes (A0) x (PP) = (A1) x (PEN),
servo piston (12) stops in that position.
• The swash plate of the pump is held at the intermediate position. [The swash plate stops at a position
where the openings from port (D) to port (E) and from port (C) to port (D) of spool (6) are approximately
equal]
• The relationship between the area receiving the pressure at both ends of servo piston (12) is (A0) : (A1) =
3 : 5, and the pressures transmitted to both ends of the piston when the piston is balanced is (PP) : (PEN)
C 5 : 3.
• The force of spring (4) is adjusted so that spool (6) can be balanced at the specified center when (PP) -
(PLS) = 1.7 MPa {17.75 kg/cm2}.
• When (PSIG) [LS-EPC valve output pressure, 0 to 2.9 MPa {0 to 30 kg/cm 2}] is transmitted to port (G), the
balanced position changes in proportion to the (PSIG) pressure within a range of (PP) - (PLS) = 1.7 MPa
{17.75 kg/cm2} to 0.27 MPa {2.78 kg/cm2}.
10-60 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Main pump
PC valve (PC-C2K0-041-K-00-A)
Function (PC-C2K0-042-K-00-A)
• The PC valve limits the oil flow to a certain level (depends on the delivery pressure) even if the travel of
the control valve is increased extremely. This is to ensure the horsepower absorbed by the pump not to
exceed the engine horsepower, when pump delivery pressures (PP1) (self pressure) and (PP2) (other
pump's pressure) are high.
• If the pump delivery pressure (PP) increases due to increased load during work, this valve decreases the
pump delivery.
• And if the pump delivery pressure goes low, it increases the pump delivery.
• The relation between the average delivery pressure of front and rear pumps [(PP1) + (PP2)] / 2 and pump
delivery (Q) is as shown in the following figure, as a parameter for each current (X) value applied to the
PC-EPC valve solenoid.
• The controller continues counting the actual engine speed.
• If the engine speed is slowed down due to increased load, the controller reduces the pump delivery to
recover the speed.
• When the load increases and the engine speed decreases below a preset value, the controller increases
the command current to the PC-EPC valve solenoid depending on the amount of engine speed decrease,
to decrease the swash plate angle.
PC210LC-10 10-61
10 Structure and function
Main pump
Operation (PC-C2K0-044-K-00-A)
When load on the actuator is small and pump pressures (PP1) and (PP2) are low
10-62 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Main pump
• Spool (3) stops at a position where the combined force exerted by springs (4) and (6) is equalized to the
combined force exerted by pump pressure (PP1) (self pressure) and pump pressure (PP2) (other pump's
pressure) acting on spool (3).
• Depending on this position, the pressure output from the PC valve [port (C) pressure] varies.
• The amperage of the command current (X) depends on the type of work (lever operation), work mode
selection, engine speed setting, and the actual engine speed.
a Other pump's pressure denotes the pressure of the pump situated on the opposite side.
For the front pump pressure, the other pump's pressure is that of the rear pump. And for the rear pump
pressure, the other pump's pressure is that of the front pump.
Action of spring
• The spring force of springs (4) and (6) in the PC valve depends on the position of the swash plate.
• When servo piston (9) moves to the right, spring (6) is compressed.
• When the piston moves further to the right, the piston comes in contact with seat (5) and spring (6) is fixed.
• Then, only spring (4) operates.
• When servo piston (9) compresses or decompresses springs (4) and (6), the spring force varies.
• When the command current (X) input to PC-EPC valve solenoid (1) varies, the thrust pushing piston (2)
varies.
• The spring forces of springs (4) and (6) are also varied by the PC-EPC valve solenoid command current
(X).
• Port (C) on the PC valve is connected to port (E) on the LS valve.
• Self pressure (PP1) is transmitted to the small diameter end of servo piston (9) and port (B), and other
pump's pressure (PP2) is transmitted to port (A).
• When pressures (PP1) and (PP2) are low, spool (3) is on the left.
PC210LC-10 10-63
10 Structure and function
Main pump
• Port (C) and port (D) are connected, and the pressure entering the LS valve becomes drain pressure (PT).
• When port (E) of the LS valve is connected to port (G), the pressure from port (J) entering the large
diameter end of the piston becomes drain pressure (PT), and servo piston (9) moves to the left.
• The pump delivery goes to increase.
• Springs (4) and (6) extend according to the movement of servo piston (9), and the reaction force of spring
decreases.
• When the reaction force of spring decreases, spool (3) moves to the right. Ports (C) is disconnected from
port (D), and pump delivery pressure port (B) is connected to port (C).
• Since the pressure in port (C) and the pressure at the large diameter side of the piston increase, servo
piston (9) stops moving to the left.
• Accordingly, the stop position (= pump delivery) of servo piston (9) is determined by the position where the
force exerted by pressures (PP1) and (PP2), the thrust generated by the PC-EPC valve solenoid, and the
force exerted by springs (4) and (6) acting on the spool (3) are balanced.
When load on the actuator is large and pump pressures (PP1) and (PP2) are high
Outline
• When the load is large and the pump delivery pressures (PP1) and (PP2) are high, the thrust moving
spool (3) to the right increases, and spool (3) comes to a position as shown above.
• The pressure from port (C) to the LS valve becomes approximately half of pump pressure (PP2), because
a part of the pressure from port (B) flows through the LS valve and port (C) to port (D), as shown above.
• When spool (3) moves to the left, the opening of ports (C) and (D) widens.
• The pressure in port (C) (=J) decreases, and the movement of servo piston (9) to the right stops.
10-64 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Main pump
• Servo piston (9) stops at a position further to the right than the position when pump pressures (PP1) and
(PP2) are low.
Operation
• When ports (E) and (G) of the LS valve are connected, the pressure is transmitted from port (J) to the
large diameter end of servo piston (9), and servo piston (9) stops moving.
• When pump pressure (PP2) increases more and spool (3) moves further to the right, pump pressure (PP1)
flows to port (C) to minimize the pump delivery.
• When servo piston (9) moves to the right, springs (4) and (6) are compressed, and spool (3) is pushed
back.
• The relationship between the average pump pressure (PP1 + PP2)/2 and servo piston (9) in terms of their
positions can be represented by the polygonal line in the figure because springs (4) and (6) form the 2-
stage springs.
• The relationship between the average pump pressure (PP1 + PP2)/2 and average pump delivery (Q)
becomes as shown below.
• If command current (X) sent to PC-EPC valve solenoid (1) increases further, the relationship between
average pump pressure (PP1 + PP2)/2 and pump delivery (Q) is shifted parallel in proportion to the thrust
of PC-EPC valve solenoid.
• Namely, the thrust of PC-EPC valve solenoid (1) is added to the pushing force to the right because of the
pump pressure transmitted to the spool (3), so the relationship between the average pump pressure (PP1
+ PP2)/2 and the pump delivery (Q) moves from (A) to (B) as the command current (X) is increased.
PC210LC-10 10-65
10 Structure and function
Main pump
When the pump controller malfunctions and the emergency pump drive switch is at “ON“ position
• If the pump controller fails, turn the emergency pump drive switch to "ON" position to select the resistor
side.
• In this case, power is taken directly from the battery, however, the current is too high as is, a resistor is
needed to control the current supplied to PC-EPC valve solenoid (1).
• Since the current is constant, the thrust applied to piston (2) is constant.
• When main pump pressures (PP1) and (PP2) are low, the combined force exerted by PC-EPC valve
solenoid (1) thrust and the pump pressure is smaller than the combined force exerted by the springs.
Spool (3) stays balanced at the left.
• Port (C) is connected to port (D) at drain pressure, and the pressure at the large diameter end of servo
piston (9) comes to drain pressure (PT) through the LS valve.
• Since the pressure at the small diameter end of the piston is large, servo piston (9) moves in the direction
to increase the delivery.
10-66 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Main pump
• As mentioned before, when the emergency pump drive switch is turned to "ON" position, the command
current (X) sent to PC-EPC valve solenoid (1) is constant.
• Therefore, the thrust applied by piston (2) to spool (3) comes to constant.
• When main pump pressures (PP1) and (PP2) increase, spool (3) moves to a position further to the right
than when the main pump load is small, and stays balanced as shown above.
• Since the pressure from port (B) flows into port (C), servo piston (9) moves to the right (delivery
decreases), and stops at a position further to the right than when the pump load is small.
• When the emergency pump drive switch is turned to "ON" position, the curve indicating the relation
between the pump delivery pressure (PP) and delivery (Q) is plotted in accordance with the current
supplied through the resistor to the PC-EPC valve solenoid.
• When the emergency pump drive switch is turned to "ON" position, the curve is plotted as (B), which is
shifted toward the left than curve (A) for a normal pump controller.
PC210LC-10 10-67
10 Structure and function
Main pump
10-68 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Main pump
C: To LS (PC) valve
P: From self-pressure reducing valve
T: To hydraulic tank
1. Connector
2. Coil
3. Valve body
4. Spring
5. Spool
6. Rod
7. Plunger
PC210LC-10 10-69
10 Structure and function
Main pump
Function (PC-C2M0-042-K-00-A)
• The EPC valve consists of the proportional solenoid and the hydraulic valve.
• When the EPC valve receives signal current (i) from the controller, it develops EPC output pressure
proportional to the amperage of the current and supplies the pressure to the control valve.
10-70 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Main pump
Operation (PC-C2M0-044-K-00-A)
• When the signal current from the controller is not flowing through coil (2), coil (2) is de-energized.
• Spool (5) is pushed to the left side by spring (4).
• Port (P) is closed, and the pressurized oil from the self-pressure reducing valve does not flow to the LS
(PC) valve.
• The pressurized oil from the LS (PC) valve is drained to the tank through port (C) and then port (T).
PC210LC-10 10-71
10 Structure and function
Main pump
• When a small signal current flows through coil (2), coil (2) is energized and a thrust pushing plunger (7) to
the right is generated.
• Rod (6) pushes spool (5) to the right, and the pressurized oil flows from port (P) to port (C).
• The pressure at port (C) increases and the total of the force applied to the surface of spool (5) and the
reaction force exerted by spring (4) becomes larger than the thrust of plunger (7).
• Spool (5) is pushed to the left, and port (P) is shut off from port (C).
• Port (C) connects to port (T).
• Spool (5) moves to a position where the thrust of plunger (7) becomes equal to the total of the force
exerted by pressure at port (C) and the reaction force exerted by spring (4).
• The circuit pressure between the EPC valve and LS (PC) valve is controlled in proportion to the amperage
of signal current.
10-72 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Main pump
PC210LC-10 10-73
10 Structure and function
Control valve
a In this section, only the 7-spool valve (6-spool valve + service valve) is shown.
10-74 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Control valve
PC210LC-10 10-75
10 Structure and function
Control valve
IS1: Pump merge-divider EPC valve (for main spool) drive signal
IS2: Pump merge-divider EPC valve (for LS spool) drive signal
IS3: Variable back pressure solenoid valve drive signal
1. Variable back pressure valve
2: Variable back pressure solenoid valve
3. Pump merge-divider EPC valve (for LS spool)
4. Pump merge-divider EPC valve (for main spool)
5. Arm hydraulic drift prevention valve (if equipped)
6. Boom hydraulic drift prevention valve
7. Service valve
8. Cover A
9. 7-spool valve
10. Arm quick return valve
11. Cover B
12. Merge-divider valve
10-76 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Control valve
PC210LC-10 10-77
10 Structure and function
Control valve
10-78 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Control valve
PC210LC-10 10-79
10 Structure and function
Control valve
10-80 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Control valve
1. Unload valve
2. Safety valve for hydraulic drift prevention valve (boom “RAISE“ and arm “OUT“)
3. Main relief valve
4. Variable back pressure valve
Arm valve
5. Arm hydraulic drift prevention valve (if equipped)
6. LS shuttle valve
7. Arm quick return valve
8. Pressure compensation valve (IN)
PC210LC-10 10-81
10 Structure and function
Control valve
9. Spool
10. Suction safety valve (IN)
11. Cooler check valve
12. Regeneration circuit check valve
13. Suction valve (OUT)
14. Pressure compensation valve (OUT)
Swing valve
21. LS selector valve
22. Pressure compensation valve (L.H.)
23. Spool
24. Pressure compensation valve (R.H.)
10-82 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Control valve
1. Return spring
2. Merge-divider valve (for LS)
3. Valve (sequence valve)
4. Spring (sequence valve)
5. Merge-divider valve (main)
6. Return spring
Boom valve
7. Boom hydraulic drift prevention valve
8. LS shuttle valve
PC210LC-10 10-83
10 Structure and function
Control valve
Bucket valve
23. LS shuttle valve
24. Pressure compensation valve (CURL)
25. Spool
26. Suction safety valve (CURL)
27. Suction safety valve (DUMP)
28. Pressure compensation valve (DUMP)
10-84 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Control valve
Service valve
1. LS shuttle valve
2. Pressure compensation valve
3. Spool
4. 2-stage suction safety valve
5. Suction safety valve
6. Unload valve
7. Main relief valve
8. LS bypass plug
Structure
• The control valves of the following types are set.
6-spool valve (without service valve)
7-spool valve (6-spool valve with service valve)
• This control valve consists of a 6-spool valve (unit type) and a set of service valve. A merge-divider valve,
a variable back pressure valve and a boom hydraulic drift prevention valve are installed to it.
• Since all the valves are assembled together with connecting bolts and their passes are connected to each
other inside the assembly, the assembly is compact and easy to maintain.
• With one spool provided for one work equipment, this control valve is simple in structure.
PC210LC-10 10-85
10 Structure and function
Control valve
1. Arm valve
2. R.H. travel valve
10-86 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Control valve
3. Swing valve
4. Boom valve
5. L.H. travel valve
6. Bucket valve
7. Service valve
8. Arm valve spool
9. R.H. travel valve spool
10. Swing valve spool
11. Boom valve spool
12. L.H. travel valve spool
13. Bucket valve spool
14. Service spool
15. Pressure compensation valve
16. Suction valve
17. Check valve (for boom regeneration circuit)
18. Check valve (for arm regeneration circuit)
19. Pump merge-divider EPC valve (for LS spool)
20. Pump merge-divider EPC valve (for main spool)
21. LS shuttle valve
22. LS bypass plug
23. LS selector valve
24. Merge-divider valve
25. Arm quick return valve
26. Arm hydraulic drift prevention valve (if equipped)
27. Self-pressure reducing valve
28. Travel junction valve
29. Variable back pressure valve
30: Variable back pressure solenoid valve
31. Cooler check valve
32. Boom hydraulic drift prevention valve
33. Main relief valve (for boom, L.H. travel, bucket, and attachment circuits)
Set pressure: 35.4 ± 0.5 MPa {360.5 ± 5 kg/cm2}
When one-touch power max. switch is set to ON position: 38.0 ± 0.5 MPa {387 ± 5 kg/cm 2}
34. Main relief valve (for arm, R.H. travel, and swing circuits)
Set pressure: 35.4 ± 0.5 MPa {360.5 ± 5 kg/cm2}
When one-touch power max. switch is set to ON position: 38.0 ± 0.5 MPa {387 ± 5 kg/cm 2}
35. Unload valve (for boom, L.H. travel, bucket, and attachment circuits)
Cracking pressure: 2.5 ± 0.5 MPa {26 ± 5 kg/cm2}
36. Unload valve (for arm, R.H. travel, and swing circuits)
Cracking pressure: 2.5 ± 0.5 MPa {26 ± 5 kg/cm2}
37. Suction safety valve
Set pressure: 24.5 ± 0.5 MPa {250 ± 5 kg/cm2}
38. Suction safety valve
Set pressure: 38.9 ± 0.5 MPa {397 ± 5 kg/cm2}
39. Suction safety valve
Set pressure: 31.4 ± 0.5 MPa {320 ± 5 kg/cm2}
40. Suction 2-stage safety valve
PC210LC-10 10-87
10 Structure and function
Control valve
10-88 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Control valve
1. LS circuit
2. Valve
3. Pump circuit
4. Tank circuit
5. Spring
Function (PC220-PQD5-042-K-00-A)
• When all control valves are at HOLD, this valve serves to drain as same amount of oil as the pump
delivery with swash plate angle at the minimum.
• The pump pressure becomes the pressure corresponding to the set load of spring (5) in the valve (referred
to as P1).
• Since LS pressure is drained from LS bypass valve, LS pressure C tank pressure C 0 MPa {0 kg/cm2}.
Operation (ALL-PQD5-044-K-00-A)
• Pressure of pump circuit (3) is received by the end of valve (2).
• Since the control valve is in NEUTRAL position, pressure of LS circuit (1) is 0 MPa {0 kg/cm 2}.
• Pressurized oil of pump circuit (3) stops at valve (2), and the pressure rises as no relief is available.
• If this pressure grows larger than the force of spring (5), valve (2) moves to the left.
• Ports (b) and (c) are interconnected, and the pump pressurized oil flows to tank circuit (4).
• The pressurized oil of LS circuit (1) passes from orifice (a) through port (c) and is drained to tank circuit
(4).
• When this valve is actuated, the LS pressure becomes nearly equal to the tank pressure.
• Since the pump delivery pressure - LS circuit pressure during unloading is larger than pump LS control
pressure, the signal is output to minimize the pump swash plate angle.
• During operation (when a given work is done within the delivery available with the minimum swash plate
angle), the delivery pressure corresponding to the minimum pump swash plate angle is set to LS pressure
+ P1 pressure.
• The LS differential pressure (dPLS) with the swash plate angle at the minimum becomes P1 pressure.
PC210LC-10 10-89
10 Structure and function
Control valve
10-90 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Control valve
1. Main pump
2. Main spool
3. Pressure compensation valve
4. Valve
5. Check valve
6. LS circuit
7. LS shuttle valve
Function (PC220-C2A4-042-K-00-A)
• The upstream pressure (spool meter-in downstream pressure) of pressure compensation valve (3) is
transmitted and led to LS shuttle valve (7) as LS pressure.
• Connected to actuator port (B) through valve (4), and makes LS pressure C actuator load pressure.
• In main spool (2), leading hole (a) with a small diameter also acts as an orifice.
• LS pressure works as source pressure when closing unload vale while control lever is operated, and this
pressure also functions as operating pressure when pressure compensation valve is compensated.
Operation (PC220-C2A4-044-K-00-A)
• When main spool (2) is operated, the pump pressure is transmitted to port (c) through leading hole (a) and
is led to LS circuit.
• When the pump pressures rises to reach the load pressure of port (B), check valve (5) opens and the
pressurized oil flows.
PC210LC-10 10-91
10 Structure and function
Control valve
1. Main pump
2. Main spool
3. Pressure compensation valve
4. LS shuttle valve
5. LS bypass plug
6. LS circuit
Function (ALL-PNSH-042-K-00-A)
• This valve relieves the residual pressure in LS pressure circuit (6) from orifices (a) and (b).
• Slows down the rising rate of LS pressure to prevent a sudden change of hydraulic pressure.
• Depending on the bypass flow from LS bypass plug (5), pressure loss is generated due to the circuit
resistance from orifice (c) of main spool (2) to LS shuttle valve (4).
• Effective LS differential pressure drops to improve a dynamic stability of the actuator.
10-92 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Control valve
1. Main pump
2. Valve
3. Shuttle valve
4. Piston
5. Spring
6. LS shuttle valve
Function
• Pressure compensation valve works as the load check valve.
• If the pump pressure (LS pressure) is lower than the load pressure at port (c), shuttle valve (3) in pressure
compensation valve piston (4) interconnects spring chamber (E) and port (C).
• The force of spring (5) operates piston (4) and valve (2) to the closing direction.
PC210LC-10 10-93
10 Structure and function
Control valve
When compensated
(When the load pressure is lower than other work equipment during a combined operation)
Function
• The pressure compensation valve closes by the LS pressure of port (D), and the spool meter-in
downstream pressure of port (B) becomes equivalent to the maximum pressure of other work equipment.
• Since the spool meter-in upstream pressure of port (A) is the pump pressure, the spool meter-in
differential pressure [upstream pressure port (A) pressure] - downstream pressure [port (B) pressure]
becomes equivalent to all the spools in operation.
• Pump flow is divided according to the ratio of the meter-in opening areas.
Operation
• Spring chamber (E) is interconnected to port (D).
• Piston (4) and valve (2) are moved in the closing direction (to the right) by the LS circuit pressure of port
(F) from other work equipment.
• Valve upstream pressure (= spool meter-in downstream pressure) of port (B) is controlled with the LS
pressure.
10-94 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Control valve
Function
• The state of division changes according to the area ratio of pressure compensation portions (A1) and (A2).
Area ratio = (A2)/(A1)
• When the area ratio is equal to 1: As the spool meter-in downstream pressure is equal to the maximum
load pressure, the oil flow is divided in the ratio as same as the opening area ratio.
• When the area ratio is more than 1: As the spool meter-in downstream pressure is higher than the
maximum load pressure, the oil flow to the compensated side is divided in a ratio lower than the opening
area ratio.
• When the area ratio is below 1: As the spool meter-in downstream pressure is lower than the maximum
load pressure, the oil flow to the compensated side is divided in a ratio higher than the opening area ratio.
PC210LC-10 10-95
10 Structure and function
Control valve
1. Main pump
2. Valve
3. Shuttle valve
4. Piston
5. Pressure compensation valve
Operation
• Shuttle valve (3) is pressed to the right side by the pressure of port (A). As a result, port (A) is
disconnected from port (C).
• Holding pressure at port (A) is transmitted to the spring chamber (B) to push piston (4) to the left so that
piston (4) is not separated from valve (2).
10-96 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Control valve
When traveling
Structure
• Since no holding pressure is generated at port (A) of the travel circuit, a pressure compensation valve
without shuttle valve (5) is adopted.
PC210LC-10 10-97
10 Structure and function
Control valve
1. Main pump
2. Boom valve spool
3. Pressure compensation valve
4. Suction safety valve
5. Suction valve
6. Check valve
7. LS shuttle valve
Function
• The regeneration circuit is installed across the cylinder bottom and cylinder head to increase flow to the
cylinder head when the boom is lowered.
Operation
• When the cylinder head pressure is lower than the bottom pressure, some of pressurized oil (A) from the
cylinder bottom flows to drain circuit (B) from the notch of boom spool (2).
• The remaining oil flows to regeneration circuit (C), opens check valve (6) and flows to the cylinder bottom
through circuit (D).
• Flow from regeneration circuit (C) merges into the oil from pump (1) in circuit (E).
10-98 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Control valve
When cylinder head pressure is higher than bottom pressure (digging operation, etc.)
Function
• Check valve (6) provided to regeneration circuit (C) closes to shut off the flow from the cylinder bottom to
the head.
PC210LC-10 10-99
10 Structure and function
Control valve
1. Main pump
2. Arm valve spool
3. Pressure compensation valve
4. Suction safety valve
5. Suction valve
6. Check valve
7. LS shuttle valve
Function
• The regeneration circuit installed between the cylinder head and cylinder bottom increases the oil flowing
to the cylinder bottom (pump delivery + regeneration flow) during arm IN operation in order to accelerate
the cylinder.
Operation
• When the cylinder head pressure is higher than the bottom pressure, part of pressurized oil (A) from the
cylinder head flows to drain circuit (B) through the notch of arm spool (2).
• The remaining oil flows to the regeneration circuit (C), opens check valve (6), and flows to the cylinder
bottom through circuit (D).
• Flow from regeneration circuit (C) merges into the oil from pump (1) in circuit (E).
10-100 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Control valve
Function
• Check valve (6) installed to regeneration circuit (C) closes and shuts off the oil flowing from the cylinder
head to the bottom.
PC210LC-10 10-101
10 Structure and function
Control valve
1. Main spool
2. Spring
3. LS spool
4. Spring
5. LS circuit (for bucket valve)
6. LS circuit (for bucket valve)
7. LS circuit (for arm valve)
8. LS circuit (for arm valve)
9. Pump merge-divider EPC valve (for main spool changeover)
10. Pump merge-divider EPC valve (for LS spool changeover)
Function
• This valve merges the pressurized oil (P1) and (P2) from the two pumps or divides them (enables them to
flow to respective control valve groups).
• This valve merges or divides LS circuit pressures as well.
10-102 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Control valve
Operation
• Since drive signal (IS1) of the EPC valve for the main spool is OFF, the output pressure of the pump
merge-divider EPC valve is 0 MPa {0 kg/cm2}.
• Main spool (1) is pressed to the right by spring (2). As a result, ports (E) and (F) are interconnected.
• Pressurized oil (P1) and (P2) discharged from the two pumps merge at ports (E) and (F), and flow to the
control valve which requires the oil.
• Since drive signal (IS2) of the EPC valve for LS spool (3) is also OFF, LS spool (3) is pressed to the right
by spring (4). As a result, ports (A) and (B) are interconnected and ports (B) and (C) are interconnected.
• The LS pressures transmitted from respective control valve spools through LS circuits (5), (6), (7), and (8)
are transmitted to all the pressure compensation valves.
When oil flowing from two pumps are divided [pump merge-divider valve changeover signals (IS1)
and (IS2) are ON]
Operation
• Since drive signal (IS1) of the main spool is ON, main spool (1) is moved to the left by the output pressure
from the pump merge-divider EPC valve. As a result, port (E) is disconnected from port (F).
• The pressurized oil from the two pumps are sent to respective control valve groups.
Pressure P1: To bucket, left travel, boom
Pressure P2: To swing, right travel, arm
• When drive signal (IS2) of the EPC valve for LS spool (3) becomes ON, LS spool (3) is also moved to the
left by the output pressure from the pump merge-divider EPC valve. As a result, ports (A) and (C) are
interconnected, and other ports remain disconnected from each other.
• The LS pressures transmitted from respective control valve spools through LS circuits (5), (6), (7), and (8)
are transmitted to respective control valves.
PC210LC-10 10-103
10 Structure and function
Control valve
a The illustration shows the condition when the combined operation of swing and R.H. travel is performed.
[When pilot pressure (BP) is supplied]
1. Valve
2. Spring
3. Piston
4. Piston
5. Swing valve spool
6. R.H. travel valve spool
7. Arm valve spool
8. LS shuttle valve
9. LS circuit
Function (PC220-J6PA-042-K-00-A)
• This valve prevents the high LS pressure of the swing valve from entering the LS circuits of work
equipment valves when the swing and work equipment are in combined operation.
• This valve serves to improve operability of the work equipment by blocking the high pressure generated
during swing operation.
Operation (ALL-J6PA-044-K-00-A)
10-104 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Control valve
PC210LC-10 10-105
10 Structure and function
Control valve
Operation (ALL-PL30-044-K-00-A)
10-106 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Control valve
PC210LC-10 10-107
10 Structure and function
Control valve
• Force of spring (8) and the force exerted by the pressure (PR) (0 MPa {0 kg/cm 2}, when engine is stopped),
are applied to valve (7) in the direction to disconnect the circuit ports (P2) and (A2).
• When the pressurized oil flows in from port (P2), valve (7) balances at a position where [Force (Area fd x
Pressure P2) = Force of spring (8) + Force (Area fd x Pressure PR)] holds.
• The opening of valve (7) is adjusted so that pressure (P2) remains at a constant level higher than pressure
(PR).
• When pressure (PR) rises above the set pressure, poppet (11) opens.
• The pressurized oil flows from port (PR) to orifice (a) in spool (14), then flows to seal drain port (TS) from
the opening of poppet (11).
• Differential pressure generated across orifice (a) in spool (14) moves spool (14) in the direction that the
spool closes the opening between ports (P2) and (PR).
• Pressure (P2) is reduced to a constant pressure (the set pressure) by the opening and supplied for use as
pressure (PR).
10-108 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Control valve
PC210LC-10 10-109
10 Structure and function
Control valve
10-110 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Control valve
PC210LC-10 10-111
10 Structure and function
Control valve
Operation (ALL-C6C0-044-K-00-A)
• If pilot pressure (PST) from the travel junction solenoid valve is shut off, travel junction spool (2) is pressed
back towards right by the force of spring (1). As a result, ports (PTL) and (PTR) are interconnected.
• If the oil flow rates to the R.H. and L.H. travel motors become different from each other, the oil flows
through the opening of travel junction spool (2) from port of higher pressure side to port of lower pressure
side supplying the difference of oil to the lower pressure side so that the oil flow rates to both motors will
be equalized.
10-112 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Control valve
• When pilot pressure (PST) from the travel junction solenoid valve is supplied, travel junction spool (2)
compresses spring (1) to the left side and ports (PTL) and (PTR) are disconnected.
• The oil flow rate to both right and left motors becomes independent.
PC210LC-10 10-113
10 Structure and function
Control valve
Function
• If boom RAISE, arm IN or OUT, bucket CURL or DUMP operation is performed when the machine is
traveling up a steep, the pilot pressure from the travel PPC valve serves to restrict the travel of respective
spools of boom, arm and bucket valves so that the oil flow rates to respective cylinders are restricted.
• To limit the travel of the boom, arm or bucket spool, the pilot pressure from the travel PPC valve passes
through the internal circuit of respective control valves and acts on the spool.
Operation (ALL-C6V1-044-K-00-A)
• The oil in the stroke limiting signal chamber (a) passes through orifices (5) and (6) of respective pistons (3)
and (4) build in the travel spring case, and then is drained through the travel PPC valve.
• When boom RAISE (or arm IN or OUT, bucket CURL or DUMP) operation is performed, spool (1) moves
to the left until it contacts the end face of spring case (2) (st0).
10-114 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Control valve
• If the right travel lever is moved to REVERSE (or FORWARD) position, the pilot pressure from the travel
PPC valve moves spool (7) to the left (or right).
• Spool (7) pushes piston (3) and orifice (5) is closed. As a result, stroke limiting signal chamber (a) and the
drain circuit from the travel PPC valve are disconnected.
• At this time, the pilot pressure from the travel PPC valve passes through orifice (6) of piston (4), acts on
the left end of piston (8) and pushes piston (8) to the right.
• When boom RAISE (or arm IN or OUT, bucket CURL or DUMP) operation is performed, spool (1) moves
to the left.
• Maximum travel of the spool is limited to (st1) that has reduction in travel by the amount of movement (st2)
of piston (8) to the right.
PC210LC-10 10-115
10 Structure and function
Control valve
Operation (ALL-L6C0-044-K-00-A)
• When operating boom “RAISE“, the pressurized oil from the control valve exerts a left-hand force on the
right side of ring-shaped area (S), of which outside diameter is poppet (5) diameter (d1) and of which
inside diameter is seat diameter (d2).
• The left-hand force on area (S) compresses spring (4) and moves poppet (5) to the left.
• As a result, the pressurized oil from the control valve passes through the opening of poppet (5) and flows
to the boom cylinder bottom.
10-116 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Control valve
• When the boom is operated to “NEUTRAL“ position, the pressurized oil flowing inside poppet (5) through
orifice (a) of poppet (5) is stopped by pilot piston (2).
• The holding pressure of boom cylinder bottom exerts a right-hand force on the left side of ring-shaped
area (S), of which outside diameter is poppet (5) diameter (d1) and of which inside diameter is seat
diameter (d2).
• The combined force of right-hand force on area (S) and the spring force of spring (4) moves poppet (5) to
the right.
• The circuit from control valve to boom cylinder bottom shuts off, then the oil pressure of the boom cylinder
bottom side is kept.
PC210LC-10 10-117
10 Structure and function
Control valve
• When operating boom “LOWER“, the pilot pressure from the PPC valve pushes pilot piston (2).
• The pressurized oil of the boom cylinder bottom flows from orifice (c) to drain port (T) through orifice (a)
and chamber (b).
• Chamber (b) inside poppet and drain port (T) are interconnected, and the pressure of chamber (b) drops.
• As the pressure of chamber (b) becomes less than the pressure of port (B), poppet (5) opens.
• As poppet (5) opens, the pressurized oil from port (B) flows to port (A) and then flows to the control valve.
10-118 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Control valve
(if equipped)
Function
• While arm is not operated by the left work equipment control lever, the hydraulic drift prevention valve
prevents pressurized oil to leak from arm cylinder head through spool (1) to prevent the arm from drifting
hydraulically.
Operation (PC-L9K0-044-K-00-A)
• During arm “OUT“ operation, the pressurized oil from the control valve exerts a left-hand force on the right
side of area (S) of ring-shaped surface, of which outside diameter is equal to diameter (d1) of poppet (5)
and of which inside diameter is equal to seat diameter (d2).
• The left-hand force on area (S) compresses spring (4) and moves poppet (5) to the left.
• As a result, pressurized oil from the control valve flows to the arm cylinder head through the opening of
poppet (5).
PC210LC-10 10-119
10 Structure and function
Control valve
• When the arm is operated to “NEUTRAL“ position, the pressurized oil flowing inside poppet (5) through
orifice (a) of poppet (5) is stopped by pilot piston (2).
• The holding pressure of arm cylinder head exerts a right-hand force on the left side of ring-shaped area
(S), of which outside diameter is equal to diameter (d1) of poppet (5) and of which inside diameter is equal
to seat diameter (d2).
• The combined force of right-hand force on area (S) and the reaction force of spring (4) moves poppet (5)
to the right.
• The circuit from control valve to arm cylinder head shuts off, then the oil pressure of the arm cylinder head
side is kept.
10-120 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Control valve
• When arm is operated “IN“, the pilot pressure from the PPC valve pushes pilot piston (2).
• The pressurized oil of the arm cylinder head flows from orifice (c) to drain port (T) through orifice (a) and
chamber (b).
• Chamber (b) inside poppet and drain port (T) are interconnected, and the pressure of chamber (b) drops.
• As the pressure of chamber (b) becomes less than the pressure of port (B), poppet (5) opens.
• As poppet (5) opens, the pressurized oil from port (B) flows to port (A) and then flows to the control valve.
PC210LC-10 10-121
10 Structure and function
Control valve
• If abnormally high pressure is generated in the boom cylinder bottom circuit, the pressurized oil in port (B)
opens check valve (6) to actuate safety valve (3).
• When the arm hydraulic drift prevention valve (optional) is installed to the arm cylinder head circuit, the
pressurized oil of the boom cylinder bottom circuit pressure or arm cylinder head circuit pressure,
whichever has higher pressure, opens check valve (6) or (6A) to actuate safety valve (3).
10-122 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Control valve
Operation (ALL-L9K1-044-K-00-A)
• In arm “OUT“ operation, the pilot pressure from the PPC valve pushes pilot piston (1).
• The pressurized oil in chamber (b) inside the valve is drained through orifice (c).
• The pressurized oil of the arm cylinder bottom side flows from orifice (c) to drain port (T) through orifice (a)
and chamber (b).
• Chamber (b) and drain port (T) are interconnected, and the pressure of chamber (b) drops.
• If the pressure in chamber (b) drops lower than that of port (A), the force exerted on the pressure receiving
surface of [Area (S2) of fd2 (surface of seat diameter)] on the port (A) side exceeds the combined force of
the force exerted on the pressure receiving surface [Area (S1) of fd1] on the chamber (b) side of valve (2)
and the spring force.
• The result is, (Force exerted on surface of fd2 > Force exerted on surface of fd1 + Force of spring).
• Valve (2) is pressed to the right and pressurized oil flows from port (A) to port (B).
• The pressurized oil of the arm cylinder bottom side is drained directly to the tank from port (B).
PC210LC-10 10-123
10 Structure and function
Control valve
• When the arm is operated from arm “OUT“ to “NEUTRAL“, the pilot pressure from PPC valve is shut off.
• The pressurized oil that flows in through orifice (a) in valve (2) and is drained, is stopped by pilot piston (1).
• The holding pressure of the arm cylinder bottom side exerts a left-hand force on the right side of ring-
shaped surface, whose area is equal to the area of (S2 - S1) of valve (2).
• The combined force of the force exerted on the ring-shaped surface and the spring force of the spring (3)
moves valve (2) to the left and shuts off port (A) and port (B).
10-124 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Control valve
Function
• This valve creates back pressure in the drain circuit to prevent cavitation caused by negative pressure in
each actuator circuit (motors, cylinders, etc.).
• In order to reduce output loss, this valve reduces the back pressure in the drain circuit when any operation
other than the travel and swing is performed.
Operation (ALL-PQ81-044-K-01-A)
PC210LC-10 10-125
10 Structure and function
Control valve
10-126 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Control valve
PC210LC-10 10-127
10 Structure and function
Control valve
1. Spring
2. Poppet
Function (PC220-PQ91-042-K-00-A)
• This valve has two selectable settings for its set pressure.
• If the extra power is necessary, this valve is set to the high-pressure setting when pilot pressure (P) is
applied to it from the 2-stage relief solenoid valve.
• The relief valve set pressure is determined by the load at installed length of spring (1). (1st stage set
pressure)
• When the 1st stage set pressure is set correctly, the 2nd stage set pressure does not need to be set.
Setting the 1st stage set pressure completes the setting of the 2nd stage set pressure.
Operation (PC-PQ91-044-K-00-A)
10-128 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Control valve
1. Spring
2. Piston
3. Spring
4. Holder
Function (PC220-PQJ2-042-K-00-A)
• This valve has two settings for its set pressure.
• This valve is set to the low-pressure setting when the pilot pressure is applied to it from the attachment
circuit selector solenoid valve.
• ON/OFF of the pilot pressure changes the set pressure according to the type of the installed attachment
(breaker, crusher, etc.).
• The set pressure of this valve is determined by the load at installed length of spring (1). (High-pressure
side)
• The set pressure of the low-pressure setting is determined by the travel of the piston.
Operation (ALL-PQJ2-044-K-00-A)
PC210LC-10 10-129
10 Structure and function
Control valve
10-130 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Swing motor
PC210LC-10 10-131
10 Structure and function
Swing motor
1. Brake spring
2. Drive shaft
3. Spacer
4. Case
5. Disc
6. Plate
7. Brake piston
8. Housing
9. Piston
10-132 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Swing motor
Type KMF125ABE-6
Theoretical delivery (cm3/rev) 125
PC210LC-10 10-133
10 Structure and function
Swing motor
• When the swing holding brake solenoid valve is de-energized, the pressurized oil from the self-pressure
reducing valve is blocked.
• Port (B) is connected to tank circuit (T).
• Brake piston (7) is pushed downward by brake spring (1).
• Disc (5) and plate (6) are pushed against each other to apply the brake.
10-134 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Swing motor
• When the swing holding brake solenoid valve is energized, the valve is switched.
• The pressurized oil from self-pressure reducing valve enters port (B), and flows into brake chamber (a).
• After entering chamber (a), the pressurized oil compresses brake spring (1) and moves brake piston (7)
upward.
• Disc (5) is separated from plate (6), releasing the brake.
Function (PC220-J6B1-044-K-00-A)
• When the swing is stopped, control valve (6) blocks the motor outlet circuit, but the motor rotation is
continued by inertial force.
• If the pressure of motor outlet circuit becomes abnormally high, it may cause damage to the motor.
• In order to prevent the motor damage, the relief valve relieves the abnormally high pressure to port (S)
from the motor outlet (high-pressure side).
PC210LC-10 10-135
10 Structure and function
Swing motor
Operation (PC-J6B1-044-K-00-A)
• When the swing control lever is moved to the “swing RIGHT position“, the pressurized oil from the pump is
supplied to port (MA) through control valve (6).
• The pressure in port (MA) rises, the starting torque is generated in the motor, and the motor starts to
rotate.
• During swing acceleration, the pilot pressure from 2-stage relief solenoid valve (7) is applied to port (PI) to
limit the relief volume.
• The pressurized oil from the outlet of the motor returns to the tank through port (MB) and control valve (6).
10-136 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Swing motor
• When the swing control lever is returned to “NEUTRAL“ from “swing RIGHT“ position, the supply of
pressurized oil from the pump to port (MA) is stopped.
• The pressurized oil from the motor outlet cannot return to the tank since the return circuit to the tank is
blocked by control valve (6). Thus, pressure in port (MB) increases.
• If the pressure in port (MB) becomes too high, the pressurized oil returns to the hydraulic tank through
relief valve (1) and port (S).
• Rotation resistance is exerted on the motor and the brake starts working.
• If the pressure in port (MB) becomes higher than that in port (MA), it presses shuttle valve (4).
• The pressure in chamber (C) becomes the same as that in port (MB), and increases to the set pressure of
relief valve (1).
• A high braking torque works on the motor, thereby stopping the motor.
• While relief valve (1) is actuated, the relieved pressurized oil and the pressurized oil from port (S) are
routed to port (MA) through the check valve (3).
• Thus, cavitations in port (MA) is prevented.
PC210LC-10 10-137
10 Structure and function
Swing motor
1. Valve seat
2. Valve
3. Poppet
4. Spring
5. Spring
6. Piston
Function (PC220-JA1A-042-K-00-A)
• This valve has two selectable settings for set pressure.
• The set pressure of this valve is determined by the load at installed length of spring (4).
• During swing acceleration, this valve receives pilot pressure (PI) from the 2-stage swing relief solenoid
valve and decreases the relief quantity (drain quantity).
• If pressure (P) is constant, energy loss can be reduced by decreasing oil flow (Q), or relief quantity (drain
quantity), according to the formula of [Energy loss = Pressure (P) x Oil flow (Q)]. Decrease in energy loss
leads to improvement of fuel consumption.
10-138 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Swing motor
Operation (PC220-JA1A-044-K-00-A)
PC210LC-10 10-139
10 Structure and function
Swing motor
10-140 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Swing motor
Function (PC220-J6B2-042-K-00-A)
• At the stop of swing operation, the upper structure may swing back. This is due to inertia of the mass of
the upper structure, the backlash and rigidity of the swing machinery system, and compressibility of the
hydraulic oil. This valve prevents such movement.
• The valve contributes to prevention of load spillage when the swing is stopped and also contributes to
reduction in the cycle time (enhances the positioning performance, enabling you to proceed to the next
work quicker than ever).
PC210LC-10 10-141
10 Structure and function
Swing motor
Operation (PC220-J6B2-044-K-00-A)
• The trapped pressure in port (MB) turns the motor in the opposite direction. (1st reverse rotation)
• Reversing pressure is generated in port (MA). Pressure (MA) is transmitted to chamber (a).
• As (fD3 > fD4) holds in regard to circle areas of spool (2), spring (3) is compressed and spool (2) is
moved to the right.
• Port (MA) and chamber (b) are interconnected to each other.
• Port (b) is interconnected to port (f) through the drilled hole (h) in spool (5). This bypasses the reversing
pressure in port (MA) to port (T), thereby preventing the 2nd reverse rotation of the motor.
10-142 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Travel motor
PC210LC-10 10-143
10 Structure and function
Travel motor
1. Regulator piston
2. Regulator valve
3. Motor case
4. Suction safety valve
5. Check valve
6. Rocker cam
7. Retainer guide
8. Output shaft
9. Pin
10-144 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Travel motor
10. Retainer
11. Piston
12. Cylinder block
13. Valve plate
14. Counterbalance valve spool
15. Ring
16. Brake piston
17. Plate
18. Disc
19. Ball retainer
Specification (PC200_10-C400-030-K-00-A)
Model HMV120-2
Min. 82
Theoretical delivery (cm3/rev)
Max. 120
Rated pressure: MPa {kg/cm2} 37.3 {380}
Min. 2,565
Rated speed (rpm)
Max. 1,595
Brake release pressure
1.18 {12}
(MPa {kg/cm2})
Travel speed changeover pressure
0.78 {8.0}
(MPa {kg/cm2})
PC210LC-10 10-145
10 Structure and function
Travel motor
• When the solenoid valve is de-energized, the pilot pressure oil from the self-pressure reducing valve does
not flow to port (P).
• Regulator valve (9) is pushed to the right by spring (10).
• The pressurized oil flowing from the control valve to end cover (8) through check valve (22) is stopped by
regulator valve (9).
• The fulcrum (a) of rocker cam (4) is located eccentric to the point of action (b) for the resultant force of
piston thrusts of cylinders (6).
• The resultant force of piston thrusts acts on rocker cam (4) as a moment that tilts the rocker cam toward
the maximum swash plate angle position.
• The pressurized oil in regulator piston (15) flows through orifice (c) in regulator valve (9), and is drained
into the motor case.
• Rocker cam (4) reaches the maximum swash plate angle position, thus, the motor capacity is maximized
and the travel speed is set to low-speed setting.
10-146 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Travel motor
• When the solenoid valve is energized, the pilot pressure oil from the self-pressure reducing valve flows to
port (P).
• Regulator valve (9) is pressed to the left.
• The pressurized oil from the control valve flows through passage (d) of regulator valve (9), and enters
regulator piston (15).
• Regulator piston (15) is pressed to the right.
• Rocker cam (4) tilts toward the minimum swash plate angle position. The motor capacity is minimized and
the travel speed is set to high-speed setting when the rocker cam reaches the position.
PC210LC-10 10-147
10 Structure and function
Travel motor
• When the travel lever is operated, the pressurized oil from the pump acts on counterbalance valve spool
(19) to make the parking brake circuit.
• The oil flows into chamber (e) of brake piston (12), compresses spring (11), and pushes piston (12) to the
left.
• Since the force pressing plate (13) and disc (14) against each other is eliminated, they are separated and
the brake is released.
10-148 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Travel motor
• When the travel lever is returned to NEUTRAL, counterbalance valve spool (19) returns to the neutral
position, and the parking brake circuit is blocked.
• The pressurized oil in chamber (e) of brake piston (12) is drained to the case through orifice (f) of brake
piston (12).
• Brake piston (12) is pressed to the right by spring (11).
• Plate (13) and disc (14) are pressed against each other, and the brake is applied.
• When brake piston (12) is returned, the flow of pressurized oil is restricted by slow return valve (22).
• This makes a delay in the application of the parking brake. The parking brake is applied after the machine
has stopped.
PC210LC-10 10-149
10 Structure and function
Travel motor
• Brake valve is comprised of suction safety valves (18A) and (18B), and counterbalance valve (18).
Function
• When the machine travels down a slope, its travel speed tends to get faster than the motor (engine) speed
because of the downward force generated from its own weight.
• Traveling the machine with the engine running at a low speed may induce idle run of the motor that allows
the machine to run out of control, posing a danger.
• These valves serve to prevent the above problem by enabling the machine to travel at a speed that
matches the engine speed (pump delivery).
10-150 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Travel motor
Operation (PC-C4N0-044-K-00-A)
• When the travel lever is operated, the pressurized oil is supplied from the control valve to port (PA).
• The oil opens suction safety valve (18A), and then flows from motor inlet port (MA) to motor outlet port
(MB).
• Since the motor outlet circuit is blocked by suction safety valve (18B) and spool (19), the pressure of the
supply side circuit increases.
PC210LC-10 10-151
10 Structure and function
Travel motor
• The pressurized oil of the supply side circuit flows through orifices (E1) and (E2) of spool (19) to chamber
(S1).
• When the pressure in chamber (S1) becomes higher than the spool selector pressure (reaction force of
spring (20)), spool (19) is pushed to the right.
• Both motor outlet port (MB) and port (PB) are connected to outlet passage (B1). As the result, the motor
outlet side opens and the motor rotates.
10-152 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Travel motor
• When the machine almost run out of control during downhill travel, the motor runs idle and the pressure of
the inlet side circuit decreases.
• The pressure in chamber (S1) decreases through orifices (E1) and (E2).
• When the pressure in chamber (S1) becomes lower than the spool selector pressure, spool (19) is
returned to the left by the reaction force of spring (20) and outlet passage (B1) is throttled.
• The pressure of the motor outlet side circuit increases and rotational resistance is generated in the motor,
preventing the machine from running out of control.
• Spool (19) moves to a position where the two forces acting on the spool balance with each other; one is
the force exerted by the pressure in the motor outlet port and the other is the sum of the force due to
machine's own weight and the force exerted by the pressure in the motor inlet port.
• Narrowing down the motor outlet side circuit in this way allows the machine to travel at a speed that
matches the pump delivery.
Function
• While the machine is stopped (or when it is travelling downhill), the counterbalance valve blocks the
passage between the inlet and outlet circuits of the motor.
• Since the motor is rotated by inertial force, the pressure in the motor outlet port is abnormally increased,
potentially causing damage to the motor and piping.
• The safety valve releases this abnormal pressure to the inlet port of the motor to prevent damage of the
equipment.
PC210LC-10 10-153
10 Structure and function
Travel motor
Operation (PC-C660-044-K-00-A)
When machine stops traveling (or traveling downhill) (when motor rotating clockwise)
• When the travel lever is set to NEUTRAL position, pressure (PA) in the motor inlet port decreases and the
pressure in chamber (S1) also decreases.
• When pressure drops below the changeover pressure of spool (19), spool (19) is pushed to the left by
reaction force of sprig (20) and narrows outlet passage (B1).
• Since inertial force maintains motor rotation, pressure (MB) of the outlet port side circuit increases.
• The pressurized oil pushes open check valve (17) and flows to the inlet side circuit on the opposite side
through notch (A1) of spool (19).
• If the pressure becomes higher than the set pressure of suction safety valve (18A), poppet (1) opens.
• When motor rotates counterclockwise, it operates reverse for clockwise rotation.
10-154 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Travel motor
• When the travel lever is operated, the pressurized oil from the pump moves spool (19) to the right.
• The pressurized oil flows to suction safety valve (18B) through check valve (16) and port (A2).
• Since the pressurized oil flowing through the circuit is throttled at notch (20), the pressure difference
between the inlet side and outlet side increases.
• The pump pressure rises and the large drawbar pull is obtained.
PC210LC-10 10-155
10 Structure and function
PPC valve
10-156 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
PPC valve
PC210LC-10 10-157
10 Structure and function
PPC valve
1. Spool
2. Piston
3. Disc
4. Nut (for lever connection)
10-158 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
PPC valve
5. Joint
6. Plate
7. Retainer
8. Valve body
9. Filter
Operation (PC-PL28-044-K-00-A)
PC210LC-10 10-159
10 Structure and function
PPC valve
• In addition, the pressure in port (P1) increases in proportion to the control lever travel.
• Accordingly, the control valve spool moves to a position at which the pressure in port (A) [equal to the
pressure in port (P1)] is balanced with the reaction force of the control valve spool return spring.
10-160 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
PPC valve
PC210LC-10 10-161
10 Structure and function
PPC valve
10-162 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
PPC valve
PC210LC-10 10-163
10 Structure and function
PPC valve
1. Plate
2. Case
3. Piston
4. Seal
5. Spool
6. Damper
10-164 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
PPC valve
Operation (PC-C6V0-044-K-00-A)
PC210LC-10 10-165
10 Structure and function
PPC valve
10-166 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
PPC valve
PC210LC-10 10-167
10 Structure and function
PPC valve
10-168 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
PPC valve
(if equipped)
PPC: Abbreviation for Proportional Pressure Control
EPC: Abbreviation for Electromagnetic Proportional Control
a For details of operation, see “Work equipment and swing PPC valve“.
PC210LC-10 10-169
10 Structure and function
PPC valve
10-170 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
PPC valve
1. Spool
2. Piston
3. Lever
4. Plate
5. Retainer
6. Valve body
7. EPC valve
PC210LC-10 10-171
10 Structure and function
PPC valve
2. Spool
3. Spring
4. Coil
5. Plunger
6. Push pin
7. Connector
Function (PC-PL2B-042-K-00-A)
• The EPC valve consists of the proportional solenoid portion and the hydraulic valve.
• When a signal current (i) from the pump controller is received, the EPC output pressure proportional to the
amperage of current is generated and output to the control valve.
Operation (PC200_10-PL2B-044-K-00-A)
10-172 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
PPC valve
PC210LC-10 10-173
10 Structure and function
PPC valve
10-174 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
PPC valve
PC210LC-10 10-175
10 Structure and function
PPC valve
(if equipped)
PPC: Abbreviation for Proportional Pressure Control
a For details of operation, see "Work equipment and Swing PPC valve".
10-176 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
PPC valve
1. Spool
2. Piston
3. Lever
4. Plate
5. Retainer
6. Valve body
PC210LC-10 10-177
10 Structure and function
Solenoid valve
a The figure shows the valve for a machine ready for installation of attachment.
10-178 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Solenoid valve
• This valve is installed between port (P) and the PPC solenoid valve. When the engine is stopped, plunger
(1) is pushed back to the left by the reaction force of spring (2), so the passage between ports (ACC) and
(P) is blocked, keeping the pressure in the accumulator.
• When the engine is running, plunger (1) is pushed to the right with the pilot pressure that is sent to port (P),
so port (P) is connected to port (ACC).
PC210LC-10 10-179
10 Structure and function
Solenoid valve
• Coil (1) is de-energized when no signal current flows through coil (1).
• Spool (2) is pushed back to the left by reaction force of spring (3).
• As the passage between ports (P) and (A) is blocked, the pilot pressure is not fed to the actuator through
port (A). At the same time, the passage to port (T) is made, so the oil from the actuator is drained to the
hydraulic tank.
• Coil (1) is energized when the signal current flows through coil (1).
• Spool (2) is pushed to the right by push pin (4).
• The passage between ports (P) and (A) is made, so the pilot pressure flows to the actuator through port
(A). At the same time, the passage to port (T) is blocked, so the oil from the actuator does not flow to the
hydraulic tank.
10-180 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Attachment circuit selector valve (for high pressure
circuit)
(if equipped)
Function (PC220-PQJ5-042-K-00-A)
• For a machine equipped with a breaker, this valve allows the oil from the breaker to return directly to the
hydraulic tank without passing through the main valve.
• For a machine equipped with other attachment (crusher, etc.), this valve serves to interconnect the
attachment to the main valve.
Operation (ALL-PQJ5-044-K-00-A)
When attachment other than breaker is installed
PC210LC-10 10-181
10 Structure and function
Attachment circuit selector valve (for high pressure
circuit)
• Pilot pressure (PI) from the attachment circuit selector solenoid valve compresses spring (2), and spool (1)
moves to the right to its stroke end.
• Port (ATT) is interconnected to port (ACC) and oil flows to the accumulator, so oil pulsation is absorbed by
the accumulator.
10-182 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Attachment circuit selector valve (for low pressure
circuit)
(if equipped)
Function (PC220-PQJ3-042-K-00-A)
• For a machine equipped with a breaker, this valve serves to interconnect between the main circuit from the
control valve to the breaker and the accumulator.
• For a machine equipped with other attachment (crusher, etc.), this valve serves to disconnect the main
circuit from the accumulator.
PC210LC-10 10-183
10 Structure and function
Attachment circuit selector valve (for low pressure
circuit)
Operation (PC-PQJ3-044-K-00-A)
When attachment other than breaker is installed
10-184 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Attachment circuit selector valve (for low pressure
circuit)
• Pilot pressure (PI) from the attachment circuit selector solenoid valve compresses spring (2), and spool (1)
moves to the right to its stroke end.
• Port (ATT) is disconnected from port (V) and is interconnected to port (T).
• The pressurized oil returning from the breaker returns directly to the hydraulic tank via port (T) without
passing through the control valve.
PC210LC-10 10-185
10 Structure and function
Center swivel joint
10-186 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Center swivel joint
2. Slipper seal
3. Rotor
4. Dust seal
5. O-ring
6. Cover
7. Shaft
PC210LC-10 10-187
10 Structure and function
Accumulator
Accumulator (PC-PL40-001-K-00-A)
1. Gas plug
2. Shell
3. Poppet
4. Holder
5. Bladder
6. Oil port
Specifications (PC-PL40-030-K-00-A)
Function (PC-PL40-042-K-01-A)
• The accumulator is installed on the solenoid valve. If the engine is stopped with the work equipment raised,
the pressure of the compressed nitrogen gas in the accumulator develops the pilot pressure to be supplied
to the control valve. Therefore, the spool can be operated to lower the work equipment by its own weight.
10-188 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Work equipment
1. Bucket
2. Bucket link
3. Bucket cylinder
4. Arm
5. Arm cylinder
6. Boom
7. Boom cylinder
PC210LC-10 10-189
10 Structure and function
Work equipment shim
Plastic shims
• The plastic shims are primarily inserted in the parts that need to be greased every 500 hours.
• The purposes of the plastic shims are to reduce the play of the work equipment in the lateral direction and
prevent squeaks and scuffing caused by rubbing of the steel parts at the end faces of the joint portions.
• Combined with the greasing interval extension bushings, the plastic shims prevent squeaks caused by
lack of grease and extend the greasing intervals.
• The plastic shims are inserted in every contact face of each part so that the steel parts at the end faces of
the joint portion will not come in contact with each other.
a Combined with the greasing interval extension bushings and dust seals, the plastic shims extend the
greasing interval to 500 hours.
10-190 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Bucket play adjustment shim
PC210LC-10 10-191
10 Structure and function
Cab mount and cab tipping stopper
1. Front damper
2. Rear damper
3. Cab tipping stopper
Structure
• 4 dampers are located in front and rear of cab (2 each), and fix cab and floor frame onto revolving frame.
• Oil-filled damper is used to absorb vibration.
• Cab tipping stopper (3) installed at a place in the rear section aims to secure the cab when the machine
tips over.
• As shown in following table, various dampers are available upon its mounting location.
Color of identifying seal
Location of damper Bent of craw
(printing)
Front left Not bent Yellow (215)
Front right Bent Blue (200)
Rear left Not bent Yellow (215)
Rear right Not bent Yellow (215)
10-192 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
ROPS cab
1. Front window
2. Windshield wiper
3. Head lamp
4. Ceiling window
5. KOMTRAX communication antenna
6. KOMTRAX GPS antenna
7. Radio antenna
8. Door
9. Mirror
Function (PC220-K000-042-K-00-A)
• ROPS cab is a structure which protects the operator fastening a seat belt not to be crushed when the
machine tips over.
PC210LC-10 10-193
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
10-194 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
PC210LC-10 10-195
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
10-196 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
Function
• The neutral safety circuit is employed to secure safety when the engine is started.
a The engine does not start until the lock lever is set to the “LOCK“ position.
• The KOMTRAX engine cut circuit is employed to disable the engine from starting when the KOMTRAX
terminal receives an engine cut command issued through external operation.
• When you cannot stop the engine due to stuck starting switch (6), engine shutdown secondary switch (7)
is usable for stopping the engine.
PC210LC-10 10-197
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
For this reason, a fail-safe mechanism is provided with the electrical system to stop the engine when an
electrical failure occurs.
• If starting switch (6) is turned to “START“ position when lock lever (9) is in the “LOCK“ position, starting
current is supplied to starting motor (15) and the engine starts.
If lock lever (9) is in the “FREE“ position, starting motor cut-off relay (11) cuts off the starting current to
starting motor (15), thus the engine does not start. This is the neutral safety mechanism.
• Upon receipt of the engine cut-off command from the external source, KOMTRAX terminal (19) sends the
signal to machine monitor (18).
Machine monitor (18) causes starting motor cut-off relay (12) to cut off the starting current to starting motor
(15), therefore the engine does not start.
Engine stop
• If starting switch (6) is turned to “OFF“ position, the current from ACC terminal of starting switch (6) to
engine controller (8) is cut off, and consequently the command current to fuel supply pump (16) is cut off.
Fuel supply pump (16) stops fuel feed, decreasing the engine speed until the engine stops.
10-198 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
PC210LC-10 10-199
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
Function
• This function allows the operator to select any of the six working modes of P, E, L, ATT-P, ATT-E and B
with the working mode selector switch of the machine monitor. The most suitable combination of engine
torque (T) and pump absorption torque can be selected depending on the work contents of the machine. If
“None“ is selected for the attachment in the default setting of the service mode, one of the three modes of
P, E and L is selectable.
• The pump controller calculates the pump absorption upper limit torque based on the working mode, speed
setting by the fuel control dial, and actual engine speed, and controls the pump to maintain it near the
setting matching point for each mode even at high loads.
• When the engine speed is lowered, the controller prevents the engine from stopping by throttling the pump
absorption torque.
10-200 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
PC210LC-10 10-201
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
• As the engine load decreases, the engine speed increases. [See (4) in graph]
• The controller raises the pump absorption upper limit torque (PT) to maintain it near the matching point.
[See (5) in graph]
• To save fuel consumption, the controller lowers the engine matching speed (Nm) at low loads (low delivery
and torque). [See (6) in graph]
B and L modes
Working mode Partial output point
B 75 %
L 70 %
Matching point
Working mode Matching point
77.2 kW/1,655 rpm
B
{103.5 HP/1,655 rpm}
73.55 kW/1,650 rpm
L
{98.60 HP/1,650 rpm}
• In B or L mode, engine output is controlled to a constant level.
10-202 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
• The controller controls the pump absorption upper limit torque (PT) to keep the engine torque constant
along the equal engine horsepower curve.
PC210LC-10 10-203
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
Control function that becomes available when emergency pump drive switch is turned on.
• Even if any abnormality occurs in the controller and no work is possible because the main pump does not
work properly, operating emergency pump drive switch (1) temporarily enables to maintain functions of the
machine with absorption torque quite similar to those in the E mode.
In this case, a constant current flows from the battery to the PC-EPC valve, so the oil pressure is sensed
by only the PC-EPC valve.
a: Emergency (when abnormal)
b: Normal (when normal)
a Emergency pump drive switch (1) is an alternative type. If the machine is operated at “Emergency (a)“
position when the machine is normal condition, Action Level “L03“ will be shown on the display.
10-204 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
PC210LC-10 10-205
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
10-206 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
16c. PC valve
17. Rear pump
17a. Servo
17b. LS valve
17c. PC valve
18. Control valve
18a. Self-pressure reducing valve
18b. Merge-divider valve
18c. Travel junction valve
18d. Main relief valve
18e. Variable back pressure valve
19. Front pump PC-EPC valve
20. Rear pump PC-EPC valve
21. LS-EPC valve
22. Pump merge-divider EPC valve (for main spool)
23. Pump merge-divider EPC valve (for LS spool)
24. Travel junction solenoid valve
25. 2-stage relief solenoid valve
26: Variable back pressure solenoid valve
Function
• The LS control function, cut-off function, and 2-stage relief function enable the machine to maintain the
optimum matching under various working conditions.
LS control function
• According to the actuator operation, the output pressure from the LS-EPC valve to LS valve varies in order
to change the selector point for pump delivery [LS set differential pressure (DLS)] in the LS valve.
• The build-up time of pump delivery will be optimized, and the ease of combined operation and fine control
will be improved.
PC210LC-10 10-207
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
A: 0 MPa {0 kg/cm2}
B: EPC pressure (Psig) = 1.8 MPa {18 kg/cm2}
Cut-off function
• This function increases PC-EPC current (J) to reduce the flow rate at relief, improving fuel consumption.
Operating for turning on cut-off function
When the one-touch power maximizing function is not activated and the average of front pump and rear
pump oil pressure sensor values is 27.9 MPa {285 kg/cm2} or higher.
The cut-off function does not work, however, while the machine is travelling, swing lock switch is in “ON“
position.
10-208 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
PC210LC-10 10-209
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
Function
• By operating the one-touch power max. switch on the L.H. work equipment control lever knob, the power
is increased for a limited time.
• This can be used to increase digging force for a limited time, for example, when digging out a rock during
excavating work.
• If the one-touch power max. switch is pressed in P mode, E mode, ATT-P mode or ATT-E mode when the
load pressure is high, the hydraulic force will be increased by approx. 7%, and the horsepower will be
increased by approx. 12% to boost the digging force.
• The functions are automatically set as follows.
Function Setting
Engine and pump combined control Matching at rated output point
34.8 MPa {355 kg/cm2}
2-stage relief function O
37.2 MPa {380 kg/cm2}
Cut-off function Cancel
a This function maintains the power maximizing operation as long as the one-touch power max. switch is
pressed. This function, however, is cancelled in about 8.5 seconds regardless of pressing of the switch.
10-210 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
1. Pump controller
2. Engine controller
3. Machine monitor
4. Fuel control dial
5. Fuel supply pump
6. Sensors
7. Oil pressure switch
8. Oil pressure sensor
9. Main pump
10. Control valve
10a. Self-pressure reducing valve
10b. Merge-divider valve
10c. Travel junction valve
11. PPC lock solenoid valve
Input and output signals
a. CAN signal
b. Oil pressure sensor signal
c. Oil pressure switch signal
d. 1st throttle signal
e. Fuel supply pump control signal
f. Sensor signals
PC210LC-10 10-211
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
Function
• When all the control levers are set to NEUTRAL position for waiting for a dump truck or work, the engine
speed is automatically reduced to its controlled speed, and fuel consumption and noise are lowered.
• When any control lever is operated, the engine speed returns immediately to the speed set with the fuel
control dial.
Operation
10-212 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
PC210LC-10 10-213
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
Function
• This is a function that raises the engine speed automatically to warm up the engine if the coolant
temperature is low after start-up of the engine.
• There are two types of the engine automatic warm-up function depending on the purpose; one is "Heater
warm-up" and the other is "Normal warm-up"
• The purpose of the heater warm-up is to raise the coolant temperature and improve the heater efficacy.
• The purpose of the normal warm-up is to warm up the engine to prevent it from being damaged by
operation in low temperature.
Operating conditions 1
Machine specification: with air conditioner
Air conditioner: blower “ON“
Coolant temperature: below 55°C
Ambient temperature: below 5°C
Manual stationary regeneration: OFF
oot accumulation: Max. 2 g/l
O O
If any of operating conditions 1 is not satisfied When all of operating conditions 1 are satisfied
Heater warm-up is disabled (normal warm-up) Heater warm-up is enabled
Operating conditions 2 (all required for operation) O
Coolant temperature: below 30°C
O
Engine speed: Max. 1,200 rpm
O O
Operation Operation
O O
Condition for cancellation Condition for cancellation
(Canceled when either one of the following (Canceled when either one of the following
conditions is met.) conditions is met.)
Coolant temperature: Min. 30°C Coolant temperature: Min. 60°C
Auto Duration of automatic warming-up: Min.
Ambient temperature: Min. 10°C
10 minutes
10-214 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
O O
Cancellation
Engine speed: as desired
PC210LC-10 10-215
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
a See "Engine automatic warm-up function" for the system circuit diagram.
• Prevents overheating to protect the engine and hydraulic components by reducing load on the pump and
lowering the engine speed if the coolant or hydraulic oil temperature becomes too high.
10-216 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
PC210LC-10 10-217
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
a See "Engine automatic warm-up function" for the system circuit diagram.
• Prevents seizure of the turbocharger by limiting the engine speed if the engine speed is increased
exponentially when starting the engine.
A: Start engine
B: Duration of turbocharger protection (approx. 0 - 20 sec.)
C: Modulating time (approx. 1 sec.)
D: 500 rpm
E: Approx. 1,050 rpm
F: 1,650 rpm (*1)
*1: Working mode: P mode
Fuel control dial: Full speed (MAX) position
When travel lever is operated
10-218 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
PC210LC-10 10-219
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
Function
Swing lock and swing holding brake function
• On machines with swing lock (manual), swing can be locked at any position by turning swing lock switch
(1) to “ON“ position.
• Interlocked with the swing operation, the swing holding brake (automatic lock) prevents hydraulic drift from
occurring after the swing stops.
• Interlocked with the L.H. and R.H. work equipment control levers and attachment control pedals
operations, the swing holding brake is canceled to reduce the load on the swing equipment during
excavation work.
Swing lock
OFF ON
switch
Swing lock Not lighting Lights up
monitor
Function Swing holding brake Swing lock
• When the L.H. and R.H. work equipment • Swing holding brake works and locks the
control levers and attachment control swing of the upper structure.
pedals are set to NEUTRAL position, the • Even if the L.H. work equipment control
swing holding brake works in approx. 5 lever is operated for swing, the swing
sec. holding brake cannot be canceled, and
Operation
• When the L.H. and R.H. work equipment the upper structure does not swing.
control lever or attachment control pedal is
operated, the swing holding brake is
canceled and the upper structure
becomes free to swing.
A: When work equipment control lever or attachment control pedal is operated (Swing holding brake
“canceled“)
B: When work equipment control levers and attachment control pedals are in “NEUTRAL“ position
C: Swing holding brake “applied“
D: Approx. 5 sec.
10-220 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
PC210LC-10 10-221
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
10-222 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
1. Pump controller
2. Engine controller
3. Machine monitor
4. Fuel control dial
5. Fuel supply pump
6. Sensors
7. Front pump oil pressure sensor
8. Rear pump oil pressure sensor
9. Oil pressure sensor
10. Travel alarm
11. Front pump
11a. Servo
11b. LS valve
11c. PC valve
12. Rear pump
12a. Servo
12b. LS valve
12c. PC valve
13. Control valve
13a. Self-pressure reducing valve
13b. Merge-divider valve
13c. Travel junction valve
14. Travel motor
15. Travel speed increase solenoid valve
PC210LC-10 10-223
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
Function
Travel speed selector function
1. Travel speed “Manual“ change
• Switching the travel speed selector switch to “Hi“, “Mi“ or “Lo“ changes the motor capacity, which
changes the machine travel speed.
Lo Mi Hi
Travel speed selector switch
(low speed) (medium speed) (high speed)
Motor flow rate (%) 75 70 100
Motor capacity (Max.) (Min.) (Min.)
Travel speed (km/h) 3.0 4.1 5.5
2. Travel speed “Automatic“ change
1) Automatic change corresponding to engine speed
• If you adjust the engine speed to 1,500 rpm or less with the fuel control dial, the travel speed does
not switch to “Hi“ when the machine is traveling in “Mi“, and automatically changes to “Mi“ when the
machine is travelling in “Hi“.
2) Automatic change according to pump delivery pressure
• If the travel circuit oil pressure increases on an uphill with the travel speed selector switch in “Hi“,
and the travel circuit oil pressure of 33.3 MPa {340 kg/cm 2} or above continues for 0.5 seconds or
more, the travel motor capacity is switched to that for medium speed travel (equivalent to “Mi“)
automatically (the travel speed switch position remains in “Hi“).
• If the travel circuit oil pressure decreases on a level ground or downhill during low speed travel
caused by the automatic speed change due to increase in the load on the travel circuit, and the
travel circuit oil pressure of 19.6 MPa {200 kg/cm2} or below continues for 0.5 seconds or more, the
travel motor capacity is switched back to that for speed of “Hi“ automatically.
10-224 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
PC210LC-10 10-225
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
10-226 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
Function
• The operating condition of each controller can be checked with the system operating lamp to prevent the
abnormal end of the disconnection of the battery power supply circuit while the controllers are in
operation.
a Before cutting off the battery power supply circuit, turn the starting switch to the “OFF“ position, and check
that the system operating lamp is OFF, then turn the battery disconnect switch to the “OFF“ position.
a If you turn the battery disconnect switch to the “OFF“ position (battery power supply circuit is cut off) while
the system operating lamp is lit, Controller Data Lost Error may occur. Do not operate the battery
disconnect switch as long as the system operating lamp is lit.
a The system operating lamp goes out in 2 minutes longest after the starting switch is turned to the “OFF“
position.
a The system operating lamp may sometimes light up while the starting switch is turned to the “OFF“
position because KOMTRAX terminal may maintain its communication under this condition.
PC210LC-10 10-227
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
a When you want to cut off the battery circuit for maintenance but the system operating lamp keeps on
lighting up, turn the starting switch to the “ON“ position once, then turn it to the “OFF“ position. The
lamp will go out in 2 minutes longest.
After the system operating lamp goes out, turn the battery disconnect switch immediately to the “OFF“
position.
10-228 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
PC210LC-10 10-229
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
Function
• Setting of the working mode and oil flow rate on the machine monitor allows controlling the oil flow rate to
the attachment when the attachment control pedal is fully depressed.
• Attachment operation switches depending on the working mode as shown below.
Working mode Attachment operation
ATT–P, ATT–E Double-acting
B Single-acting
10-230 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
PC210LC-10 10-231
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
10-232 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
PC210LC-10 10-233
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
10-234 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
PC210LC-10 10-235
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
10-236 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
PC210LC-10 10-237
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
10-238 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
PC210LC-10 10-239
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
1. Knob
2. Dial
3. Spring
4. Ball
5. Potentiometer
6. Connector
Function (PC-AGJ7-042-K-00-A)
• This dial is installed in the right console box. Turning knob (1) causes potentiometer (5) shaft to rotate.
• As the potentiometer shaft is turned, the resistance of the variable resistor in potentiometer (5) changes
and a throttle signal is sent to the engine controller.
• The hatched areas in the graph are abnormality detection areas. If the throttle voltage is within the area,
the engine speed drops down to low idle.
10-240 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
1. Resistance
2. Connector
Specifications (PC220-C3VR-030-K-00-A)
Resistance: 20 z
Function (PC-C3VR-042-K-00-A)
• When the emergency pump drive switch or the emergency work equipment drive switch is turned to “ON“
position, this resistor sends an electric current to each PC-EPC valve that is appropriate for their condition.
a No electric current flows in the normal condition.
PC210LC-10 10-241
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
Specifications (PC220-Q2V1-030-K-00-A)
Resistance: 120 z
Function (PC220-Q2V1-042-K-00-A)
• This resistance controls the reflection of the high-frequency signals at the end of CAN communication line
not to generate noise on the CAN communication signals sending and receiving between controllers.
a If this resistance is missing, an error occurs on CAN communication and the machine cannot be
operated.
1. Connector
2. Sensor
3. O-ring
Specifications (PC220-ABK6-030-K-00-A)
Contact type: Normally closed
Function (PC-ABK6-042-K-00-A)
10-242 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
• This oil pressure switch is installed to the cylinder block. It detects engine oil pressure, and turns the
switch to "ON" position when the pressure goes below the specified value.
PC210LC-10 10-243
10 Structure and function
Electrical control system
1. Plug
2. Switch
3. Connector
Specifications (PC220-E610-030-P-00-A)
Contact type: Normally open
Operating (ON) pressure: 490 ± 98.1 kPa {5.0 ± 1.0 kg/cm2}
Resetting (OFF) pressure: 294 ± 49.0 kPa {3.0 ± 0.5 kg/cm2}
Function (PC220-E610-042-P-00-A)
• Two sensors are installed to attachment PPC valve. They detect PPC oil pressure during attachment
operation and turn the switch to “ON“ position if the pressure is equal or higher than the specified
pressure.
10-244 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Machine monitor system
1. Machine monitor
2. Battery
3. Pump controller
4. Engine controller
5. Air conditioner controller
6. KOMTRAX terminal
7. Sensors and switches
8. Wiper motor and window washer motor
9. Camera
Input and output signals
a. Power supply
b. CAN signal
c. Sensor and switch signals
d. Drive signal
e. Camera signal
Function
• The monitor system keeps the operator informed of all machine functions, by monitoring the machine
conditions by using the sensors and switches installed in various parts of the machine and processing
them instantly to display on the machine monitor.
PC210LC-10 10-245
10 Structure and function
Machine monitor system
The information displayed on the machine monitor falls into the following types:
1. Alarm when the machine has trouble
2. Machine status display (coolant temperature, hydraulic oil temperature, fuel level, etc.)
3. Display of camera image
• The switches on the machine monitor have an operating function to control the machine.
10-246 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Machine monitor system
Function
• The machine monitor has monitor display function, mode selection function and switch function for
electrical parts etc. Also it has an alarm buzzer.
• The machine monitor has a CPU (Central Processing Unit) in it to process, display, and output the
information.
• The machine monitor consists of a display and switches: the display is of LCD type, and the switches are
of flat sheet switch.
• If a failure occurs in the machine monitor itself, controller or wiring circuit between monitor and controller,
the monitor does not display properly.
PC210LC-10 10-247
10 Structure and function
Machine monitor system
10-248 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Machine monitor system
PC210LC-10 10-249
10 Structure and function
Machine monitor system
Display (PC-Q1LA-042-K-00-A)
A: Standard screen
B: Check before starting screen
C: Maintenance interval warning screen
D: Warning screen
E: Guidance screen
F: Camera image screen
a Camera image screen (F) shown in the figure is when two or more cameras are installed
1. Message monitor
2. KDPF regeneration monitor
3. Engine stop monitor
4. Seatbelt monitor
5. Air conditioner monitor
6. Wiper monitor
10-250 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Machine monitor system
PC210LC-10 10-251
10 Structure and function
Machine monitor system
Gauge
Gauge Display item Description Remarks
Temperature Background • Indicates
Range
(°C) color corresponding
W1 105 Red temperature range.
(*1) • Alarm buzzer sounds
W2 102 Red
Engine coolant when the temperature
W3 100 Blue is 105°C or higher.
temperature
gauge W4 85 Blue • If the monitor
W5 60 Blue background appears
white, warm-up the
W6 30 White engine.
Temperature Background • Indicates
Range
(°C) color corresponding
H1 105 Red temperature range.
(*1) • Alarm buzzer sounds
H2 102 Red
when the temperature
Hydraulic oil H3 100 Blue is 105°C or higher.
temperature H4 85 Blue • If the monitor
gauge H5 40 Blue background appears
white, warm up the
H6 20 White hydraulic
components.
Range Quantity (l) Background • Indicates
color corresponding
F1 304 Blue remaining fuel level.
(*1) F2 245 Blue
Fuel level gauge F3 200 Blue
F4 100 Blue
F5 60 Blue
F6 41 Red
• Indicates
instantaneous fuel
Segment Load level consumption
(average of fuel
consumption per 3
minutes) in 10 steps.
(*2) Light to (It is displayed when
Green 1 to 8
Eco gauge medium the user menu's
“ECO guidance“ o
“Display setting“ o
“Eco gauge display“
Orange 9 , 10 Heavy is set.)
• Indicates
accumulated engine
operating hours (the
Service meter 00000.0 h to 99999.9 h alternator is running).
(F4 switch changes it
to clock display.)
10-252 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Machine monitor system
*1: If the gauge signal is not available due to open circuit in CAN communication line, the gauge pointer
disappears.
*2: Display item is switched when the user menu's “ECO guidance“ o “Display setting“ are specified.
PC210LC-10 10-253
10 Structure and function
Machine monitor system
Caution monitor
Description
Monitor
Symbol Display item display Action level Remarks
Range
(Background monitor
color)
Lights up • Background color
Min. 102°C (Red) L02 changes depending
Min. 30°C or Lights up on the temperature
— detected.
below 102°C (Blue)
(*1) • Alarm buzzer sounds
Engine coolant when the temperature
temperature is 105°C or higher.
Lights up • If the monitor
Below 30°C —
(White) background appears
white, warm-up the
engine.
Lights up • Background color
Min. 102°C (Red) L02 changes depending
Min. 20°C or Lights up on the temperature
— detected.
below 102°C (Blue)
• Alarm buzzer sounds
(*1) when the temperature
Hydraulic oil is 105°C or higher.
temperature • If the monitor
Lights up background appears
Below 20°C —
(White) white, warm up the
hydraulic
components.
10-254 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Machine monitor system
Description
Monitor
Symbol Display item display Action level Remarks
Range
(Background monitor
color)
When • When failure is
abnormal detected with the
Lights up (*3) engine stopped, the
(*1) (When below (Yellow) L01 monitor lights up on
Engine oil level specified
level) the screen.
When normal Lights out —
When • When failure is
abnormal detected with the
(*1) Lights up (*3) engine running, the
(When above (Yellow)
Clogging of air specified L01 monitor lights up on
cleaner level) the screen.
When normal Lights out —
When • When failure is
abnormal detected with the
(There is engine running, the
water Lights up monitor lights up on
(*1) — the screen.
collected (Red)
Water separator above the
specified
amount.)
When normal Lights out —
When • The display changes
exceeding Lights up depending on the
—
maintenance (Red) time to/after the
interval maintenance.
• After the starting
Maintenance (*2) switch is turned to
interval warning “ON“ position , the
When Lights up monitor turns on if the
exceeding —
(Yellow) monitor light-up
maintenance conditions are met,
notifying time and then goes out in
30 seconds.
When action • When failure is
level “L04“ or Lights up detected in the
(Red) L04 and L03
“L03“ is machine system, the
System status detected monitor lights up.
• When the
When action Lights up (*3) background color is
level “L01“ is (Yellow) L01 red, the alarm buzzer
detected
sounds.
When action • When failure is
level “L04“ or Lights up detected in the
(Red) L04 and L03
“L03“ is engine system, the
State of engine detected monitor lights up.
system • When the
When action (*3)
Lights up background color is
level “L01“ is (Yellow) L01 red, the alarm buzzer
detected
sounds.
PC210LC-10 10-255
10 Structure and function
Machine monitor system
Description
Monitor
Symbol Display item display Action level Remarks
Range
(Background monitor
color)
When action • When failure is
level “L04“ or Lights up detected in the
(Red) L04 and L03
“L03“ is hydraulic system, the
State of detected monitor lights up.
hydraulic system • When the
When action Lights up (*3) background color is
level “L01“ is (Yellow) L01 red, the alarm buzzer
detected
sounds.
When action • When failure is
level “L04“ or Lights up detected in the KDPF
(Red) L04 and L03
“L03“ is system, the monitor
State of KDPF detected lights up.
system • When the
When action Lights up (*3) background color is
level “L01“ is (Yellow) L01 red, the alarm buzzer
detected
sounds.
When action • The monitor lights up
level “L04“ or Lights up when soot is
(Red) L03
“L03“ is deposited inside
detected KDPF or cleaning
Deposition of function is abnormally
soot on KDPF degraded.
When action Lights up (*3) When the
level “L01“ is (Yellow) L01 background color is
detected
red, the alarm buzzer
sounds.
• The monitor lights up
Engine Engine Lights up and alarm buzzer
overspeed overspeed is (Red) L02 sounds when engine
detected overspeed is
detected.
• When failure is
State of air When air (*3) detected in the air
Lights up
conditioner conditioner is conditioner system,
(Yellow) L01
system abnormal the monitor lights up.
When action Lights up • When failure is
level “L04“ is (Red) L04 detected on the
detected machine, the monitor
When action Lights up lights up.
level “L03“ is (Red) L03 When the
detected background color is
Action level
When action Lights up red, the alarm buzzer
level “L02“ is (Red) L02 sounds.
detected
When action Lights up (*3)
level “L01“ is (Yellow)
detected L01
*1: It is included in the check before starting items. After the staring switch is turned to “ON“ position, the
monitor turns on for two seconds, and changes to the standard screen if no failure is found.
*2: The notifying time is changeable from the items in “Maintenance mode display setting“ of the service mode.
*3: Monitor goes out after lighting up for 2 seconds.
10-256 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Machine monitor system
Pilot monitor
Symbol Display item Description Remarks
• It operates automatically • Indicates preheat
at a low temperature. operating status.
Automatic (Symbol lights up as long
preheating as for approx. 30
seconds)
• It goes off after the engine
is started.
Elapsed time
Preheating after turning
the starting Monitor
switch to display
Manual “HEAT
preheating (Preheating)“
0 to 30 sec. Lights up
30 to 40 sec. Flashes
After 40 sec.
Lights out
or longer
One-touch • Indicates the
power max. Monitor display operating status of
switch one-touch power
One-touch Lights up maximizing function.
power max.
ON (Goes out if pressed for 8.5
seconds)
OFF Lights out
Swing lock Swing brake Monitor • Indicates swing lock
switch cancel switch display operating status.
OFF OFF Lights out
Swing lock ON OFF Lights up
OFF ON Flashes
ON ON Flashes
• Indicates front glass
INT: Intermittent operation
wiper operating
Wiper ON: Continuous operation condition.
Lights out: Holds in position
• Indicates air
Lights up: ON conditioner and air
Air conditioner blower operating
Lights out: OFF
status.
• Indicates whether
seatbelt is fastened.
• Indicates
KDPF Lights up: KDPF is being regenerated regenerating state of
regeneration Lights out: KDPF regeneration is finished KDPF.
PC210LC-10 10-257
10 Structure and function
Machine monitor system
10-258 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Machine monitor system
Switches (PC-Q1C0-042-K-00-A)
PC210LC-10 10-259
10 Structure and function
Machine monitor system
10-260 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Machine monitor system
Green arrow: Selects the item on the right side of the tab.
Switching the select item White arrow: Selects the item on the right side of the current item.
(To the leftmost item from the rightmost item.)
Green arrow: Selects the item on the left side of the tab.
Switching the select item White arrow: Selects the item on the left side of the current item.
(To the rightmost item from the leftmost item.)
PC210LC-10 10-261
10 Structure and function
Machine monitor system
Guidance
Item Function
icon
Starts function.
Start (Used for starting measurement of split fuel consumption on the fuel
consumption display screen.)
Stops operation.
Stop (Used for stopping measurement of split fuel consumption on fuel
consumption display screen.)
Switching to ATT1 oil flow Switching the current screen to attachment 1 oil flow setting screen.
setting screen (Enabled only when attachments 1 and 2 are equipped)
Switching to ATT2 oil flow Switching the current screen to attachment 2 oil flow setting screen.
setting screen (Enabled only when attachments 1 and 2 are equipped)
Switching to oil flow setting Switches to the attachment and breaker oil flow setting screen.
screen
10-262 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Machine monitor system
Guidance
Item Function
icon
Switches to the currently occurring failures list screen.
Switching to the currently Background colors allow confirming the type of information
occurring failures list transmitted.
screen • Red: When an action level of L2, L3 or L4 is displayed
• Yellow: When the action level of L1 is displayed
Display No. 1 and No. 2 Display both images of No. 1 and No. 2 cameras simultaneously.
camera screens
PC210LC-10 10-263
10 Structure and function
Machine monitor system
10-264 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Machine monitor system
PC210LC-10 10-265
10 Structure and function
Machine monitor system
a For how to operate the service mode functions, see “Service mode“ section in Testing and adjusting.
10-266 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
KOMTRAX system
• The KOMTRAX system consists of the KOMTRAX terminal, communication antenna and GPS antenna.
• This system transmits various machine information by use of the radio communication. This system allows
the KOMTRAX operator to refer the information and provide various services to the customers.
• Information transmittable from the KOMTRAX system are as follows.
1. Operation map
2. Service meter reading
3. Location information
4. Abnormality record
a To provide the services, you need to make an arrangement for starting the KOMTRAX service separately.
PC210LC-10 10-267
10 Structure and function
KOMTRAX system
Type: TC330
10-268 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
KOMTRAX system
Function (PC-Q220-042-K-00-A)
• This terminal utilizes satellite communications technology.
• The terminal is an equipment which transmits various machine information obtained through network
signals and input signals, as well as GPS positioning data. The terminal can transmit data via the
communication antenna.
• The status of the terminal can be checked by using the menu of “KOMTRAX setting“ in the service mode
of the machine monitor .
• Use of KOMTRAX terminal must be limited for the countries in which such communication is allowed.
• This terminal has LED lamps and 7-segment lamp indicator used for testing and troubleshooting on its
display section.
a When commencing operation of the KOMTRAX system or changing the country in which the system is
used, you must give notice about the name of the country to Komatsu Ltd.
a When operating the system in Japan, install a terminal dedicated for use in Japan.
PC210LC-10 10-269
10 Structure and function
Sensor
Sensor (ALL-E700-001-P-00-A)
1. Connector
2. Sensor
Function (ENG-AAP2-042-K-00-A)
• This sensor, installed to the air intake cover at the engine top side, detects the ambient pressure to output
the corresponding variable voltage.
Output characteristics
10-270 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Sensor
1. Connector
2. Sensor
3. O-ring
Function (ENG-AAM7-042-K-00-A)
• This sensor is installed to the engine intake manifold. It detects the engine intake air pressure and its
temperature, and outputs signals as a variable voltage for pressure, and as variable resistance for
temperature.
a "Charge pressure and temperature" are the engine intake air pressure and temperature of a turbocharged
engine. These are also referred to as "boost pressure and temperature" or "intake air pressure and
temperature".
Output characteristics
PC210LC-10 10-271
10 Structure and function
Sensor
1. Connector
2. Sensor
3. O-ring
Function (ENG-BA87-042-K-00-A)
• This sensor, installed on the cylinder head of the engine, converts the temperature variation into the
resistance variation, and outputs the corresponding signals.
Ne (crankshaft) speed sensor (ENG-AG42-041-K-00-A)
1. O-ring
2. Sensor
3. Connector
Function (ENG-AG42-042-K-00-A)
• This sensor, installed to the crankshaft pulley on the engine front cover, outputs the pulse voltage due to
the gear rotation.
10-272 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Sensor
1. O-ring
2. Sensor
3. Connector
Function (ENG-AG62-042-K-00-A)
• This sensor, installed to the ring of camshaft on the engine front cover, outputs the pulse voltage due to
the gear rotation.
Common rail pressure sensor (ENG-AE28-041-K-00-A)
1. Connector
2. Sensor
Function (ENG-AE28-042-K-00-A)
• This sensor, installed to the common rail in the engine, detects the fuel pressure to output the
corresponding variable voltage.
PC210LC-10 10-273
10 Structure and function
Sensor
1. O-ring
2. Sensor
3. Connector
Function (ENG-AAN5-042-K-00-A)
• This sensor, installed to the pressure outlet tube installed to the exhaust manifold of the engine, detects
the exhaust pressure to output the corresponding variable voltage.
EGR orifice temperature sensor (ENG-A9U5-041-K-00-A)
1. Connector
2. Sensor
3. Washer
Function (ENG-A9U5-042-K-00-A)
• This sensor, installed on the EGR gas piping between EGR cooler and EGR valve of the engine, converts
the temperature variation into the resistance variation, and outputs the corresponding signals.
10-274 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Sensor
1. O-ring (small)
2. O-ring (large)
3. Sensor
4. Connector
Function (ENG-A9S2-042-K-00-A)
• This sensor, installed to EGR valve in the engine, detects the EGR valve opening to output the
corresponding variable voltage.
Output characteristics
• The relation between stroke and output voltage is as shown in the following graph.
PC210LC-10 10-275
10 Structure and function
Sensor
1. Sensor
2. O-ring
3. Connector
Function (ENG-AAQ4-042-K-00-A)
• This sensor, installed to KVGT in the engine, outputs the pulse voltage due to the rotation of KVGT
turbine.
a The 3-pole connector is applied for this sensor, however, available pins are the pin No. 1 and No. 2 only,
and it has no pin No. 3.
KVGT position sensor (ENG-AAQ3-041-K-00-A)
1. O-ring (small)
2. O-ring (large)
3. Sensor
4. Connector
Function (ENG-AAQ3-042-K-00-A)
• This sensor, installed to KVGT in the engine, detects the location of the nozzle ring which is built in KVGT
to output the corresponding variable voltage.
10-276 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Sensor
Output characteristics
• The relation between stroke and output voltage is as shown in the following graph.
1. Connector
2. O-ring
3. Sensor
Function (ENG-A96H-042-K-00-A)
• This sensor, installed to the outlet side of air cleaner, converts the variations of intake air flow and
temperature into the resistance variation, and outputs the corresponding signals.
a The “MAF (Mass Air Flow)“ means the “intake air flow“.
PC210LC-10 10-277
10 Structure and function
Sensor
1. High-pressure port
2. Low-pressure port
3. Connector
4. Sensor
Function (ENG-A9HL-042-K-00-A)
• This sensor, installed to KDPF, detects the inlet pressure and outlet pressure of KDPF to output the
corresponding variable voltage.
• The output pressure difference is the difference between the KDPF inlet pressure which is detected at
high-pressure port (1) and the KDPF outlet pressure which is detected at low-pressure port (2).
• The KDPF outlet pressure is output as a pressure which is detected at low-pressure port (2).
KDOC inlet temperature sensor (ENG-A9HG-041-K-00-A)
1. Sensor
2. Connector
Function (ENG-A9HG-042-K-00-A)
• This sensor, installed to the inlet side of KDOC which is built in KDPF, converts the temperature variation
into the resistance variation, and outputs the corresponding signals.
10-278 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Sensor
1. Sensor
2. Connector
Function (ENG-A9HH-042-K-00-A)
• This sensor, installed to the outlet side of KDOC which is built in KDPF, converts the temperature variation
into the resistance variation, and outputs the corresponding signals.
KDPF outlet temperature sensor (ENG-A9HJ-041-K-00-A)
1. Sensor
2. Connector
Function (ENG-A9HJ-042-K-00-A)
• This sensor, installed to the outlet side of KDPF, converts the temperature variation into the resistance
variation, and outputs the corresponding signals.
PC210LC-10 10-279
10 Structure and function
Sensor
1. Connector
2. Sensor
3. O-ring
Function (ENG-A18C-042-K-00-A)
• This sensor, installed to the inlet side of KCCV head portion, detects the crankcase pressure (blowby
pressure) to output the corresponding variable voltage.
Engine oil level sensor (ENG-AB45-041-K-00-A)
1. Connector
2. Bracket
3. Float
4. Switch
Function (ENG-AB45-042-K-00-A)
• This sensor, installed on the side face of the oil pan, turns “OFF“ by the lowered float, if the oil level
becomes lower than specified.
10-280 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Sensor
1. Connector
2. Float
3. Arm
4. Valve body
5. Spring
6. Variable resistor
Function (PC-AD41-042-K-00-A)
• This sensor is installed on the side face of the fuel tank. The float moves up and down according to the
fuel level.
• The movement of the float activates the variable resistor through the arm. As a result, the source voltage
is changed according to the resistance change due to the arm angle change and is output as a signal.
PC210LC-10 10-281
10 Structure and function
Sensor
1. Float
2. Sensor
3. Connector
4. Reservoir tank
Function (PC-B252-042-K-00-A)
• This sensor is integrated with reservoir tank, and is activated by the lowered float, if the coolant level
becomes lower than specified.
10-282 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Sensor
1. Connector
2. Plug
3. Thermistor
Function (PC-PMT1-042-K-00-A)
• This sensor, installed on the suction pipe of main pump, senses the temperature variation as the change
in thermistor resistance, and outputs the corresponding signals.
Front pump oil pressure sensor (PC-C3W4-041-K-00-A)
1. O-ring
2. Sensor
3. Connector
Function (PC-C3W4-042-K-00-A)
• The sensor is installed in the control valve. It detects the delivery pressure of the front pump and outputs
variable voltage signal.
PC210LC-10 10-283
10 Structure and function
Sensor
Output characteristics
1. O-ring
2. Sensor
3. Connector
Function (PC-C3W5-042-K-00-A)
• The sensor is installed in the control valve. It detects the delivery pressure of the rear pump and outputs
variable voltage signal.
Output characteristics
10-284 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Sensor
1. O-ring
2. Sensor
3. Connector
Function (PC-E720-042-P-00-A)
• PPC oil pressure sensors, 8 of which are installed to interconnect blocks in the pilot circuit between control
valves and PPC valve, and 4 of which are installed to travel PPC valves, detect the pilot pressures, and
output the corresponding variable voltage.
Output characteristics
PC210LC-10 10-285
10 Structure and function
Sensor
1. Adapter
2. Hood
3. Indicator
4. Connector
Function (PC-A968-042-K-00-A)
• This sensor is installed on the air cleaner outlet side. The switch is turned to “ON“ position, if the air
cleaner is clogged and the pressure level drops to the specified level (negative pressure).
Front pump swash plate sensor (PC-C3W9-041-K-00-A)
1. Sensor case
2. Spool
3. Lead wire
4. Connector
L: Operation stroke (9 mm)
Function (PC200_10-C3W9-042-K-00-A)
• This senor is installed to the front pump side of the main pump. It detects the stroke of servo piston and
outputs variable voltage signal.
• The output voltages are sent to the pump controller which converts the voltages into the pump swash
plate angles (oil flow) to process them.
10-286 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Sensor
Output characteristics
• The relation between stroke and output voltage is as shown in the following graph.
• The relation between oil flow of pump and output voltage is as shown in the following graph.
1. Sensor case
2. Spool
3. Lead wire
4. Connector
L: Operation stroke (9 mm)
PC210LC-10 10-287
10 Structure and function
Sensor
Function (PC200_10-C3WB-042-K-00-A)
• This senor is installed to the rear pump side of the main pump. It detects the stroke of servo piston and
outputs variable voltage signal.
• The output voltages are sent to the pump controller which converts the voltages into the pump swash
plate angles (oil flow) to process them.
Output characteristics
• The relation between stroke and output voltage is as shown in the following graph.
• The relation between oil flow of pump and output voltage is as shown in the following graph.
10-288 PC210LC-10
10 Structure and function
Sensor
1. Connector
2. Tube
3. Sensor
4. O-ring
Function (PC-AEB3-042-K-00-A)
• This sensor is installed to the cup of fuel prefilter.
• This sensor outputs a signal when detecting water exists in the fuel beyond the specified level.
PC210LC-10 10-289
10-290 PC210LC-10
SHOP MANUAL
HYDRAULIC EXCAVATOR
PC210LC-10
Model Serial Number
PC210LC-10 20-1
20 Standard value tables
Table of contents
20-2 PC210LC-10
20 Standard value tables
Standard value table for engine
Standard
Item Measurement condition Unit value for new Repair limit
machine
High idle rpm 1,850 ± 70 1,850 ± 70
• Coolant temperature: 30 to rpm
Low idle 1,050 ± 50 1,050 ± 50
Rotating speed 102°C
• Swing lock switch: ON Rated rpm 2,000 2,000
speed
Engine
outlet
• Coolant temperature: 30 to (between Bosch
102°C — 2.7
turbochar- index
Exhaust gas • At relief with arm IN ger and
color • Swing lock switch: ON KDPF inlet)
• After kept for 5 seconds at
KDPF outlet
normal condition Bosch
(exhaust — 0.5
pipe outlet) index
Intake valve mm 0.25 0.152 to 0.381
• Coolant temperature :
Valve clearance Normal temperature Exhaust mm 0.51 0.381 to 0.762
Engine
valve
Compres- MPa Min. 2.41 Min. 1.69
sion
Compression • Engine oil temperature: 40 to pressure {kg/cm2} {Min. 24.6} {Min. 17.2}
pressure 60°C
Engine rpm
speed 250 to 280 250 to 280
• Coolant temperature: 30 to 102°C
Blowby • Hydraulic oil temperature: 45 to 55°C kPa Max. 0.98 Max. 1.96
pressure • Arm IN relief + One-touch power max. ON {mmH2O} {Max. 100} {Max. 200}
• KCCV circuit disconnected
MPa Min. 0.29 Min. 0.25
• Coolant temperature: 30 to High idle
Engine oil {kg/cm2} {Min. 3.0} {Min. 2.5}
pressure 102°C
MPa Min. 0.10 Min. 0.07
• SAE15W-40 oil Low idle
{kg/cm2} {Min. 1.0} {Min. 0.7}
EGR valve and
MPa Min. 1.2 Min. 1.2
KVGT drive oil • Coolant temperature: 30 to
102°C {kg/cm2} {Min. 12.0} {Min. 12.0}
pressure Low idle
• Hydraulic oil temperature: 45
KVGT control oil MPa 0.3 to 1.0 0.3 to 1.0
to 55°C
pressure {kg/cm2} {3.1 to 10.2} {3.1 to 10.2}
Engine oil
• Whole speed range (inside oil pan) °C 80 to 110 MAX.120
temperature
Auto- Auto-
• Between fan pulley and alternator pulley tensioner tensioner
Fan belt tension • Deflection when pressed with finger at 98 mm
N {10 kg} (Automatic (Automatic
adjustment) adjustment)
PC210LC-10 20-3
20 Standard value tables
Standard value table for engine
Standard
Item Measurement condition Unit value for new Repair limit
machine
Air conditioner • Between compressor pulley and fan pulley
compressor belt • Deflection when pressed with finger at 60 mm 6.3 to 8.7 6.3 to 8.7
tension N {6.2 kg}
20-4 PC210LC-10
20 Standard value tables
Standard value table for machine
Engine speed
Machine model PC210LC–10
Standard
value for Repair limit
Item Measurement condition Unit
new
machine
• Coolant temperature: 30 to 102°C
• Hydraulic oil temperature: 45 to 55°C
At 2-pump relief • Engine: High idle rpm 1,850 ± 100 1,850 ± 100
Rotating speed • Power mode (P)
• Swing lock switch: OFF
• At relief with arm IN
• Coolant temperature: 30 to 102°C
• Hydraulic oil temperature: 45 to 55°C
Speed at 2-pump
• Engine: High idle rpm
relief + One-touch 1,950 ± 100 1,950 ± 100
• Power mode (P)
power max. is ON
• Arm IN relief + Left knob switch in ON
position
Speed when auto- • Engine: High idle
deceleration is • Auto-deceleration switch in ON position rpm 1,050 ± 100 1,050 ± 100
operated • All control levers at NEUTRAL
Control valve spool stroke
Machine model PC210LC-10
Standard
value for Repair limit
Item Measurement condition Unit
new
machine
• Engine stopped RAISE mm 11.5 ± 0.5 11.5 ± 0.5
Boom control valve • For measuring point, see LOWER mm 9.5 ± 0.5 9.5 ± 0.5
"Control valve". DIGGING mm 11.5 ± 0.5 11.5 ± 0.5
Arm control valve
DUMP mm 9.5 ± 0.5 9.5 ± 0.5
DIGGING
Bucket control valve mm 9.5 ± 0.5 9.5 ± 0.5
DUMP
Left swing
Swing control valve mm 9.5 ± 0.5 9.5 ± 0.5
Right swing
Forward
Travel control valve mm 9.5 ± 0.5 9.5 ± 0.5
Reverse
PC210LC-10 20-5
20 Standard value tables
Standard value table for machine
20-6 PC210LC-10
20 Standard value tables
Standard value table for machine
Oil pressure
Machine model PC210LC-10
Standard
value for Repair limit
Item Measurement condition Unit
new
machine
• Hydraulic oil temperature: 45 to 55°C
• Engine: High idle MPa 3.5 ± 1.0 3.5 ± 1.0
Unload pressure • Power mode (P)
• Hydraulic pump output pressure with all {kg/cm 2} {36 ± 10} {36 ± 10}
control levers in NEUTRAL position
• Hydraulic oil temperature: 45 34.8 (+1.5 /
to 55°C At normal MPa -1.2) 33.1 to 37.2
• Engine: High idle relief {kg/cm } {355 (+15 /
2 {338 to 380}
• Power mode (P) -12)}
Boom relief pressure • Hydraulic pump outlet
37.3 (+1.5 /
pressure with all
At power MPa -1.2) 36.1 to 39.7
measurement circuits
relieved maximizing {kg/cm } {380 (+15 /
2 {368 to 405}
-12)}
34.8 (+1.5 /
At normal MPa -1.2) 33.1 to 37.2
relief {kg/cm2} {355 (+15 / {338 to 380}
Arm relief pressure -12)}
37.3 (+1.5 /
At power MPa -1.2) 36.1 to 39.7
maximizing {kg/cm2} {380 (+15 / {368 to 405}
-12)}
34.8 (+1.5 /
At normal MPa -1.2) 33.1 to 37.2
relief {kg/cm } {355 (+15 /
2 {338 to 380}
-12)}
Bucket relief pressure
37.3 (+1.5 /
At power MPa -1.2) 36.1 to 39.7
maximizing {kg/cm } {380 (+15 /
2 {368 to 405}
-12)}
• Hydraulic oil temperature: 45 to 55°C MPa 29.3 ±1.5 27.4 to 31.3
Swing relief pressure • Engine: High idle {kg/cm2} {300 ± 15} {280 to 320}
• Power mode (P)
38.7 (+1.0 /
• Hydraulic pump outlet pressure with all
MPa -2.0) 36.8 to 40.2
Travel relief pressure measurement circuits relieved
• Sudden turning back must be avoided {kg/cm 2} {395 (+10 / {375 to 410}
-20)}
• Hydraulic oil temperature: 45 to 55°C
• Engine: High idle 3.23 (+0.2 /
Control circuit oil MPa 2.75 to 3.43
• Self-pressure reducing valve outlet -0.3)
pressure {kg/cm2} {28 to 35}
pressure with all control levers in {33 (+2 / -3)}
NEUTRAL position
• Hydraulic oil temperature: 45 All control MPa 3.5 ± 1.0 3.5 ± 1.0
to 55°C levers in
{kg/cm2} {36 ± 10} {36 ± 10}
• Engine: High idle NEUTRAL
• Power mode (P)
LS differential 1.8 (+0.05 / 1.8 (+0.05 /
• Travel speed: Hi
pressure Travel MPa -0.1) -0.1)
• Run either track idle
• LS differential pressure = levers at
{kg/cm2} {18 (+0.5 / {18 (+0.5 /
Pump pressure - LS half stroke
-1.0)} -1.0)}
pressure
PC210LC-10 20-7
20 Standard value tables
Standard value table for machine
Swing
Machine model PC210LC-10
Standard
value for Repair limit
Item Measurement condition Unit
new
machine
• Hydraulic oil temperature: 45 to 55°C
• Engine: High idle deg. Max. 100 Max. 130
Overswing • Power mode (P)
• Overswing of swing circle after one turn (mm) (-) (-)
• For measuring posture, see "Swing 1"
• Hydraulic oil temperature: 45 90 degrees sec. 3.1 ± 0.3 Max. 3.7
to 55°C
• Engine: High idle
• Power mode (P)
Swing drift on a slope • Time required to pass 90 180
degrees and 180 degrees sec. 4.4 ± 0.4 Max. 5.5
degrees
points after starting swing
• For measuring posture, see
"Swing 1"
• Hydraulic oil temperature: 45 to 55°C
• Engine: High idle
Time required to finish • Power mode (P)
sec. 24.2 ± 2.5 Max. 30
swinging • Time required to complete five turns after
one turn
• For measuring posture, see "Swing 1"
• Hydraulic oil temperature: 45 to 55°C
• Engine stopped
• On slope of 15 deg., set upper structure
Amount of Hydraulic crosswise and make matchmarks on inner
mm 0 0
drift of swing race and outer race of swing circle.
• Distance that matchmarks move apart
after 5 minutes
• For measuring posture, see "Swing 2"
• Hydraulic oil temperature: 45 to 55°C
Leakage from swing • Engine: High idle
• Swing lock switch: ON l/min Max. 5 Max. 10
motor
• Leakage in 1 minute during swing relief
20-8 PC210LC-10
20 Standard value tables
Standard value table for machine
Traveling
Machine model PC210LC–10
Standard
value for Repair limit
Item Measurement condition Unit
new
machine
• Hydraulic oil temperature: 55.9 (+3.9/-
Lo sec. 48.6 to 63.8
Within operating range 7.3)
• Engine: High idle Mi sec. 40.8 ± 4.1 36.7 to 48.9
Travel speed (idle • Power mode (P)
running) • Time required to make five
idle turns of track off ground
after one idle turn Hi sec. 28.8 ± 1.5 27.3 to 32.3
• For measuring posture, see
"Travel 1"
• Hydraulic oil temperature: 24 (+1.7 /
Lo sec. 20.9 to 26.7
Within operating range -3.1)
• Engine: High idle Mi sec. 17 ± 2.5 14.5 to 20.5
Travel speed (actual • Power mode (P)
running) • Time required for traveling 20
m after 10 m trial run Hi sec. 13 ± 1.0 12.0 to 15.0
• For measuring posture, see
"Travel 2"
• Hydraulic oil temperature: Within
operating range
• Engine: High idle
• Power mode (P)
Travel deviation • Travel speed: Lo mm Max. 150 Max. 250
• Travel deviation (x) in travel of 20 m after
running up 10 m on firm and level ground
• For measuring posture, see "Travel 2" and
"Travel 3"
• Hydraulic oil temperature: Within
operating range
• Engine stopped
Machine drift on a • Place machine on slope of 12 deg. with
mm 0 0
slope sprocket on uphill side.
• Travel distance by hydraulic drift of travel
for 5 minutes
• For measuring posture, see "Travel 4"
• Hydraulic oil temperature: Within
operating range
Leakage from travel • Engine: High idle l/min 13.6 27.2
motor • Lock sprocket with pin, etc.
• Leakage in 1 minute during travel relief
PC210LC-10 20-9
20 Standard value tables
Standard value table for machine
Work equipment
• Hydraulic drift of work equipment
Machine model PC210LC-10
Standard
Item Measurement condition Unit value for new Repair limit
machine
Whole work • Hydraulic oil temperature: Within operating
mm Max. 600 Max. 900
equipment range
Hydraulic drift of • Measure on level and flat surface.
• Bucket filled up with dirt and sand, or at the mm Max. 18 Max. 27
boom cylinder
Hydraulic drift of rated load (0.8 m3: 1,440 kg)
• Horizontal boom top face, fully retracted mm Max. 160 Max. 240
boom cylinder
arm, fully extended bucket cylinder
• Engine stopped
• Work equipment control lever in NEUTRAL
position
• Fall amount for 15 minutes as measured
every 5 minutes starting immediately after
initial setting
Hydraulic drift of • Whole work equipment: Hydraulic drift
measured at tooth tip mm Max. 40 Max. 58
bucket cylinder
• Boom cylinder: Retraction amount of
cylinder
• Arm cylinder: Extension amount of cylinder
• Bucket cylinder: Retraction amount of
cylinder
• For measuring posture, see "Work
equipment 1"
• Work equipment speed
Machine model PC210LC-10
Standard
Item Measurement condition Unit value for new Repair limit
machine
• Hydraulic oil temperature: RAISE sec. 3.6 ± 0.4 Max. 4.7
Within operating range
• Engine: High idle
• Power mode (P)
• Time required to move boom
Boom speed
between RAISE stroke end LOWER sec. 2.9 ± 0.3 Max. 3.7
and ground touch point of
bucket
• For measuring posture, see
"Work equipment 2"
• Hydraulic oil temperature: DIGGING sec. 3.5 ± 0.4 Max. 4.5
Within operating range
• Engine: High idle
• Power mode (P)
Arm speed • Time required to move bucket
between DUMP stroke end DUMP sec. 2.7 ± 0.3 Max. 3.5
and CURL stroke end
• For measuring posture, see
"Work equipment 3"
• Hydraulic oil temperature: DIGGING sec. 2.6 ± 0.3 Max. 3.3
Within operating range
• Engine: High idle
• Power mode (P)
Bucket speed • Time required to move bucket
between DUMP stroke end DUMP sec. 1.9 ± 0.2 Max. 2.7
and CURL stroke end
• For measuring posture, see
"Work equipment 4"
20-10 PC210LC-10
20 Standard value tables
Standard value table for machine
• Time lag
Machine model PC210LC-10
Standard
Item Measurement condition Unit value for new Repair limit
machine
• Hydraulic oil temperature: Within operating
range
• Engine at low idle
• Power mode (P)
• Set boom at full RAISE position. Move
Boom time lag boom control lever to LOWER position. sec. Max. 1.0 Max. 1.2
Measure length of time before front of
machine starts lifting off the ground after
work equipment touches the ground.
• For measuring posture, see "Work
equipment 5"
• Hydraulic oil temperature: Within operating
range
• Engine at low idle
• Power mode (P)
• Set arm to the max. DUMP position. Move
Arm time lag arm control lever to IN position. The time sec. Max. 2.0 Max. 2.8
required from when the arm is stopped once
at an approximately vertical orientation until
it starts moving to the IN side again.
• For measuring posture, see "Work
equipment 6"
• Hydraulic oil temperature: Within operating
range
• Engine at low idle
• Power mode (P)
• Set bucket at full DUMP position. Move
bucket control lever to CURL position. The
Bucket time lag sec. Max. 1.0 Max. 3.6
time required from when the bucket is
stopped once at an approximately vertical
orientation until it starts moving to the CURL
side again.
• For measuring posture, see "Work
equipment 7"
• Oil leakage
Machine model PC210LC-10
Standard
Item Measurement condition Unit value for new Repair limit
machine
Cylinder internal • Hydraulic oil temperature: Within operating
oil leakage range cc/min 4.5 20
• Engine: High idle
Center swivel joint • Leakage amount for 1 minute during relief of cc/min 10 50
cylinder to be measured or travel motor
PC210LC-10 20-11
20 Standard value tables
Standard value table for machine
20-12 PC210LC-10
20 Standard value tables
Standard value table for machine
Hydraulic pump
Machine model PC210LC-10
Discharge Discharge
Item Measurement condition Unit Standard Repair limit
value
• Pump speed (rpm): 1,700 rpm
• PC-EPC current value (mA): 440 mA
• Test pump discharge pressure (MPa {kg/
cm2})
: P1 Q Q
Performance of
• Discharge pressure of another pump (MPa l/min
hydraulic pump (See graph) (See graph)
{kg/cm2})
: P2
• Average discharge pressure (MPa {kg/
cm2})
: Pp=(P1+P2)/2
a Bring pump discharge pressure P1 and P2 as close as possible to the average pressure when measuring.
Avoid measuring the near turning point of the graph because the error increases there.
a When measuring with the pump mounted on the machine, if it is impossible to set the engine speed to the
specified speed by using the fuel control dial, take the pump discharge and the engine speed at the time of
measurement, and use them as a base for calculating the pump discharge at the specified speed.
PC210LC-10 20-13
20 Standard value tables
Standard value table for machine
Swing 1: Overrun when stopping swing, time required for starting swing, time required for swing
20-14 PC210LC-10
20 Standard value tables
Standard value table for machine
PC210LC-10 20-15
20 Standard value tables
Standard value table for machine
20-16 PC210LC-10
20 Standard value tables
Standard value table for machine
PC210LC-10 20-17
20 Standard value tables
Standard value table for electrical system
Controller (PC200_10-RA1E-033-K-00-A)
Equipment name Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. Turn the starting switch to OFF position, and set the battery disconnect switch
to OFF position.
2. Insert T-adapter into connector CE03.
Continuous 3. Turn the battery disconnect switch to ON position.
Engine power 4. Measure voltage with the starting switch at OFF position and when starting
controller supply engine.
voltage Between CE03 (1) and (21) 20 to 30 V
Between CE03 (2) and (31) 20 to 30 V
Voltage
Between CE03 (11) and (21) 20 to 30 V
Between CE03 (12) and (31) 20 to 30 V
1. Turn the starting switch to OFF position, and disconnect the battery ground
Continuous cable.
power 2. Disconnect connector CP01, and connect T-adapter to female side.
supply 3. Connect the ground cable, and turn the starting switch to ON position.
voltage Between CP01(female) (1) and (2) 20 to 30 V
Voltage
Between CP01 (female) (4) and (5) 20 to 30 V
Pump
controller 1. Turn the starting switch to OFF position, and disconnect the battery ground
cable.
Solenoid 2. Disconnect connector CP02, and connect T-adapter to female side.
power 3. Connect the ground cable, and turn the starting switch to ON position.
supply
Between CP02(female) (116) and ground 20 to 30 V
voltage
Voltage Between CP02(female) (118) and ground 20 to 30 V
Between CP02(female) (121) and ground 20 to 30 V
1. Turn the starting switch to OFF position, and set the battery disconnect switch
to OFF position.
Continuous 2. Insert T-adapter into connector CM01.
Machine power 3. Turn the battery disconnect switch to ON position, and turn the starting switch
monitor supply to ON position (connect ACC).
voltage
Between CM01 (1) and (3) 20 to 30 V
Voltage
Between CM01 (2) and (4) 20 to 30 V
20-18 PC210LC-10
20 Standard value tables
Standard value table for electrical system
PC210LC-10 20-19
20 Standard value tables
Standard value table for electrical system
20-20 PC210LC-10
20 Standard value tables
Standard value table for electrical system
PC210LC-10 20-21
20 Standard value tables
Standard value table for electrical system
20-22 PC210LC-10
20 Standard value tables
Standard value table for electrical system
PC210LC-10 20-23
20 Standard value tables
Standard value table for electrical system
20-24 PC210LC-10
20 Standard value tables
Standard value table for electrical system
PC210LC-10 20-25
20 Standard value tables
Standard value table for electrical system
20-26 PC210LC-10
20 Standard value tables
Standard value table for electrical system
PC210LC-10 20-27
20 Standard value tables
Standard value table for electrical system
20-28 PC210LC-10
SHOP MANUAL
HYDRAULIC EXCAVATOR
PC210LC-10
Model Serial Number
PC210LC-10 30-1
30 Testing and adjusting
Table of contents
30-2 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
General information on testing and adjusting
Q'ty
adjusting item bol Part No. Part name Remarks
Testing boost -101 to 200 kPa {-760 to 1,500
A 799-201-2202 Boost gauge kit 1 mmHg}
pressure
Testing 1 799-201-9002 Handy smoke checker 1
exhaust gas B Commercially Bosch index: 0 to 9
color 2 Smoke meter 1
available
Testing and 1 795-799-1131 Gear 1
adjusting valve C Commercially
2 Feeler gauge 1
clearance available
1 795-502-1590 Gauge assembly 1 0 to 7 MPa {0 to 70 kg/cm2}
2 795-799-6700 Puller 1
Testing
Adapter
compression D 3 795-790-4411 1
pressure 4 6754-11-3130 Gasket 1
Commercially
5 Hose 1 Inside diameter: approx. 15mm
available
1 799-201-1506 Blowby checker 1 0 to 10 kPa {0 to 1,000 mmH2O}
Testing blowby Commercially Plug
2 1 Hose inside diameter: 24 mm
pressure E available
Commercially Pipe outside diameter: 25.4 mm,
3 Plug 2 Pipe inside diameter: 20.4 mm
available
Pressure gauge: 2.5, 6, 40, 60
799-101-5002 Hydraulic tester 1 MPa {25, 60, 400, 600 kg/cm2}
1 799-101-5160 • Nipple 1
799-101-5150 • Hose 1
Testing engine
oil pressure F 790-261-1150 • Hose 1
Pressure gauge: 60 MPa {600 kg/
2 790-261-1204 Digital hydraulic tester 1 cm2}
Pressure gauge: 1.0 MPa {10 kg/
3 799-401-2320 Gauge 1 cm2}
1 799-401-3100 Adapter 1
2 799-401-3200 Adapter 1
Pressure gauge: 2.5, 6, 40, 60
799-101-5002 Hydraulic tester 1 MPa {25, 60, 400, 600 kg/cm2}
Measuring 799-101-5160 • Nipple 2 R1/8
EGR valve and • Hose
KVGT oil G 3 799-101-5150 1
790-261-1150 • Hose 1
pressures
Pressure gauge: 2.5 MPa {25 kg/
799-101-5140 • Gauge 1 cm2}
Pressure gauge: 60 MPa {600 kg/
4 790-261-1204 Digital hydraulic tester 1 cm2}
PC210LC-10 30-3
30 Testing and adjusting
General information on testing and adjusting
Q'ty
adjusting item bol Part No. Part name Remarks
Pressure gauge: 2.5, 6, 40, 60
799-101-5002 Hydraulic tester 1 MPa {25, 60, 400, 600 kg/cm2}
799-101-5160 • Nipple 1 R1/8
1 799-101-5150 • Hose 1
790-261-1150 • Hose 1
Pressure gauge: 2.5 MPa {25 kg/
799-101-5140 • Gauge 1 cm2}
Pressure gauge: 60 MPa {600 kg/
2 790-261-1204 Digital hydraulic tester 1 cm2}
Testing fuel 795-790-4430 Adapter 2
pressure H 3 O-ring
6215-81-9710 1
4 795-790-5110 Screw 1 M12 x 1.5 o R1/8
Pressure gauge: 1.0 MPa {10 kg/
5 799-401-2320 Gauge 1 cm2}
6 795-790-5120 Screw 1 M14 x 1.5 o R1/8
700-201-2202 Boost gauge kit 1
799-101-5160 • Nipple 1 R1/8
7 799-401-2610 • Hose 1
-101 to 200 kPa {-760 to 1,500
799-401-2311 • Gauge 1 mmHg}
1 795-790-4700 Tester kit 1
2 6164-81-5790 Joint 1
3 07206-30812 Joint bolt 1
4 6754-71-1130 Seal washer 1
Testing fuel Commercially
discharge, 5 Stopwatch 1
J available
return and Commercially
leakage 6 Hose 1 Inside diameter: approx. 14 mm
available
Commercially Measuring cylinder
7 1
available
Commercially
8 Hose 1 Inside diameter: approx. 8 mm
available
Measuring
swing circle Commercially Dial gauge
K 1
bearing available
clearance
Testing fuel Developer
circuit for Commercially
L for dye penetrant check 1
leakage available
(color checker)
Measuring and Pressure gauge: 2.5, 6, 40, 60
799-101-5002 Hydraulic tester 1 MPa {25, 60, 400, 600 kg/cm2}
adjusting oil
pressure in
work M 1 Pressure gauge: 60 MPa {600 kg/
equipment, 790-261-1204 Digital hydraulic tester 1 cm2}
swing, and
travel circuits
30-4 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
General information on testing and adjusting
Q'ty
adjusting item bol Part No. Part name Remarks
Pressure range: 5 MPa {50 Kg/
796T-440-1200 Sensor adapter 1 cm2}
796-440-1150 • Wiring harness 1
1 799-401-2350 • Washer 1
790-261-1130 • Coupling 1
Testing source Pressure range: 5 MPa {50 Kg/
7861-93-1840 • Pressure sensor 1 cm2}
pressure of N
control circuit 799-101-5220 Nipple 1 Size: 10 x 1.25 mm
2
07002-11023 O-ring 1
Pressure gauge: 2.5, 6, 40, 60
799-101-5002 Hydraulic tester 1 MPa {25, 60, 400, 600 kg/cm2}
3
Pressure gauge: 60 MPa {600 kg/
790-261-1204 Digital hydraulic tester 1 cm2}
Measuring and Pressure gauge: 2.5, 6, 40, 60
799-101-5002 Hydraulic tester 1 MPa {25, 60, 400, 600 kg/cm2}
adjusting oil
pressure in P 1
Pressure gauge: 60 MPa {600 kg/
pump PC 790-261-1204 Digital hydraulic tester 1 cm2}
control circuit
Measuring and Pressure gauge: 2.5, 6, 40, 60
799-101-5002 Hydraulic tester 1 MPa {25, 60, 400, 600 kg/cm2}
adjusting oil 1
pressure in Q Pressure gauge: 60 MPa {600 kg/
790-261-1204 Digital hydraulic tester 1 cm2}
pump LS
control 2 799-401-2701 Differential pressure gauge 1 50 MPa {500 kg/cm2}
Pressure gauge: 2.5, 6, 40, 60
799-101-5002 Hydraulic tester 1 MPa {25, 60, 400, 600 kg/cm2}
Measuring 1
solenoid valve Pressure gauge: 60 MPa {600 kg/
R 790-261-1204 Digital hydraulic tester 1 cm2}
output
pressure 799-401-3100 Adapter 1 Size: 02
2
02896-11008 O-ring 1
Pressure gauge: 2.5, 6, 40, 60
799-101-5002 Hydraulic tester 1 MPa {25, 60, 400, 600 kg/cm2}
Measuring 1
PPC valve Pressure gauge: 60 MPa {600 kg/
S 790-261-1204 Digital hydraulic tester 1 cm2}
output
pressure 799-401-3100 Adapter 1 Size: 02
2
799-401-3200 Adapter 1 Size: 03
Testing oil Commercially
T Measuring cylinder 1
leakage available
Testing coolant
temperature
— 799-101-1502 Digital thermometer 1 -99.9 to 1,299°C
and oil
temperature
Testing 79A-264-0021 Push-pull scale 1 0 to 294 N {0 to 30 kg}
operating effort
and —
79A-264-0091 Push-pull scale 1 0 to 490 N {0 to 50 kg}
depressing
effort
Testing stroke
— Commercially
and hydraulic Ruler 1
available
drift
Testing work
equipment — Commercially Stopwatch 1
speed available
Testing voltage — Commercially
Multimeter 1
and resistance available
PC210LC-10 30-5
30 Testing and adjusting
General information on testing and adjusting
Q'ty
adjusting item bol Part No. Part name Remarks
Removal and
installation of
boost pressure — Commercially 3.26 mm Torx wrench
Torx wrench 1
and available (KTC Q4T15 or equivalent)
temperature
sensors
Removal and
installation of
engine oil — 795-799-6210 Socket 1 27 mm deep socket
pressure
switch
Removal and
installation of 19 mm deep socket
engine coolant — 795T-981-1010 Socket 1
temperature (MITOLOY 4ML-19 or equivalent)
sensor
30-6 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
General information on testing and adjusting
Note) Komatsu will not be held responsible for special tools manufactured according to these sketches.
N1: Sensor adapter
—: Socket
PC210LC-10 30-7
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
a Check the engine speed by using the 4) Operate the L.H. work equipment control
"Monitoring/Pre-defined" or "Monitoring lever to relieve the arm circuit at the IN stroke
Function" of the machine monitor. end and test the engine speed.
5. Measuring speed (around rated speed) at 2-
a Check the engine speed under the following
pump relief + one-touch power maximizing
conditions.
function
• Coolant temperature: 30 to 102°C
1) Start the engine and operate the arm cylinder
• Hydraulic oil temperature: 45 to 55°C
to arm IN stroke end.
Testing (PC200_10-A000-388-K-00-A) 2) Set the fuel control dial to high idle (MAX)
position and set the working mode to Power
1. Preparation
mode (P).
Operate the machine monitor so that it can
3) While operating the L.H. work equipment
monitor the engine speed.
control lever to relieve the arm circuit at arm
a For the machine monitor operating method, IN stroke end and pressing the one-touch
see the section of "Special functions of power maximizing switch, measure the
machine monitor". engine speed.
a Monitoring code: 01002 “Engine speed“ a The one-touch power maximizing function is
reset automatically in approximately 8.5
seconds even if the switch is kept pressed.
Accordingly, test the engine speed in that
period.
a You may measure with the swing lock switch
ON.
6. Measuring the engine speed when auto-
deceleration is activated
1) Start the engine, set the fuel control dial to
high idle (MAX) position, and turn the auto-
deceleration function ON.
2) Set all the levers and pedals for work
equipment control, swing control, and travel
2. Testing low idle speed in neutral and test the engine speed when
1) Start the engine and set the fuel control dial the auto-decelerator operates.
to low idle (MIN) position.
2) Set all the levers and pedals for work a The engine speed automatically lowers to a
equipment control, swing control, and travel certain level approximately 5 seconds after
in neutral and test the engine speed. all the levers and pedals are set to the
3. Testing high idle speed NEUTRAL position. This level is the auto-
deceleration speed.
1) Start the engine and set the fuel control dial
to high idle (MAX) position.
2) Set the working mode in Power Mode (P)
and set the auto-deceleration to OFF.
3) Set the swing lock switch to the ON position.
4) Set all the levers and pedals for work
equipment control, swing control, and travel
in neutral and test the engine speed.
4. Measuring engine speed at 2-pump relief
1) Start the engine and operate the arm cylinder
to arm IN stroke end.
2) Set the swing lock switch to the OFF
position.
3) Set the fuel control dial to high idle (MAX)
position and set the working mode to Power
mode (P).
30-8 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
PC210LC-10 30-9
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
30-10 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
1. Open engine hood and remove step (1) and plug 1) Connect the probe hose, receptacle of the
(2). accelerator switch and air hose to smoke
meter B2.
a The supplied air pressure must be 1.5
MPa {15 kg/cm2} or below.
2) Connect the power cable to the receptacle.
a Before connecting the power cable, make
sure that the power switch of the smoke
meter is turned OFF.
3) Insert probe [1] of the smoke meter B2 into
port (3) for the removed plug.
4) Loosen the cap nut of the suction pump and
place the filter paper.
2. Checking with handy smoke checker B1 a Place the filter paper securely so that the
exhaust gas does not leak.
1) Place a sheet of filter paper to smoke
5) Turn on the power switch of smoke meter B2.
checker B1.
2) Insert the exhaust gas intake pipe into plug
hole (3).
3) Start the engine, run it at high idle, and
perform the arm IN relief. Operate the handle
PC210LC-10 30-11
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
30-12 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
PC210LC-10 30-13
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
30-14 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
PC210LC-10 30-15
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
a Testing tools
Sym-
Part No. Part name
bol
1 795-502-1590 Gauge assembly
2 795-799-6700 Puller
3 795-790-4411 Adapter
D
4 6754-11-3130 Gasket
5 Commercially Hose (inside diameter:
available approximately 15 mm)
30-16 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
PC210LC-10 30-17
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
30-18 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
PC210LC-10 30-19
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
1. Open the engine hood and remove step (1). a If the swing lock switch is turned to the ON
position, the main relief valve is set for high-
pressure relief.
5. Measure the blowby pressure when the
hydraulic relief is made by arm IN operation at
engine high idle.
a Read the blowby gas pressure when the
gauge pointer stands still.
Blowby pressure Max. 1.96 kPa {200 mm H2O}
30-20 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
PC210LC-10 30-21
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
1. Open the engine hood and remove step (1) 4. Start the engine and measure the oil pressures
at low idle.
a When EGR valve and KVGT driving oil
pressure are within the following standard
range, they are normal.
Drive oil pressure of Min. 1.2 MPa
EGR valve and KVGT Min. {12.0 kg/cm2}
KVGT control oil 0.3 to 1.0 MPa
pressure {3.1 to 10.2 kg/cm2}
30-22 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
a Testing tools
Sym-
Part No. Part Name
bol
799-101-5002 Hydraulic tester
799-101-5160 ・ Nipple
1 799-101-5150 ・ Hose
790-261-1150 ・ Hose
799-101-5140 ・ Gauge
2 790-261-1204 Digital hydraulic tester
795-790-4430 Adapter
3
H 6215-81-9710 O-ring
4 795-790-5110 Screw
5 799-401-2320 Gauge
6 795-790-5120 Screw
799-201-2202 Boost gauge kit
799-101-5160 ・ Nipple
7
799-401-2610 ・ Hose
799-401-2311 ・ Gauge
k When removing and installing the fuel system inspection equipment, stop the engine and wait for
30 seconds until the remaining pressure is released from the fuel circuit. (Do not start inspection
work immediately after the engine is stopped since remaining pressure is present.)
k Park the machine on level ground and lower the work equipment to the ground.
a Test only the fuel pressure in the low-pressure circuit from the feed pump through the fuel main filter to the
supply pump and in the return circuit between the supply pump/common rail/ injector and fuel tank.
k Since the pressure in the high-pressure circuit from the supply pump through the common rail to
the injector is very high and dangerous, do not measure it.
PC210LC-10 30-23
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
30-24 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
PC210LC-10 30-25
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
30-26 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
PC210LC-10 30-27
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
30-28 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
a Testing tools
Sym-
Part No. Part Name
bol
1 795-790-4700 Multimeter kit
2 6164-81-5790 Joint
3 07206-30812 Joint bolt
4 6745-71-1130 O-ring
Commercially Stopwatch
5
J available
Commercially Hose (inside diameter:
6 about 14 mm)
available
Commercially Measuring cylinder
7
available
Commercially Hose (inside diameter:
8 about 8 mm)
available
k Park the machine on level ground and lower the work equipment to the ground.
a Since some fuel flows out during check, prepare an oil pan of about 20 l .
k When removing and installing the fuel system inspection equipment, stop the engine and wait for
30 seconds until the remaining pressure is released from the fuel circuit. (Do not start inspection
work immediately after the engine is stopped since remaining pressure is present.)
PC210LC-10 30-29
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
30-30 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
Testing supply pump return rate a If the engine cannot be started, you can
1. Disconnect fuel return hose (2) on the return measure the fuel pressure while rotating the
side of the supply pump. engine using the starting motor. However, to
protect the starting motor, do not rotate the
engine for more than 20 seconds
continuously. “Crank the engine for 15
seconds, then stop for 15 seconds and crank
it again for 15 seconds.“ Do the
measurement in this manner.
PC210LC-10 30-31
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
Testing leakage from pressure limiter a If the engine cannot be started, you can
1. Remove joint bolt (1) of the pressure limiter and measure the fuel pressure while rotating the
disconnect spill tube (2). engine using the starting motor. However, to
protect the starting motor, do not rotate the
engine for more than 20 seconds
continuously. “Crank the engine for 15
seconds, then stop for 15 seconds and crank
it again for 15 seconds.“ Do the
measurement in this manner.
30-32 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
Testing injector return rate from injector a If the engine cannot be started, you can
measure the fuel pressure while rotating the
a The fuel return rate from the injector is tested
engine using the starting motor. However, to
while spill tube (2) of the pressure limiter is
protect the starting motor, do not rotate the
connected. Accordingly, before testing the return
engine for more than 20 seconds
rate from the injector, check that the leakage
continuously. “Crank the engine for 15
from the pressure limiter is normal.
seconds, then stop for 15 seconds and crank
1. Remove check valve (1) of the cylinder head it again for 15 seconds.“ Do the
and disconnect spill tube (2). measurement in this manner.
PC210LC-10 30-33
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
30-34 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
PC210LC-10 30-35
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
a Testing tools 9. Stop the engine and check the fuel piping and
Symbol devices for fuel leakage.
Part No. Part Name
Developer for dye a Check the high-pressure circuit for fuel
Commercially penetrant check
L leakage focusing on the area to which color
available (color checker) checker L is sprayed.
k Very high pressure is generated in the high- a If any fuel leakage is detected, repair it and
pressure circuit of the fuel system. If fuel perform inspection again from Step 1.
leaks while the engine is running, it presents a If no fuel leakage is detected, inspection is
a serious danger that could result in a fire. completed.
After checking the fuel system or removing
its parts, check it for fuel leakage according
to the following procedure.
30-36 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
PC210LC-10 30-37
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
30-38 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
Testing (PC200_10-K5A0-285-K-00-A)
PC210LC-10 30-39
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
30-40 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Engine and cooling system
a The auto-tensioner is provided for the fan belt. 2. Replace fan belt (2).
Thus, testing and adjustment of the belt is • Check each pulley for breakage and crack.
usually not necessary.
a Disconnect the air conditioner compressor belt
before replacing the fan belt.
k Place the machine on a level ground and
lower the work equipment to the ground.
Replacing (PC220-B430-923-K-00-A)
PC210LC-10 30-41
30 Testing and adjusting
Power train
a Testing tools 5. From this state, read the dial gauge K value.
Sym- a The value indicated by dial gauge K is the
Part No. Part Name
bol clearance of the bearing.
Commercially Dial gauge
K
available
Testing (PC-J117-365-K-00-A)
30-42 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Undercarriage and frame
2. Decreasing tension
1) Loosen valve (2) to discharge grease, and
then tighten it.
PC210LC-10 30-43
30 Testing and adjusting
Hydraulic system
30-44 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Hydraulic system
Testing and adjusting oil pressure in work equipment, swing, and travel
circuits (PC200_10-C000-360-K-00-A)
a Tools for testing and adjusting 2. Start the engine to increase the hydraulic oil
Sym- temperature to 45 to 55°C and measure the
Part No. Part name pump discharge pressure.
bol
799-101-5002 Hydraulic tester
M 1
790-261-1204 Digital hydraulic tester
Testing (PC200_10-C000-362-K-00-A) a When the oil flow from the pumps is divided,
the front pump and rear pump actuate each
Measuring method by using oil pressure gauge actuator independently as shown on the
1. Open the side cover on the right side of the table. Note that the relieved valve varies
machine body and connect oil pressure gauge depending on the actuator.
[1] of hydraulic tester M1 to ports (1) and (2).
a When the work equipment circuit or swing
a Use the oil pressure gauge of 60 MPa {600 circuit is relieved singly, the oil flows from the
kg/cm2}. pumps are merged. When the travel circuit is
• (1): Rear pump discharge pressure pickup relieved singly, the oil flows from the pumps
port are divided.
• (2): Front pump discharge pressure pickup
port a The actuators in the table are arranged in the
order that the control valves are viewed from
the front of the machine. (As for the service
valve, the table shows an example in which
an attachment is installed.)
Pump Actuator Valve to be relieved
(R unload valve) (R main relief valve)
Service Safety valve
Rear Bucket R main relief valve
L.H.
R main relief valve
travel
Boom R main relief valve
(Merge-divider valve) (Travel junction valve)
(Self-pressure reducing valve)
Swing Swing motor safety valve
R.H.
Front F main relief valve
travel
Arm F main relief valve
(F unload valve) (F main relief valve)
(Centralized safety valve) (Back pressure valve)
3. Testing unload pressure
1) Start the engine, set the working mode to
power mode (P), and turn the auto
deceleration OFF.
PC210LC-10 30-45
30 Testing and adjusting
Hydraulic system
a If the one-touch power maximizing switch Measuring method by using machine monitor
is not pressed, the low relief pressure is a The oil pressure in the work equipment, swing,
obtained. If the former is pressed, the and travel circuits (pump discharge pressure)
high relief pressure is obtained. can be checked from the “Monitoring/Pre-
a If the swing lock switch is set to the ON defined“ or “Monitoring“ screen of the machine
position, the 2-stage relief valve is kept monitor.
ON and the relief valve is relieved at high 1. Start the engine and set the machine monitor to
pressure. Therefore, keep the swing lock “Monitoring/Pre-defined“ or “Monitoring“ screen.
switch at the OFF position.
5. Testing swing relief pressure a For the setting method, see "Special
functions of machine monitor".
1) Start the engine, set the working mode to the
Power Mode (P), and turn the swing lock • Monitoring code: 01100 “F Pump Pressure“
switch ON. • Monitoring code: 01101 “R Pump Pressure“
2) Measure the hydraulic oil pressure when the • “Monitoring/Pre-defined (8/14)“ screen
engine is running at high idle and the swing
circuit is relieved.
a Hydraulic oil pressure when the swing
motor safety valve is relieved is
displayed.
a The swing motor relief pressure is lower
than that of the main relief valve.
6. Testing travel relief pressure
1) Run the engine and lock the travel
mechanism.
30-46 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Hydraulic system
PC210LC-10 30-47
30 Testing and adjusting
Hydraulic system
30-48 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Hydraulic system
a Testing tools
Sym-
Part No. Part name
bol
Sensor adapter
796T-440-1200
(5 MPa {50 kg/cm2})
796-440-1150 • Wiring harness
1
799-401-2350 • Washer
790-261-1130 • Coupling
N
7861-93-1840 • Pressure sensor
799-101-5220 Nipple (M10 x 1.25 mm)
2
07002-11023 O-ring
799-101-5002 Hydraulic tester
3 3. Start the engine to increase the hydraulic oil
790-261-1204 Digital hydraulic tester temperature to 45 to 55°C.
4. Measure the hydraulic oil pressure, when the
k Lower the work equipment to the ground and
engine is running at full speed and all the control
stop the engine. Operate the control levers
levers are set to the NEUTRAL.
several times to release the remaining
pressure in the piping, and then loosen the
oil filler cap of the hydraulic tank slowly to
release the internal pressure.
PC210LC-10 30-49
30 Testing and adjusting
Hydraulic system
30-50 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Hydraulic system
PC210LC-10 30-51
30 Testing and adjusting
Hydraulic system
30-52 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Hydraulic system
PC210LC-10 30-53
30 Testing and adjusting
Hydraulic system
30-54 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Hydraulic system
PC210LC-10 30-55
30 Testing and adjusting
Hydraulic system
Almost same
LS valve pressure Approx. 0.6 (3/5)
output of above
pressure pressure
Operation of lever
All control levers Travel lever at
and pedals in half stroke
NEUTRAL (Track runs idle)
30-56 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Hydraulic system
PC210LC-10 30-57
30 Testing and adjusting
Hydraulic system
3. While running the engine at high idle under the 1. Connect oil pressure gauge [1] of hydraulic
following condition, measure the pump tester Q1 to LS set selector pressure pickup port
discharge pressure and LS pressure (actuator (7).
load pressure) simultaneously.
a Use the oil pressure gauge of 6.0 MPa {60
• Working mode: P mode
kg/cm2}.
• Travel speed: Hi
• Work equipment, swing and travel: When all
levers are at NEUTRAL and when travel
lever is at half stroke (to run a track idle off
ground)
30-58 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Hydraulic system
PC210LC-10 30-59
30 Testing and adjusting
Hydraulic system
a Testing tools
Sym-
Part No. Part name
bol
799-101-5002 Hydraulic tester
1
790-261-1204 Digital hydraulic tester
R
799-401-3100 Adapter (size: 02)
2
02896-11008 O-ring
1. Disconnect outlet hoses (1) to (7) of the solenoid a When testing at hoses (2) to (7), remove the
valves to be measured. undercover of the control valve.
No. Target solenoid valves of measurement
1 PPC lock solenoid valve
2 2-stage relief solenoid valve
3 Swing holding brake solenoid valve
4 Travel speed increase solenoid valve
5 Travel junction solenoid valve
6 2-stage swing relief solenoid valve
Attachment selector solenoid valve
7
(for the machine with the attachment)
30-60 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Hydraulic system
PC210LC-10 30-61
30 Testing and adjusting
Hydraulic system
Signals of work equipment and swing (Work equipment includes All are OFF. OFF
attachment.) Any one is
ON
ON.
(4) Operation table of travel speed increase solenoid valve
Operating condition Operation
Overheat 2nd setting is ON.
Fuel control dial is at 1,500 rpm or below.
Travel speed switch is at Lo.
OFF
Travel signal is OFF.
When F or R pump pressure is 24.5 MPa
Travel speed switch:
{250 kg/cm2} or above.
Mi, Hi Travel signal is ON.
When F or R pump pressure is 15.3 MPa
{150 kg/cm2} or below. ON
Other than the above conditions
(5) Operation table of travel junction solenoid valve
Operating condition Operation
Travel steering signal is ON.
When " travel only" When F or R pump pressure ON
signal is ON. is 24.5 MPa {250 kg/cm2} or
Travel steering signal is OFF.
above.
Other than the above conditions OFF
30-62 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Hydraulic system
PC210LC-10 30-63
30 Testing and adjusting
Hydraulic system
a Testing tools
Sym-
Part No. Part name
bol
799-101-5002 Hydraulic tester
1
790-261-1204 Digital hydraulic tester
S
799-401-3100 Adapter (Size: 02)
2
799-401-3200 Adapter (Size: 03)
30-64 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Hydraulic system
PC210LC-10 30-65
30 Testing and adjusting
Hydraulic system
30-66 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Hydraulic system
a Before testing pump swash plate sensor, check a Testing condition and judgment: If the voltages
that oil pressure in work equipment, swing, and are as shown in the table, pump swash plate
travel circuits, control circuit source pressure, sensor is correct.
and no-load travel speed are correct. Pump swash plate
Lever control sensor voltage
a Test pump swash plate sensor under the
following conditions. All control levers and
pedals are at neutral. 1.35 ± 0.63 V
• Hydraulic oil temperature: 45 to 55°C
Travel lever is at stroke
• Working mode: P mode end.
3.35 ± 0.63 V
Testing output voltage of pump swash plate (run track idle off
sensor ground)
a Output voltage of pump swash plate sensor can
be checked by using monitoring function of
machine monitor.
(For the operating method, see "Special
functions of machine monitor".)
• Monitoring code:
01138 “F pump sw plate sensor volt“
01140 “R pump sw plate sensor volt“
Testing (PC220-C3WG-36J-K-00-A)
PC210LC-10 30-67
30 Testing and adjusting
Hydraulic system
a If the work equipment (cylinder) drifts 2) Operate the arm control lever to the arm IN
hydraulically, perform check to see if the position.
problem is in the cylinder seal or control valve • If the lowering speed is increased at this
according to the following procedure. time, the cylinder seal is defective.
Checking (PC-L410-360-K-00-A) • If the lowering speed does not change at
this time, the control valve is defective.
1. Checking boom cylinder and bucket cylinder
a Operate the control lever with the engine
1) Set the work equipment in the same posture
starting switch in the ON position.
as when measuring hydraulic drift, and stop
the engine. a If there is no more pressure in the
accumulator, run the engine for
a Put a weight equivalent to the rated load
approximately 10 seconds to charge the
or fill the bucket with the earth and sand.
accumulator.
[Reference] In case of the hydraulic drift is
caused by defective cylinder packing, the
reason why the drift speed becomes faster by
above mentioned operation is as follows:
1) If the work equipment is set to the above
posture (where the work equipment holding
pressure is applied to the bottom side), the
oil leaks from the bottom side to the head
side. The volume on the head side is less
than that on the bottom side by the volume of
the rod, so the pressure in the head side is
increased by the oil flowing in from the
bottom side.
2) When testing the boom cylinder, set the 2) As the inner pressure in the head side is
boom control lever to the RAISE position. increased, it is balanced with the pressure in
When testing the bucket cylinder, set the the bottom side at a certain level (which
bucket control lever to the CURL position. depends on the leak quantity), and the
• If the lowering speed is increased at this lowering speed is reduced.
time, the cylinder seal is defective. 3) If the circuit on the head side is opened to
• If the lowering speed does not change at the drain circuit by the above operation of the
this time, the control valve is defective. lever (the bottom side is closed by the check
a Operate the control lever with the engine valve at this time), the oil in the head side
starting switch in the ON position. flows in the drain circuit. As a result, the
pressure is in balanced and the lowering
a If there is no more pressure in the speed is increased.
accumulator, run the engine for 3. Testing PPC valve
approximately 10 seconds to charge the Measure the hydraulic drift of the work
accumulator. equipment when the work equipment lock lever
2. Checking arm cylinder is in the LOCK and FREE positions with the
1) Move the arm cylinder to about 100 mm accumulator charged fully.
before the IN stroke end and stop the engine.
a Operate the control lever with the engine
starting switch in the ON position.
a If there is no more pressure in the
accumulator, run the engine for
approximately 10 seconds to charge the
accumulator.
a If there is any difference in the hydraulic drift
between LOCK and FREE positions, the
PPC valve is defective (some internal
defect).
30-68 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Hydraulic system
PC210LC-10 30-69
30 Testing and adjusting
Hydraulic system
a Use the following part to block on the 1) Remove the travel motor cover.
hose end. 2) Run the engine, lock the travel mechanism,
07379-00640 (Flange #06) and stop the engine.
a Start measuring the oil leakage 30 a Start measuring the oil leakage 30
seconds after relieving is started, and seconds after relieving is started, and
measure the leak for 1 minute. measure the leak for 1 minute.
a After measuring one time, swing 180 deg., a Take measurement several times, moving
and then measure the leak again. the motor a little each time (i.e. change
4) After finishing testing, return the machine the position of the valve plate and
status as it was. cylinder, and that of the cylinder and
5. Measurement of oil leakage from travel motor piston each time).
30-70 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Hydraulic system
PC210LC-10 30-71
30 Testing and adjusting
Hydraulic system
q: Execution of work
o: Go to next procedure
Air bleeding procedure and item
1 2 3 4 5 6
Bleeding air Checking oil
from Starting the Bleeding air Bleeding air Bleeding air
level and
hydraulic engine from cylinder from swing from travel
operating
pump motor motor
machine
• Replacement of
hydraulic oil q q
q q q q
• Cleaning (See note) (See note)
strainer
• Replacing
return oil filter q o o o q
element
• Replacing or
repairing
hydraulic pump q q q o o q
• Removal of
suction piping
• Replacing or
repairing
control valve
q q o o q
• Removal of
Detail of work, remarks
control valve
piping
• Replacement
or repair of
cylinder q q o o q
• Removal of
cylinder piping
• Replacing or
repairing swing
motor
q o q o q
• Removal of
swing motor
piping
• Replacing or
repairing travel
motor
q o o q q
• Removal of
travel motor
piping
• Replacing or
repairing swivel
joint q o o o q
• Installing swivel
joint piping
Note: Bleed air from the swing motor and travel motor only when the oil in the motor cases is drained.
2) After oil containing no bubbles flows out,
Bleeding air (PC220-C000-231-P-01-A) tighten air bleeder (1).
1. Air bleeding from hydraulic pump 3 Air bleeder: 7.8 to 9.8 Nm {0.8 to
1.0 kgm}
a Keep the oil filler cap of the hydraulic tank
loosened while the air is bled from the
hydraulic pump.
1) Loosen air bleeder (1) and check that oil
oozes out from it.
30-72 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Hydraulic system
2. Starting engine
When running the engine after performing step 1,
let it low-idle for 10 minutes.
6. Bleeding air from swivel joint
a When the automatic warm-up operation is 1) Run the engine at low speed.
started due to low engine coolant 2) Raise a track and run it idle slowly (forward
temperature, stop the engine once and and reverse directions) to bleed air. Apply the
cancel the automatic warm-up operation same procedure to the right and left tracks.
using the fuel dial. (You can cancel the 7. Checking oil level and starting work
automatic warm-up function by turning the
1) Run the engine, retract the arm cylinder and
starting switch to the ON position and
bucket cylinder to the stroke end, lower the
keeping the fuel dial in the MAX position for 3
work equipment to the ground, and stop the
seconds or longer.)
engine.
3. Bleeding air from cylinder
a When the cylinder has been replaced, bleed
the air before connecting the work equipment.
The above step is necessary particularly
when boom cylinder is installed on work
equipment because the LOWER side does
not move to the stroke end in this state.
1) Run the engine at low idle for approximately
5 minutes.
2) While running the engine at low speed, raise
and lower the boom four to five times.
a Stop the piston rod approximately 100
mm before each stroke end. Do not
cause the relief. 2) Check the oil level using sight gauge (3) on
3) While running the engine at full speed, the rear side of the hydraulic tank.
perform step 2). a If the oil leakage is between lines (H) and
4) While running the engine at low idle speed, (L), it is normal.
move the piston rod to the stroke end and
relieve the oil. a If the oil level is below line (L), add new
5) Bleed air from the arm cylinder and bucket oil.
cylinder according to steps 2) to 4).
4. Bleeding air from swing motor
1) Run the engine at low speed.
2) Swing to the right and left slowly to bleed air.
5. Bleeding air from travel motor
1) Run the engine at low speed.
2) Loosen air bleeder (2) and check that oil
oozes out from it.
3) After oil containing no bubbles flows out,
tighten air bleeder (2).
PC210LC-10 30-73
30 Testing and adjusting
Cab and its attachments
[Reference]
• Note that the tightening torque for mounting bolt
(4) of cab tipping stopper (3) is different from that
of a common bolt 30 mm in diameter.
3 Bolt (4):
245 to 309 Nm {25 to 31.5kgm}
30-74 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Cab and its attachments
1. Mirror installing positions • Adjust the mirror so that the side of the
machine is reflected in it as shown in the
figure.
PC210LC-10 30-75
30 Testing and adjusting
Cab and its attachments
30-76 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
PC210LC-10 30-77
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
30-78 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
The machine monitor has the ordinary functions and special functions and displays information of various
types on the multi-information display panel.
Some information are displayed automatically according to the configuration of the machine monitor and the
others are displayed according to the operation of the switches.
1. Ordinary functions: Operator mode
The information items in this mode are displayed ordinarily. The operator can display and set them by
operating the switches (Display and setting of some items need special operations of the switches).
2. Special function: Service mode
The information items in this mode are not displayed ordinarily. Each technician can display them by
operating the switches specially.
This mode is used for special setting, testing, adjusting, or troubleshooting.
PC210LC-10 30-79
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
30-80 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
PC210LC-10 30-81
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
30-82 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
Display of KOMATSU logo (PC220-Q180-044-K-01-A) a If this screen is displayed, call the person
When starting switch is turned to ON position, responsible for the operation of KOMTRAX in
KOMATSU logo is displayed for 2 seconds. your Komatsu distributor and ask for remedy.
a After the KOMATSU logo screen is displayed for
2 seconds, the screen changes to "Password
input" screen, or "Check before starting" screen.
PC210LC-10 30-83
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
a If any abnormalities are detected in the check a The maintenance reminder function is enabled
before starting, the screen changes to "Warning or disabled by using the machine monitor in the
after the check before starting" screen or service mode.
"Overdue Maintenance" screen.
a If no abnormalities were detected in the check
before starting, display changes to "Working
Mode and Travel Speed Check" screen.
a The monitors (6 monitors) on the screen shows
the items currently subjected to the check before
starting.
Display of ending of maintenance a Right end of the screen displays ECO gauge (b)
interval (PC220-Q180-044-K-06-A) (turn on or off the display in the operator mode).
If the check before starting detected a maintenance
item that is near or overdue the set interval, the
maintenance monitor is displayed for 30 seconds to
urge the operator to perform maintenance.
a This screen is displayed only when the
maintenance reminder function is enabled. If the
remaining time of any item is 30 hours or less,
the yellow icon is displayed. If the remaining
time of any item is 0 hour or less, the red icon is
displayed.
30-84 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
PC210LC-10 30-85
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
2. Operate the function switches or working mode • If an attachment other than the breaker is
selector switch to select the desired working used, the machine may move unexpectedly
mode and enter the selection. or may not operate normally or the hydraulic
Function switch components may be damaged.
• [F3]: Moves to lower item • After the breaker mode is selected, the
• [F4]: Moves to upper item screen to confirm the selection of the breaker
• [F5]: Cancels selection and returns to mode is displayed (The buzzer sounds
standard screen intermittently while this screen is displayed).
• [F6]: Enters selection and returns to standard • If the setting is confirmed on this screen, the
screen screen changes to the standard screen.
Working mode selector switch If "No" is selected: Screen returns to working
• Pressed : Moves to lower item mode selecting screen
• Kept pressed : Enters selection and returns If [Yes] is selected: Working mode is set to
to standard screen breaker mode [B]
a If you do not touch any of the function
switches and working mode selector switch
for 5 seconds, the selection is determined
and the screen changes to the standard
screen.
a When large monitor (a) is displayed, the a When large monitor (a) is displayed, the display
display of working mode monitor (b) is of travel speed monitor (b) is changed, too.
changed, too.
30-86 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
PC210LC-10 30-87
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
30-88 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
PC210LC-10 30-89
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
a The lamp for the E-mode recommendation a The lamp for the low fuel level guidance goes
guidance goes out automatically after 10 out automatically after 10 seconds has
seconds has passed since it appeared, or if passed since it appeared, or if the function
the function switch [F5] is pressed. switch [F5] is pressed.
30-90 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
a Even if KDPF regeneration monitor (1) lights 1) When the degree of emergency is low
up, the machine does not need to be stopped If KDPF soot accumulation monitor (2) is
and the operator can continue work normally, yellow (Action level (3): L01), the following
as long as the alarm monitor is not displayed screen is displayed first.
at the center of the standard screen.
PC210LC-10 30-91
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
30-92 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
PC210LC-10 30-93
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
30-94 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
a Remedies requested to operator by displayed action levels (The following table is an excerpt from the
"Operation and Maintenance Manual".)
Degree of
Action level Buzzer Alarm monitor Remedy
urgency
Stop immediately and perform
Q checking and maintenance.
High L04 Q
(Continuous) Ask your Komatsu distributor for
testing and repair services.
Stop work, move machine to safe
place, stop it, and perform checking
Q
L03 Q and maintenance.
(Intermittent)
Ask your Komatsu distributor for
testing and repair services.
I Stop the work, and then run the
engine at medium speed with no
Q load or stop it. If the condition is not
L02 Q
(Intermittent) improved, ask your Komatsu
distributor for testing and repair
services.
Some functions are restricted, but
the machine can operate. After
L01 finishing work, perform checking
Low (For 2 seconds ― Q and maintenance.
only) Ask your Komatsu distributor to
perform testing or repairs as
necessary.
PC210LC-10 30-95
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
30-96 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
PC210LC-10 30-97
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
30-98 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
Service mode (PC220-Q194-100-K-00-A) a The menu items which can be selected in the
To change the mode of the machine monitor to the service menu are as follows (including some
service mode from the operator mode, perform the items which need special operations).
following operation. Monitoring / Pre-defined(PAGE
This operation is always required when you use the 01 30-100)
service mode. 02 Monitoring(PAGE 30-105)
1. Check of screen display and operation of Abnormality record (mechanical
switches systems)(PAGE 30-114)
03
While the standard screen is displayed, perform Abnormality record (electrical
the following operation by using the numeral systems)(PAGE 30-115)
input switches. Maintenance Record(PAGE 30-
04 116)
• Operation of switches (While pressing [4],
press the switches in order): Maintenance Mode Setting
[4]+[1] o [ 2 ] o [ 3 ] 05
(PAGE 30-117)
a This operation of the switches is accepted Phone number entry(PAGE 30-
06 120)
only while the standard screen is displayed.
Default (Key-on Mode)(PAGE
30-120)
Default value setting (Unit)
07 (PAGE 30-121)
Default (With/Without
Attachment)(PAGE 30-122)
Default (Camera)(PAGE 30-123)
Testing (Cylinder Cut-out
operation)(PAGE 30-124)
Testing (Regeneration for
08 Service)(PAGE 30-125)
Testing (KDPF Memory Reset)
(PAGE 30-127)
2. Selection of service menu Adjustment (Pump Absorption
Torque (F))(PAGE 30-128)
When the "Service Menu" screen is displayed,
the service mode is selected. Select the desired Adjustment (Pump Absorption
service menu by using the function switches or Torque (R))(PAGE 30-128)
numeral input switches. Adjustment (travel low speed
• [F3]: Moves to lower item setting)(PAGE 30-129)
• [F4]: Moves to upper item Adjustment (Attachment Flow
• [F5]: Returns the display to the standard Adjustment)(PAGE 30-130)
screen (operator mode) Adjustment (F pump swash plate
• [F6]: Validates the selection sensor calibration)(PAGE 30-
132)
a If you input a 2-digit code by using the Adjustment (R pump swash plate
numeral input switches, the corresponding 09 sensor calibration)(PAGE 30-
menu is directly selected. This will allow you 137)
to validate the selection using [F6].
Adjustment (Pump calibration:
Matching speed calibration)
(PAGE 30-142)
PC210LC-10 30-99
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
30-100 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
PC210LC-10 30-101
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
List of monitoring / pre-defined items (SI unit indicates the default values)
Support screen (1/14) Machine basic items
Applicable
No. ID Item name Unit (SI)
equipment
1 01002 Engine speed r/min ENG
2 04107 Coolant temperature °C ENG
3 37212 Engine oil switch ENG
4 18400 Intake temperature °C ENG
5 04401 Hydr. oil temperature °C PUMP
Battery power
6 03203 supply V ENG
30-102 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
PC210LC-10 30-103
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
30-104 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
PC210LC-10 30-105
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
30-106 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
PC210LC-10 30-107
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
30-108 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
PC210LC-10 30-109
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
30-110 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
PC210LC-10 30-111
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
30-112 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
PC210LC-10 30-113
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
a Equipment in charge
ENG: The engine controller detects monitoring information.
KDPF: Engine controller is in charge of detecting monitoring information.
PUMP: The pump controller detects monitoring information.
MON: The machine monitor detects monitoring information.
Note 1: Fuel Rate (Code No. : 37300) is theoretical fuel consumption ratio. (Since it is a theoretical value,
there is some differences between the actual fuel consumption ratio).
30-114 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
PC210LC-10 30-115
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
30-116 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
PC210LC-10 30-117
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
30-118 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
PC210LC-10 30-119
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
5. Setting of each maintenance item • [F5] Cancels contents of setting before entry
Select each maintenance item. After the screen and returns to the "Maintenance Mode
is displayed, set the item by using the function Change" screen
switches. • [F6]: Enters setting and returns to
• ON: Function of the selected individual "Maintenance Mode Change" screen
maintenance item becomes effective in
a When you enter by using [F6] and return to
operator mode.
the "Maintenance Mode Setting" screen by
• OFF: Function of the selected individual
using [F5] , your setting is validated.
maintenance item becomes ineffective in
operator mode. a If the set value of an item of which
• [F3]: Moves selection to the below item maintenance reminder function is set to "ON"
• [F4]: Moves selection to the above item is changed after 1 operating hour or more
• [F5]: Cancels selection and returns to the from the setup, the change is recognized as
"Maintenance Mode Change" screen a reset of the remaining time.
• [F6]: Enters selection and returns to
"Maintenance Mode Change" screen
30-120 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
Phone number entry (PC220-Q19A-110-K-00-A) a Up to 14 digits can be input from the left.
The telephone number, which is displayed together Input nothing in the surplus places.
with the "Occurred error list" in the operator mode, a If an input numeral is wrong, move the cursor
can be input and changed according to the following (orange background) to that digit and
procedure. overwrite it with the correct numeral.
If a telephone number is not input with this function,
a If [F6] is pressed without inputting a digit,
no telephone number is displayed in the operator
there is not information of telephone No.
mode.
Accordingly, no telephone No. is displayed in
1. Selecting menu the operator mode.
Select “Phone Number Entry“ on the “Service
Menu“ screen.
PC210LC-10 30-121
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
3. Selecting mode
Default value setting (Unit) (PC220-Q1F3-100-K-00-A)
After the “Key-on Mode“ screen is displayed,
Use the menu of "Default" to check or change
select the mode to be set by using the function
various settings of the machine monitor and
switches.
machine.
• Power mode: [P] is displayed when the
starting switch is set to ON position The unit selecting function is used to select the unit
• Economy mode: [E] is displayed when the of the data to be displayed in monitoring, etc.
starting switch is set to ON position 1. Selecting menu
• Lifting Operation Mode: [L] is displayed when Select “Default“ on “Service Menu“ screen.
the starting switch is turned to ON position.
• Breaker Mode: [B] is displayed when the
starting switch is turned to ON position.
• Attachment/P-mode: [ATT/P] is displayed
when the starting switch is set to the ON
position.
• Attachment/E-mode: [ATT/E] is displayed
when the starting switch is set to the ON
position.
• Mode at Previous Key-off: Final mode in
previous operation is displayed when the
starting switch is turned to ON position.
• [F3]: Moves selection to the below item
• [F4]: Moves selection to the above item 2. Selecting sub menu
• [F5]: Cancels selection and returns the After the “Default“ screen is displayed, select
display to Default screen “Unit“ by using the function switch or numeral
input switches.
30-122 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
3. Selecting With/Without
After the “With/Without Attachment“ screen is
displayed, select a setting by using the function
switch.
• Without Attachment: When attachment is not
installed
• With Attachment: When attachment is
Default (With/Without Attachment) (PC220-Q1F4- installed
100-K-00-A) • [F3]: Moves selection to the below item
Use the menu of Default to check or change various • [F4]: Moves selection to the above item
settings of the machine monitor and machine. • [F5]: Cancels selection and returns the
Use the sub menu of "With/Without Attachment" to display to Default screen
configure attachment setting when the attachment • [F6]: Enters selection and returns the display
is installed or removed. to Default screen
1. Selecting menu a When an attachment is installed, if this
Select “Default“ on “Service Menu“ screen. setting is not configured correctly, the
attachment setting in the operator mode
cannot be performed. As a result, the
attachment may not work normally or the
hydraulic components may be damaged.
PC210LC-10 30-123
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
30-124 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
1. Selecting menu
Select “Diagnostic Tests“ on “Service Menu“
screen.
PC210LC-10 30-125
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
[Reference]
• If a normally operating cylinder is cut out, the
following phenomena occur.
1) Lowering of engine speed
2) Fuel Inject Command (quantity) increases.
• If the engine is running at near high idle,
4. Releasing cut-out cylinder however, the engine speed may not lower for
When changing a cylinder to be cut out or when the reason of engine control.
Cylinder Cut-Out operation is finished, select a • In this case, lower the engine speed with the
cut-out cylinder to be reset with the function fuel control dial and judge by increase of the
switches. injection rate command.
a This operation may be performed while the Testing (Regeneration for Service) (PC220-A9H0-
engine is running. 252-K-00-A)
a When [F6] is pressed, if background (a) of In the machine monitor, the cylinder cut-out mode
the selected cylinder No. becomes blue, the operation and the KDPF regeneration operation can
cylinder is reset. be executed as well as their cancellation.
Active regeneration for service refers to the method
a If the machine monitor releases a cut-out of burning soot by performing the KDPF
cylinder but the engine controller cannot regeneration, regardless of the soot accumulation.
release the cut-out cylinder, the background
(a) of the cylinder number becomes red. 1. Selecting menu
Select “Diagnostic Tests“ on “Service Menu“
a The cut-out cylinder mode operation is not screen.
automatically released after the screen
returns to the operator mode. Accordingly, be
sure to perform the releasing operation after
the cylinder cut-out mode operation is
finished.
5. Holding displayed data
Each time [F4] is pressed during the Cylinder
Cut-Out operation, the displayed data is newly
held (c) (the real-time data is kept displayed on
the left side).
While the data is held, if [F4] is pressed, the data
holding function is reset.
a The holding function is available for a
cylinder, regardless of whether it is cut out or 2. Selecting sub menu
not. After the “Diagnostic Tests“ screen is displayed,
select “Regeneration for Service“ by using the
function switch or numeral input switches.
a Select this item similarly to an item on the
“Service Menu“ screen.
30-126 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
a While the KDPF regeneration status is in the a Before performing the manual stationary
manual stationary regeneration or stopped, regeneration, make sure the surrounding
“Regeneration for Service“ cannot be environment is safe, no people and no
selected. combustibles are in the area. When you
have to move the machine again for the
sake of security, move it to a safe place
and repeat the operation from the start.
a The active regeneration for service
automatically stops in 40 minutes.
However, if the regeneration is started
with the soot accumulation of
approximately 4 g/liter and if the soot
accumulation still remains at above 1.9 g/
liter after 40 minutes from the start, the
operation is switched to the automatic
regeneration. The regeneration is
continued until the soot accumulation
3. Setting regeneration for service decreases to 1.9 g/liter.
When “Regeneration for Service“ screen is
displayed, the following informations are
displayed corresponding to the KDPF
regeneration condition. Set the KDPF
regeneration according to the given messages.
(a): Soot accumulation level
(b): Regenerating condition of KDPF
(c): Selectable items
(d): Message
PC210LC-10 30-127
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
30-128 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
a Select this item similarly to an item on the Adjustment (Pump Absorption Torque
“Service Menu“ screen. (R)) (PC220-C202-27E-K-00-A)
You can make various adjustments related to the
machine with the machine monitor.
PC210LC-10 30-129
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
The sub menu of Pump Absorption Torque (R) is a The 3-digit number in the left column do not
used to finely adjust the absorption torque of the change since it is the code of this function.
rear hydraulic pump.
1. Selecting menu
Select “Adjustment“ on “Service Menu“ screen.
30-130 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
PC210LC-10 30-131
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
30-132 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
Calibration Calibra-
of front tion of rear
pump pump
swash swash
plate plate
sensor sensor
Removal and installation
or replacement of front Necessary ―
pump swash plate sensor
Removal and installation
Neces-
or replacement of rear ―
sary
pump swash plate sensor
Replacement of main Neces-
Necessary
pump assembly sary
Replacement of pump Neces-
Necessary 1. Preparation for calibration
controller sary
Adjustment and Before starting calibration, set the machine
disassembly of front Necessary ― under the following condition
pump PC valve • Hydraulic oil temperature: 50°C
Adjustment and • Working mode: P mode
Neces- • Travel speed: Hi
disassembly of rear ―
sary
pump PC valve 2. Selecting menu
Select “Adjustment“ on “Service Menu“ screen.
PC210LC-10 30-133
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
4. Calibration of front pump swash plate sensor for 3) When the speed of the track running idle is
the maximum angle stabilized,
1) After the “Cal F pump swash plate max“ is hold down [F1] of the machine monitor to
displayed, calibrate the front pump swash start calibration.
plate sensor for the maximum angle by A bar is displayed during calibration.
running track idle off the ground and Keep running the track idle until calibration is
operating the function switches. finished.
[F1]: START
[F2]: CLEAR
[F5]: Returns to the adjustment screen
[F6]: Enters setting
30-134 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
PC210LC-10 30-135
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
30-136 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
Object
MIN MAX
Cause Pump
Calibration Calibration Content Remedies
code Calibration
of swash of swash
plate plate of IT
Engine speed is out of Set the engine to Hi idle
E-3 — — q standard range speed.
Engine torque is out of Perform troubleshooting for
E-4 — — q standard range engine and pump
PC-EPC current is out of Perform troubleshooting for
E-5 — — q standard range PC-EPC current
When bucket CURL circuit is
relieved, bucket CURL PPC
pressure is below standard Set bucket CURL lever to full
E-6 — — q value or bucket CURL PPC stroke.
pressure sensor is out of the
normal range (*1)
Working mode is not set to [P] Set working mode is to [P] or
E-7 — — q or [ATT/P] [ATT/P].
Swing emergency stop switch Set swing emergency stop
E-8 — — q is not set to ON position switch to ON position.
Swing lock switch is not set to Set swing lock switch to ON
E-9 — — q ON position position.
Set air conditioner to OFF
E-A — — q Air conditioner is ON position.
Output voltage of pump swash
Perform troubleshooting for
FF q q — plate sensor is out of
swash plate sensor
calibration range
KDPF regeneration is
G-1 — — q End KDPF regeneration.
underway
(*1) When the sensor voltage is out of the normal range (0.5 to 4.5 V), the pump controller recognizes the
relief pressure to be 0 MPa {0 kg/cm2}. Accordingly, perform troubleshooting, referring to Troubleshooting
(Failure codes "DHPAMA" and "DHPBMA").
PC210LC-10 30-137
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
30-138 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
PC210LC-10 30-139
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
[Reference]
• The alphabet letter at the right top of the
screen indicates the following condition.
D: Default
F: Adjustment value at shipment from factory
(Factory shipment state (Normal))
U: User calibration value 3) Perform arm IN relief operation. When the
5. Matching speed check (arm IN relief) engine speed is stabilized, hold down [F1] on
the machine monitor to start checking.
1) When the “Matching Speed Check“ screen is During matching speed check, a bar is
displayed, relieve the arm IN circuit and displayed on the screen. Keep relief
check the matching speed by using the operation until the check is finished.
function switch.
[F1]: START
[F5]: Returns to pump calibration screen
30-140 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
PC210LC-10 30-141
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
30-142 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
Object
MIN MAX
Cause Pump
Calibration Calibration Content Remedies
code Calibration
of swash of swash
plate plate of IT
Engine speed is out of Set the engine to Hi idle
E-3 — — q standard range speed.
Engine torque is out of Perform troubleshooting for
E-4 — — q standard range engine and pump
PC-EPC current is out of Perform troubleshooting for
E-5 — — q standard range PC-EPC current
When bucket CURL circuit is
relieved, bucket CURL PPC
pressure is below specified Set bucket CURL lever to full
E-6 — — q value or bucket CURL PPC stroke.
pressure sensor is out of the
normal range (*1)
Working mode is not set to [P] Set working mode is to [P] or
E-7 — — q or [ATT/P] [ATT/P].
Swing emergency stop switch Set swing emergency stop
E-8 — — q is not set to ON position switch to ON position.
Swing lock switch is not set to Set swing lock switch to ON
E-9 — — q ON position position.
Set air conditioner to OFF
E-A — — q Air conditioner is ON position.
Output voltage of pump swash
Perform troubleshooting for
FF q q — plate sensor is out of
swash plate sensor
calibration range
KDPF regeneration is
G-1 — — q End KDPF regeneration.
underway
(*1) When the sensor voltage is out of the normal range (0.5 to 4.5 V), the pump controller recognizes the
relief pressure to be 0 MPa {0 kg/cm2}. Accordingly, perform troubleshooting, referring to Troubleshooting
(Failure codes "DHPAMA" and "DHPBMA").
PC210LC-10 30-143
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
4. Selecting matching speed calibration menu When [F6] is pressed, if the “Pump Calibration“
After the “Pump Calibration“ screen is displayed, screen is displayed and alphabet letter "D" is
select “Matching Speed Calibration“ by using the indicated at the right top of the screen, initialization
function switch or numeral input switches. is completed.
30-144 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
When the “No Injection“ screen is displayed, the a This function can be selected even when the
message to ask if no injection cranking should engine is running. However, if you execute
be performed appears. Select the answer by the no injection cranking, a message “The
using the function switch. engine is operating. Please turn the key off
• [F5]: Do not perform (return to Service Menu once.“ is displayed on the screen.
screen)
• [F6]: Executes
PC210LC-10 30-145
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
2. Selecting submenu
After the “KOMTRAX Settings” screen is
displayed, select “Terminal Status” with the
function switches or numeral input switches.
a Select this submenu as in the case of
selecting a menu on the "Service Menu"
screen.
30-146 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
PC210LC-10 30-147
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
30-148 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
a Adjust the camera so that persons in the area a The claw of cover (2) is made of plastic, so
(W) of 1 meter around the rear of the machine is be careful not to break it when removing.
displayed on the machine monitor in the
operator's cab.
Adjusting (PC220-Q162-270-K-01-A)
PC210LC-10 30-149
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
30-150 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
PC210LC-10 30-151
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
30-152 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Electrical system
PC210LC-10 30-153
30 Testing and adjusting
Pm clinic
Pm clinic (ALL-2160-001-A-00-A)
30-154 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Pm clinic
Coolant
Engine coolant Color of monitor
temperature
temperature light (a)
gauge level
6 105°C
Red
5 102°C
4 100°C
3 85°C Blue
2 60°C
1 30°C White
Hydraulic oil
Hydraulic oil Color of monitor
temperature
temperature light (a)
gauge level
6 105°C
Red
5 102°C
4 100°C
3 85°C Blue
2 40°C
1 20°C White
PC210LC-10 30-155
30 Testing and adjusting
Pm clinic
30-156 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Pm clinic
PC210LC-10 30-157
30 Testing and adjusting
Pm clinic
Measured value
Auto-deceleration
Service limit
Working mode
Check item
Standard
No good
GOOD
Unit
No.
30-158 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Pm clinic
Measured value
Fuel control dial
Service limit
Working mode
Check item
Standard
No good
GOOD
Unit
No.
No good
Service
GOOD
No. Check item Fuel Work- Unit Standard sured
Work equipment posture, limit
control ing value
etc.
dial mode
Hydraulic drift
measured at Boom top horizontal, Arm
Engine stop mm/15
1 bucket tooth cylinder retracted fully, Max 600 Max 900
minutes
tip Bucket loaded
PC210LC-10 30-159
30 Testing and adjusting
Pm clinic
4. Hydraulic circuit
[1] [2] [3] [4] [5]
Testing conditions 60 MPa 60 MPa 60 MPa 60 MPa 6 MPa
{600 kg/ {600 kg/ {600 kg/ {600 kg/ {60 kg/
cm2} cm2} cm2} cm2} cm2}
No good
Fuel control dial
GOOD
No.
Working mode
R pump main
F pump main
R pump LS
F pump LS
Control
Self-
pressure All levers in — — — —
1 A
reducing NEUTRAL
valve OFF
Main relief
2 valve (low B B B B —
pressure)
Arm OUT relief
Main relief
3 valve (high ON C C C C —-
pressure)
Unload All levers in —-
4 D1 D1 D2 D2
valve NEUTRAL
MAX P Right track run
idle, Lever E1 — E2 - —
moved halfway
5 LS valve
Left track run
idle, Lever - E1 — E2 —
OFF moved halfway
Swing lock
switch ON, — — —
Swing F F
Right swing
motor relief
6
safety Swing lock
valve switch ON, Left — — —
F F
swing relief
30-160 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Pm clinic
No good
Fuel control dial
GOOD
No.
Working mode
R pump main
F pump main
R pump LS
F pump LS
Control
Right track
locked ,Right — — — —
G
track forward
relief
Main relief
Right track
valve,
locked , Right — — — —
travel G
track reverse
motor
relief
7 safety MAX P OFF
Left track
valve,
locked, Left — — — —
travel G
track forward
junction
relief
valve
Left track
locked, Left — — — —
G
track reverse
relief
Oil pressure to be checked Unit Standard Service limit
A (Control source
2.93 to 3.43 {30 to 35} 2.75 to 3.43 {28 to 35}
pressure)
B (Work equipment
33.6 to 36.3 {343 to 370} 33.1 to 37.2 {338 to 380}
relief pressure, low)
C (Work equipment
new machine
PC210LC-10 30-161
30 Testing and adjusting
Pm clinic
No good
Testing cm2} cm2} cm2} cm2} cm2}
GOOD
No.
tools Wor-
Fuel L.H. Operation of
king work F pump R pump F pump R pump
control knob Control
mod- main main servo servo
dial switch equipment
e
Servo Arm OUT H1 H1 H2 H2
8 MAX P OFF —
piston relief
Oil pressure to be checked Unit Standard Service limit
Standard
* Gauge connection changing work: Change gauges [3] and [4] to 6 MPa {60 kg/cm2} and exchange
hoses of gauges [3], [4], and [5].
[1] [2] [3b] [4b] [5a]
Testing conditions 60 MPa 60 MPa 6 MPa
6 MPa {60 6 MPa {60
{600 kg/ {600 kg/ {60 kg/
kg/cm2} kg/cm2}
No good
Testing cm2} cm2} cm2}
GOOD
No.
tools Operation
Fuel Work- L.H.
of work F pump R pump F pump (F) R pump
control ing knob (R) LS-EPC
equip- main main
dial mode switch
ment
MIN — — J1 J1 —
PC-EPC(F) P All levers — — J2 J2 —
valve in
9 E — — J3 J3 —
PC-EPC NEU-
(R) valve L TRAL — — J4 J4 —
B — — J5 J5 —
Travel
speed:
LO
Travel — — — — K1
lever in
OFF NEU-
MAX TRAL
Travel
LS-EPC
10 P speed: MI
valve
Travel — — — — K2
lever
operated
Travel
speed: HI
Travel — — — — K3
lever
operated
30-162 PC210LC-10
30 Testing and adjusting
Pm clinic
PC210LC-10 30-163
30 Testing and adjusting
Pm clinic
30-164 PC210LC-10
SHOP MANUAL
HYDRAULIC EXCAVATOR
PC210LC-10
Model Serial Number
40 Troubleshooting
6 40 Troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-1
40 Troubleshooting
Table of contents
40-2 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Table of contents
PC210LC-10 40-3
40 Troubleshooting
Table of contents
Failure code [CA2271] EGR Valve Pos Sens High Error ...................................................... 40-276
Failure code [CA2272] EGR Valve Pos Sens Low Error ....................................................... 40-278
Failure code [CA2288] Turbo Speed High Error 1................................................................ 40-281
Failure code [CA2311] IMV Solenoid Error ......................................................................... 40-282
Failure code [CA2349] EGR Valve Solenoid Open Error ...................................................... 40-283
Failure code [CA2353] EGR Valve Solenoid Short Error ...................................................... 40-285
Failure code [CA2357] EGR Valve Servo Error ................................................................... 40-287
Failure code [CA2373] Exhaust Manifold Press Sens High error........................................... 40-288
Failure code [CA2374] Exhaust Manifold Press Sens Low error ........................................... 40-290
Failure code [CA2375] EGR Orifice Temp Sens High Error .................................................. 40-292
Failure code [CA2376] EGR Orifice Temp Sens Low Error ................................................... 40-294
Failure code [CA2381] KVGT Pos Sens High Error ............................................................. 40-296
Failure code [CA2382] KVGT Pos Sens Low Error .............................................................. 40-298
Failure code [CA2383] KVGT Solenoid Open Error ............................................................. 40-301
Failure code [CA2386] KVGT Solenoid Short Error ............................................................. 40-303
Failure code [CA2387] KVGT Servo Error .......................................................................... 40-305
Failure code [CA2554] Exh Manifold Press Sens In Range Error .......................................... 40-306
Failure code [CA2555] Grid Htr Relay Volt Low Error ........................................................... 40-307
Failure code [CA2556] Grid Htr Relay Volt High Error .......................................................... 40-309
Failure code [CA2637] KDOC Face Plugging ..................................................................... 40-311
Failure code [CA2639] Manual Stationary Regeneration Request......................................... 40-313
Failure code [CA2961] EGR Orifice Temp High Error 1 ........................................................ 40-316
Failure code [CA2973] Chg Air Press Sensor In Range Error ............................................... 40-317
Failure code [CA3133] KDPF Outlet Press Sens High Error ................................................. 40-318
Failure code [CA3134] KDPF Outlet Press Sens Low Error.................................................. 40-320
Failure code [CA3135] KDPF Outlet Press Sens In Range Error .......................................... 40-322
Failure code [CA3251] KDOC Inlet Temp High Error............................................................ 40-326
Failure code [CA3253] KDOC Temp Error - Non Regeneration............................................. 40-329
Failure code [CA3254] KDOC Outlet Temp High Error 1 ...................................................... 40-332
Failure code [CA3255] KDPF Temp Error - Non Regeneration.............................................. 40-335
Failure code [CA3256] KDPF Outlet Temp High Error 1 ....................................................... 40-338
Failure code [CA3311] KDOC Outlet Temp High Error 2....................................................... 40-341
Failure code [CA3312] KDPF Outlet Temp High Error 2 ....................................................... 40-344
Failure code [CA3313] KDOC Inlet Temp Sensor Low Error ................................................. 40-347
Failure code [CA3314] KDOC Inlet Temp Sens High Error ................................................... 40-350
Failure code [CA3315] KDOC Inlet Temp Sens In Range Error............................................. 40-353
Failure code [CA3316] KDOC Outlet Temp Sens Low Error ................................................. 40-357
Failure code [CA3317] KDOC Outlet Temp Sens High Error................................................. 40-360
Failure code [CA3318] KDOC Outlet Temp Sens In Range Error .......................................... 40-364
Failure code [CA3319] KDPF Outlet Temp Sens High Error ................................................. 40-368
Failure code [CA3321] KDPF Outlet Temp Sens Low Error .................................................. 40-372
Failure code [CA3322] KDPF Outlet Temp Sens In Range Error........................................... 40-375
Failure code [CA3419] Mass Air Flow Sensor Sup Volt High Error ........................................ 40-379
Failure code [CA3421] Mass Air Flow Sensor Sup Volt Low Error ......................................... 40-381
Failure code [CA3741] Rail Press Valve Trip Error............................................................... 40-383
Failure code [D110KB] Battery Relay Output Voltage .......................................................... 40-384
Failure code [D19JKZ] Personal Code Relay Abnormality.................................................... 40-386
Failure code [D811MC] KOMTRAX Error............................................................................ 40-389
Failure code [D862KA] GPS Antenna Open Circuit ............................................................. 40-390
Failure code [D8ALKA] System Operating Lamp Disconnection (KOMTRAX)........................ 40-391
Failure code [D8ALKB] System Operating Lamp Short Circuit (KOMTRAX) .......................... 40-393
Failure code [D8AQKR] CAN2 Discon (KOMTRAX) ............................................................ 40-394
Failure code [DA20MC] Pump Controller............................................................................ 40-395
Failure code [DA22KK] Pump Solenoid Power Low Error..................................................... 40-396
Failure code [DA25KP] 5V Sensor 1 Power Abnormality...................................................... 40-398
Failure code [DA29KQ] Model Selection Abnormality .......................................................... 40-401
Failure code [DA2LKA] System Operating Lamp Disconnection (Pump Con) ........................ 40-403
Failure code [DA2LKB] System Operating Lamp Short Circuit (Pump Con) ........................... 40-405
Failure code [DA2QKR] CAN2 Discon (Pump Con) ............................................................. 40-406
40-4 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Table of contents
PC210LC-10 40-5
40 Troubleshooting
Table of contents
40-6 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Table of contents
PC210LC-10 40-7
40 Troubleshooting
Table of contents
40-8 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
(Rev. 2011/09)
k Place the machine on a level ground, and make sure that the frame lock bar, chocks, and parking
brake are applied.
k When performing the operation with two or more service technicians, keep strictly to the agreed
signals, and do not allow any unauthorized person to come near.
k Ifthe radiator cap is removed when the engine is hot, hot water may spurt out and cause burns, so
wait for the engine to cool down before starting troubleshooting.
k Be extremely careful not to touch any hot parts or to get caught in any rotating parts.
k Before disconnecting wiring, remove the key and turn the battery disconnect switch to OFF
position.
k When removing the plug or cap from a component which is under pressure of oil, water, or air,
always release the internal pressure first. When installing measuring equipment, be sure to
connect it properly.
Troubleshooting denotes to locate the primary cause, fix the trouble without delay and prevent its recurrence.
Despite the importance of understanding the structure and operation of the target system in troubleshooting,
you should be aware how interviewing with the operator concerned can facilitate in roughly identifying the
cause of the given undesirable symptom.
1. When performing troubleshooting, do not hurry to disassemble the components.
If components are disassembled immediately after any failure occurs:
• Parts that have no connection with the failure or other unnecessary parts will be disassembled.
• It will become impossible to find the cause of the failure.
It will also cause a waste of manhours, parts, or oil or grease, and at the same time, will also lose the
confidence of the user or operator.
For this reason, when performing troubleshooting, it is necessary to perform thorough prior investigation
and to perform troubleshooting in accordance with the fixed procedure.
2. Points to ask the user or operator
1) Have any other problems occurred apart from the problem that has been reported?
2) Was there anything strange about the machine before the failure occurred?
3) Did the failure occur suddenly, or were there problems with the machine condition before the failure?
4) Under what conditions did the failure occur?
5) Had any repairs been performed before the failure? When were these repairs performed?
6) Has the same kind of failure occurred before?
3. Check before troubleshooting
1)Is there any sign of irregularities of the machine?
2)Make checks before starting day's work.
3)Make checks of other items.
4)Check other maintenance matters which can be checked externally and are considered to be
necessary.
4. Checking failure
Check the extent of the failure by yourself, and judge whether it is a real failure or a problem with the
method of operation, etc.
a When operating the machine to reenact the troubleshooting symptoms, do not perform any inspection
or measurement that may make the problem worse.
5. Troubleshooting
Use the results of the investigation and inspection in Items 2 to 4 to narrow down the probable causes of
the failure, then use the troubleshooting flowchart to locate the failure exactly.
PC210LC-10 40-9
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-10 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
(Rev. 2011. 7)
PC210LC-10 40-11
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-12 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
Judge-
No. Role ment Remedy
value
1 Check for unusual noise and smell - Correct
2 Check for dirt around engine - Remove
3 Check for water leakage around engine - Correct
4 Check for oil leakage around engine - Correct
5 Check for leakage from fuel line - Correct
6 Check of radiator for clogging - Remove
a: Engine, lubricating oil and coolant
2 Correct
Between
3 Check of hydraulic oil level Refilling of oil
H and L
4 Check of hydraulic oil strainer - Clean and drain
5 Check of hydraulic oil filter - Replace
Between
6 Check of swing machinery case oil level Refilling of oil
H and L
Between Refilling of oil
7 Check of damper case oil level
H and L
8 Check of final drive case oil level - Refilling of oil
from cylinder
9 Air bleeding -
PC210LC-10 40-13
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
Judge-
No. Role ment Remedy
value
1 Check of battery terminal for looseness and corrosion - Retighten or replace
2 Check of alternator terminal for looseness and corrosion - Retighten or replace
3 Check of starting motor terminal for looseness and corrosion - Retighten or replace
20 to 30 Charge or replace
4 Check of battery voltage (with engine stopped)
V
Between
5 Check of battery electrolyte level Add or replace
H and L
Check of wiring harness for discoloration, burnt areas and cover
6 peeling - Repair or replace
Check for coming off of wiring harness clamp and sagging of wiring -
7 Correct
harness
c: Electrical parts
40-14 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
Before starting the engine, look around and under the machine to check for any loose nuts or bolts, leakages
of oil, fuel or coolant, and check the condition of the work equipment and hydraulic system.
Check the connectors for looseness, the wiring harnesses for play, and the hot parts for accumulated dust.
k Accumulated combustibles around hot engine parts such as the engine, KDPF, and turbocharger,
etc. and fuel or oil leakages may cause a machine fire. Be sure to check thoroughly and repair any
failures.
a a1 and a2, —, b1, b2, — refer to the symbols in the table on the previous page.
a1. and b1. Check for unusual noise and smell
Check for unusual noise and smell.
Some causes of unusual noise and smell can damage the machine if they are left as they are. Therefore, stop
the machine immediately when you find any abnormality.
a2. Check around engine and dirt removal
Check and remove any accumulated dirt around the engine and any combustibles (dead leaves, twigs, etc.)
on hot engine parts such as the engine, KDPF, turbocharger, etc.
a3. Check for water leakage around engine
a4. Check for oil leakage around engine
Check any oil leaks from the engine and any water leaks from the cooling system. If any of them is abnormal,
carry out a repair.
a5. Check for leakage from fuel line
Check any fuel leaks and damaged hoses and tubes. If any of them is abnormal, carry out a repair.
a6. Check of radiator and dirt removal
Check and remove any accumulated dirt and combustibles (dead leaves, twigs, etc.) around the radiator.
For removal of dirt from the radiator, see the Operation and Maintenance Manual, "Cleaning and testing of
radiator fins, oil cooler fins, aftercooler fins, fuel cooler fins and air conditioner condenser fins (machine with
the air conditioner)".
a14. Check around KDPF and dirt removal
Check and remove any accumulated dirt and combustibles (dead leaves, twigs, etc.) around KDPF.
a15. Check around KDPF for gas leakage
Check piping between the turbocharger and KDPF and joints of KDPF for gas leakage (sticking soot, etc.) If
any abnormality is found, repair.
b2. Check of work equipment, cylinders, linkage and hoses for breakage, wear and clearance
Check the work equipment, cylinders, linkage and hoses for cracks and excessive wear, check that the
clearance between them is within the normal range, and then repair any abnormalities.
b3. Check of hydraulic equipment, hydraulic tank, hoses and joints for oil leakage
Check and repair any oil leaks.
c1. Check around battery and dirt removal
Check and remove any accumulated dirt and combustibles (dead leaves, twigs, etc.) around the battery.
c16. Check and cleaning of rear view camera
Check the rear view camera for any defect, and repair any failures.
d1. Check of undercarriage (track, sprocket, idler and guard) for abnormalities, wear, loose bolts and
oil leakage from roller
Repair any abnormalities.
d2. Check of handrails and steps for abnormalities and loose bolts
Repair any abnormalities and retighten any loose bolts.
d3. Check and cleaning of rear view mirrors
Check and repair any abnormalities and breakage of the rear view mirrors.
PC210LC-10 40-15
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
Clean the mirror surfaces and adjust their angles so that the operator can see the area behind machine at the
operator's seat.
e1. Check of gauges and monitors for abnormalities
Check the gauges and monitors inside the operator cab. If any of them is abnormal, replace it.
Clean up the surfaces.
e2. Check of seat belt and mounting hardware
Check the hooks, locks and hook fittings for damage. If any of them has a problem, replace.
Testing in accordance with testing procedure (PC200_10-5150-280-A-00-A)
40-16 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
2. Place a container under drain hose (1) to catch • The water separator forms one unit with fuel
the drained fuel. pre-filter (1).
3. Turn drain valve (2) to the OPEN (O) position 2. It is possible to judge the water level and amount
and drain all the sediment and water of sediment by looking through transparent cap
accumulated at the bottom together with the fuel. (2). If there is any water or sediment collected at
4. When clean fuel comes out, turn drain valve (2) the bottom, place a container to catch the drain
to the CLOSE (S) position. water under drain hose (3).
5. Close side cover. 3. Loosen drain valve (4) to drain the water.
4. When fuel starts to drain from drain hose (3),
tighten drain valve (4) immediately.
PC210LC-10 40-17
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
a If transparent cap (2) is dirty or it is difficult to a If the transparent cap is tightened too much,
see the inside, clean transparent cap (2) the O-ring may be damaged, and this may
when replacing fuel pre-filter cartridge (1). cause the leakage of fuel. If it is not tightened
enough, fuel may leak through the gap at the
a When the drain valve (4) has been removed
O-ring. Always observe the specified
during the cleaning operation, coat the O-ring
tightening angle.
with grease and tighten until it contacts the
10.Clean the filter holder, fill the new filter cartridge
bottom.
with clean fuel, apply thin film of oil to the -ring,
Replacement of fuel pre-filter cartridge
then install it to the filter holder.
1. Turn valve (1) at the bottom of the fuel tank to
CLOSE position (S). a When adding fuel, do not remove cap (B) at
the center. Always fill the fuel from the dirty
side of eight small holes (A).
a After adding fuel, remove cap (B) and install
the fuel filter.
a Always fill with clean fuel. Be careful not to let
any dirt or dust get into the fuel. In particular,
center portion is the clean side, so do not
remove cap (B) when adding fuel. Be careful
not to let dirt or dust get into the center clean
side part.
40-18 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-19
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-20 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-21
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
a Do not clean the air cleaner element until the air 4. Wipe off the dirt stuck to the inside of the air
cleaner clogging monitor on the monitor panel cleaner body (7) and cover (3) with clean cloth.
lights up. If the element is cleaned frequently
a Do not tap or hit the element against any
before the air cleaner clogging monitor lights up,
other object when cleaning it.
the air cleaner is not able to display its
performance fully, and the cleaning efficiency
goes down.
a Dust attached to the element often drops into
inner element side during cleaning. If performing
checking, cleaning, and maintenance while
engine is running, dust may enter and may
damage the engine. When cleaning, be sure to
stop the engine.
Cleaning of outer element
a Before and after cleaning the element, do not
leave it or keep it under direct sunlight.
a Replace the outer element if it is cleaned six 5. Remove any dirt or dust that is accumulated on
times or used throughout a year. Replace the vacuator valve (4) installed to cover (3).
inner element as well when replacing the outer
element.
a Replace both inner and outer elements when the
air cleaner clogging monitor (1) lights up soon
after installing the cleaned outer element even
though it has not been cleaned six times.
1. Open the side cover at the rear left side of the
machine, and remove three hooks (2) to remove
cover (3).
40-22 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-23
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-24 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-25
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
1. Pull out dipstick (G) and wipe the oil off of the
gauge with a cloth.
2. Fully insert dipstick (G) into the dipstick pipe.
3. Pull out dipstick (G) and check that the oil level
is between the (H) and (L) marks on the dipstick.
4. If the oil does not reach the (L) mark on dipstick
(G), add oil through oil filler port (F).
5. If the oil level is above the (H) mark on dipstick
3. Remove bolts and remove cover (1).
(G), loosen drain valve (P) and drain the excess
When doing this, the cover (1) may jump out
oil.
under the force of spring (2), so hold the cover
down as removing the bolts. • Set a container to receive the oil under drain
4. After removing spring (2), valve (3) and strainer valve (P) before draining the oil.
(4), remove element (5). 6. After checking oil level or adding oil, insert the
dipstick (G) into the hole and install the cap to oil
• Check the bottom of the filter case for dirt or
filler port (F).
other material, and remove any if found. At
that time, take extreme care for any dirt or
other material not to drop into the hydraulic
tank.
5. Clean the removed parts in flushing oil.
6. Install new element (5).
7. Set strainer (4), valve (3), and spring (2) on the
top of the element.
8. Set cover (1) and install it with mounting bolts
while pressing it by hand.
9. Tighten mounting bolts.
40-26 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-27
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-28 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
a Do not add the battery fluid above the UPPER • When electrolyte level cannot be checked
LEVEL line. If done, the fluid may leak and the through the side face of the battery
coating surface may be damaged or the parts 1. Remove the cap (2) from the top of battery.
may be corroded. (Described above)
2. Observe fluid level port (3), and check the fluid
a To avoid freezing, add the purified water (such
level. If the fluid level is below sleeve (4), always
as a commercial battery fluid) before starting the
add the fluid (such as a commercial battery fluid)
work in the next day.
until it reaches the bottom of sleeve (the UPPER
• When checking the electrolyte level through the LEVEL).
side face of the battery
• (A) Correct level: Since the electrolyte level
1. Wipe and clean the battery surface, especially
reaches to the sleeve bottom, the shape of
around the battery level lines, with a wet cloth,
the electrode plates appears distorted due to
and check to see that the battery fluid is
the surface tension.
between the UPPER LEVEL and LOWER
• (B) Low: Since the electrolyte level does not
LEVEL lines.
reach the sleeve bottom, the shape of the
a Do not clean the battery with a dry cloth electrode plates appears straight.
since static electricity may cause an 3. After adding the refined water, tighten the cap
explosion. (2).
PC210LC-10 40-29
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-30 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
• Cab ground T02 c10. Check the connector pins for corrosion,
a (T02) is not required checking since it is bending and deformation.
connected (T01) and it is located down side of • Disconnect the connectors, and check their pins
rear left inside the cab. for corrosion, bending, sinking than other pins,
and extension of female pins.
• If pins are defective, repair or replace them.
a If the pins are not shiny, apply contact restorer to
them and connect and disconnect the
connectors several times to shine them. (If the
pins do not become shiny, connect and
disconnect the connectors 10 times)
c11. Check of connector for water and foreign
material insertion.
• Disconnect connectors, and check them for
insertion of water or foreign materials.
PC210LC-10 40-31
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
There are two fusible links (F04) and (F05) you can
see when cover on the air cleaner is removed, and
cover of battery relay is removed.
40-32 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-33
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
1. Machine monitor
1) Remove the screws (three pcs.) mounting
cover (1). 4) Insert or connect troubleshooting T-adapters
in or to connectors CM01, CM02, and CM04
a One of the three screws is covered with on machine monitor (7).
cap (2).
a Disconnect connector P31 of the sunlight
sensor and remove cover (1).
2. Engine controller
1) Remove the undercover.
a The engine controller is mounted on the
2) Remove a mounting bolt and duct (6).
engine (on the counterweight side).
3) Insert a flat-head screwdriver in slit (3) and
2) Insert or connect troubleshooting T-adapters
pull it up around projection (4) to remove
in or to connectors ECMJ1, ECMJ2, and
cover (5).
CE03 on engine controller (8).
a Connectors are fixed with screw. Loosen
the screws before disconnecting them.
a When returning, tighten the screw to the
specified torque.
3 Screw: 3 ± 1 Nm {0.3 ± 0.1 kgm}
3. Pump controller
40-34 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
1) Slide the operator's seat and seat stand to a The connectors of the pump controller
the forward end. have a special locking mechanism.
2) Remove the five mounting bolts and cool & Disconnect them according to steps (a) to
hot box (9). (c) and connect them according to steps
(d) to (f) as shown below.
a While removing the cool and hot box,
disconnect the drain hose. Disconnection: (a) Unlock - (b) Slide lever
3) Remove the two mounting bolts, one - (c) Disconnect connector.
fastener, and magazine box (10). Connection: (d) Position connector - (e)
4) Remove the three mounting bolts and cover Slide lever - (f) Lock.
(11).
5) Remove the seven mounting bolts and cover
(14).
PC210LC-10 40-35
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-36 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-37
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
2. On the service menu screen, press switch [F3] (R) in the panel switch section twice, and then select "03
Abnormality Record".
3. Press switch [F6] in the panel switch section to confirm, and then enter the "Abnormality record" screen.
40-38 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
4. Press switch [F6] in the panel switch section to confirm, and then enter the "Mechanical system failure
record" screen.
5. Press switch [F3] (R) in the panel switch section to check failure codes one by one and take record of all
information of all failure codes.
a A failure code of the mechanical system cannot be deleted.
6. Press switch [F5] (return) in the panel switch section to return to the "Abnormality record" screen.
7. Similarly to 2 and 3, enter the "Electrical system abnormality record" screen.
8. Press switch [F3] (R) in the panel switch section to check failure codes one by one and take record of all
information of all failure codes.
a If [E] is displayed on the left of a failure code, that failure code is "active" (the failure is still occurring or
normal resetting is not confirmed yet). If [E] is not displayed on the left of a failure code, that failure
code is "non-active" and disappears in the following clearing step. Accordingly be sure to take record
of that failure code.
9. While pressing number key [4] in the panel switch section, press [1], [2], and [3] in this order to enter the
"Clearing mode". (Same as 1)
10.Press switch [F2] (CLEAR) in the panel switch section.
11.Press switch [F6] in the panel switch section to clear all failure codes temporarily.
12.Press switch [F5] (return) in the panel switch section to return to the "Electrical system abnormality record"
screen. Check if there is any failure code still displayed and take record.
13.Press switch [F5] (return) in the panel switch section to return to the "Abnormality record" screen.
PC210LC-10 40-39
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-40 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-41
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
Troubleshooting
No. Problem
Index
40 Fine control performance or response is low H-5
Problems related to work equipment
41 Speed or power of boom is low. H-6
42 Speed or power of arm is low. H-7
43 Speed or power of bucket is low H-8
44 Work equipment single operation does not function. H-9
45 Hydraulic drift of boom is large. H-10
46 Hydraulic drift of arm is large. H-11
47 Hydraulic drift of bucket is large. H-12
48 Time lag in work equipment operation is large. H-13
49 When performing hydraulic relief of a work equipment, other work equipment move. H-14
50 Power maximizing function does not work. H-15, E-40
51 Power maximizing function is not reset. E-41
52 When attachment is installed, attachment circuit is not switched to desired one. H-34, E-58
53 Flow rate of attachment circuit cannot be adjusted H-35
Problems related to combined operation
54 Work equipment on large load side moves slower during combined operation H-16
When performing combined operation of swing and boom RAISE , boom RAISE
55 speed is slow. H-17
When performing combined operation of swing and travel , travel speed lowers
56 significantly. H-18
Problems related to travel
57 Machine deviates during travel H-19
58 Travel speed is low H-20
59 Machine is not steered well or steered-travel power is low. H-21
60 Travel speed does not switch or travel speed is too low or high. H-22, E-31, E-32
61 Travel system does not work (only one side) H-23
62 Alarm does not sound during travel. E-42
63 Alarm does not stop sounding while machine is stopped. E-43
Problems related to swing
64 Upper structure swings neither to the right nor left H-24
65 Upper structure does not swing in only one direction H-25
66 Swing acceleration is poor or swing speed is slow in both right and left directions. H-26
Swing acceleration performance is poor or swing speed is slow in only one
67 H-27
direction.
Upper structure overruns excessively when it stops swinging in both right and left
68 H-28
directions.
69 Upper structure overruns excessively when it stops swinging in only one direction. H-29
70 Large shock is made when upper structure stops swinging H-30
71 Large unusual noise is heard when upper structure stops swinging. H-31
72 While swing brake is applied, swing drift on slope is large. H-32
73 While swing brake is released, swing drift on slope is large. H-33
When swing brake cancel switch is set to CANCEL position, machine cannot
74 swing. E-38
When swing brake cancel switch is set to Normal position, swing holding brake
75 does not operate. E-39
Problems related to machine monitor
76 When starting switch is turned to ON position, machine monitor displays nothing E-5
When starting switch is turned to ON position (with engine stopped), engine oil level
77 monitor lights up in red. E-6
When starting switch is turned to ON position (with engine stopped), radiator
78 coolant level monitor lights up in red. E-7
79 Engine coolant temperature monitor lights in white while engine is running. E-8
40-42 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
Troubleshooting
No. Problem
Index
80 Hydraulic oil temperature monitor lights in white while engine is running. E-9
81 Charge level monitor lights up while engine is running. E-10
82 Fuel level monitor lights up in red while engine is running. E-11
83 Air cleaner clogging monitor lights up in red while engine is running. E-12
84 Water separator monitor lights up while engine is running. E-13
85 Engine coolant temperature monitor lights in red while engine is running. E-14
86 Hydraulic oil temperature monitor lights in red while engine is running. E-15
87 Engine oil pressure monitor lights in red while engine is running. E-16
88 Fuel level gauge keeps indicating minimum or maximum. E-17
Fuel level gauge does not indicate actual fuel level (Indication is not minimum or
89 maximum). E-18
90 Engine coolant temperature gauge keeps indicating minimum or maximum. E-19
Engine coolant temperature gauge does not indicate actual coolant temperature
91 (Indication is not minimum or maximum). E-20
92 Hydraulic oil temperature gauge keeps indicating minimum or maximum. E-21
Hydraulic oil temperature gauge does not indicate actual oil temperature (Indication
93 is not minimum or maximum). E-22
94 Displays on machine monitor are different from those for applicable model. E-23
95 Machine monitor does not display partially. E-24
96 Function switch does not operate E-25
97 Alarm buzzer cannot be canceled E-33
98 When starting switch is in OFF position, service meter is not displayed. E-34
99 Machine monitor cannot be set in service mode E-35
100 Horn does not sound. E-44
101 Horn does not stop sounding. E-45
102 When wiper switch is operated, wiper monitor does not light up or go off. E-46
103 When wiper switch is operated, windshield wiper does not operate. E-47
104 When window washer switch is operated, window washer does not operate. E-48
"Testing and
Air conditioner does not operate normally (including failure code related to air troubleshooting
105 conditioner) procedure" in
Chapter 80
106 Monitoring function does not display lever control signal normally E-49 to E-57
Others
107 KOMTRAX system does not work properly E-59
PC210LC-10 40-43
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
(Rev. 2011/12)
a The following information is summarized in the troubleshooting table. Before performing troubleshooting,
understand that information fully.
Action level Failure code
Display on Failure name displayed on the Abnormality Record screen
Display on Failure
machine of the machine monitor
machine monitor
monitor
Detail of Description of the failure detected by the machine monitor or controller
failure
Action of An action that is performed to protect the system and devices when a failure is detected by
controller the machine monitor or controller
Problem on A problem that appears as a failure on the machine as a result of an action (above) that is
machine performed by the machine monitor or controller.
Related Information on occurred failure or troubleshooting
information
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1 Defective — <Contents of description>
Open or short circuit in wiring • Procedure
2
harness • Measuring location
Open circuit in wiring harness
a "Between A and B" denotes measuring values such as voltage
3 (wire breakage or defective and resistance between A and B.
contact of connector)
Ground fault in wiring harness a "Between A and ground" means the measurement of voltage,
4 resistance or others between terminal A and the place which has
(contact with ground circuit) a continuity with chassis frame such as unpainted hexagonal
Hot short circuit head bolt or bolt hole which has no rust, etc.
5
(contact with 24 V circuit) • Criteria to judge probable causes (standard value), remarks
<How to use troubleshooting sheet>
• Perform troubleshooting procedures in numerical order.
• If the check result does not meet the criteria, the probable cause
described on the left column is the actual cause of the failure.
• If the check result meet the criteria and there is no specific
instruction, proceed to the next step (cause).
• If a defect is found and repaired, check that the defect has been
corrected.
<Failures in wiring harness>
Short circuit in wiring harness • Open circuit
6 Connection of connector is defective or wiring harness is broken.
• Ground fault
A harness not to be connected to the ground (earth) circuit comes
into contact with the ground (earth) circuit or chassis accidentally.
• Hot short circuit
A harness not to be connected to the power (24 V) circuit comes into
contact with the power (24 V) circuit accidentally.
• Short circuit
An independent wire in the harness erroneously comes into contact
with another independent wire.
(poor insulation at connector and others)
40-44 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-45
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
a Since the pressure sensor consists not only of resistors but also “electronic circuits“ such as amplifiers, it
may have the differences among the resistances measured and its own polarities. So troubleshooting
must be performed carefully.
Failure codes that require this diagnosis
• CA123: Boost pressure sensor low error
• CA451: Common rail pressure sensor high error
Procedure
1. Measure and record resistance of the pressure sensor unit.
1) Disconnect pressure sensor connector (1) and connect socket (2) to the connector on the sensor side.
2) Measure resistances R1 and R2 between pins.
a If polarities of multimeter probes to apply are reversed, measured values may change. Therefore,
when measuring resistances in steps 1 and 2, apply the multimeter probes to the pressure sensor
connector so that their polarities match those of the sensor.
a If measured value is infinite, measure the resistances with multimeter probes exchanged each
other to reverse their polarities and record the finite value obtained as a measured value.
a Since measured values may disperse, measure several times.
Cause of this dispersion appears to be a charge in a sensor. Repeat steps 1 and 2 several times.
Consider this dispersion when determining whether the wiring harness is open in step 3.
2. Measure and record resistance with the wiring harness between the pressure sensor and engine
controller connected.
1) Since 5 V power supply to the pressure sensor is supplied to other sensors, disconnect other sensor
connectors first. (*)
2) Connect the pressure sensor to be measured, disconnect connector (3) on the engine controller side,
and connect T-adapter (4) to the connector on the wiring harness side.
3) Connect T-box (5) to T-adapter (4) and measure respective pins for resistances R1' and R2'.
3. Determining open circuit
If there is an “apparent difference“ between resistances R1 and R2 measured in step 1 and resistances
R1' and R2' measured in step 2, determine that "wiring harness is open".
a “Apparent difference“ means a difference of 10 or more times.
40-46 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-47
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-48 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
Number
Connector No. Model Equipment name Address
of pins
FUEL RAIL Common rail pressure sensor
BOSCH 3 AJ4
PRESS
H08 M 4 Intermediate connector (speaker) X4
H09 M 8 Intermediate connector (cab roof) X4
H14 S090 22 Intermediate connector (right console harness) S9
H15 S090 22 Intermediate connector (right console harness) U1
H16 S090 22 Intermediate connector (left console harness) X3
INJECTOR #1 Terminal 2 INJECTOR#1 AE4
INJECTOR #2 Terminal 2 INJECTOR#2 AE5
INJECTOR #3 Terminal 2 INJECTOR#3 AF5
INJECTOR #4 Terminal 2 INJECTOR#4 AG5
INJECTOR #5 Terminal 2 IINJECTOR#5 AH5
INJECTOR #6 Terminal 2 INJECTOR#6 AI5
INJECTOR Intermediate connector (INJECTOR#1 and #2)
DT 4 AE4
CYL 1&2
INJECTOR Intermediate connector (INJECTOR#3 and #4)
DT 4 AJ4
CYL 3&4
INJECTOR Intermediate connector (INJECTOR#5 and #6)
DT 4 AJ5
CYL 5&6
INLET
METERING BOSCH 2 Supply pump solenoid (IMV) AJ3
VALVE
INTER-
DT 12 Intermediate connector AH5
CONNECT
J01 J 20 Junction connector (black) W3
J02 J 20 Junction connector (pink) W2
J03 J 20 Junction connector (orange) V2
J04 J 20 Junction connector (pink) X3
J05 J 20 Junction connector (pink) X6
J06 J 20 Junction connector (orange) X8
K01 M 2 Resister for PC-EPC valve O8
K02 DT 3 CAN terminating resistor1 AG1
L01 DT 2 Boom working lamp E8
L02 DT 2 R.H. working lamp F2
L03 M 2 Room lamp S9
L05 SWP 2 Intermediate connector (revolving warning lamp) AC8
L09 DT 2 Rear working lamp J9
L15 DT 2 Revolving warning lamp AB9
L19 DT 2 System operating lamp B7
M01B PA 10 Radio U1
M01A ― 3 Radio (AUX jack) ―
M01B M 3 Intermediate connector (AUX) AD2
M01C ― 3 AUX (audio external input) jack AC1
M02 M 2 L.H. speaker AD8
M03 M 2 R.H. speaker AC9
M04 YAZAKI 2 Cigarette lighter S9
M05 M 6 Front window wiper motor O4
M06 YAZAKI 2 Front window washer motor E2
M07 090 2 Horn (treble tone) G1
M08 090 2 Horn (bass tone) G1
M09 M 2 Option power supply connector (1) M5
M10 M 2 Intermediate connector (optional power supply) N5
M11 DT 6 DC/DC converter X6
PC210LC-10 40-49
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
Number
Connector No. Model Equipment name Address
of pins
M12 M 2 Option power supply connector (2) X6
M13A M 2 12V power supply socket (1) X8
M13B M 2 12V power supply socket (2) X7
M14 DT 2 Travel alarm K2
Optional power supply connector (continuous
M1A M 2 power supply)[power supply outlet] M5
M35 DT 2 Air suspension system V1
M36 DT 2 Heated seat U1
M40 X 2 Cab left headlamp AB1
M41 X 2 Cab right headlamp Y8
M80 X 3 Bucket quick coupler control box O7
M81 X 2 Bucket quick coupler solenoid valve J2
N08 DT 12 Service connector T9
OEM
CONNECTION FRAMATOME 24 Intermediate connector (engine wiring harness) AI1
[E24]
OIL
PRESSURE FRAMATOME 2 Engine oil pressure switch AE2
SWITCH
P01 AMP 3 Bucket CURL PPC pressure sensor D3
P02 AMP 3 Boom LOWER PPC pressure sensor D3
P03 AMP 3 Left SWING PPC oil pressure sensor D2
P04 AMP 3 Arm IN PPC pressure sensor D3
P05 AMP 3 Bucket DUMP PPC pressure sensor D3
P06 AMP 3 Boom RAISE PPC pressure sensor D2
P07 AMP 3 Right SWING PPC pressure sensor D3
P08 AMP 3 Arm OUT PPC pressure sensor D2
P09 AMP 3 L.H. travel forward PPC pressure sensor P1
P10 AMP 3 L.H. travel reverse PPC pressure sensor Q1
P11 AMP 3 R.H. travel forward PPC pressure sensor P1
P12 AMP 3 R.H. travel reverse PPC pressure sensor P1
Intermediate connector (service PPC oil
P13 X 2 pressure switch) O3
R.H.attachment control pedal forward tilt PPC oil
P14 X 2 pressure switch O3
R.H.attachment control pedal backward tilt PPC
P15 X 2 oil pressure switch O2
L.H.attachment control pedal forward tilt PPC oil
P16 X 2 pressure switch Q1
P17 S090 2 Dual pressure switch V2
P18 090 2 Outer temperature sensor L3
P20 M 3 Fuel control dial P8
P21 DT 2 Fuel level sensor G9
P22 DT 2 Hydraulic oil temperature sensor J9
P23 DT 2 Air cleaner clogging sensor B7
P24 X 2 Coolant level sensor K3
P25 AMP 3 Front pump oil pressure sensor B3
P26 AMP 3 Rear pump oil pressure sensor B3
P27 DT 3 Front pump swash plate sensor H9
P28 DT 3 Rear pump swash plate sensor H9
L.H.attachment control pedal backward tilt PPC
P30 X 2 oil pressure switch R1
P31 050 2 Sunlight sensor O6
40-50 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
Number
Connector No. Model Equipment name Address
of pins
P44 DT 2 Engine oil level sensor AJ7
P47 DT 2 Water-in-fuel sensor G9
P49 AMP 3 Service oil pressure sensor G9
P55 FRAMATOME 4 MAF sensor C8
P57 FRAMATOME 3 Crankcase pressure sensor K9
R01 Terminal 1 Battery relay (terminal E) B9
R02 Terminal 1 Battery relay (terminal BR) B9
R03 Terminal 1 Battery relay (terminal M) A9
R04 Terminal 1 Battery relay (terminal B) A9
R05 Relay 5 Lamp relay T9
R06 Relay 5 Starting motor cut-off relay (for PPC lock) V9
R07 Relay 5 Starting motor cut-off relay (for personal code) V9
R08 Relay 5 Horn relay U9
R10 Relay 5 Rear working lamp relay U9
R12 Relay 5 Cab headlamp relay T9
Electrical air intake heater (ribbon heater)(coil
R15 Terminal 1 circuit) C8
Electrical air intake heater (ribbon heater)
R16A Terminal 1 (contact circuit) C7
Electrical air intake heater (ribbon heater)
R16B Terminal 1 (contact circuit) C9
R17 DT 2 Safety relay (terminal S and R) C9
R18 Relay 5 Automatic preheating relay W9
R21 Relay 5 Air conditioner compressor solenoid clutch relay W9
R28 Terminal 1 Safety relay (terminal C) A8
R29 Terminal 1 Safety relay (terminal B) A8
S01 ― 5 Starting switch P7
S02 SWP 6 Lamp switch P8
S04 SWP 6 Swing lock switch Q8
S07 SWP 6 Revolving warning lamp switch Q8
S10 Y090 2 Horn switch R1
S11 Y090 2 One-touch power maximizing switch T1
S14 M 3 PPC lock switch U1
S18 SWP 6 Engine shutdown secondary switch T1
S19 DT 2 Seat belt alarm switch S1
S21 ― 12 Emergency pump drive switch O9
S22 ― 4 Swing brake cancel switch O9
Intermediate connector (emergency activation
S25 090 16 switch) O8
S30 S 8 Model Selection connector U9
SB Terminal 2 Starting motor (terminal B) AH6
SC Terminal 1 Starting motor (terminal C) AH5
T01 Terminal 2 Floor frame ground able W2
T02 Terminal 1 Cab ground AD2
T03 Terminal 1 Radio ground cable T1
T04 Terminal 1 Revolving frame ground cable H1
T05 Terminal 1 Revolving frame ground cable I1
T06 Terminal 1 Revolving frame ground cable I1
T07 Terminal 1 Revolving frame ground cable I2
T08 Terminal 1 Revolving frame ground cable K3
T09 Terminal 1 Revolving frame ground cable J2
T10 Terminal 1 Revolving frame ground cable J2
PC210LC-10 40-51
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
Number
Connector No. Model Equipment name Address
of pins
T12 Terminal 1 Engine controller ground cable L7
TERMINATOR CAN terminating resistor2
DT 3 AI1
PORT
TOOL PORT DT 3 Connector for communication AH1
V01 DT 2 PPC lock solenoid valve C1
V02 DT 2 2-stage relief solenoid valve A1
V03 DT 2 Swing brake solenoid valve C2
V04 DT 2 Travel speed increase solenoid valve A2
V05 DT 2 Travel junction solenoid valve C2
V06 DT 2 Swing cut-off solenoid valve A3
V07 DT 2 Attachment selector solenoid valve A2
V11 DT 2 Front pump PC-EPC valve J9
V12 DT 2 Rear pump PC-EPC valve I9
V19 DT 2 LS-EPC valve L9
V23 DT 2 Merge-divider EPC valve (for main spool) B4
V24 DT 2 Merge-divider EPC valve (for LS spool) C4
V25 DT 2 Variable back pressure solenoid valve B3
V30 DT 2 Attachment oil flow adjustment EPC valve O3
W03 X 2 Window rear limit switch AB9
40-52 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-53
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-54 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-55
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
Layout of connectors(4/6)
40-56 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-57
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-58 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
a The terms of male and female refer to the pins, while the terms of male housing and female housing refer
to the mating portion of the housing.
PC210LC-10 40-59
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-60 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-61
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-62 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-63
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-64 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-65
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-66 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-67
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-68 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-69
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-70 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-71
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-72 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-73
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-74 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-75
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-76 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-77
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-78 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-79
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-80 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-81
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-82 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-83
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-84 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-85
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-86 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-87
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-88 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-89
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-90 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-91
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-92 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-93
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-94 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
a The vertical column indicates a part number of T-branch box or T-branch adapter, while the horizontal
column indicates a part number of harness checker assembly.
T-adapter kit
Identification symbol
Number of pins
Out of kit
799-601-2500
799-601-2700
799-601-2800
799-601-7000
799-601-7100
799-601-7400
799-601-7500
799-601-8000
799-601-9000
799-601-9100
799-601-9200
799-601-9300
799-601-4101
799-601-4201
Part number Part name
PC210LC-10 40-95
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
T-adapter kit
Identification symbol
Number of pins
Out of kit
799-601-2500
799-601-2700
799-601-2800
799-601-7000
799-601-7100
799-601-7400
799-601-7500
799-601-8000
799-601-9000
799-601-9100
799-601-9200
799-601-9300
799-601-4101
799-601-4201
Part number Part name
40-96 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
T-adapter kit
Identification symbol
Number of pins
Out of kit
799-601-2500
799-601-2700
799-601-2800
799-601-7000
799-601-7100
799-601-7400
799-601-7500
799-601-8000
799-601-9000
799-601-9100
799-601-9200
799-601-9300
799-601-4101
799-601-4201
Part number Part name
PC210LC-10 40-97
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
T-adapter kit
Identification symbol
Number of pins
Out of kit
799-601-2500
799-601-2700
799-601-2800
799-601-7000
799-601-7100
799-601-7400
799-601-7500
799-601-8000
799-601-9000
799-601-9100
799-601-9200
799-601-9300
799-601-4101
799-601-4201
Part number Part name
799-601- q
Adapter for DT (green) 8 DT8G q
9080
799-601- q
Adapter for DT (Brown) 8 DT8BR q
9090
799-601- DT12G- q
Adapter for DT (gray) 12 q
9110 R
799-601- q
Adapter for DT (black) 12 DT12B q
9120
799-601- q
Adapter for DT (green) 12 DT12G q
9130
799-601- q
Adapter for DT (Brown) 12 DT12BR q
9140
799-601- Adapter for HD30-18 8 D18-8 q q
9210
799-601- Adapter for HD30-18 14 D18-14 q q
9220
799-601- Adapter for HD30-18 20 D18-20 q q
9230
799-601- Adapter for HD30-18 21 D18-21 q q
9240
799-601- Adapter for HD30-24 9 D24-9 q q
9250
799-601- Adapter for HD30-24 16 D24-16 q q
9260
799-601- Adapter for HD30-24 21 D24-21 q q
9270
799-601- Adapter for HD30-24 23 D24-23 q q
9280
799-601- Adapter for HD30-24 31 D24-31 q q
9290
799-601- q
Plate for HD30 (24-pin) q q
9310
799-601- q
T-box (for ECONO) 24 q q
9320
799-601-
Case q
9330
799-601-
Case q
9340
799-601- q
Adapter for DRC 40 DRC-40
9350
799-601- q
Adapter for DRC 24 DRC-24
9360
799-601- Socket for engine (CRI-T2) 2 G q
9410*
Adapter for engine (CRI-T2) q q
799-601- Adapter for engine (CRI-T3)
PFUEL 3 A3
9420
Oil pressure sensor
799-601- Socket for engine (CRI-T2) q q
2 P
9430* Socket for engine(CRI-T3) PCV
799-601- Socket for engine (CRI-T2) 1, 2, 3
3 q
9440*
40-98 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
T-adapter kit
Identification symbol
Number of pins
Out of kit
799-601-2500
799-601-2700
799-601-2800
799-601-7000
799-601-7100
799-601-7400
799-601-7500
799-601-8000
799-601-9000
799-601-9100
799-601-9200
799-601-9300
799-601-4101
799-601-4201
Part number Part name
PC210LC-10 40-99
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
T-adapter kit
Identification symbol
Number of pins
Out of kit
799-601-2500
799-601-2700
799-601-2800
799-601-7000
799-601-7100
799-601-7400
799-601-7500
799-601-8000
799-601-9000
799-601-9100
799-601-9200
799-601-9300
799-601-4101
799-601-4201
Part number Part name
40-100 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
Type of Source of
power Fuse
power Fuse No. Destination of power
supplied to capacity
supply
fuse
Light relay, rear light relay, and cab light relay
PC-EPC (F) solenoid valve and PC-EPC (R) solenoid
valve
[When operating emergency pump drive switch]
1 5A Swing brake solenoid valve
[When operating swing brake cancel switch]
Boom raise throttle EPC valve
[[When operating emergency boom raise throttle cancel
switch]
2 30 A Pump controller (solenoid power supply)
PPC hydraulic lock solenoid valve
3 5A Starting motor cut-off relay (PPC lock)
Fusible link
Switched F04 (65 A) Starting motor cut-off relay (personal code)
power 4 10 A Window washer motor and cigarette lighter
supply 5 10 A Horn, horn relay
6 5A Heater relay and electric air intake heater
7 10 A Revolving warning lamp (if equipped)
Radio, speaker, and left knob switch (pump controller
8 10 A input)
9 20 A Working lamp
10 20 A Air conditioner unit and air conditioner compressor
11 10 A Headlamp
12 10 A Option power supply (1)
Optional power supply (2), 12 V power supply, and air
13 30 A suspension seat with heater
Starting 14 5A Air conditioner controller power supply
switch 15 5A Starting switch, auxiliary engine stop switch
16 10 A Radio backup, room lamp , and system operating lamp
Continu- 17 20 A Machine monitor and pump controller
Fusible link
ous power 18 30 A Engine controller
F05 (30 A)
supply 19 5A Air conditioner controller backup
20 10 A Optional power source (continuous power supply)
PC210LC-10 40-101
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
* There are two fusible links (F04) and (F05) you can find when cover on the air cleaner is removed, and
cover of battery relay is removed.
40-102 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-103
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
1] Stop the engine and wait until the Case 1-4] From the KDPF reset screen, perform
temperature of piping around the engine resetting after KDPF change.
cools down. Remove the KDPF, and then Case 1-5] Start the engine and run at low idle to
remove the KCSF. warm up.
2] Install the replacement KCSF (new or Case 1-6] Perform Regeneration for Service.
reused) to the machine. (In this case, Regeneration for Service may
3] Turn the starting switch to the ON continue for about 2 hours, since it is set to
position. From the KDPF reset screen, terminate when the soot accumulation drops to 2
perform resetting after KDPF cleaning. g/l.)
4] From the KDPF reset screen, perform Case 1-7] When Regeneration for Service is
resetting after KDPF change. completed, check that failure codes (CA1922,
5] Start the engine and run at low idle to CA1921, and CA2639) are not displayed.
warm up. <Case 2> When Regeneration for Service is
6] Perform regeneration for service. performed (KDPF removal unnecessary)
3) If Soot Level High Error 2 (CA1922) is
a If the following conditions are met, the total
displayed
soot sediment is not beyond the limit (9 g/l),
1] Stop the machine and check that failure but the differential pressure has increased
code (CA1922) is displayed on the due to clogging caused by uneven
machine monitor. accumulation of soot. In this case, actual
2] Check the abnormality record for failure regeneration will not result in abnormal
codes "CA2639: Manual Stationary burning. Regeneration for Service can be
Regeneration Request", "CA1921: KDPF performed safely without replacing the KCSF,
Soot Level High Error 1", and "CA1922: and the KCSF can be continuously used
KDPF Soot Level High Error 2"on the after the regeneration.
machine monitor.
• After checking that no sensor related failures
<Case 1> When KDPF is removed and KCSF is
are present, perform this work if any of the
replaced
following is met.
a If the following conditions are met, soot • Time between activation of "CA2639: Manual
accumulation is beyond the limit to burn Stationary Regeneration Request (L01)" and
away by regeneration. The KDPF must be "CA1921: KDPF Soot Level High Error 1
removed to change the KCSF. (L03)" < 360 sec. (KOMTRAX history) or <
• Time between activation of "CA2639: Manual 0.1 h (Abnormality record screen on monitor)
Stationary Regeneration Request (L01)" and • "Time between activation of "CA1921: KDPF
"CA1921: KDPF Soot Level High Error 1 Soot Level High Error 1 (L03)" and "CA1922:
(L03)" X 360 sec. (KOMTRAX history) or X KDPF Soot Level High Error 2 (L04)" <
0.1 h (Abnormality record screen on monitor) 360sec. (KOMTRAX history) or < 0.1 h
and (Abnormality record screen on monitor)
• Time between activation of "CA1921: KDPF [Contents of work]
Soot Level High Error 1 (L03)" and "CA1922: Case 2-1] Start the engine and run at low idle to
KDPF Soot Level High Error 2 (L04)" X360 warm up. From the KDPF reset screen, perform
sec. (KOMTRAX history) or X 0.1 h resetting after KDPF cleaning.
(Abnormality record screen on monitor) Case 2-2] Perform Regeneration for Service.
[Contents of work] (In this case, Regeneration for Service may
Case 1-1] Stop the engine and wait until the continue for about 2 hours, since it is set to
temperature of piping around the engine cools terminate when the soot accumulation drops to 2
down, then remove KCSF. g/l.)
Case 1-2] Install the replacement KCSF (new or Case 2-3] When Regeneration for Service is
reused). completed, check that failure codes (CA1922,
Case 1-3] Turn the starting switch to the ON CA1921, and CA2639) are not displayed.
position. From the KDPF reset screen, perform 3. When cleaning and replacing KDOC
resetting after KDPF cleaning. 1) If cracks or damages are found during
inspection
a When resetting after KDPF cleaning is
performed, changes in ( ) are reflected. 1] If cracks or damages are found in the
(Soot accumulation amount: 9 g/lo8.1 g/l; KDOC, replace it with a new one.
Action level: L04oL03; Failure code: 2] From the KDPF reset screen, perform
CA1922oCA1921) resetting after KDOC change.
40-104 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-105
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-106 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
a KDPF differential pressure sensor is the same as KDPF outlet pressure sensor.
• CA1883 Short-circuit connector for KDPF delta pressure sensor
PC210LC-10 40-107
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-108 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-109
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-110 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-111
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-112 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-113
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
40-114 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
PC210LC-10 40-115
40 Troubleshooting
General information on troubleshooting
a In this table, failure codes are arranged in the order of characters from numeric to alphabetic character.
a Applicable component is the controller or machine monitor which checks the system.
MON: Machine monitor
ENG: Engine controller
PUMP: pump
KOMTRAX: KOMTRAX terminal
a The failure codes that do not have numbers in the action level columns are not displayed on the standard
screen even when a failure related to them occurs. They are simply recorded in the abnormality record
(electrical system or mechanical system) of the service menu.
a History category means the classification of either electrical system or mechanical system which is used
for storage in the Failure History of the service menu.
For details, see "Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)".
40-116 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-117
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-118 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-119
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-120 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-121
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-122 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-123
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-124 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-125
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-126 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-127
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-128 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-129
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
k Since the temperature of the KDPF and KDOC will become higher than 500 °C , take
care not to get burn injury.
• Signal voltage from KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47301(V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47300 (°C ))
• Signal voltage from KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47401(V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47400 (°C ))
• Signal voltage from KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47201(V))
• Temperature sensed by KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
Related function. (Code: 47200 (°C ))
information • KDOC inlet temperature, KDOC outlet temperature, and KDPF outlet temperature with
engine running at idle (without regenerating KDPF) are all approx. 100 to 250 °C and
temperature differences among them are approx. 10 °C (KDOC inlet temperature>KDOC
outlet temperature>KDPF outlet temperature).
• When active regeneration (manual stationary regeneration) is in progress, KDOC inlet
temperature is approx. 250 to 400 °C , and KDOC outlet temperature and KDPF outlet
temperature reach to approx. 450 to 550 °C .
• If there is a significant difference between KDOC inlet temperature and KDOC outlet
temperature when KDPF is completely cool or engine is running at idle (without
regenerating KDPF), replace KDOC inlet temperature sensor or KDOC outlet temperature
sensor, whichever is suspected to be defective, judging from KDPF outlet temperature.
• KDOC inlet temperature sensor connecter label "TEMP1" is indicated on KDPF
temperature sensor consolidating box in black embossed letters (same for KDOC outlet
temperature sensor connector label "TEMP2" and KDPF outlet sensor connector label
"TEMP3").
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
Defective wiring harness information on troubleshooting", and check it.
1 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
connector
If this failure code does not appear, harness connector is defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform the following.
Defective KDOC inlet If failure code [CA3313], [CA3314], or [CA3315] is displayed, perform
2 temperature sensor troubleshooting for it.
40-130 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
a Turn starting switch to ON position and check that failure code [CA2639] is not displayed.
PC210LC-10 40-131
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
k Since the temperature of the KDPF and KDOC will become higher than 500 °C , take
care not to get burn injury.
• Signal voltage from KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47301(V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47300 (°C ))
• Signal voltage from KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47401(V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47400 (°C ))
• Signal voltage from KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47201(V))
• Temperature sensed by KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47200 (°C ))
• KDOC inlet temperature, KDOC outlet temperature, and KDPF outlet temperature with
engine running at idle (without regenerating) are all approx. 100 to 250 °C and
Related temperature differences among them are approx. 10 °C (KDOC inlet temperature>KDOC
information outlet temperature>KDPF outlet temperature).
• When manual stationary regeneration is performed as an action taken for A1U0N3 or
A1U0N4, dosing fuel is not injected. Therefore, KDOC inlet, KDOC outlet, and KDPF
outlet temperatures will be around 250 to 400 °C .
• In other cases than the above, when active regeneration (manual stationary regeneration)
is in progress, the KDOC inlet temperature will be approx. 250 to 400 °C , and the KDOC
outlet temperature and KDPF outlet temperature will both be approx. 450 to 550 °C .
• It takes about 40 minutes to perform active regeneration (manual stationary
regeneration).
• If there is a significant difference between the KDOC inlet temperature and KDOC outlet
temperature when the KDPF is completely cool or engine running at idle (not
regenerating), replace the KDOC inlet temperature sensor or the KDOC outlet
temperature sensor, whichever is suspected to be abnormal, judging by the KDPF outlet
temperature reading.
• KDOC inlet temperature sensor connecter label "TEMP1" is indicated on KDPF
temperature sensor consolidating box in black embossed letters (same for KDOC outlet
temperature sensor connector label "TEMP2" and KDPF outlet sensor connector label
"TEMP3").
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. Perform manual stationary regeneration by following the instructions
Performing manual stationary on the monitor.
1
regeneration (to dry KCSF) If this failure code is cleared after regeneration is performed, repair is
complete.
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
Defective wiring harness information on troubleshooting", and check it.
2 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
connector
If this failure code does not appear, harness connector is defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform the following.
40-132 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
a Turn the starting switch ON and make sure that this failure code and code [A1U0N3] are not displayed.
PC210LC-10 40-133
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-134 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-135
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Open circuit in a If no failure is found by check on cause 2, this check is not required.
wiring harness 1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
4 (wire breakage or 2. Disconnect connectors CM01 and E12, and connect T-adapters to each female
defective contact of side.
connector) Between CM01 (female) (16) and E12
Resistance (female) (1) Max. 1 z
40-136 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-137
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Action
Failure code Abnormally low engine oil pressure
level Failure (Engine controller system)
L03 B@BAZG
Details of • While engine is running, engine controller detects engine oil pressure drop (sensor
failure contact is closed) from signal voltage of engine oil pressure switch.
• Displays engine oil pressure monitor yellow on machine monitor.
Action of • If cause of failure disappears, machine becomes normal by itself.
controller • Limits engine output and allows engine to run.
Problem on • If machine is operated as it is, engine may be damaged.
machine • Engine output decreases.
• Signal from engine oil pressure switch is input to engine controller. If engine oil pressure
Related switch is closed (turned ON) while engine is running, engine controller transmits this
information signal to machine monitor to display this failure code.
• Method of reproducing failure code: Starting engine.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Lowered engine oil Engine oil pressure may be low. Check it and fix if it is low.
pressure (when
1 system works
properly)
If no failure is found by above checks, engine oil pressure monitor system may be
defective. Perform troubleshooting in E-mode.
Defective engine oil • E-14 Coolant temperature monitor lights up in red while engine is running
pressure monitor (PAGE 40-577)
2
system • E-15 Hydraulic oil temperature monitor lights up in red while engine is running
(PAGE 40-578)
• E-16 Engine oil pressure monitor lights up in red while engine is running(PAGE
40-579)
40-138 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-139
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-140 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-141
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-142 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-143
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA115] Eng Ne and Bkup Speed Sens Error (PC200-CA115-400-A-00-A)
40-144 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA122] Chg Air Press Sensor High Error (D65-CA122-400-A-Z0-A)
Action
Failure code Charge pressure sensor high error
level Failure
(Engine controller system)
L03 CA122
Detail of • High voltage is detected in pressure signal circuit of charge (boost) pressure &
failure temperature sensor.
• Takes it that charge pressure is at calculated value and allows engine to run.
Action of • Restricts engine output and allows engine to run.
controller • Closes EGR valve.
• Stops regeneration control by KDPF.
Problem on • Engine output lowers.
machine
• Input voltage from charge (boost) pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring
function.
(Code: 36501 (V))
• Charge (boost) pressure sensed by charge (boost) pressure sensor can be checked with
Related
monitoring function.
information
(Code: 36500 (kPa))
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
• If sensor connector is disconnected, code [CA123] for "Low Error" is displayed, even in
normal condition.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
information on troubleshooting", and check it.
Defective wiring harness 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
1
connector If this failure code does not appear, wiring harness connector is
defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform the following.
Defective sensor power If failure code [CA187] or [ CA227] is also displayed, perform
2 troubleshooting for it first.
source 2 circuit
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector BOOST PRESS & IMT.
3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
If failure code changes from [CA122] to [CA123] ,boost pressure sensor
is defective.
a Failure code [CA153] for temperature sensor is displayed at the
Defective boost pressure & same time.
3 temperature sensor Ignore this failure code since it appears because of disconnection of
sensor.
• Reference
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Insert T-adapter in connector ECM J1.
3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
Sensor 0.3 to 4.7
Voltage Between ECM J1 (15) and (59)
output V
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connectors ECM J1 and BOOST PRESS & IMT, and
4 Short circuit in wiring harness connect T-adapter to female side of ECM J1.
Resis- Between ECM J1 (female) (15) and (60) Min. 100
tance kz
PC210LC-10 40-145
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-146 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA123] Chg Air Press Sensor Low Error (D65-CA123-400-A-Z0-A)
Action
Failure code Charge air pressure sensor low error
level Failure
(Engine controller system)
L03 CA123
Detail of • Low voltage is detected in pressure signal circuit of charge (boost) pressure &
failure temperature sensor.
• Takes it that charge pressure is at calculated value and allows engine to run.
Action of • Restricts engine output and allows engine to run.
controller • Closes EGR valve.
• Stops regeneration control by KDPF.
Problem on
• Engine output lowers.
machine
• Input voltage from charge (boost) pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring
function.
(Code: 36501 (V))
• Charge (boost) pressure sensed by charge (boost) pressure sensor can be checked with
monitoring function.
Related (Code: 36500 (kPa))
information • Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
• Since troubleshooting "socket" for this sensor features female connector only, it is not
usable for checking open circuit in wiring harness and voltage at sensor connector (not
designed for T-adapter).
• If sensor connector is disconnected, this failure code is displayed.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
Defective wiring harness information on troubleshooting", and check it.
1 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
connector
If this failure code does not appear, harness connector is defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform the following.
Defective power supply
system of charge pressure If failure code [CA187] or [CA227] is also displayed, perform
2 sensor (boost pressure troubleshooting for it first.
sensor)
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connectors CAM SENSOR, AMB. AIR PRESSURE,
BOOST PRESS & IMT, and ECM J1.
3 Short circuit in wiring harness 3. Connect T-adapter to female side of ECM J1.
PC210LC-10 40-147
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-148 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-149
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-150 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-151
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-152 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-153
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-154 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-155
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-156 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA153] Chg Air Temp Sensor High Error (D65-CA153-400-A-Z0-A)
Action level Failure code Charge (Air) temperature sensor High error.
Failure
L03 CA153 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • High voltage is detected in charge (boost) temperature sensor signal circuit.
failure
• Takes it that charge temperature (boost temperature) is at calculated value and allows
engine to run.
Action of • Closes EGR valve.
controller • Restricls engine output and allows engine to run.
• Stops KDPF regeneration control.
Problem on • Engine does not start easily at low temperature.
machine • Engine output lowers.
• Signal voltage from charge temperature sensor (boost temperature sensor) can be
checked with monitoring function (Code: 18501 (V)).
• Temperature sensed by charge temperature sensor (boost temperature sensor) can be
checked with monitoring function. (Code: 18500 ( °C ))
Related • Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
information • Because troubleshooting "socket" for this sensor features female connector only, it is not
connectable to female connector of sensor wiring harness, and thus not usable for
checking open circuit (not designed for T-adapter).
• This failure code is displayed if temperature sensor connector is disconnected.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
information on troubleshooting", and check it.
Defective wiring harness 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
1
connector If this failure code does not appear, wiring harness connector is
defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform following.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector BOOST PRESS & IMT, and connect socket to
male side of connector.
a If temperature sensor has resistance of 80 z to 48 kz , regard charge
temperature sensor as normal.
Defective charge -40 °C 41 to 48 kz
2 temperature sensor -20 °C 14 to 16 kz
Between BOOST PRESS & IMT 0 °C 5.4 to 6.1 kz
Resis- (male) (3) and (4) 30 °C 1.6 to 1.8 kz
tance a Charge temperature 560 to 600
60 °C
-Resistance characteristics kz
90 °C 230 to 250 z
130 °C 80 to 90 z
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector ECM J1 and connect T-adapter to female side
of connector.
Open or short circuit in wiring Between ECM J1 (female) (5) and (59)
3
harness
Resis- a Use Temperature-Resistance 80 z to 48
tance characteristics table for troubleshooting on kz
cause 2.
If no failure is found in above checks, engine controller is defective.
4 Defective engine controller
(Since this is internal defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
PC210LC-10 40-157
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-158 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA154] Chg Air Temp Sensor Low Error (D65-CA154-400-A-Z0-A)
Action level Failure code Charge (boost) temperature sensor signal voltage is too low.
Failure
L03 CA154 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • Low voltage is detected in charge (boost) temperature sensor signal circuit.
failure
• Takes it that charge temperature (boost temperature) is at calculated value and allows
engine to run.
Action of • Closes EGR valve.
controller • Restricts engine output and allows engine to run.
• Stops KDPF regeneration control.
Problem on • Engine does not start easily at low temperature.
machine • Engine output lowers.
• Signal voltage from charge temperature sensor (boost temperature sensor) can be
checked with monitoring function (Code: 18501 (V)).
• Temperature sensed by charge temperature sensor (boost temperature sensor) can be
Related checked with monitoring function. (Code: 18500 ( °C ))
information • Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
• If temperature sensor connector is disconnected, this failure code is not displayed but
failure code [CA153] for "High Error" is displayed.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
information on troubleshooting", and check it.
Defective wiring harness 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
1
connector If this failure code does not appear, wiring harness connector is
defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform following.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector BOOST PRESS & IMT, and connect socket to
male side of connector.
a If charge temperature sensor has resistance of 80 z to 48 kz ,
regard charge temperature sensor as normal.
-40 °C 41 to 48 kz
Defective charge -20 °C 14 to 16 kz
2 temperature sensor Between BOOST PRESS & IMT 0 °C 5.4 to 6.1 kz
(male) (3) and (4) 30 °C 1.6 to 1.8 kz
Resis- a Charge temperature 560 to 600
tance 60 °C
-Resistance characteristics kz
90 °C 230 to 250 z
130 °C 80 to 90 z
Between BOOST PRESS & IMT Whole
(male) (3) and ground range Min. 100 kz
PC210LC-10 40-159
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-160 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-161
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-162 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Action
Failure code Ambient Pressure Sensor High Error
level Failure
(Engine controller system)
L03 CA221
Detail of • High voltage appears in signal circuit of ambient pressure sensor.
failure
• Takes it that ambient pressure is at fixed value of 52.44 kPa (0.53 kg/cm 2) and allows
engine to run.
Action of • Limits engine output and allows engine to run.
controller • Closes EGR valve.
• Stops KDPF regeneration control.
Problem on • Engine output decreases.
machine
• Input voltage from ambient pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring function.
(Code: 37401 (V))
Related • Ambient pressure sensed by ambient pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring
information function. (Code: 37400 (kPa))
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
information on troubleshooting", and check it.
1 Defective harness connector 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
If this failure code disappears, harness connector is defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform following checks.
Defective sensor power If failure code [CA187] or [ CA227] is also displayed, perform
2 supply 1 circuit troubleshooting for it first.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector AMB. AIR PRESSURE.
3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
If failure code [CA221] changes to [CA222], sensor is defective.
Defective ambient pressure • Reference
3
sensor 1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Insert T-adapters in connector ECM J1.
3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
Sensor 0.5 to 4.5
Voltage Between ECM J1 (16) and (60)
output V
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connectors ECM J1 and AMB AIR PRESSURE, and
4 Short circuit in wiring harness connect T-adapters to either female side.
Resis- Between ECM J1 (60) and (16), or between Min. 100
tance AMB. AIR PRESSURE (female) (1) and (3) kz
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector AMB. AIR PRESSURE.
Hot short circuit in wiring 3. Connect T-adapters to female side of connector AMB. AIR
harness (contact with 24 V PRESSURE or insert T-adapters into connector ECM J1.
5
circuit) 4. Turn starting switch to ON position with connector AMB AIR
PRESSURE disconnected.
Between ECM J1 (16) and (59), or between
Voltage Max. 1 V
AMB. AIR PRESSURE (female) (3) and (2)
If no failure is found by above checks, engine controller is defective.
6 Defective engine controller
(Since this is an internal defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
PC210LC-10 40-163
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-164 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-165
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-166 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-167
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-168 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Action
Failure code Ne Speed Sensor Supply Voltage Error
level Failure
(Engine controller system)
L01 CA238
Detail of • Low voltage appears in power supply circuit of engine Ne speed sensor.
failure
Action of • Controls engine by using signals from engine Bkup speed sensor.
controller
• Running engine stops (when Bkup (CAM) speed sensor is also defective).
Problem on • Stopped engine cannot be started (when Bkup (CAM) speed sensor is also defective).
machine • Engine starting performance becomes deteriorated
• Engine hunts.
Related • Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
information
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
information on troubleshooting", and check it.
1 Defective harness connector 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
If this failure code disappears, harness connector is defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform following checks.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector CRANK SENSOR, and turn starting switch to
ON position.
2 Defective sensor If this failure code is not displayed, crank sensor is defective.
a Other failure codes (many codes) are also displayed. They are
generated because of disconnection of connector. Ignore failure
codes other than [CA238].
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect harness connector ECM J1 and turn starting switch to
ON position.
3 Defective wiring harness If this failure code is not displayed, engine wiring harness is defective.
a Other failure codes (many codes) are also displayed. They are
generated because of disconnection of connector. Ignore failure
codes other than [CA238].
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector ECM J1 and connect T-adapters to male side.
4 Defective engine controller 3. Turn starting switch to ON position with engine wiring harness
disconnected.
Voltage Between ECM J1 (male) (36) and (37) 4.75 to 5.25
V
PC210LC-10 40-169
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA239] Ne Speed Sens Supply Volt High Error (PC220_10-CA239-400-A-
00-A)
Action Ne speed sensor supply voltage high error
Failure code
level Failure
(Engine controller system)
L01 CA239
Details of • High voltage appears in power supply circuit of engine Ne speed sensor.
failure
Action of • Controls engine with signal from engine Bkup speed sensor.
controller
• Running engine stops (when Bkup speed sensor is also defective).
Problem on • Stopped engine cannot be started (when Bkup speed sensor is also defective).
machine • Engine startability becomes poor.
• Engine hunts.
Related • Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
information
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. Perform checkup referencing descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in
"c: Electrical equipment"of "Checks before troubleshooting" in "General
Defective wiring information on troubleshooting".
1 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
harness connector
If this failure code does not appear, wiring harness connector is defective.
a If this failure code is displayed, implement the following.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector CRANK SENSOR, and turn starting switch to ON
2 Defective sensor
position.
If this failure code is not displayed, sensor is defective.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect wiring harness ECM J1 and turn starting switch to ON position.
Defective wiring If this failure code is not displayed, engine wiring harness is defective.
3
harness
a Many other failure codes appear at same time because of disconnection of
connector. Ignore failure codes other than [CA239].
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector ECM J1 and connect T-adapters to male side.
Defective engine
4 3. Turn starting switch to ON position with engine wiring harness connector
controller
disconnected.
Voltage Between ECM J1 (male) (36) and (37) 4.75 to 5.25 V
40-170 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-171
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-172 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-173
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-174 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
• Input voltage from ambient pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring function.
(Code: 37401 (V))
Related • Ambient pressure sensed by ambient pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring
information function.
(Code: 37400 (kPa))
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
PC210LC-10 40-175
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-176 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-177
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-178 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-179
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-180 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-181
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-182 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-183
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-184 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-185
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-186 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-187
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-188 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-189
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-190 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-191
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA356] Mass Air Flow Sensor High Error (PC200LC_10-CA356-400-A-Z0-A)
Action level Failure code Mass Air Flow Sensor High Error
Failure
L03 CA356 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • High frequency is input to mass air flow sensor signal circuit.
failure
• Takes it that mass air flow is at fixed value (10 kg/min) and allows engine to run.
Action of • Closes EGR valve.
controller • Limits engine output and allows engine to run.
• Stops KDPF regeneration control.
Problem on • Engine output decreases.
machine
• Since sensor output is 5 V pulse voltage, it cannot be measured by using multimeter.
Related • Mass air flow sensor and intake air temperature sensor are integrated.
information • Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
information on troubleshooting", and check it.
1 Defective harness connector 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
If this failure code disappears, harness connector is defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform following checks.
Defective sensor power If failure code [CA3419] or [CA3421] is also displayed, perform
2 supply system troubleshooting for it first.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Defective mass air flow 2. Disconnect connector P55.
3 sensor 3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
(internal defect) If this failure code changes to [CA357], mass air flow sensor is
defective.
1. Be ready with starting switch at OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector P55, and connect T-adapters to female side.
Defective sensor power
4 3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
supply system
Power Approx. 12
Voltage Between P55 (female) (2) and (3)
supply V
a If no failure is found by check on cause 4, this check is not required.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Open circuit in wiring harness 2. Disconnect connectors ECM J1 and P55, and connect T-adapters to
5 (wire breakage or defective each female side.
contact of connector) a To check open circuit in GND line
Resis- Between ECM J1 (female) (22) and P55
(female) (3) Max. 10 z
tance
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connectors ECM J1 and P55, and connect T-adapters to
female side of ECM J1.
6 Short circuit in wiring harness
a Check by using multimeter in continuity mode.
Resis- Between ECM J1 (female) (23) and each pin Min. 100
tance other than pin (23) kz
If no failure is found by above checks, engine controller is defective.
7 Defective engine controller
(Since this is an internal defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
40-192 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-193
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA357] Mass Air Flow Sensor Low Error (PC200LC_10-CA357-400-A-Z0-A)
Action level Failure code Mass Air Flow Sensor Low Error
Failure
L03 CA357 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • Low frequency is input to mass air flow sensor signal circuit.
failure
• Takes it that mass air flow is at fixed value (10 kg/min) and allows engine to run.
Action of • Closes EGR valve.
controller • Limits engine output and allows engine to run.
• Stops KDPF regeneration control.
Problem on • Engine output decreases.
machine
• Since sensor output is 5 V pulse voltage, it cannot be measured by using multimeter.
• Mass air flow sensor and intake air temperature sensor are integrated.
Related • If sensor connector is disconnected, both this failure code and failure code [CA691] are
information displayed.
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
information on troubleshooting", and check it.
1 Defective harness connector 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
If this failure code disappears, harness connector is defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform following checks.
Defective sensor power If failure code [CA3419] or [CA3421] is also displayed, perform
2 supply system troubleshooting for it first.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Defective mass air flow 2. Replace mass air flow sensor.
3 sensor 3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
(internal defect) If this failure code does not appear, original mass air flow sensor is
defective.
1. Be ready with starting switch at OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector P55, and connect T-adapters to female side.
Defective sensor power
4 3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
supply system
Power Approx. 12
Voltage Between P55 (female) (2) and (3)
supply V
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connectors ECM J1 and P55, and connect T-adapters to
each female side.
a If no failure is found by check on cause 4,
this check is not required. Max. 10 z
Open circuit in wiring harness Between ECM J1 (female) (21) and P55
5 (wire breakage or defective (female) (2)
contact of connector) Resis-
a If no failure is found by check on cause 4,
tance
this check is not required. Max. 10 z
Between ECM J1 (female) (22) and P55
(female) (3)
Between ECM J1 (female) (23) and P55
(female) (1) Max. 10 z
40-194 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-195
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-196 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-197
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-198 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-199
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-200 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-201
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-202 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-203
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-204 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-205
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-206 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-207
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-208 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-209
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA488] Chg Air Temp High Torque Derate (D65-CA488-400-A-Z0-A)
Action level Failure code Chg Air Temp High Torque Derate
Failure
L03 CA488 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • Temperature signal from boost pressure & temperature sensor exceeds upper limit of
failure control temperature.
Action of • Restricts engine output and allows engine to run.
controller
Problem on • Engine output lowers.
machine
• Boost temperature can be checked with monitoring function.
Related (Code: 18500 Boost temperature)
information • Method of reproducing failure code: Start engine.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Aftercooler cooling performance may be degraded. Check for following
points:
Drop of cooling performance
1 • Defective fan rotation
of aftercooler
• Insufficient cooling air
• Clogged aftercooler fins
Unusual rise of turbocharger Outlet temperature of turbocharger may be unusually high. Check
2 outlet temperature related parts.
Defective boost temperature
3 Perform troubleshooting for failure codes [CA153] and [CA154].
sensor system
40-210 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA515] Rail Press Sens Sup Volt High Error (WA380_7-CA515-400-A-Z0-A)
Action level Failure code Rail Pressure Sensor Supply Voltage High Error
Failure
L03 CA515 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • High voltage appears in common rail pressure sensor power supply (5 V) circuit.
failure
Action of • Limits engine output and allows engine to run.
controller
Problem on • Engine output decreases.
machine
• Signal voltage from common rail pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring
function.
(Code: 36401 (V))
• Pressure sensed by common rail pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring
Related function.
information (Code: 36400 (MPa))
• Since female connector alone is provided for "socket" used for troubleshooting of this
sensor, it is not usable for check of open circuit in wiring harness and voltage at sensor
connector (.not designed as T-adapter).
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
information on troubleshooting", and check it.
1 Defective harness connector 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
If this failure code disappears, harness connector is defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform following checks.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector FUEL RAIL PRESS.
3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
Defective common rail If this failure code disappears, sensor is defective.
2 pressure sensor
a Other failure codes (many codes) are also displayed. They are
generated because of disconnection of connector. Ignore failure
codes other than this code.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector ECM J2.
3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
If this failure code does not appear, wiring harness may be defective.
3 Defective wiring harness Perform following troubleshooting.
a Other failure codes (many codes) are also displayed. They are
generated because of disconnection of connector. Ignore failure
codes other than this code.
a If no failure is found by check on cause 3, this check is not required.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Hot short circuit in wiring
2. Disconnect connector FUEL RAIL PRESS.
4 harness
3. Insert T-adapters into connector ECM J2.
(contact with 24 V circuit) 4. Turn starting switch to ON position.
Voltage Between ECM J2 (31) and (21) 4.75 to 5.25
V
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector ECM J2 and connect T-adapters to male side.
5 Defective engine controller 3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
Voltage Between ECM J2 (male) (31) and (21) 4.75 to 5.25
V
PC210LC-10 40-211
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-212 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA516] Rail Press Sens Sup Volt Low Error (WA380_7-CA516-400-A-Z0-A)
Action level Failure code Rail Pressure Sensor Supply Voltage Low Error
Failure
L03 CA516 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • Low voltage appears in common rail pressure sensor power supply (5 V) circuit.
failure
Action of • Limits engine output and allows engine to run.
controller
Problem on • Engine output decreases.
machine
• Signal voltage from common rail pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring
function.
(Code: 36401 (V))
• Pressure sensed by common rail pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring
Related function.
information (Code: 36400 (MPa))
• Since female connector alone is provided for "socket" used for troubleshooting of this
sensor, it is not usable for check of open circuit in wiring harness and voltage at sensor
connector (.not designed as T-adapter).
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
information on troubleshooting", and check it.
1 Defective harness connector 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
If this failure code disappears, harness connector is defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform following checks.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector FUEL RAIL PRESS.
Defective common rail 3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
2 pressure sensor If this failure code disappears, sensor is defective.
(internal defect) a Other failure codes (many codes) are also displayed. They are
generated because of disconnection of connector. Ignore failure
codes other than this code.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector ECM J2.
3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
If this failure code does not appear, wiring harness may be defective.
3 Defective wiring harness Perform following troubleshooting.
a Other failure codes (many codes) are also displayed. They are
generated because of disconnection of connector. Ignore failure
codes other than this code.
a If no failure is found by check on cause 3, this check is not required.
Ground fault in wiring 1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
4 harness 2. Disconnect connectors ECM J2 and FUEL RAIL PRESS, and
(contact with ground circuit) connect T-adapters to female side of ECM J2.
Resis- Between ECM J2 (female) (31) and ground
Min. 100 kz
tance
a If no failure is found by check on cause 3, this check is not required.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Short circuit in wiring harness
5 2. Disconnect connectors ECM J2 and FUEL RAIL PRESS, and
(contact with ground circuit) connect T-adapters to female side of ECM J2.
Resis- Between ECM J2 (female) (21) and (31) Min. 100 kz
tance
PC210LC-10 40-213
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-214 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Action
Failure code Rail Press High Error
level Failure
(Engine controller system)
L01 CA553
Detail of • Excessively high pressure trouble (1) has occurred in the common rail circuit.
failure
Action of • None in particular
controller
Problem on • Engine noise becomes louder at no or light load.
machine • Engine output lowers.
• Common rail pressure can be checked with monitoring function.
Related (Code 36400: Common rail pressure)
information • Method of reproducing failure code: Start engine.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1 Defect in related system If another failure code is displayed, perform troubleshooting for it.
Connection of ground terminals may be defective. Check the following
terminals.
Defective connection of • Ground terminal of machine ((–) terminal of battery)
2 ground terminal • Ground terminal of engine
• Ground terminal of engine controller
• Ground terminal of starting motor
Defective common rail
3 Perform troubleshooting for failure code [CA451], [CA452]
pressure sensor system
PC210LC-10 40-215
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-216 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-217
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-218 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Note 1: Check following points when performing troubleshooting of low-pressure circuit devices.
1) Volume of remaining fuel
2) Clogging of fuel tank breather
3) Fuel leakage from low-pressure fuel piping and clogging of piping
4) Clogging of fuel pre-filter
5 Clogging of fuel main filter
6) After clogging of filters, etc. is removed, if this failure code does not disappear, replace fuel filter.
Reference
High pressure pipe from common rail is connected to injector via inlet connector (11) in cylinder head.
Since inlet connector (11) is tightened with retainer (10), retighten retainer (10).
3 retainer (10) : 50 ± 4 Nm {5 ± 0.4 kgm}
Width across flats 24 mm
PC210LC-10 40-219
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-220 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-221
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-222 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-223
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-224 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA691] Intake Air Temp Sens High Error (PC200LC_10-CA691-400-A-Z0-A)
Action level Failure code Intake Air Temperature Sensor High Error
Failure
L01 CA691 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • High voltage is detected in signal circuit of intake air temperature sensor.
failure
Action of • Takes it that intake temperature is at fixed value (25 °C ) and allows engine to run.
controller
Problem on
machine
• Mass air flow sensor and intake temperature sensor are integrated.
• Signal voltage from intake air temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 18401 (V))
Related • Temperature sensed by intake air temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
information function. (Code: 18400 (°C))
• If sensor connector is disconnected, this failure code is displayed together with failure
code [CA357].
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
information on troubleshooting", and check it.
Defective wiring harness 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
1
connector If this failure code does not appear, wiring harness connector is
defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform following.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector P55 and connect T-adapters to male side.
Defective intake temperature -30 °C 25 to 28 kz
2 sensor Between P55 (male) (4) and (3) 0 °C 5.5 to 6.1 kz
(internal defect) Resis-
tance a Intake temperature - resistance 25 °C 1.9 to 2.1 kz
characteristics 40 °C 1.1 to 1.2 kz
100 °C 180 to 185 z
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Open or short circuit in wiring 2. Disconnect connector ECM J1 and connect T-adapter to female side
harness of connector.
3 (short circuit, wire breakage Resis- Between ECM J1 (female) (6) and (22) 180 z to 28
and defective contact of tance kz
connector) a Use Intake temperature - Resistance characteristics table for
troubleshooting on cause 2.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Hot short circuit in wiring 2. Disconnect connector P55.
harness 3. Insert T-adapters to connector ECM J1, or connect T-adapters to
4
female side of connector P55.
(Contact with 24 V circuit)
Between ECM J1 (6) and (22) or between
Voltage Max. 5.25 V
P55 (4) (female) (4) and (3)
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connectors ECM J1 and P55, and connect T-adapters to
female side of ECM J1.
5 Short circuit in wiring harness
a Check with multimeter in continuity mode.
Resis- Between ECM J1 (female) (6) and each pin
other than (6) Min. 100 kz
tance
If no failure is found in above checks, engine controller is defective.
6 Defective engine controller
(Since this is an internal defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
PC210LC-10 40-225
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-226 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA692] Intake Air Temp Sens Low Error (PC200LC_10-CA692-400-A-Z0-A)
Action level Failure code Intake Air Temperature Sensor Low Error
Failure
L01 CA692 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • Low voltage error is detected in signal circuit of intake air temperature sensor.
failure
Action of • Takes it that intake temperature is at fixed value (25 °C ) and allows engine to run.
controller
Problem on
machine
• Signal voltage from intake air temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 18401 (V))
Related • Temperature sensed by intake air temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
information function. (Code: 18400 (°C))
• Mass air flow sensor and intake temperature sensor are integrated.
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
information on troubleshooting", and check it.
Defective wiring harness 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
1
connector If this failure code does not appear, wiring harness connector is
defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform following.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector P55.
3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
If this failure code changes to failure code [CA691], intake air
temperature sensor is defective.
•
• Reference
Defective intake temperature
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2 sensor
2. Disconnect connector P55 and connect T-adapters to male side.
(internal defect)
-30 °C 25 to 28 kz
Between P55 (male) (4) and (3) 0 °C 5.5 to 6.1 kz
25 °C 1.9 to 2.1 kz
Resis- a Intake temperature - resistance
tance characteristics 40 °C 1.1 to 1.2 kz
100 °C 180 to 185 z
Between P55 (male) (4) and Whole
ground (sensor body) range Min. 100 kz
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Open or short circuit in wiring 2. Disconnect connector ECM J1 and connect T-adapter to female side
harness of connector.
3 (short circuit, wire breakage Resis- Between ECM J1 (female) (6) and (22) 180 z to 28
and defective contact of tance kz
connector) a Use Intake temperature - Resistance characteristics table for
troubleshooting on cause 2.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Ground fault in wiring harness 2. Disconnect connectors ECM J1 and P55, and connect T-adapters to
4 either female side.
(contact with ground circuit)
Resis- Between ground and ECM J1 (female) (6) or
P55 (female) (4) Min. 100 kz
tance
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connectors ECM J1 and P55, and connect T-adapters to
5 Short circuit in wiring harness female side of ECM J1.
a Check with multimeter in continuity mode.
PC210LC-10 40-227
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-228 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA697] ECM Int Temp Sensor High Error (PC220_10-CA697-400-A-00-A)
PC210LC-10 40-229
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA698] ECM Int Temp Sensor Low Error (PC220_10-CA698-400-A-00-A)
40-230 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA731] Eng Bkup Speed Sens Phase Error (WA380_7-CA731-400-A-Z0-A)
Action level Failure code Engine Bkup Speed Sensor Phase Error
Failure
L01 CA731 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • Phase error occurs between signals of engine Ne speed sensor and engine Bkup speed
failure sensor.
Action of • Continues to control engine by using engine Ne speed sensor signal.
controller
• Engine can not start or engine is hard to start.
Problem on • Idle speed is unstable.
machine • Exhaust gas color becomes black.
Related • Method of reproducing failure code: Start engine.
information
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Damaged engine Ne speed Engine Ne speed sensor may be damaged. Check it.
1
sensor
Damaged engine Bkup speed Engine Bkup speed sensor may be damaged. Check it.
2
sensor
Speed sensing wheel on crankshaft side may be installed improperly
or damaged. Check it according to following procedure.
1. Align paint mark (M1) of damper with mounting bolt (M2) of
Improper installation or damper.
3 damage of speed sensing a No.1 cylinder is not at its compression top dead center with
wheel on crankshaft side damper at that position (approximately 76 to 88 degrees before
to compression top dead center).
2. Installation is correct if center of slot (WS) of speed sensing wheel
is positioned under top surface (M2) of Ne speed sensor.
Speed detection ring on camshaft side may be installed improperly or
damaged. Check it according to following procedure.
Improper installation or 1. Set No. 1 cylinder to compression top dead center (align stamping
4 damage of speed sensing ring mark).
on camshaft side 2. Remove Bkup speed sensor.
3. Installation is correct if twin groove (single rib) (B) of speed sensing
ring is visible through sensor mounting hole (H).
Defective timing adjustment of Timings of crankshaft and camshaft may not be matched each other.
5
crankshaft and camshaft Check them.
Ground terminals may be connected defectively. Check following
terminals :
Defective connection of ground • Ground terminal of machine ((-) terminal of battery)
6
terminal • Ground terminal of engine
• Ground terminal of engine controller
• Ground terminal of starting motor
PC210LC-10 40-231
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-232 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-233
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-234 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-235
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
• Reference
Check of camshaft ring for looseness
Remove front cover and check camshaft ring for looseness.
a See Disassembly and assembly, "Removal and installation of engine front seal".
a Prepare front seal, liquid gasket LG-7 and front seal tool (795–799–6400)) beforehand.
Removal
1. Remove fan and fan belt, For details, see Disassembly and assembly, "Removal and installation of engine
front seal".
2. Remove damper assembly (1).
(DP): Dowel pin
40-236 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
5. Check that mounting bolt (4) of camshaft ring (5) is not loosened.
3 Mounting bolt (4):
10 ± 2 Nm {0.98 ± 0.2 kgm}
(DP): Dowel pin
Installation
a See figures shown in removal procedure section.
1. Install front cover (2).
2 Front cover:
Liquid gasket (LG-7)
2. See Disassembly and assembly, "Removal and installation of engine front seal".
1) install front cover (3).
2) Install dowel pin (DP), and install damper assembly.
3) Install fan belt, and install the fan.
4) Install the cooling system assembly.
PC210LC-10 40-237
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-238 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
k Since KDPF and KDOC are heated to 500°C or above, take care not to get burn
injury.
• Signal voltage from KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47301 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47300 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47401 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47400 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47201 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47200 (°C))
Related • KDOC inlet temperature, KDOC outlet temperature, and KDPF outlet temperature when
information engine is at idle (KDPF regeneration is not executed) are approx. 100 to 250°C, and
difference between these temperatures is approx. 10°C. (KDOC inlet temperature >
KDOC outlet temperature > KDPF outlet temperature)
• When active regeneration (manual stationary regeneration) is in progress, KDOC inlet
temperature is approx. 250 to 400°C, and KDOC outlet temperature and KDPF outlet
temperature are approx. 450 to 550°C.
• KDOC inlet temperature sensor connector label "TEMP1" expressed in black embossed
letters is seen on KDPF temperature sensor consolidating box (KDOC outlet temperature
sensor connector label "TEMP2" and KDPF outlet sensor connector label "TEMP3" are
shown similarly to "TEMP1").
• As to procedure for accessing KDPF temperature sensor, see 50 Disassembly and
assembly, "Removal and installation of KDPF assembly" and "Disassembly and assembly
of KDPF".
• Engine controller stops approximately 30 seconds after starting switch is turned to the
OFF position. So when you restart engine, wait one minute minimum before turning
starting switch to the ON position again.
• When this failure code appears, perform troubleshooting according to following work flow.
A. Identification of cause and repair
Machine O
operation for B. Machine operation for clearing failure code
clearing
failure code a This failure code does not disappear by simply turning starting switch to ON position from
OFF position after repair. You must perform machine operation for clearing failure code
after repair trouble.
A. Identification of cause and repair
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective KDOC inlet If failure code [CA3313], [CA3314], or [CA3315] is also displayed,
1 temperature sensor perform troubleshooting for [CA3313], [CA3314], or [CA3315].
Defective KDOC outlet If failure code [CA3316], [CA3317], or [CA3318] is also displayed,
2 temperature sensor perform troubleshooting for [CA3316], [CA3317], or [CA3318].
PC210LC-10 40-239
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-240 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
k Since KDPF and KDOC are heated to 500°C or above, take care not to get burn
injury.
• Signal voltage from KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47301 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47300 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47401 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47400 (°C)
• Signal voltage from KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47201 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47200 (°C))
• KDOC inlet temperature, KDOC outlet temperature, and KDPF outlet temperature when
engine is at idle (KDPF regeneration is not executed) are approx. 100 to 250°C, and
difference between these temperatures is approx. 10°C. (KDOC inlet temperature >
KDOC outlet temperature > KDPF outlet temperature)
Related • When manual stationary regeneration (normal) is in progress, KDOC inlet temperature is
information approx. 250 to 400°C, and KDOC outlet temperature and KDPF outlet temperature are
approx. 450 to 550°C.
• When manual stationary regeneration without injecting dosing fuel (KDOC drying) is in
progress, KDOC inlet temperature, KDOC outlet temperature, and KDPF outlet
temperature are all approx. 250 to 400°C.
• KDOC inlet temperature sensor connector label "TEMP1" expressed in black embossed
letters is seen on KDPF temperature sensor consolidating box (KDOC outlet temperature
sensor connector label "TEMP2" and KDPF outlet sensor connector label "TEMP3" are
shown similarly to "TEMP1").
a When KDOC in KDPF is changed, perform reset procedure for KDOC change and then
finish repair.
• Procedure of performing manual stationary regeneration from Regeneration for Service.
a When soot accumulation is at level 3 or lower, the manual stationary regeneration can be
performed only from "Regeneration for Service".
1. Start the engine.
2. Make sure that machine is in safe condition.
3. From service menu of machine monitor, select "Diagnostic Tests", open "02 Regeneration
for Service", and then perform "Manual Stationary Regeneration (manual stationary
regeneration will be completed in approx. 40 minutes).
PC210LC-10 40-241
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
a Failure code [CA2637] may be displayed at the same time, however, perform
troubleshooting for this failure code [CA1691].
Related • Method of reproducing failure code:
information When KDOC is changed, there is no need to check completion of repair.
When KDOC is not changed, start engine and turn manual stationary regeneration switch
ON. (See cause 6.)
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
• If there is a significant difference between KDOC outlet temperature
Defective KDOC outlet and KDOC inlet temperature and KDPF outlet temperature when
1 temperature sensor KDPF is completely cool or engine running at idle (not regenerating),
replace KDOC outlet temperature sensor.
1. Rapidly accelerate engine from low idle to high idle two times, and
then keep engine running at high idle for five seconds.
• If excessive black smoke is exhausted when accelerating engine or
running it at high idle, perform troubleshooting for "S-9 KDPF gets
2 Unusual exhaust gas color
clogged in a short time".
a It does not matter that black smoke particles are exhausted during
engine acceleration but are not exhausted during running at high
idle.
a Dry KDOC.
1. Turn starting switch to ON position.
2. Monitor signal voltages from KDOC inlet temperature sensor and
KDPF outlet temperature sensor, note temperature values from each
Defective KDOC sensor with KDPF under initial condition and during manual
3 stationary regeneration, and check that KDOC outlet temperature
(KDOC drying)
sensor is normal. (See "Related information".)
3. Perform manual stationary regeneration. (See "Related
information".)
a Since this is for drying KDOC, dosing fuel is not injected during
regeneration.
1. Remove KDPF.
Defective KDOC 2. Remove KDOC.
4 (dirty or cracked or damaged 3. Blow air from KDOC outlet side to clean ceramic surfaces inside
KDOC surface) KDOC.
4. Check ceramic inside KDOC for cracks.
If cracks are found in KDOC, KDOC is defective (replace KDOC).
a Perform the following regardless whether KDOC is replaced or not.
1. Install KDOC and KDPF.
2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
3. From service menu of machine monitor, display the "Diagnostic
Tests" screen, open "03 KDPF Memory Reset", and then perform "03
KDOC Change" (reset after KDOC change).
a When reset after KDOC change is performed, failure codes
5 Reset after KDOC change [CA1691] and [CA2637] will not be displayed. At that time, remedy of
not injecting dosing fuel when the failure code is displayed is
released.
a Check that reset after KDOC change is completed successfully (by
reset count). If not, perform troubleshooting again.
a When KDOC is replaced, finish troubleshooting without performing
manual stationary regeneration.
40-242 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-243
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Action
Failure code
level Failure Sensor power supply 5 high error
L03 CA1695
Details of • High voltage appears in 5 V power supply for KDPF differential pressure sensor and
failure KDPF outlet pressure sensor.
• Takes it that KDPF outlet pressure sensor is at fixed value (0 kPa {0 kg/cm 2}) and allows
engine to run.
• Takes it that KDPF delta pressure sensor value is at recommended value (or at 0 kPa {0
Action of kg/cm2}).
controller • Closes EGR valve.
• Limits engine output and allows engine run.
• Stops KDPF regeneration control.
Problem on • Engine output decreases.
machine
Related • KDPF delta pressure sensor and KDPF outlet pressure sensor are integrated.
information • Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. Perform checkup referencing the descriptions of wiring harness and
connectors in "c: Electrical equipment"of "Checks before troubleshooting" in
Defective wiring "General information on troubleshooting".
1 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
harness connector
If this failure code does not appear, wiring harness connector is defective.
a If this failure code is displayed, implement the following.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Defective KDPF
2. Disconnect connector E25.
delta pressure
3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
2 (outlet pressure)
sensor a Ignore displayed failure codes other than this one.
(internal defect) If this failure code does not appear, KDPF delta pressure (outlet pressure) sensor
is defective.
Ground fault in 1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
wiring harness 2. Disconnect connectors CE03 and E25, and connect T-adapters to either
3 (contact with GND female side.
circuit) Between CE03 ground and (female) (52)
Resistance or E25 (female) (4) Min. 100 kz
40-244 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-245
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Action
Failure code
level Failure Sensor power supply 5 low error
L03 CA1696
Details of • Low voltage appears in 5 V power supply for KDPF delta pressure sensor and KDPF
failure outlet pressure sensor.
• Takes it that KDPF outlet pressure sensor is at fixed value (0 kPa {0 kg/cm 2}) and allows
engine to run.
• Takes it that KDPF delta pressure sensor value is at recommended value (or at 0 kPa {0
Action of kg/cm2}) and allows engine to run.
controller • Closes EGR valve.
• Limits engine output and allows engine to run.
• Stops KDPF regeneration control.
Problem on • Engine output decreases.
machine
Related • KDPF delta pressure sensor and KDPF outlet pressure sensor are integrated.
information • Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. Perform checkup referencing the descriptions of wiring harness and
connectors in "c: Electrical equipment"of "Checks before troubleshooting" in
Defective wiring "General information on troubleshooting".
1 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
harness connector
If this failure code does not appear, wiring harness connector is defective.
a If this failure code is displayed, implement the following.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Defective KDPF
2. Disconnect connector E25.
delta pressure
3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
2 (outlet pressure)
sensor a Ignore displayed failure codes other than this one.
(internal defect) If this failure code does not appear, KDPF delta pressure (outlet pressure) sensor
is defective.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Short circuit in 2. Disconnect connectors CE03 and E25, and connect T-adapters to female side
3 wiring harness of connector CE03.
Between CE03 (female) (52) and each
Resistance pin other than (52) Min. 100 kz
40-246 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-247
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-248 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-249
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-250 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-251
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Action level Failure code KDPF delta pressure sensor high error
Failure
L03 CA1879 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • High voltage appears in KDPF delta pressure sensor signal circuit.
failure
• Takes it that KDPF delta pressure is at recommended value and allows engine to run.
(If another failure code is also generated, controller may run engine using delta pressure
Action of of 0 kPa.)
controller • Closes EGR valve.
• Limits engine output and allows engine to run.
• Stops KDPF regeneration control.
Problem on • Engine output lowers.
machine
k Since the temperature of the KDPF will become higher than 500 °C , take care not to
get burn injury.
• KDPF delta pressure sensor and KDPF outlet pressure sensor are integrated.
Related • If failure code [CA1695] is not displayed but failure code [CA3133] is displayed, GND line
information may have open circuit (defective connection of connector).
• Signal voltage from KDPF delta pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring function.
(Code: 47101(V))
• Delta pressure sensed by KDPF delta pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47100 (kPa))
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
Defective wiring harness information on troubleshooting", and check it.
1 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
connector
If this failure code does not appear, harness connector is defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform the following.
If failure code [CA1695] or [CA1696] is displayed, perform
troubleshooting for it first.
Defective sensor power 1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2 supply system 2. Disconnect connector E25 and connect T-adapters to female side.
3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
Voltage Between E25 (female) (4) and (1) 4.75 to 5.25 V
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector E25.
3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
Defective KDPF delta If failure code changes to [CA1881], KDPF delta pressure sensor is
3 pressure sensor defective.
a If this failure code is still displayed, the wiring harness or engine
controller is defective.
a Ignore other displayed failure codes.
a If no failure is found by check on cause 2, this check is not required.
Open circuit in wiring 1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
harness 2. Disconnect connectors CE03 and E25, and connect T-adapters to
4 each female side.
(wire breakage or defective
contact of connector) a To check for open circuit in GND line
Resis- Between CE03 (female) (43) and E25
(female) (1) Max. 10 z
tance
40-252 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-253
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Action level Failure code KDPF deltal pressure sensor low error
Failure
L03 CA1881 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • Low voltage appears in the KDPF delta pressure sensor signal circuit.
failure
• Takes it that KDPF delta pressure is at recommended value and allows engine to run.
(If another failure code is also generated, controller may run engine using delta pressure
Action of of 0 kPa.)
controller • Closes EGR valve.
• Limits engine output and allows engine to run.
• Stops KDPF regeneration control.
Problem on • Engine output lowers.
machine
k Since the temperature of the KDPF will become higher than 500 °C , take care not to
get burn injury.
• KDPF delta pressure sensor and KDPF outlet pressure sensor are integrated.
• If failure code [CA1696] is not displayed but failure code [CA3134] is displayed, the
Related sensor connector may be disconnected or an open circuit (poor connection in connector)
information is suspected in the 5 V line.
• This failure code is displayed if the sensor connector is disconnected.
• Signal voltage from KDPF delta pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring function.
(Code: 47101(V))
• Differential pressure sensed by KDPF delta pressure sensor can be checked with
monitoring function. (Code: 47100 (kPa))
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
Defective wiring harness information on troubleshooting", and check it.
1 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
connector
If this failure code does not appear, harness connector is defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform the following.
If failure code [CA1695] or [CA1696] is displayed, perform
troubleshooting for it first.
Defective sensor power 1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2 supply system 2. Disconnect connector E25 and connect T-adapters to female side.
3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
Voltage Between E25 (female) (4) and (1) 4.75 to 5.25
V
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connectors CE03 and E25, and connect T-adapters to
each female side.
a If no failure is found by check on cause 2,
this check is not required. Max. 10 z
Open circuit in wiring harness Between CE03 (female) (43) and E25
3 (wire breakage or defective (female) (1)
contact of connector) Resis-
a If no failure is found by check on cause 2,
tance
this check is not required. Max. 10 z
Between CE03 (female) (52) and E25
(female) (4)
Between CE03 (female) (55) and E25
(female) (2) Max. 10 z
40-254 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-255
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Action level Failure code KDPF Delta Pressure Sensor In Range Error
Failure
L03 CA1883 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • Signal voltage from KDPF delta pressure sensor is out of range. (Signal voltage from
failure sensor is within "operating" range.)
• Takes it that KDPF delta pressure is at estimated value and allows engine to run.
(If another failure code is also generated, controller may use delta pressure of 0 kPa to
run engine.)
Action of • Closes EGR valve.
controller • Limits engine output and allows engine to run.
• Stops KDPF regeneration control.
a You can cancel above measures by "turning starting switch to OFF position once, then
turning starting switch to ON position" after failure code is generated.
Problem on • Engine output decreases.
machine
k Since KDPF is heated to 500°C or above, take care not to get burn injury.
• KDPF delta pressure sensor and KDPF outlet pressure sensor are integrated.
• Signal voltage from KDPF delta pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring function.
(Code: 47101 (V))
• Delta pressure sensed by KDPF delta pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47100 (kPa))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47300 (°C))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
Related function. (Code: 47400 (°C))
information • Temperature sensed by KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47200 (°C))
• Temperature sensed by torque converter oil temperature sensor can be checked with
monitoring function. (Code: 30100 (°C))
a Use "Short-circuit connector: 799T-601-4611".
• As to procedure for accessing KDPF delta pressure sensor, wiring harness, and tube, see
50 Disassembly and assembly, "Removal and installation of KDPF assembly" and
"Disassembly and assembly of KDPF".
• Engine controller stops approximately 30 seconds after starting switch is turned to OFF
position. So when you restart engine, wait 1 minute minimum before turning starting
switch to ON position again.
• When this failure code appears, perform troubleshooting according to following work flow.
A. Identification of cause and repair
Machine O
operation for B. Machine operation for clearing failure code
clearing
failure code a This failure code does not disappear by simply turning starting switch to ON position from
OFF position after repair. You must perform machine operation for clearing failure code
after repair trouble.
A. Identification of cause and repair
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
If failure code [CA1695] or [CA1696] is also displayed, perform
troubleshooting for [CA1695] or [CA1696] first.
Defective sensor power 1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
1 supply system 2. Disconnect connector E25 and connect T-adapter to female side.
3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
Voltage Between E25 (female) (4) and (1) 4.75 to 5.25 V
40-256 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-257
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
1. Turn starting switch to ON position and leave it in that position for 1 minute. (In order to allow engine
controller to determine drift of voltage when starting switch is turned to ON position)
2. Turn starting switch from OFF position to ON position.
3. Start engine and run it at low idle (with no load) for approximately 1 minute.
4. After finishing warm-up operation, set swing lock switch to OFF position, working mode to P-mode, and
fuel control dial to MAX position.
5. Perform arm IN relief for 40 seconds.
a Take care not to overheat hydraulic oil.
a If failure code disappears, repair is complete.
6. If failure code still remains displayed, repeat above step 5 three times.
a If failure code disappears, repair is complete.
a When service tool "INSITE" is available, you can clear every failure code by executing "Reset All Faults"
command.
For how to use "INSITE", see "INSITE" operation manual.
If this failure code appears again after above procedures are
9 Defective engine controller implemented, engine controller is defective.
40-258 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
k Since KDOC and KDPF are heated to 500°C or above, take care not to get burn
injury.
• Signal voltage from KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47301 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47300 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47401 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47400 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47201 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47200 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDPF delta pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring function.
(Code: 47101 (V))
• Delta pressure sensed by KDPF delta pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47100 (kPa))
• KDOC inlet temperature, KDOC outlet temperature, and KDPF outlet temperature when
engine is at idle (KDPF regeneration is not executed) are approx. 100 to 250°C, and
Related difference between these temperatures is approx. 10°C. (KDOC inlet temperature >
information KDOC outlet temperature > KDPF outlet temperature)
• When the active regeneration (the manual stationary regeneration) is in progress, KDOC
inlet temperature is approx. 250 to 400°C, and KDOC outlet temperature and KDPF outlet
temperature are approx. 450 to 550°C.
• KDOC inlet temperature sensor connector label "TEMP1" expressed in black embossed
letters is seen on KDPF temperature sensor consolidating box (KDOC outlet temperature
sensor connector label "TEMP2" and KDPF outlet sensor connector label "TEMP3" are
shown similarly to "TEMP1").
• Soot accumulation in KDPF is classified into 8 levels. Current soot accumulation level can
be checked on machine monitor by selecting the "02 Regeneration for Service" screen.
• The manual stationary regeneration can be performed for removing soot when soot
accumulation is up to level 7.
• If soot accumulation reaches level 8, failure code [CA1922] is displayed. At this level, the
KDPF is completely clogged with soot, and inspection, cleaning, or replacement is
required.
a Time required for the manual stationary regeneration depends on the accumulated soot in
KCSF, however, it is estimated as follows.
• If soot accumulation is level 4: Approx. 40 minutes to 1 hour
• If soot accumulation is level 5: Approx. 1 to 2 hours
• If soot accumulation is level 6 or 7: Approx. 1 to 3 hours
• If soot accumulation is level 8: The manual stationary regeneration can not be performed.
PC210LC-10 40-259
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-260 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-261
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
k Since KDOC and KDPF are heated to 500°C or above, take care not to get burn
injury.
• Signal voltage from KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47301 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47300 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47401 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47400 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47201 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47200 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDPF delta pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring function.
(Code: 47101 (V))
• Delta pressure sensed by KDPF delta pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring
Related function. (Code: 47100 (kPa))
information • KDOC inlet temperature, KDOC outlet temperature, and KDPF outlet temperature when
engine is at idle (KDPF regeneration is not executed) are approx. 100 to 250°C, and
difference between these temperatures is approx. 10°C. (KDOC inlet temperature >
KDOC outlet temperature > KDPF outlet temperature)
• When the active regeneration (the manual stationary regeneration) is in progress, KDOC
inlet temperature is approx. 250 to 400°C, and KDOC outlet temperature and KDPF outlet
temperature are approx. 450 to 550°C.
• KDOC inlet temperature sensor connector label "TEMP1" expressed in black embossed
letters is seen on KDPF temperature sensor consolidating box (KDOC outlet temperature
sensor connector label "TEMP2" and KDPF outlet sensor connector label "TEMP3" are
shown similarly to "TEMP1").
• Soot accumulation in KDPF is classified into 8 levels. Current soot accumulation level can
be checked on machine monitor by selecting the "02 Regeneration for Service" screen.
• The manual stationary regeneration can be performed for removing soot when soot
accumulation is up to level 7.
• If soot accumulation reaches level 8, failure code [CA1922] is displayed. At this level, the
KDPF is completely clogged with soot, and inspection, cleaning, or replacement is
required.
40-262 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
a Time required for the manual stationary regeneration depends on the accumulated soot in
KCSF, however, it is estimated as follows.
• If soot accumulation is level 4: Approx. 40 minutes to 1 hour
• If soot accumulation is level 5: Approx. 1 to 2 hours
• If soot accumulation is level 6 or 7: Approx. 1 to 3 hours
• If soot accumulation is level 8: The manual stationary regeneration can not be performed.
Factors for excessive soot accumulation
1. Engine runs with light loads and cannot keep exhaust gas temperature high enough to
burn soot in KDPF.
• If temperature of the gas entered into after-treatment system (KDPF) is low, a large
amount of soot may accumulate.
• To avoid the soot accumulation in KDPF, the engine must run under high load.
2. Engine has failure that lead to excessive black smoke.
3. "Regeneration Disable" is set from the screen monitor.
• Even if the soot is accumulated, regeneration does not start automatically.
You must move the machine to a safe place to release the "Regeneration Disable",
and perform the regeneration.
a Releasing method of "Regeneration Disable"
Select the "Cancel of Regeneration Disable" from the ”KDPF Regeneration” screen and
execute.
Related
information (For details, see Operation and Maintenance Manual, "Operation", "Handling KDPF",
"Operation procedure of KDPF Regeneration Disable".)
• Procedure of performing the manual stationary regeneration from the "Regeneration for
Service".
a When soot accumulation is at level 3 or lower, the manual stationary regeneration can be
performed only from the "Regeneration for Service".
1. Start the engine.
2. Make sure that machine is in safe condition.
3. From service menu of machine monitor, display the "Diagnostic Tests" screen, open
"Regeneration for Service", and then perform the "Manual Stationary Regeneration".
a Resetting after KDPF cleaning
From service menu of machine monitor, display the "Diagnostic Tests" screen, open
"KDPF Memory Reset", and then perform "KDPF Cleaning" (reset after KDPF cleaning).
a Resetting after KDPF change
From service menu of machine monitor, display the "Diagnostic Tests" screen, open
"KDPF Memory Reset", and then perform "KDPF Change" (resetting after KDPF change).
a When KCSF in KDPF is changed, always perform resetting procedures for KDPF cleaning
and KDPF change, and then perform the "Manual Stationary Regeneration" from the
"Regeneration for Service" to eliminate moisture from KCSF.
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to the ON position.
PC210LC-10 40-263
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-264 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-265
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-266 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-267
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
k Since KDPF is heated to 500°C or above, take care not to get burn injury.
• KDPF delta pressure sensor and KDPF outlet pressure sensor are integrated.
• Signal voltage from KDPF delta pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring function.
(Code: 47101 (V))
• Delta pressure sensed by KDPF delta pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47100 (kPa))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
Related function. (Code: 47300 (°C))
information • Temperature sensed by KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47400 (°C))
• Temperature sensed by KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47200 (°C))
• As to procedure for accessing KDPF delta pressure sensor, wiring harness, and tube, see
50 Disassembly and assembly, "Removal and installation of KDPF assembly" and
"Disassembly and assembly of KDPF".
• Engine controller stops approximately 30 seconds after starting switch is turned to OFF
position. So when you restart engine, wait 1 minute minimum before turning starting
switch to ON position again.
• When this failure code appears, perform troubleshooting according to following work flow.
A. Identification of cause and repair
O
Machine B. Machine operation for clearing failure code
operation for
clearing a This failure code does not disappear by simply turning starting switch to ON position from
failure code OFF position after repair. You must perform machine operation for clearing failure code
after repair trouble.
a In machine operation for clearing failure code, "dummy temperature sensor: 799T-601-
4680" is used.
A. Identification of cause and repair
40-268 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-269
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-270 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA2185] Throt Sensor Sup Volt High Error (PC400-CA2185-400-A-Z0-A)
Action level Failure code Throttle Sensor Supply Voltage High Error
Failure
L03 CA2185 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • High voltage appears in throttle sensor power supply (5 V) circuit.
failure
• Uses throttle value obtained before failure detection to run engine if failure is detected
Action of with starting switch at ON position.
controller • Uses full throttle value to run engine if starting switch is set to ON position after failure
detection.
Problem on • Engine speed cannot be controlled by using fuel control dial.
machine
Related • Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
information
N- Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Cause
o.
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General information
Defective wiring harness on troubleshooting", and check it.
1 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
connector
If this failure code disappears, wiring harness connector is defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform following checks.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector P20, and turn starting switch to ON position.
Defective throttle sensor
2 (fuel control dial) If this failure code disappears, throttle sensor is defective.
a Other failure codes are also displayed. They are generated because of
disconnection of connector. Ignore failure codes other than [CA2185].
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connectors CE03 and P20, and connect T-adapter to
Short circuit in wiring
3 female side of CE03.
harness
Resis- Between CE03 (female) (42) and each pin other
Min. 1 Mz
tance than pin CE03 (female) (42)
Hot short circuit in wiring 1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector P20, and connect T-adapter to female side.
4 harness 3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
(contact with 24 V circuit)
Voltage Between P20 (female) (1) and ground 4.75 to 5.25 V
If no failure is found by above checks, engine controller is defective. (Since
this is an internal defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
• Reference
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
5 Defective engine controller
2. Insert T-adapter into connector CE03.
3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
Power
Voltage Between CE03 (42) and (41)
supply 4.75 to 5.25 V
PC210LC-10 40-271
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-272 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA2186] Throt Sensor Sup Volt Low Error (PC400-CA2186-400-A-Z0-A)
Action level Failure code Throttle Sensor Supply Voltage Low Error
Failure
L03 CA2186 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • Low voltage appears in throttle sensor power supply (5 V) circuit.
failure
• Uses throttle value obtained before failure detection to run engine if failure is detected
Action of with starting switch at ON position.
controller • Uses full throttle value to run engine if starting switch is set to ON position after failure
detection.
Problem on • Engine speed cannot be controlled by using fuel control dial.
machine
Related • Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
information
N- Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Cause
o.
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General information
Defective wiring harness on troubleshooting", and check it.
1 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
connector
If this failure code disappears, wiring harness connector is defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform following checks.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector P20, and turn starting switch to ON position.
Defective throttle sensor
2 (fuel control dial) If this failure code disappears, throttle sensor is defective.
a Other failure codes are also displayed. They are generated because of
disconnection of connector. Ignore failure codes other than [CA2186].
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Ground fault in wiring 2. Disconnect connectors CE03 and P20, and connect T-adapter to either
3 harness female side.
(contact with ground circuit) Resis- Between ground and CE03 (female) (42) or P20
Min. 1 Mz
tance (female) (1)
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connectors CE03 and P20, and connect T-adapter to
Short circuit in wiring female side of CE03.
4 3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
harness
Resis- Between CE03 (female) (42) and each pin other
Min. 1 Mz
tance than pin CE03 (female) (42)
If no failure is found by above checks, engine controller is defective. (Since
this is an internal defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
• Reference
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
5 Defective engine controller
2. Insert T-adapter into connector CE03.
3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
Power
Voltage Between CE03 (42) and (41)
supply 4.75 to 5.25 V
PC210LC-10 40-273
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-274 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-275
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA2271] EGR Valve Pos Sens High Error (D65-CA2271-400-A-Z0-A)
Action level Failure code EGR Valve Position Sensor High Error
Failure
L03 CA2271 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • High voltage appears in signal circuit of EGR valve lift sensor.
failure
• Closes EGR valve.
Action of • Limits engine output and allows engine to run.
controller • Stops KDPF regeneration control.
Problem on • Engine output decreases.
machine
• Signal voltage from EGR valve lift sensor can be checked with monitoring function.
(Code: 18101 (V))
Related • Position sensed by EGR valve lift sensor can be checked with monitoring function.
information (Code: 18100 (mm))
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
information on troubleshooting", and check it.
1 Defective harness connector 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
If this failure code disappears, harness connector is defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform following checks.
Defective sensor power If failure code [CA352] or [CA386] is displayed, perform troubleshooting
2 supply circuit for [CA352] or [CA386] first.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Defective EGR valve lift 2. Disconnect connector SEGR.
3 sensor 3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
(internal defect) If failure code [CA2271] changes to [CA2272], EGR valve lift sensor is
defective.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector INTER-CONNECT.
3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
If failure code [CA2271] changes to [CA2272], connector box is
Defective connector box
4 defective.
(internal short circuit)
a EGR solenoid failure code [CA2349], KVGT sensor failure code
[CA2382], and KVGT solenoid failure code [CA2383] are also
displayed. They are generated because of disconnection connector
INTER-CONNECT. Ignore these failure codes.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connectors INTER-CONNECT and SEGR, and connect
Open circuit in connector box T-adapters to INTER-CONNECT male side and SEGR female side.
5 (wire breakage or defective
contact of connector) a To check open circuit in GND line
Resis- Between INTER-CONNECT (male) (4) and
SEGR (female) (B) Max. 10 z
tance
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connectors ECM J2 and INTER-CONNECT, and
Open circuit in wiring harness connect T-adapters to each female side.
6 (wire breakage or defective a To check open circuit in GND line
contact of connector) a If no failure is found by check on cause 2, this check is not required.
Resis- Between ECM J2 (female) (47) and INTER-
CONNECT (female) (4) Max. 10 z
tance
40-276 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-277
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA2272] EGR Valve Pos Sens Low Error (D65-CA2272-400-A-Z0-A)
Action level Failure code EGR Valve Position Sensor Low Error
Failure
L03 CA2272 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • Low voltage appears in signal circuit of EGR valve lift sensor.
failure
• Closes EGR valve.
Action of • Limits engine output and allows engine to run.
controller • Stops KDPF regeneration control.
Problem on • Engine output decreases.
machine
• Signal voltage from EGR valve lift sensor can be checked with monitoring function.
(Code: 18101 (V))
Related • Position sensed by EGR valve lift sensor can be checked with monitoring function.
information (Code: 18100 (mm))
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
information on troubleshooting", and check it.
1 Defective harness connector 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
If this failure code disappears, harness connector is defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform following checks.
If failure code [CA352] or [CA386] is displayed, perform troubleshooting
for [CA352] or [CA386] first.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Defective sensor power
2 2. Disconnect connector SEGR and connect T-adapters to female side.
supply circuit
3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
Between SEGR (female) (A) and Power 4.75 to 5.25
Voltage
(B) supply V
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connectors INTER-CONNECT and SEGR, and connect
T-adapters to INTER-CONNECT male side and SEGR female side.
a If no failure is found by check on cause 2,
this check is not required. Between INTER- Max. 10 z
Open circuit in connector box CONNECT (male) (3) and SEGR (female)
3 (wire breakage or defective (A).
contact of connector) Resis-
a If no failure is found by check on cause 2,
tance
this check is not required. Between INTER- Max. 10 z
CONNECT (male) (4) and SEGR (female)
(B).
Between INTER-CONNECT (male) (5) and
SEGR (female) (C) Max. 10 z
40-278 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-279
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-280 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-281
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-282 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-283
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-284 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-285
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-286 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-287
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA2373] Exhaust Manifold Press Sens High error (D65-CA2373-400-
A-Z0-A)
Action level Failure code Exhaust Manifold Pressure Sensor High Error
Failure
L03 CA2373 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • High voltage appears in signal circuit of exhaust manifold pressure sensor.
failure
• Takes it that exhaust manifold pressure is at calculated value and allows engine to run.
Action of • Closes EGR valve.
controller • Limits engine output and allows engine to run.
• Stops KDPF regeneration control.
Problem on • Engine output decreases.
machine
• Signal voltage from exhaust manifold pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring
function.
(Code: 48301 (V))
Related • Pressure sensed by exhaust manifold pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring
information function.
(Code: 48300 (MPa))
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
information on troubleshooting", and check it.
1 Defective harness connector 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
If this failure code disappears, harness connector is defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform following checks.
Defective sensor power If failure code [CA352] or [CA386] is displayed, perform troubleshooting
2 supply circuit for [CA352] or [CA386] first.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Defective boost pressure 2. Disconnect connector EXHAUST PRESSURE.
3 sensor 3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
(internal defect) If failure code [[CA2373] changes to [CA2374], exhaust manifold
pressure sensor is defective.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Short circuit in wiring harness 2. Disconnect connectors ECM J2 and EXHAUST PRESSURE, and
4 (Short circuit between wiring connect T-adapters to each female side.
harnesses) Resis- Between ECM J2 (34) and (30), or between Min. 100
tance EXHAUST PRESSURE (female) (3) and (1) kz
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Hot short circuit in wiring 2. Disconnect connector EXHAUST PRESSURE and connect T-
harness adapters to female side.
5 3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
(contact with 24 V circuit)
Between EXHAUST PRESSURE (female) (3)
Voltage Max. 1 V
and (2)
If no failure is found by above checks, engine controller is defective.
(Since this is an internal defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
• Reference
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
6 Defective engine controller
2. Insert T-adapters into connector ECM J2.
3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
Sensor 0.2 to 4.7
Voltage Between ECM J2 (34) and (47)
output V
40-288 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-289
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA2374] Exhaust Manifold Press Sens Low error (D65-CA2374-400-
A-Z0-A)
Action level Failure code Exhaust Manifold Pressure Sensor Low Error
Failure
L03 CA2374 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • Low voltage appears in signal circuit of exhaust manifold pressure sensor.
failure
• Takes it that exhaust manifold pressure is at calculated value and allows engine to run.
Action of • Closes EGR valve.
controller • Limits engine output and allows engine to run.
• Stops KDPF regeneration control.
Problem on • Engine output decreases.
machine
• Signal voltage from exhaust manifold pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring
function.
(Code: 48301 (V))
Related • Pressure sensed by exhaust manifold pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring
information function.
(Code: 48300 (MPa))
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
information on troubleshooting", and check it.
1 Defective harness connector 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
If this failure code disappears, harness connector is defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform following checks.
If failure code [CA352] or [CA386] is displayed, perform troubleshooting
for [CA352] or [CA386] first.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Defective sensor power 2. Disconnect connector EXHAUST PRESSURE and connect T-
2 supply circuit adapters to female side.
3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
Between EXHAUST PRESSURE Power 4.75 to 5.25
Voltage
(female) (1) and (2) supply V
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connectors ECM J2 and EXHAUST PRESSURE, and
connect T-adapters to each female side.
Open circuit in wiring harness Between ECM J2 (30) and EXHAUST
PRESSURE (female) (1) Max. 10 z
3 (wire breakage or defective
contact of connector) Resis- Between ECM J2 (female) (47) and EXHAUST
PRESSURE (female) (2) Max. 10 z
tance
Between ECM J2 (female) (34) and EXHAUST
PRESSURE (female) (3) Max. 10 z
40-290 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-291
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA2375] EGR Orifice Temp Sens High Error (D65-CA2375-400-A-Z0-A)
Action level Failure code EGR Orifice Temperature Sensor High Error
Failure
L03 CA2375 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • High voltage appears in signal circuit of EGR orifice temperature sensor.
failure
• Runs engine by setting EGR orifice temperature to calculated value.
Action of • Closes EGR valve.
controller • Limits engine output and allows engine to run.
• Stops KDPF regeneration control.
Problem on • Engine output decreases.
machine
• Signal voltage from EGR orifice temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function.
(Code: 48501 (V))
Related • Temperature sensed by EGR orifice temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
information function.
(Code: 48500 (°C))
• This failure code appears if sensor connector is disconnected.
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
information on troubleshooting", and check it.
1 Defective harness connector 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
If this failure code disappears, harness connector is defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform following checks.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector EXHAUST GAS TEMPERATURE and
connect T-adapters to male side.
760 to 880
-30 °C
kz
380 to 515
0 °C
kz
155 to 225
25 °C
kz
Defective EGR orifice
Between EXHAUST GAS 21 to 29
2 temperature sensor (internal 80 °C
defect) TEMPERATURE (male) (1) and (2) kz
Resis- 900 to
tance 200 °C
1050 z
150 to 200
300 °C
z
400 °C 40 to 56 z
500 °C 15 to 22 z
Between EXHAUST GAS
Whole Min. 100
TEMPERATURE (male) (2) and
range kz
ground (sensor body)
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Open or short circuit in wiring 2. Disconnect connector ECM J2 and connect T-adapters to female
harness side.
3 (short circuit, wire breakage a Use Temperature-Resistance characteristics table of EGR orifice
or defective contact of temperature sensor that is used for check on cause 2 as resistance
connector) criteria.
Resis- Between ECM J2 (female) (18) and (48) 15 z to
tance 880 kz
40-292 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-293
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA2376] EGR Orifice Temp Sens Low Error (PC220_10-CA2376-400-A-00-A)
40-294 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-295
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-296 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-297
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-298 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-299
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-300 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-301
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-302 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-303
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-304 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-305
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA2554] Exh Manifold Press Sens In Range Error (D65-CA2554-400-
A-Z0-A)
Action level Failure code Exhaust Manifold Pressure Sensor In Range Error
Failure
L03 CA2554 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • Signal voltage output from exhaust manifold pressure sensor is out of normal range.
failure
• Takes it that exhaust manifold pressure is at calculated value and allows engine to run.
Action of • Closes EGR valve.
controller • Limits engine output and allows engine to run.
• Stops KDPF regeneration control.
Problem on • Engine output decreases.
machine
• Signal voltage from exhaust manifold pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring
function.
(Code: 48301 (V))
Related • Pressure sensed by exhaust manifold pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring
information function.
(Code: 48300 (MPa))
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position, or start engine
and run engine at high idle.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Blocked piping of exhaust Exhaust manifold pressure sensor piping may be blocked. Check piping
1 manifold pressure sensor for clogging.
Defective exhaust manifold Exhaust manifold pressure sensor system may be defective. Perform
2 pressure sensor troubleshooting for failure codes [CA2373] and [CA2374].
40-306 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA2555] Grid Htr Relay Volt Low Error (PC200LC_10-CA2555-400-A-Z0-A)
Action level Failure code Grid Heater Relay Voltage Low Error
Failure
L01 CA2555 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • Open circuit is in preheat relay drive circuit (primary circuit).
failure
Action of • None in particular
controller
Problem on • Intake air heater does not work in auto preheating mode (resulting in degraded startability
machine and emission of white smoke at low temperatures).
• Temperature sensed by charge temperature sensor (boost temperature sensor) can be
checked with monitoring function. (Code: 18500 (°C))
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position (boost
temperature: Max. -4 °C).
• Troubleshooting of this failure code covers circuits from engine controller to primary circuit
Related (coil) of preheat relay R18.
information • For troubleshooting of heater relay and secondary circuit of preheat relay R18, see
following E-mode troubleshooting.
• E-2 Manual preheating system does not work
• E-3 Automatic preheating system does not work
• E-4 While preheating is working, preheating monitor does not light up
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
Defective wiring harness information on troubleshooting", and check it.
1 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
connector
If this failure code disappears, wiring harness connector is defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform following checks.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect relay R18, and connect T-adapter to male side.
Resis- Between R18 (male) (1) and (2)
200 to 400 z
tance
2 Defective preheat relay R18
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Replace relay R18 with another one.
3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
If this failure code disappears, original preheat relay R18 is defective.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Open or short circuit in wiring 2. Disconnect connector CE03, and connect T-adapter to female side.
3
harness Resis- Between CE03 (female) (4) and (13)
200 to 400 z
tance a Coil resistance of relay R18
a If no failure is found by check on cause 3, this check is not required.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector CE03 and relay R18, and connect T-adapter
4 Open circuit in wiring harness to each female side.
Between CE03 (female) (4) and R18 (female)
Max. 10 z
Resis- (1)
tance Between CE03 (female) (13) and R18
(female) (2) Max. 10 z
If no failure is found by above checks, engine controller is defective.
5 Defective engine controller
(Since this is an internal defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
PC210LC-10 40-307
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-308 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA2556] Grid Htr Relay Volt High Error (PC200LC_10-CA2556-400-A-Z0-A)
Action level Failure code Grid Heater Relay Voltage High Error
Failure
L01 CA2556 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • Short circuit is in preheat relay drive circuit (primary circuit).
failure
Action of • None in particular
controller
Problem on • Intake air heater does not work in auto preheating mode (resulting in degraded startability
machine and emission of white smoke at low temperatures).
• Temperature sensed by charge temperature sensor (boost temperature sensor) can be
checked with monitoring function. (Code: 18500 (°C))
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position (boost
temperature: Max. -4 °C).
• Troubleshooting of this failure code covers circuits from engine controller to primary circuit
Related (coil) of preheat relay R18.
information • For troubleshooting of heater relay and secondary circuit of preheat relay R18, see
following E-mode troubleshooting.
• E-2 Manual preheating system does not work
• E-3 Automatic preheating system does not work
• E-4 While preheating is working, preheating monitor does not light up
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
Defective wiring harness information on troubleshooting", and check it.
1 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
connector
If this failure code disappears, wiring harness connector is defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform following checks.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect relay R18, and connect T-adapter to male side.
Resis- Between R18 (male) (1) and (2)
200 to 400 z
tance
2 Defective preheat relay R18
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Replace relay R18 with another one.
3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
If this failure code disappears, original preheat relay R18 is defective.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector CE03 and relay R18, and connect T-adapter
3 Ground fault in wiring harness to either female side.
Resis- Between ground and CE03 (female) (4) or
R18 (female) (1) Min. 100 Kz
tance
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector CE03 and relay R18, and connect T-adapter
to female side of CE03.
4 Short circuit in wiring harness a Check by using multimeter in continuity mode.
No continuity
Between CE03 (female) (4) and each pin
Continuity (No sound is
other than pin (4)
heard)
If no failure is found by above checks, engine controller is defective.
5 Defective engine controller
(Since this is an internal defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
PC210LC-10 40-309
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-310 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
a When KDOC in KDPF is changed, perform reset procedure for KDOC change and then
finish repair.
• Procedure of performing manual stationary regeneration from Regeneration for Service.
a When soot accumulation is at level 3 or lower, the manual stationary regeneration can be
performed only from "Regeneration for Service".
Related 1. Start the engine.
information 2. Make sure that machine is in safe condition.
3. From service menu of machine monitor, display the "Diagnostic Tests" screen, open
"02 Regeneration for service", and then perform the "Manual Stationary
Regeneration".
• If the KDOC efficiency is still low, this failure code [CA2637] may be displayed repeatedly
and failure code [CA1691] indicating the poor regeneration may be displayed.
<How to clear failure code>
• Start the engine and perform the warm-up operation, then operate the machine under
normal conditions for approximately 3 hours.
(If the exhaust gas temperature is high, this operation time can be reduced.)
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1 Defective KVGT If failure code [CA238*] is displayed, troubleshoot for it first.
If failure code [CA227*], [CA23**] or others is displayed, troubleshoot for
2 Defective EGR valve
it first.
1. Remove turbocharger exhaust connector.
Defective turbocharger 2. Check for oil or fuel inside turbocharger exhaust connector.
3
exhaust connector • If contaminated, troubleshoot for failure codes [CA227*], [CA23**],
etc., relating to the EGR valve and KVGT.
Defective exhaust connector Check exhaust system between turbocharger and KDPF for damage of
4 and ducts connected to the connector and ducts, and for loose connection.
KDPF
1. Rapidly accelerate engine from low idle to high idle two times, and
then keep engine running at high idle for 5 seconds.
• If excessive black smoke is exhausted when running the engine at
high idle, troubleshoot for "S-9 KDPF gets clogged in a short time".
5 Unusual exhaust gas color
a It does not matter that black smoke particles are exhausted during
engine acceleration but are not exhausted during running at high
idle.
PC210LC-10 40-311
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
a Operate the machine approximately 3 hours and check that this failure code is not displayed.
40-312 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Action of
• Normal control
controller
k Since KDOC and KDPF are heated to 500°C or above, take care not to get burn
injury.
• Signal voltage from KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47301 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47300 (°C))
• KVGT solenoid current can be checked with monitoring function. (Code: 48800 (mA))
• Signal voltage from KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47401 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47400 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47201 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47200 (°C))
• KDOC inlet temperature, KDOC outlet temperature, and KDPF outlet temperature when
engine is at idle (KDPF regeneration is not executed) are approx. 100 to 250°C, and
difference between these temperatures is approx. 10°C. (KDOC inlet temperature >
KDOC outlet temperature > KDPF outlet temperature)
• When the active regeneration (the manual stationary regeneration) is in progress, KDOC
inlet temperature is approx. 250 to 400°C, and KDOC outlet temperature and KDPF outlet
Related temperature are approx. 450 to 550°C.
information • KDOC inlet temperature sensor connector label "TEMP1" expressed in black embossed
letters is seen on KDPF temperature sensor consolidating box (KDOC outlet temperature
sensor connector label "TEMP2" and KDPF outlet sensor connector label "TEMP3" are
shown similarly to "TEMP1").
• How to perform the manual stationary regeneration
1. Start the engine.
2. Make sure that machine is in safe condition.
3. From the service menu of the machine monitor, display the "Diagnostic Tests" screen,
open "Regeneration for Service", and perform the "Manual Stationary Regeneration".
a While the regeneration for service is in progress, the “monitoring” screen is displayed by
performing the switch operation: keep pressing numeral input switch [4] and sequentially
press [1], [2] and [3] in order.
(For detail, see Testing and adjusting “Regeneration for service ” . )
a Time required for the manual stationary regeneration depends on the accumulated soot in
KCSF, however, it is estimated as follows.
• If soot accumulation is level 4: Approx. 40 minutes to 1 hour
• If soot accumulation is level 5: Approx. 1 to 2 hours
• If soot accumulation is level 6 or 7: Approx. 1 to 3 hours
• If soot accumulation is level 8: The manual stationary regeneration can not be performed.
a If this failure code is still displayed after several hours have passed after the manual
stationary regeneration, perform the following troubleshooting procedures.
PC210LC-10 40-313
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
a If another failure code is displayed (including when the manual stationary regeneration is
in progress), perform troubleshooting for it first.
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to the ON position.
40-314 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-315
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-316 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA2973] Chg Air Press Sensor In Range Error (D65-CA2973-400-A-Z0-A)
Action level Failure code Charge Air Pressure Sensor In Range Error
Failure
L03 CA2973 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • Output signal from boost pressure sensor is out of normal range.
failure
• Takes it that boost temperature is at calculated value and allows engine to run.
Action of • Closes EGR valve.
controller • Limits engine output and allows engine to run.
• Stops KDPF regeneration control.
Problem on • Engine output decreases.
machine
• Signal voltage from boost pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring function.
(Code: 36501 (V))
Related • Pressure sensed by boost pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring function.
information (Code: 36500 (MPa))
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective boost pressure Boost pressure sensor system may be defective. Perform
1 troubleshooting for failure codes [CA122] and [CA123].
sensor
PC210LC-10 40-317
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA3133] KDPF Outlet Press Sens High Error (PC200LC_10-CA3133-400-A-
Z0-A)
Action level Failure code KDPF Outlet Pressure Sensor High Error
Failure
L03 CA3133 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • High voltage appears in signal circuit of KDPF outlet pressure sensor.
failure
• Takes it that KDPF delta pressure is at estimated value (gauge pressure) and allows
Action of engine to run.
controller (Controller may use 0 kPa (gauge pressure) to run engine if another failure code is also
displayed.)
Problem on
• None
machine
k Since KDPF is heated to 500°C or above, take care not to get burn injury.
• KDPF delta pressure sensor and KDPF outlet pressure sensor are integrated.
• If failure code [CA1695] is not displayed but failure code [CA1879] is on screen, GND
Related circuit probably has open circuit (defective contact of connector).
information • Signal voltage from KDPF outlet pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47001 (V))
• Delta pressure sensed by KDPF outlet pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47000 (kPa))
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
40-318 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-319
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA3134] KDPF Outlet Press Sens Low Error (PC200LC_10-CA3134-400-A-
Z0-A)
Action level Failure code KDPF Outlet Pressure Sensor Low Error
Failure
L03 CA3134 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • Low voltage appears in signal circuit of KDPF outlet pressure sensor.
failure
• Takes it that KDPF outlet pressure is at estimated value (gauge pressure) and allows
Action of engine to run
controller (Controller may use 0 kPa (gauge pressure) to run engine if another failure code is also
displayed.)
Problem on
• None
machine
k Since KDPF is heated to 500°C or above, take care not to get burn injury.
• KDPF delta pressure sensor and KDPF outlet pressure sensor are integrated.
• If failure code [CA1696] is not displayed but failure code [CA1881] is on screen, sensor
connector is probably disconnected or 5 V circuit probably has open circuit (defective
Related contact of connector).
information • This failure code appears if sensor connector is disconnected.
• Signal voltage from KDPF outlet pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47001 (V))
• Delta pressure sensed by KDPF outlet pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47000 (kPa))
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
N- Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Cause
o.
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
Defective wiring harness information on troubleshooting", and check it.
1 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
connector
If this failure code disappears, wiring harness connector is defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform following checks.
If failure code [CA1695] or [CA1696] is also displayed, perform
troubleshooting for [CA1695] or [CA1696] first.
Defective sensor power supply 1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2 system
2. Disconnect connector E25 and connect T-adapter to female side.
3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
Voltage Between E25 (female) (4) and (1) 4.75 to 5.25 V
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connectors CE03 and E25, and connect T-adapter to
each female side.
a If no failure is found by check on cause 2,
this check is not required. Max. 1 z
Open circuit in wiring harness Between CE03 (female) (43) and E25
3 (wire breakage or defective (female) (1)
contact of connector) Resis-
a If no failure is found by check on cause 2,
tance
this check is not required. Max. 1 z
Between CE03 (female) (52) and E25
(female) (4)
Between CE03 (female) (58) and E25
(female) (3) Max. 1 z
40-320 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-321
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA3135] KDPF Outlet Press Sens In Range Error (PC200LC_10-
CA3135-400-A-Z0-A)
Action level Failure code KDPF Outlet Pressure Sensor In Range Error
Failure
L03 CA3135 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • Pressure value sensed by KDPF outlet pressure sensor is higher than normal value.
failure (Signal voltage from sensor is within "operating" range.)
• Takes it that KDPF outlet pressure is at estimated value (gauge pressure) and allows
Action of engine to run
controller (Controller may use 0 kPa (gauge pressure) to run engine if another failure code is also
displayed.)
Problem on
• None
machine
k Since KDPF is heated to 500°C or above, take care not to get burn injury.
• KDPF delta pressure sensor and KDPF outlet pressure sensor are integrated.
• Signal voltage from KDPF outlet pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47001 (V))
• Outlet pressure sensed by KDPF outlet pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47000 (kPa))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47300 (°C))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
Related function. (Code: 47400 (°C))
information • Temperature sensed by KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47200 (°C))
a Use "Short-circuit connector: 799T-601-4670" (its wiring is not identical with that of "Short-
circuit connector: 799-601-4611).
• As to procedure for accessing KDPF delta pressure sensor, wiring harness, and tube, see
50 Disassembly and assembly, "Removal and installation of KDPF assembly" and
"Disassembly and assembly of KDPF".
• Engine controller stops approximately 30 seconds after starting switch is turned to OFF
position. So when you restart engine, wait 1 minute minimum before turning starting
switch to ON position again.
• When this failure code appears, perform troubleshooting according to following work flow.
A. Identification of cause and repair
O
Machine B. Machine operation for clearing failure code
operation for
clearing a This failure code does not disappear by simply turning starting switch to ON position from
failure code OFF position after repair. You must perform machine operation for clearing failure code
after repair trouble.
a In machine operation for clearing failure code, "dummy temperature sensor: 799T-601-
4680" is used.
A. Identification of cause and repair
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
If failure code [CA1695] or [CA1696] is also displayed, perform
troubleshooting for [CA1695] or [CA1696] first.
Defective sensor power 1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
1 supply system 2. Disconnect connector E25 and connect T-adapter to female side.
3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
Voltage Between E25 (female) (4) and (1) 4.75 to 5.25 V
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
Defective wiring harness equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
2 information on troubleshooting", and check it and fix trouble as
connector
needed.
40-322 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-323
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-324 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-325
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
k Since KDPF and KDOC are heated to 500°C or above, take care not to get burn
injury.
• Signal voltage from KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47301 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47300 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47401 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47400 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47201 (V))
Related • Temperature sensed by KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
information function. (Code: 47200 (°C))
• KDOC inlet temperature, KDOC outlet temperature, and KDPF outlet temperature when
engine is at idle (KDPF regeneration is not executed) are approx. 100 to 250°C, and
difference between these temperatures is approx. 10°C. (KDOC inlet temperature >
KDOC outlet temperature > KDPF outlet temperature)
• Misfire of cylinder can induce following phenomena.
1. Combustion is impaired causing high exhaust temperature.
2. Cylinders other than disabled cylinder may increase their fuel injection in order to
compensate for torque drop, causing high exhaust temperature.
• As to procedure for accessing KDPF temperature sensor, see 50 Disassembly and
assembly, "Removal and installation of KDPF assembly" and "Disassembly and assembly
of KDPF".
• Engine controller stops approximately 30 seconds after starting switch is turned to OFF
position. So when you restart engine, wait 1 minute minimum before turning starting
switch to ON position again.
• When this failure code appears, perform troubleshooting according to following work flow.
A. Identification of cause and repair
Machine O
operation for B. Machine operation for clearing failure code
clearing
failure code a This failure code does not disappear by simply turning starting switch to ON position from
OFF position after repair. You must perform machine operation for clearing failure code
after repair trouble.
A. Identification of cause and repair
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective KDOC inlet If failure code [CA3313], [CA3314] or [CA3315] is also displayed,
1 temperature sensor perform troubleshooting for [CA3313], [CA3314] or [CA3315] first.
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
Defective wiring harness equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
2
connector information on troubleshooting", and check it and fix trouble as
needed.
40-326 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-327
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-328 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
k Since KDPF and KDOC are heated to 500°C or above, take care not to get burn
injury.
• Signal voltage from KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47301 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47300 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47401 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47400 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
Related function. (Code: 47201 (V))
information • Temperature sensed by KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47200 (°C))
• Misfire of cylinder can induce following phenomena.
1. Combustion is impaired causing high exhaust temperature.
2. Since cylinders other than disabled cylinder increase their fuel injection to compensate
for torque drop, exhaust temperature may rise and KDOC inlet temperature high error
may be generated.
• As to procedure for accessing KDPF temperature sensor, see 50 Disassembly and
assembly, "Removal and installation of KDPF assembly" and "Disassembly and assembly
of KDPF".
• Engine controller stops approximately 30 seconds after starting switch is turned to OFF
position. So when you restart engine, wait 1 minute minimum before turning starting
switch to ON position again.
• When this failure code appears, perform troubleshooting according to following work flow.
A. Identification of cause and repair
O
Machine B. Machine operation for clearing failure code
operation for
clearing a This failure code does not disappear by simply turning starting switch to ON position from
failure code OFF position after repair. You must perform machine operation for clearing failure code
after repair trouble.
a In machine operation for clearing failure code, "dummy temperature sensor: 799T-601-
4680" is used.
A. Identification of cause and repair
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective KDOC inlet Perform checks on causes 1 and 3 to 5 of troubleshooting for failure
1 temperature sensor code [CA3251] (causes related to sensor and wiring harness).
Defective KDOC outlet Perform checks on causes 1 and 3 to 5 of troubleshooting for failure
2 temperature sensor code [CA3254] (causes related to sensor and wiring harness).
PC210LC-10 40-329
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-330 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-331
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
k Since KDPF and KDOC are heated to 500°C or above, take care not to get burn
injury.
• Signal voltage from KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47301 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47300 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47401 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47400 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47201 (V))
Related • Temperature sensed by KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
information function. (Code: 47200 (°C))
• KDOC inlet temperature, KDOC outlet temperature, and KDPF outlet temperature when
engine is at idle (KDPF regeneration is not executed) are approx. 100 to 250°C, and
difference between these temperatures is approx. 10°C. (KDOC inlet temperature >
KDOC outlet temperature > KDPF outlet temperature)
• Misfire of cylinder can induce following phenomena.
1. Combustion is impaired causing high exhaust temperature.
2. Cylinders other than disabled cylinder may increase their fuel injection in order to
compensate for torque drop, causing high exhaust temperature.
• As to procedure for accessing KDPF temperature sensor, see 50 Disassembly and
assembly, "Removal and installation of KDPF assembly" and "Disassembly and assembly
of KDPF".
• Engine controller stops approximately 30 seconds after starting switch is turned to OFF
position. So when you restart engine, wait 1 minute minimum before turning starting
switch to ON position again.
• When this failure code appears, perform troubleshooting according to following work flow.
A. Identification of cause and repair
Machine O
operation for B. Machine operation for clearing failure code
clearing
failure code a This failure code does not disappear by simply turning starting switch to ON position from
OFF position after repair. You must perform machine operation for clearing failure code
after repair trouble.
A. Identification of cause and repair
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective KDOC outlet If failure code [CA3316], [CA3317], or [CA3318] appears, perform
1 temperature sensor troubleshooting for [CA3316], [CA3317] or [CA3318] first.
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
Defective wiring harness equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
2 information on troubleshooting", and check it and fix trouble as
connector
needed.
40-332 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-333
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-334 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
k Since KDPF and KDOC are heated to 500°C or above, take care not to get burn
injury.
• Temperature sensed by KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47300 (°C))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
Related function. (Code: 47400 (°C))
information • Temperature sensed by KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47200 (°C))
• As to procedure for accessing KDPF temperature sensor, see 50 Disassembly and
assembly, "Removal and installation of KDPF assembly" and "Disassembly and assembly
of KDPF".
• Engine controller stops approximately 30 seconds after starting switch is turned to OFF
position. So when you restart engine, wait 1 minute minimum before turning starting
switch to ON position again.
• When this failure code appears, perform troubleshooting according to following work flow.
A. Identification of cause and repair
O
Machine B. Machine operation for clearing failure code
operation for
clearing a This failure code does not disappear by simply turning starting switch to ON position from
failure code OFF position after repair. You must perform machine operation for clearing failure code
after repair trouble.
a In machine operation for clearing failure code, "dummy temperature sensor: 799T-601-
4680" is used.
A. Identification of cause and repair
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective KDPF outlet If failure code [CA3319], [CA3321] or [CA3322] is also displayed,
1 temperature sensor perform troubleshooting for [CA3319], [CA3321] or [CA3322] first.
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
Defective wiring harness equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
2
connector information on troubleshooting", and check it and fix trouble as
needed.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connectors CE03 and TEMP3 (KDPF outlet temperature
sensor), and connect T-adapter to female side of CE03.
3 Short circuit in wiring harness a Check by using multimeter in continuity mode.
Between CE03 (female) (54) and No continuity (no sound
Continuity is heard)
each pin other than pin (54)
PC210LC-10 40-335
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-336 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-337
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
k Since KDPF and KDOC are heated to 500°C or above, take care not to get burn
injury.
• Signal voltage from KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47301 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47300 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47401 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47400 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47201 (V))
Related • Temperature sensed by KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
information function. (Code: 47200 (°C))
• KDOC inlet temperature, KDOC outlet temperature, and KDPF outlet temperature when
engine is at idle (KDPF regeneration is not executed) are approx. 100 to 250°C, and
difference between these temperatures is approx. 10°C. (KDOC inlet temperature >
KDOC outlet temperature > KDPF outlet temperature)
• Misfire of cylinder can induce following phenomena.
1. Combustion is impaired causing high exhaust temperature.
2. Cylinders other than disabled cylinder may increase their fuel injection in order to
compensate for torque drop, causing high exhaust temperature.
• As to procedure for accessing KDPF temperature sensor, see 50 Disassembly and
assembly, "Removal and installation of KDPF assembly" and "Disassembly and assembly
of KDPF".
• Engine controller stops approximately 30 seconds after starting switch is turned to OFF
position. So when you restart engine, wait 1 minute minimum before turning starting
switch to ON position again.
• When this failure code appears, perform troubleshooting according to following work flow.
A. Identification of cause and repair
Machine O
operation for B. Machine operation for clearing failure code
clearing
failure code a This failure code does not disappear by simply turning starting switch to ON position from
OFF position after repair. You must perform machine operation for clearing failure code
after repair trouble.
A. Identification of cause and repair
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective KDPF outlet If failure code [CA3319], [CA3321] or [CA3322] is also displayed,
1 temperature sensor perform troubleshooting for [CA3319], [CA3321] or [CA3322] first.
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
Defective wiring harness equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
2
connector information on troubleshooting", and check it and fix trouble as
needed.
40-338 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-339
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-340 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
k Since KDPF and KDOC are heated to 500°C or above, take care not to get burn
injury.
• Signal voltage from KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47301 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47300 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47401 (V))
Related • Temperature sensed by KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
information function. (Code: 47400 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47201 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47200 (°C))
• As to procedure for accessing KDPF temperature sensor, see 50 Disassembly and
assembly, "Removal and installation of KDPF assembly" and "Disassembly and assembly
of KDPF".
• Engine controller stops approximately 30 seconds after starting switch is turned to the
OFF position. So when you restart engine, wait 1 minute minimum before turning starting
switch to the ON position again.
• When this failure code appears, perform troubleshooting according to following work flow.
A. Identification of cause and repair
Machine O
operation for C. Machine operation for confirming completion of repair
clearing
failure code a This failure code disappears when starting switch is turned from OFF position to ON
position after repair. However, following machine operation must be done to confirm
completion of repair.
A. Identification of cause and repair
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective KDOC outlet If failure code [CA3316], [CA3317], or [CA3318] appears, perform
1 temperature sensor troubleshooting for [CA3316], [CA3317] or [CA3318] first.
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
Defective wiring harness equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
2
connector information on troubleshooting", and check it and fix trouble as
needed.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connectors CE03 and TEMP2 (KDOC outlet temperature
sensor), and connect T-adapter to female side of CE03.
3 Short circuit in wiring harness
a Check by using multimeter in continuity mode.
Between CE03 (female) (48) and No continuity (no sound
Continuity
each pin other than pin (48) is heard)
PC210LC-10 40-341
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-342 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-343
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
k Since KDPF and KDOC are heated to 500°C or above, take care not to get burn
injury.
• Signal voltage from KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47301 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47300 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47401 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47400 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47201 (V))
Related • Temperature sensed by KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
information function. (Code: 47200 (°C))
• KDOC inlet temperature, KDOC outlet temperature, and KDPF outlet temperature when
engine is at idle (KDPF regeneration is not executed) are approx. 100 to 250°C, and
difference between these temperatures is approx. 10°C. (KDOC inlet temperature >
KDOC outlet temperature > KDPF outlet temperature)
• Misfire of cylinder can induce following phenomena.
1. Combustion is impaired causing high exhaust temperature.
2. Cylinders other than disabled cylinder may increase their fuel injection in order to
compensate for torque drop, causing high exhaust temperature.
• As to procedure for accessing KDPF temperature sensor, see 50 Disassembly and
assembly, "Removal and installation of KDPF assembly" and "Disassembly and assembly
of KDPF".
• Engine controller stops approximately 30 seconds after starting switch is turned to the
OFF position. So when you restart engine, wait 1 minute minimum before turning starting
switch to the ON position again.
• When this failure code appears, perform troubleshooting according to following work flow.
A. Identification of cause and repair
Machine O
operation for C. Machine operation for confirming completion of repair
clearing
failure code a This failure code disappears when starting switch is turned from OFF position to ON
position after repair. However, following machine operation must be done to confirm
completion of repair.
A. Identification of cause and repair
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective KDPF outlet If failure code [CA3319], [CA3321] or [CA3322] is also displayed,
1 temperature sensor perform troubleshooting for [CA3319], [CA3321] or [CA3322] first.
See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
Defective wiring harness equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General information
2
connector on troubleshooting", and check it and fix trouble as needed.
40-344 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-345
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-346 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA3313] KDOC Inlet Temp Sensor Low Error (PC200LC_10-CA3313-400-A-
Z0-A)
Action level Failure code KDOC Inlet Temperature Sensor Low Error
Failure
L03 CA3313 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • Low voltage appears in KDOC inlet temperature sensor circuit.
failure
• Uses KDOC outlet temperature for KDOC inlet temperature to run engine.
(If failure is detected in KDOC outlet temperature sensor, too, controller takes it that
Action of KDOC inlet temperature is at default value (250°C) and allows engine to run.)
controller • Closes EGR valve
• Limits engine output and allows engine to run.
• Stops KDPF regeneration control.
Problem on • Engine output decreases.
machine
k Since KDPF and KDOC are heated to 500°C or above, take care not to get burn
injury.
• Signal voltage from KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47301 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47300 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47401 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47400 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
Related
function. (Code: 47201 (V))
information
• Temperature sensed by KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47200 (°C))
• If sensor connector is disconnected or open circuit occurs, this failure code does not
appear but failure code [CA3314] for "High Error" appears.
• KDOC inlet temperature sensor connector label "TEMP1" expressed in black embossed
letters is seen on KDPF temperature sensor consolidating box (KDOC outlet temperature
sensor connector label "TEMP2" and KDPF outlet sensor connector label "TEMP3" are
shown similarly to "TEMP1").
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
<How to clear failure code>
To avoid error due to improper operation, start and run engine at idle for 1 minute. If this
failure code is cleared, repair is complete.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
Defective wiring harness information on troubleshooting", and check it.
1 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
connector
If this failure code disappears, wiring harness connector is defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform following checks.
PC210LC-10 40-347
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-348 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-349
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA3314] KDOC Inlet Temp Sens High Error (PC200LC_10-CA3314-400-A-Z0-
A)
Action level Failure code KDOC Inlet Temperature Sensor High Error
Failure
L03 CA3314 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • High voltage appears in KDOC inlet temperature sensor circuit.
failure
• Uses KDOC outlet temperature for KDOC inlet temperature to run engine.
(If failure is detected in KDOC outlet temperature sensor, too, controller takes it that
Action of KDOC inlet temperature is at default value (250°C) and allows engine to run.)
controller • Closes EGR valve
• Limits engine output and allows engine to run.
• Stops KDPF regeneration control.
Problem on • Engine output decreases.
machine
k Since KDPF and KDOC are heated to 500°C or above, take care not to get burn
injury.
• Signal voltage from KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47301 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47300 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47401 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47400 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47201 (V))
Related
• Temperature sensed by KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
information
function. (Code: 47200 (°C))
• This failure code appears if sensor connector is disconnected.
• If failure codes [CA3317] and [CA3319] are also displayed, connector in KDPF
temperature sensor consolidating box may be disconnected or probably has open circuit
(defective contact of connector) in ground line.
• KDOC inlet temperature sensor connector label "TEMP1" expressed in black embossed
letters is seen on KDPF temperature sensor consolidating box (KDOC outlet temperature
sensor connector label "TEMP2" and KDPF outlet sensor connector label "TEMP3" are
shown similarly to "TEMP1").
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
<How to clear failure code>
To avoid error due to improper operation, start and run engine at idle for 1 minute. If this
failure code is cleared, repair is complete.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
Defective wiring harness information on troubleshooting", and check it.
1 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
connector
If this failure code disappears, wiring harness connector is defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform following checks.
40-350 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-351
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-352 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA3315] KDOC Inlet Temp Sens In Range Error (PC200LC_10-CA3315-
400-A-Z0-A)
Action level Failure code KDOC Inlet Temperature Sensor In Range Error
Failure
L03 CA3315 (Engine controller system)
• Difference between temperature sensed by KDOC inlet temperature sensor and that by
Detail of KDOC outlet temperature sensor differs from expected value.
failure (Signal voltage is within input range.)
• Uses KDOC outlet temperature for KDOC inlet temperature to run engine.
(If failure is detected in KDOC outlet temperature sensor, too, controller takes it that
Action of KDOC inlet temperature is at default value (250°C) and allows engine to run.)
controller • Closes EGR valve
• Limits engine output and allows engine to run.
• Stops KDPF regeneration control.
Problem on • Engine output decreases.
machine
k Since KDPF and KDOC are heated to 500°C or above, take care not to get burn
injury.
• Signal voltage from KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47301 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47300 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47401 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47400 (°C))
Related • Signal voltage from KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
information function. (Code: 47201 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47200 (°C))
• KDOC inlet temperature sensor connector label "TEMP1" expressed in black embossed
letters is seen on KDPF temperature sensor consolidating box (KDOC outlet temperature
sensor connector label "TEMP2" and KDPF outlet sensor connector label "TEMP3" are
shown similarly to "TEMP1").
• As to procedure for accessing KDPF temperature sensor, see 50 Disassembly and
assembly, "Removal and installation of KDPF assembly" and "Disassembly and assembly
of KDPF".
• Engine controller stops approximately 30 seconds after starting switch is turned to the
OFF position. So when you restart engine, wait 1 minute minimum before turning starting
switch to the ON position again.
• When this failure code appears, perform troubleshooting according to following work flow.
A. Identification of cause and repair
O
Machine B. Machine operation for clearing failure code
operation for
clearing a This failure code does not disappear by simply turning starting switch to ON position from
failure code OFF position after repair. You must perform machine operation for clearing failure code
after repair trouble.
a In machine operation for clearing failure code, "dummy temperature sensor: 799T-601-
4680" is used.
A. Identification of cause and repair
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective KDOC inlet If failure code [CA3313] or [CA3314] is displayed, perform
1 temperature sensor troubleshooting for it first.
PC210LC-10 40-353
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-354 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-355
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-356 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA3316] KDOC Outlet Temp Sens Low Error (PC200LC_10-CA3316-400-A-
Z0-A)
Action level Failure code KDOC Outlet Temperature Sensor Low Error
Failure
L03 CA3316 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • Low voltage appears in KDOC outlet temperature sensor circuit.
failure
• Uses KDOC inlet temperature for KDOC outlet temperature to run engine.
(If failure is detected in KDOC inlet temperature sensor, too, controller takes it that KDOC
Action of outlet temperature is at default value (250°C) and allows engine to run.)
controller • Closes EGR valve
• Limits engine output and allows engine to run.
• Stops KDPF regeneration control.
Problem on • Engine output decreases.
machine
k Since KDPF and KDOC are heated to 500°C or above, take care not to get burn
injury.
• Signal voltage from KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47301 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47300 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47401 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47400 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
Related
function. (Code: 47201 (V))
information
• Temperature sensed by KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47200 (°C))
• If sensor connector is disconnected or open circuit occurs, this failure code does not
appear but failure code [CA3317] for "High Error" appears.
• KDOC inlet temperature sensor connector label "TEMP1" expressed in black embossed
letters is seen on KDPF temperature sensor consolidating box (KDOC outlet temperature
sensor connector label "TEMP2" and KDPF outlet sensor connector label "TEMP3" are
shown similarly to "TEMP1").
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
<How to clear failure code>
To avoid error due to improper operation, start and run engine at idle for 1 minute. If this
failure code is cleared, repair is complete.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
Defective wiring harness information on troubleshooting", and check it.
1 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
connector
If this failure code disappears, wiring harness connector is defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform following checks.
PC210LC-10 40-357
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-358 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-359
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA3317] KDOC Outlet Temp Sens High Error (PC200LC_10-CA3317-400-
A-Z0-A)
Action level Failure code KDOC Outlet Temperature Sensor High Error
Failure
L03 CA3317 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • High voltage appears in KDOC outlet temperature sensor circuit.
failure
• Uses KDOC inlet temperature for KDOC outlet temperature to run engine.
(If failure is detected in KDOC inlet temperature sensor, too, controller takes it that KDOC
Action of outlet temperature is at default value (250°C) and allows engine to run.)
controller • Closes EGR valve
• Limits engine output and allows engine to run.
• Stops KDPF regeneration control.
Problem on • Engine output decreases.
machine
k Since KDPF and KDOC are heated to 500°C or above, take care not to get burn
injury.
• Signal voltage from KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47301 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47300 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47401 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47400 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
Related function. (Code: 47201 (V))
information • Temperature sensed by KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47200 (°C))
• This failure code appears if sensor connector is disconnected.
• If failure codes [CA3314] and [CA3319] are also displayed, connector in KDPF
temperature sensor consolidating box may be disconnected or probably has open circuit
(defective contact of connector) in ground line.
• KDOC inlet temperature sensor connector label "TEMP1" expressed in black embossed
letters is seen on KDPF temperature sensor consolidating box (KDOC outlet temperature
sensor connector label "TEMP2" and KDPF outlet sensor connector label "TEMP3" are
shown similarly to "TEMP1").
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
<How to clear failure code>
To avoid error due to improper operation, start and run engine at idle for 1 minute. If this
failure code is cleared, repair is complete.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
Defective wiring harness information on troubleshooting", and check it.
1 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
connector
If this failure code disappears, wiring harness connector is defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform following checks.
40-360 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-361
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-362 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-363
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA3318] KDOC Outlet Temp Sens In Range Error (PC200LC_10-
CA3318-400-A-Z0-A)
Action level Failure code KDOC Outlet Temperature Sensor In Range Error.
Failure
L03 CA3318 (Engine controller system)
• Difference between temperature sensed by KDOC outlet temperature sensor and that by
Detail of KDOC inlet temperature sensor differs from expected value.
failure (Signal voltage is within input range.)
• Uses KDOC inlet temperature for KDOC outlet temperature to run engine.
(If failure is detected in KDOC inlet temperature sensor, too, controller takes it that KDOC
Action of outlet temperature is at default value (250°C) and allows engine to run.)
controller • Closes EGR valve
• Limits engine output and allows engine to run.
• Stops KDPF regeneration control.
Problem on • Engine output decreases.
machine
k Since KDPF and KDOC are heated to 500°C or above, take care not to get burn
injury.
• Signal voltage from KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47301 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47300 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47401 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47400 (°C))
Related • Signal voltage from KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
information function. (Code: 47201 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47200 (°C))
• KDOC inlet temperature sensor connector label "TEMP1" expressed in black embossed
letters is seen on KDPF temperature sensor consolidating box (KDOC outlet temperature
sensor connector label "TEMP2" and KDPF outlet sensor connector label "TEMP3" are
shown similarly to "TEMP1").
• As to procedure for accessing KDPF temperature sensor, see 50 Disassembly and
assembly, "Removal and installation of KDPF assembly" and "Disassembly and assembly
of KDPF".
• Engine controller stops approximately 30 seconds after starting switch is turned to OFF
position. So when you restart engine, wait 1 minute minimum before turning starting
switch to ON position again.
• When this failure code appears, perform troubleshooting according to following work flow.
A. Identification of cause and repair
O
Machine B. Machine operation for clearing failure code
operation for
clearing a This failure code does not disappear by simply turning starting switch to ON position from
failure code OFF position after repair. You must perform machine operation for clearing failure code
after repair trouble.
a In machine operation for clearing failure code, "dummy temperature sensor: 799T-601-
4680" is used.
A. Identification of cause and repair
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective KDOC outlet If failure code [CA3316] or [CA3317] is displayed, perform
1 temperature sensor troubleshooting for it first.
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
Defective wiring harness equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
2 information on troubleshooting", and check it and fix trouble as
connector
needed.
40-364 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-365
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-366 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-367
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA3319] KDPF Outlet Temp Sens High Error (PC200LC_10-CA3319-400-A-
Z0-A)
Action level Failure code KDPF Outlet Temperature Sensor High Error
Failure
L03 CA3319 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • High voltage appears in KDPF outlet temperature sensor circuit.
failure
• Uses KDOC outlet temperature for KDPF outlet temperature to run engine.
(If failure is detected in KDOC outlet temperature sensor, controller takes it that KDPF
Action of outlet temperature is at default value (250°C) and allows engine to run.)
controller • Closes EGR valve
• Limits engine output and allows engine to run.
• Stops KDPF regeneration control.
Problem on • Engine output decreases.
machine
k Since KDPF and KDOC are heated to 500°C or above, take care not to get burn
injury.
• Signal voltage from KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47301 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47300 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47401 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47400 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
Related function. (Code: 47201 (V))
information • Temperature sensed by KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47200 (°C))
• This failure code appears if sensor connector is disconnected.
• If failure codes [CA3314] and [CA3317] are also displayed, connector in KDPF
temperature sensor consolidating box may be disconnected or probably has open circuit
(defective contact of connector) in ground line.
• KDOC inlet temperature sensor connector label "TEMP1" expressed in black embossed
letters is seen on KDPF temperature sensor consolidating box (KDOC outlet temperature
sensor connector label "TEMP2" and KDPF outlet sensor connector label "TEMP3" are
shown similarly to "TEMP1").
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
<How to clear failure code>
To avoid error due to improper operation, start and run engine at idle for 1 minute. If this
failure code is cleared, repair is complete.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
Defective wiring harness information on troubleshooting", and check it.
1 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
connector
If this failure code disappears, wiring harness connector is defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform following checks.
40-368 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-369
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-370 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-371
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA3321] KDPF Outlet Temp Sens Low Error (PC200LC_10-CA3321-400-A-
Z0-A)
Action level Failure code KDPF Outlet Temperature Sensor Low Error
Failure
L03 CA3321 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • Low voltage appears in KDPF outlet temperature sensor circuit.
failure
• Uses KDOC outlet temperature for KDPF outlet temperature to run engine.
(If failure is detected in KDOC outlet temperature sensor, controller takes it that KDPF
Action of outlet temperature is at default value (250°C) and allows engine to run.)
controller • Closes EGR valve
• Limits engine output and allows engine to run.
• Stops KDPF regeneration control.
Problem on • Engine output decreases.
machine
k Since KDPF and KDOC are heated to 500°C or above, take care not to get burn
injury.
• Signal voltage from KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47301 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47300 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47401 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47400 (°C))
Related • Signal voltage from KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
information function. (Code: 47201 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47200 (°C))
• If sensor connector is disconnected or open circuit occurs, this failure code does not
appear but failure code [CA3319] for "High Error" appears.
• KDOC inlet temperature sensor connector label "TEMP1" expressed in black embossed
letters is seen on KDPF temperature sensor consolidating box (KDOC outlet temperature
sensor connector label "TEMP2" and KDPF outlet sensor connector label "TEMP3" are
shown similarly to "TEMP1").
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
<How to clear failure code>
To avoid error due to improper operation, start and run engine at idle for 1 minute. If this
failure code is cleared, repair is complete.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
Defective wiring harness information on troubleshooting", and check it.
1 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
connector
If this failure code disappears, wiring harness connector is defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform following checks.
40-372 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-373
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-374 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA3322] KDPF Outlet Temp Sens In Range Error (PC200LC_10-
CA3322-400-A-Z0-A)
Action level Failure code KDPF Outlet Temperature Sensor In Range Error
Failure
L03 CA3322 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • Temperature sensed by KDPF outlet temperature sensor differs from expected value.
failure (Signal voltage is within input range.)
• Uses KDOC outlet temperature for KDPF outlet temperature to run engine.
(If failure is detected in KDOC outlet temperature sensor, controller takes it that KDPF
Action of outlet temperature is at default value (250°C) and allows engine to run.)
controller • Closes EGR valve
• Limits engine output and allows engine to run.
• Stops KDPF regeneration control.
Problem on • Engine output decreases.
machine
k Since KDPF and KDOC are heated to 500°C or above, take care not to get burn
injury.
• Signal voltage from KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47301 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC inlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47300 (°C))
• Signal voltage from KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47401 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDOC outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47400 (°C))
Related • Signal voltage from KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
information function. (Code: 47201 (V))
• Temperature sensed by KDPF outlet temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 47200 (°C))
• KDOC inlet temperature sensor connector label "TEMP1" expressed in black embossed
letters is seen on KDPF temperature sensor consolidating box (KDOC outlet temperature
sensor connector label "TEMP2" and KDPF outlet sensor connector label "TEMP3" are
shown similarly to "TEMP1").
• As to procedure for accessing KDPF temperature sensor, see 50 Disassembly and
assembly, "Removal and installation of KDPF assembly" and "Disassembly and assembly
of KDPF".
• Engine controller stops approximately 30 seconds after starting switch is turned to the
OFF position. So when you restart engine, wait 1 minute minimum before turning starting
switch to the ON position again.
• When this failure code appears, perform troubleshooting according to following work flow.
A. Identification of cause and repair
O
Machine B. Machine operation for clearing failure code
operation for
clearing a This failure code does not disappear by simply turning starting switch to ON position from
failure code OFF position after repair. You must perform machine operation for clearing failure code
after repair trouble.
a In machine operation for clearing failure code, "dummy temperature sensor: 799T-601-
4680" is used.
A. Identification of cause and repair
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective KDPF outlet If failure code [CA3313] or [CA3314] is displayed, perform
1 temperature sensor troubleshooting for it first.
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
Defective wiring harness
2 equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
connector
information on troubleshooting", and check it.
PC210LC-10 40-375
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-376 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-377
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-378 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA3419] Mass Air Flow Sensor Sup Volt High Error (PC200LC_10-
CA3419-400-A-Z0-A)
Action level Failure code Mass Air Flow Sensor Supply Voltage High Error
Failure
L03 CA3419 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • High voltage appears in power supply (12 V) circuit of mass air flow sensor.
failure
a If signal voltage of mass air flow sensor becomes abnormal, controller takes following
measures that are similar to those for failure codes [CA356] and [CA357].
Action of • Takes it that mass air flow is at fixed value (10 kg/min) and allows engine to run.
controller • Closes EGR valve.
• Limits engine output and allows engine to run.
• Stops KDPF regeneration control.
Problem on • Engine output decreases.
machine
Related • Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
information
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
information on troubleshooting", and check it.
1 Defective harness connector 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
If this failure code disappears, harness connector is defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform following checks.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector P55.
Defective mass air flow 3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
2 sensor If this failure code does not appear, MAF sensor is defective.
(internal defect)
a Other failure codes (many codes) are also displayed. They are
generated because of disconnection of connector. Ignore failure
codes other than this code.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector ECM J1.
3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
3 Defective wiring harness If this failure code does not appear, wiring harness is defective.
a Other failure codes (many codes) are also displayed. They are
generated because of disconnection of connector. Ignore failure
codes other than this code.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector ECM J1 and connect T-adapters to male side.
3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
4 Defective engine controller Approx. 12
Voltage Between ECM J1 (male) (21) and (22)
V
If no failure is found by above checks, engine controller is defective.
(Since this is an internal defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
PC210LC-10 40-379
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-380 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [CA3421] Mass Air Flow Sensor Sup Volt Low Error (PC200LC_10-
CA3421-400-A-Z0-A)
Action level Failure code Mass Air Flow Sensor Supply Voltage Low Error
Failure
L03 CA3421 (Engine controller system)
Detail of • Low voltage appears in power supply (12V) circuit of mass air flow sensor.
failure
a If signal voltage of mass air flow sensor becomes abnormal, controller takes following
measures that are similar to those for failure codes [CA356] and [CA357].
Action of • Takes it that mass air flow is at fixed value (10 kg/min) and allows engine to run.
controller • Closes EGR valve.
• Limits engine output and allows engine to run.
• Stops KDPF regeneration control.
Problem on • Engine output decreases.
machine
Related • Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
information
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. See descriptions of wiring harness and connectors in "c: Electrical
equipment" in "Checks before troubleshooting" of "General
information on troubleshooting", and check it.
1 Defective harness connector 2. Turn starting switch to ON position.
If this failure code disappears, harness connector is defective.
a If this failure code appears, perform following checks.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector P55.
Defective mass air flow 3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
2 sensor If this failure code does not appear, MAF sensor is defective.
(internal defect)
a Other failure codes (many codes) are also displayed. They are
generated because of disconnection of connector. Ignore failure
codes other than this code.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector ECM J1.
3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
Defective wiring harness or
3 If this failure code does not appear, wiring harness is defective.
connector
a Other failure codes (many codes) are also displayed. They are
generated because of disconnection of connector. Ignore failure
codes other than this code.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Ground fault in wiring harness 2. Disconnect connectors ECM J1 and P55, and connect T-adapters to
4 either female side.
(contact with ground circuit)
Resis- Between ground and ECM J1 (female) (21) or
P55 (female) (2) Min. 1 Mz
tance
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connectors ECM J1 and P55, and connect T-adapters to
5 Short circuit in wiring harness either female side.
Resis- Between ECM J1 (female) (21) and (22) or
between P55 (female) (2) and (3) Min. 1 Mz
tance
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector ECM J1 and connect T-adapters to male side.
3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
6 Defective engine controller Approx. 12
Voltage Between ECM J1 (male) (21) and (22)
V
If no failure is found by above checks, engine controller is defective.
(Since this is an internal defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
PC210LC-10 40-381
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-382 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Action
Failure code Common rail pressure limiter valve is open.
level Failure
(Engine controller system)
L03 CA3741
Failure • Engine controller determines that common rail pressure limiter valve opens.
Action of • Lowers set value of common rail pressure.
controller
Problem on • Engine output lowers. Engine may not start again.
machine
• Signal voltage from common rail pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring
function.
(Code: 36401 (V))
Related • Pressure sensed by common rail pressure sensor can be checked with monitoring
information function.
(Code: 36400 (MPa))
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Common rail pressure limiter
1 Perform troubleshooting for failure code [CA449].
valve is open.
PC210LC-10 40-383
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-384 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-385
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-386 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-387
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-388 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-389
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Figure of structure
40-390 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-391
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-392 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-393
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-394 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-395
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-396 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-397
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-398 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-399
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-400 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-401
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-402 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-403
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-404 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-405
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-406 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-407
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-408 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-409
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-410 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-411
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-412 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-413
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-414 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-415
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-416 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-417
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-418 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-419
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-420 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-421
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-422 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-423
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-424 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-425
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-426 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-427
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-428 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-429
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-430 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-431
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position and disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Disconnect connectors CM02, CP01, ECM J1, ECM J2, and Terminal port, and
connect T-adapters to any female side.
Between ground and any of CP01
(female) (7), CM02 (female) (10), (11) or Min. 1 Mz
Ground fault in ECM J1 (female) (8)
wiring harness Between ground and ECM J2 (female)
6 (contact with GND Min. 1 Mz
(24) or Terminal port (female) (A)
circuit) Resistance Between ground and any of CP01
(female) (26), CM02 (female) (12) or Min. 1 Mz
ECM J1 (female) (18)
Between ground and any of ECM J2
(female) (25) or Terminal port (female) Min. 1 Mz
(B)
a If no failure is found by check on cause 3 (no open circuit), measure at only one
place each.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position and disconnect battery ground cable.
2. Disconnect either connector CM02, CP01 or Terminal port, and connect T-
adapters to female side.
3. Connect battery ground cable.
Short circuit or hot 4. Turn starting switch to ON position.
short circuit in
7 wiring harness a Measurement is not conducted on ECM J1 and ECM J2.
(contact with 24 V a Since voltages of CAN_H and CAN_L lines normally 2.5±1 V including during
circuit) communication, regard lines as normal if their voltages are between 1 and 4 V.
Between ground and any of CP01
(female) (7), CM02 (female) (10), (11) or 1 to 4 V
Terminal port (female) (A)
Voltage
Between ground and any of CP01
(female) (26), CM02 (female) (12) or 1 to 4 V
Terminal port (female) (B)
40-432 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-433
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-434 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Action level Failure code Short circuit in hydraulic oil temperature sensor system
Failure
L01 DGH2KB (Pump controller system)
Detail of • Signal voltage of hydraulic oil temperature sensor circuit is below 1 V, so pump controller
failure determines that circuit shorts.
Action of • If cause of failure disappears, machine becomes normal by itself.
controller
Problem on • While hydraulic oil temperature rises to normal range, indicator of hydraulic oil
machine temperature gauge does not move from top of white range (bottom of green range).
• Signal voltage from hydraulic oil temperature sensor can be checked with monitoring
Related function.
information (Code: 04402: Hydr. Temp. Sensor Volt)
• Method of reproducing failure code: Start engine.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector P22 and connect T-adapters to male side.
Approx. 90
10 °C
Defective hydraulic oil kz
Between P22 (male) (1) and (2) Approx. 35
temperature sensor 30 °C
1 kz
tor (internal open or short Resis- a Temperature-Resistance Approx.
circuit) tance characteristics of oil 80 °C
temperature sensor 6.5 kz
Approx.
100 °C
3.5 kz
Between P22 (male) (2) and ground Min. 1 Mz
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector P22 and connect T-adapters to female side.
3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
Open circuit, short circuit, a If voltage is 0 V, wiring harness has open circuit or ground fault or
ground fault or hot short short circuit, and if voltage is 24 V, wiring harness has hot short
2
circuit in wiring harness circuit.
a Voltage of approximately 5 V is applied to temperature sensor signal
circuit through resistor in pump controller.
Voltage Between P22 (female) (1) and (2) Approx. 5
V
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector CP01 and connect T-adapters to female side.
a Use Temperature-Resistance characteristics table for
troubleshooting on cause 1 as resistance criteria.
Short circuit or ground fault in
3 wiring harness a If resistance is above 1 Mz , wiring harness has open circuit. If
resistance is below 1 z , wiring harness has short circuit.
3.5 to 90
Resis- Between CP01 (female) (28) and (46) kz
tance Between CP01 (female) (28) and ground Min. 1 Mz
a If no failure is found by check on cause 2, this check is not required.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Ground fault in wiring harness
4 2. Disconnect connectors CP01 and P22, and connect T-adapters to
(contact with ground circuit) either female side.
Resis- Between ground and CP01 (female) (28) or
P22 (female) (2) Min. 1 Mz
tance
If no failure is found by above checks, pump controller is defective.
5 Defective pump controller
(Since this is an internal defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
PC210LC-10 40-435
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-436 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [DHA4KA] Air Cleaner Clog Sensor Open Circuit (PC220_10-DHA4KA-
400-A-00-A)
Action Open circuit in air cleaner clogging sensor
Failure code
level Failure
(Machine monitor system)
L01 DHA4KA
Details of • Air cleaner clogging switch signal voltage is not below 1 V while engine is stopped, so
failure machine monitor determines that air cleaner is clogged (switch contact is open).
Action of • Displays system abnormality monitor yellow on machine monitor.
controller
Problem on • If machine is operated as it is, engine may be broken.
machine
• Input state (ON/OFF) from air cleaner clogging switch can be checked with monitoring
Related function.
information (Code: 04501 Monitor input: 2)
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective air 1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
cleaner clogging 2. Disconnect connector P23 and connect T-adapters to male side.
switch 3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
1
(internal open
circuit in wiring Between P23 When air cleaner is
Resistance (male) (1) and (2) Max. 1 z
harness) normal *1
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Open circuit in
2. Disconnect connectors CM02 and P23, and connect T-adapters to each female
wiring harness
side.
2 (wire breakage or
Between CM02 (female) (4) and P23
defective contact of Max. 1 z
Resistance (female) (1)
connectors)
Between P23 (female) (2) and ground Max. 1 z
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Insert T-adapters into connectors CM01 and CM02.
Defective machine 3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
3
monitor
Between CM02 (4) When air cleaner is
Voltage Max. 1 V
and CM01 (3) normal
• Air cleaner suction resistance
*1: Max. -3,430 Pa {-350 mmH2O}
PC210LC-10 40-437
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-438 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-439
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-440 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-441
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-442 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-443
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-444 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-445
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [DHS4MA] Bucket Curl PPC Press Sensor Abnormality (PC200-
DHS4MA-400-A-00-A)
Action Bucket CURL PPC pressure sensor malfunction
Failure code
level Failure
(Pump controller system)
L01 DHS4MA
Details of • Signal voltage of bucket CURL PPC pressure sensor circuit is below 0.3 V or above 4.5
failure V.
Action of • Controls machine taking it that bucket CURL PPC pressure is 0 MPa {0 kg/cm 2}.
controller • If cause of failure disappears, machine becomes normal by itself.
Problem on • Automatic deceleration cannot be canceled.
machine • Bucket CURL performance lowers.
a If 5 V circuit (3) and ground circuit (1) of pressure sensor are connected to reverse
polarities, pressure sensor is damaged. Accordingly, take extreme care when checking.
Related • As T-adapter for pump controller connector is "socket-type box", operating voltage cannot
information be measured at pump controller connector.
• Bucket CURL PPC pressure can be checked with monitoring function.
(Code: 07300 Bucket CURL PPC pressure)
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position or start engine.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective 5 V If failure code [DA25KP] is also displayed, perform troubleshooting for it first.
1 sensor power
supply 1 line
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector P01 and connect T-adapters to female side.
Defective 5 V 3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
2 sensor power
supply 1 line a If power supply voltage is abnormal, proceed to check on cause 4.
Between P01
Voltage Power supply 4.5 to 5.5 V
(female) (3) and (1)
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Insert T-adapter into connector P01.
3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
Between P01 (2)
Voltage Sensor output 0.5 to 4.5 V
and (1)
a If power supply voltage is normal and sensor output voltage is abnormal, it is
Defective bucket difficult to judge whether cause is defective sensor, ground fault or hot short
CURL PPC circuit of harness. Check as followings.
3 pressure sensor
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
(internal defect) 2. Replace connector P01 with connector of other PPC pressure sensor.
3. Turn starting switch to ON position and display "Abnormality Record" screen of
electrical system on machine monitor.
4. If E mark is not displayed for this failure code, bucket CURL PPC pressure
sensor is defective.
a After finishing test, restore connector.
40-446 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-447
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-448 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-449
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-450 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-451
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-452 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-453
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-454 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-455
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-456 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-457
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-458 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-459
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-460 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-461
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-462 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Circuit diagram related to arm DUMP (arm OUT) PPC pressure sensor
PC210LC-10 40-463
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
a If 5 V circuit (3) and ground circuit (1) of pressure sensor are connected inversely,
pressure sensor will be broken. Accordingly, take extreme care when checking.
Related • As T-adapter for pump controller connector is "socket-type box", operating voltage cannot
information be measured at pump controller connector.
• Bucket DUMP PPC pressure can be checked with monitoring function.
(Code: 07301 Bucket DUMP PPC pressure)
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position or start engine.
40-464 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-465
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-466 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-467
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-468 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-469
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-470 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-471
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-472 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-473
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-474 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-475
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-476 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-477
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-478 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Detail of • Signal voltage of F pump swash plate sensor circuit is below 0.4 V or above 4.6 V.
failure
PC210LC-10 40-479
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-480 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-481
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-482 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-483
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-484 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-485
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-486 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-487
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-488 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Action level Failure code Open circuit in travel speed selector solenoid circuit
Failure
L01 DW43KA (Pump controller system)
Detail of • No current flows when pump controller drives travel speed selector solenoid, so pump
failure controller determines that open circuit exists in travel speed selector solenoid circuit.
Action of • None in particular (Since no current flows, solenoid is not energized.)
controller • If cause of failure disappears, machine becomes normal by itself.
Problem on • "Hi" travel speed is slow. (Although "Hi" is displayed on machine monitor, actual travel
machine speed is still "Lo".)
• Controller's command (ON/OFF) to travel speed selector solenoid can be checked with
monitoring function. (As long as controller's command to solenoid is "ON", sensor status
displayed on monitoring screen is "ON" even if solenoid is not energized due to short
Related
circuit.)
information
(Code: 02300 Solenoid 1)
• Method of reproducing failure code: Start engine, set travel speed to High and operate
travel lever.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Defective travel speed 2. Disconnect connector V04, and connect T-adapters to male side.
1
selector solenoid
Resistance Between V04 (male) (1) and (2) 20 to 60 z
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector CP02 and connect T-adapters to female side.
Between CP02 (female) (93) and each of
Resistance (115), (117), and (120) 20 to 60 z
Open circuit in wiring
a If no failure is found by above checks , this check is not required.
harness
2 1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
(wire breakage or defective
2. Disconnect connectors CP02 and V04, and connect T-adapters to
contact of connector)
each female side.
Between CP02 (female) (93) and V04
(female) (1) Max. 1 z
Resistance
Between each of CP02 (female) (115),
(117), and (120), and V04 (female) (2) Max. 1 z
If no failure is found by above checks, pump controller is defective.
3 Defective pump controller
(Since this is an internal defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
PC210LC-10 40-489
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-490 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-491
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-492 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [DW45KA] Swing holding brake Sol Open Circuit (PC200LC_10-
DW45KA-400-A-Z0-A)
Action
Failure code Swing Holding Brake Solenoid Open Circuit
level Failure
(Pump controller system)
L03 DW45KA
• Controller output voltage to solenoid is above standard value when pump controller does
Detail of not drive swing holding brake solenoid, so pump controller determines that open circuit
failure exists in swing holding brake solenoid circuit.
• None in particular. (Since no current flows, solenoid is not energized, so swing holding
Action of brake is kept applied.)
controller • If cause of failure disappears, machine becomes normal by itself.
Problem on • Upper structure does not swing (swing holding brake is not released).
machine
• If solenoid and wiring harness are normal, swing operation is possible by setting swing
brake cancel switch to RELEASE position. (However, swing brake is not released when
starting switch is in OFF position. Swing holding brake remains applied.)
• Keep swing brake cancel switch in RELEASE position during troubleshooting. When
starting switch is turned to ON position in this condition, normally current flows through
swing holding brake solenoid circuit to release swing holding brake.
Related • Controller's command (ON/OFF) to swing holding brake solenoid can be checked with
information monitoring function. (As long as controller's command to solenoid is "ON", sensor status
displayed on monitoring screen is "ON" even if solenoid is not energized due to open
circuit.)
(Code: 02300 Solenoid 1)
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
• Power for swing holding brake solenoid is supplied from pin (101) of pump controller
connector CP02 or fuse No.1 in fuse box F01.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Blown fuse No. 1 (right top
1 If fuse is blown, see failure code [DW45KB].
fuse) in fuse box F01
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Defective swing holding 2. Disconnect connector V03, and connect T-adapters to male side.
2
brake solenoid
Resistance Between V03 (male) (1) and (2) 20 to 60 z
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Remove diode arrays D01 and D03, and connect T-adapters to each
male side.
Defective diode array D01 or a Check by using multimeter in diode range.
3
D03 Between D01 (male) (3) (+) and (7) (-) No continuity
Between D01 (male) (7) (+) and (3) (-) Continuity
Continuity
Between D03 (male) (5) (+) and (1) (-) No continuity
Between D03 (male) (1) (+) and (5) (-) Continuity
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Remove diode D01.
3. Disconnect connector CP02, and connect T-adapter to each female
Open circuit in wiring side.
harness
4 a Swing lock switch OFF position.
(wire breakage or defective
contact of connector) Between CP02 (female) (101) and D01
(female) (7) Max. 1 z
Resistance
Between D01 (female) (3) and CP02
(female) (115) 20 to 60 z
PC210LC-10 40-493
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-494 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-495
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [DW45KB] Swing holding brake Sol Short Circuit (PC200LC_10-
DW45KB-400-A-Z0-A)
Action
Failure code Swing Holding Brake Solenoid Short Circuit
level Failure
(Pump controller system)
L03 DW45KB
Detail of • Abnormal current flows when pump controller drives swing holding brake solenoid, so
failure pump controller determines that short circuit exists in swing holding brake solenoid circuit.
• Stops driving swing holding brake solenoid.
Action of • Even if cause of failure disappears, machine does not become normal until starting switch
controller is turned to OFF position.
Problem on • Upper structure does not swing (swing holding brake is not released).
machine
• If solenoid and wiring harness are normal, swing operation is possible by setting swing
brake cancel switch to RELEASE position. (However, swing brake is not released when
starting switch is in OFF position. Swing holding brake remains applied.)
• Keep swing lock switch in OFF position and swing brake cancel switch in RELEASE
position during troubleshooting. When starting switch is turned to ON position in this
condition, normally current flows through swing holding brake solenoid circuit to release
swing holding brake.
Related
• Controller's command (ON/OFF) to swing holding brake solenoid can be checked with
information
monitoring function. (As long as controller's command to solenoid is "ON", sensor status
displayed on monitoring screen is "ON" even if solenoid is not energized due to short
circuit.)
(Code: 02300 Solenoid 1)
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
• Power for swing holding brake solenoid circuit is supplied from pin (101) of pump
controller connector CP02 or fuse No.1 in fuse box F01.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Blown fuse No. 1 (right top Even if fuse is blown, perform troubleshooting according to following
1 fuse) in fuse box F01 steps to identify cause.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Defective swing holding 2. Disconnect connector V03, and connect T-adapters to male side.
2
brake solenoid Resis- Between V03 (male) (1) and (2) 20 to 60 z
tance Between V03 (male) (1) and ground Min. 1 Mz
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Remove diode arrays D01 and D03, and connect T-adapters to each
male side.
a Check by using multimeter in diode range.
Defective diode array D01 or No
3 Between D01 (male) (3) (+) and (7) (-)
D03 continuity
Between D01 (male) (7) (+) and (3) (-) Continuity
Continuity
No
Between D03 (male) (1) (+) and (5) (-)
continuity
Between D03 (male) (5) (+) and (1) (-) Continuity
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Remove fuse No.1 (right top, 5A) in fuse box F01 and diode D01.
Ground fault in wiring harness 3. Disconnect connectors CP02, D01, and V03.
4 4. Connect T-adapters to female side of connectors CP02 and D01.
(contact with ground circuit)
Resis- Between CP02 (female) (101) and ground Min. 1 Mz
tance Between D01 (female) (3) and ground Min. 1 Mz
40-496 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-497
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-498 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-499
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-500 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-501
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-502 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-503
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-504 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-505
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-506 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
a If cause 2 is not the cause for the trouble, this check is not required.
Breaking of 1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
harness 2. Disconnect connectors CP02 and V02, and connect T-adapters to each female
3 (Wire breakage or side.
defective contact of Between CP02 (female) (109) and V02
(female) (1) Max. 1 z
connectors) Resistance
Between V02 (female) (2) and each of
CP02 (female) (115), (117) and (120) Max. 1 z
Defective pump If no failure is found by above checks, pump controller is defective. (Since this is
4 an internal defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
controller
PC210LC-10 40-507
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-508 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Action
Failure code Short circuit in 2-stage relief solenoid
level Failure
(Pump controller system)
L01 DWK0KB
Detail of • Abnormal current flows when pump controller drives 2-stage relief solenoid, so pump
failure controller determines that short circuit exists in 2-stage relief solenoid circuit.
• Stops driving 2-stage relief solenoid.
Action of • Even if cause of failure disappears, machine does not become normal until starting switch
controller is set to OFF position.
Problem on • Travel power is low (main relief valve is not set to high-pressure setting).
machine • One-touch power maximizing function does not work.
• Controller's command (ON/OFF) to 2-stage relief solenoid can be checked with
monitoring function. (As long as controller's command to solenoid is "ON", sensor status
displayed on monitoring screen is "ON" even if solenoid is not energized due to short
circuit.)
Related (Code: 02300 Solenoid 1)
information • As T-adapter for pump controller connector is "socket-type box", operating voltage cannot
be measured at pump controller connector.
• Controller detects open circuit only when Open circuit in 2-stage relief solenoid.
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective 2-stage relief 1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
solenoid 2. Disconnect connector V08, and connect T-adapters to male side.
1
(internal short circuit or Resis- Between V08 (male) (1) and (2) 20 to 60 z
ground fault) tance Between V08 (female) (1) and ground Min. 1 Mz
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Ground fault in wiring harness 2. Disconnect connectors CP02 and V08, and connect T-adapters to
2 female side of V08.
(contact with ground circuit)
Resis- Between ground and CP02 (female) (109) or
V08 (female) (1) Min. 1 Mz
tance
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connectors CP02 and V08, and connect T-adapters to
3 Short circuit in wiring harness female side of V08.
Resis- Between V08 (female) (1) and (2)
Min. 1 Mz
tance
If no failure is found by above checks, pump controller is defective.
4 Defective pump controller
(Since this is an internal defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
PC210LC-10 40-509
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-510 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [DWK2KA] Variable Back Press Sol Open Circuit (PC220_10-DWK2KA-
400-A-00-A)
Action Open circuit in variable back-pressure solenoid circuit
Failure code
level Failure
(Pump controller system)
L01 DWK2KA
Details of • Controller output voltage to variable back-pressure solenoid exceeds standard value
failure when it stops outputting drive current to variable back-pressure solenoid.
Action of • None in particular (Since no current flows, solenoid is not energized.)
controller • If cause of failure disappears, machine becomes normal by itself.
Problem on • Set pressure of back-pressure valve cannot be changed
machine
• Controller's command (ON/OFF) to variable back-pressure solenoid can be checked with
monitoring function. (If controller sends solenoid ON command, monitoring display is ON
Related even if solenoid is not switched to ON due to open circuit.)
information (Code: 02301 Solenoid 2)
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective variable 1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
back pressure 2. Disconnect connector V25 and connect T-adapters to male side.
1 solenoid
(internal open Resistance Between V25 (male) (1) and (2) 20 to 60 z
circuit)
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Open circuit or
2. Disconnect connector CP02 and connect T-adapters to female side.
2 ground fault in
wiring harness Between CP02 (female) (113) and each
Resistance of CP02 (female) (115), (117) and (120) 20 to 60 z
PC210LC-10 40-511
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-512 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [DWK2KB] Variable Back Press Sol Short Circuit (PC220_10-DWK2KB-
400-A-00-A)
Action Short circuit in variable back pressure solenoid valve
Failure code
level Failure
(Pump controller system)
L01 DWK2KB
Details of • When outputting current to variable back pressure solenoid, abnormal current flows in
failure circuit and short circuit is detected.
• Stops output to variable back pressure solenoid.
Action of • Even if cause of failure disappears, machine does not become normal until starting switch
controller is turned to OFF position.
Problem on • Set pressure of back pressure valve cannot be changed.
machine
• Controller's command (ON/OFF) to variable back pressure solenoid can be checked by
using monitoring function. (If controller sends solenoid ON command, monitoring display
Related is ON even if solenoid is not switched ON due to short circuit.)
information (Code: 02301 Solenoid 2)
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective variable 1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
back pressure 2. Disconnect connector V25, and connect T-adapter to male side.
solenoid
1 Between V25 (male) (1) and (2) 20 to 60 z
(internal short
circuit or ground Resistance
Between V25 (male) (1) and ground Min. 1 Mz
fault)
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector CP02 and connect T-adapter to female side.
Short circuit or
Between CP02 (female) (113) and each
2 ground fault in 20 to 60 z
of CP02 (female) (115), (117) and (120)
harness Resistance
Between CP02 (female) (113) and
ground Min. 1 Mz
PC210LC-10 40-513
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-514 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [DWK8KA] Swing Press C/O Sol Open Circuit (PC220_10-DWK8KA-400-A-
00-A)
Action Open circuit of swing cut-off solenoid system
Failure code
level Failure
(Pump controller system)
L01 DWK8KA
Details of • When the output to swing cut-off solenoid is OFF, open circuit is detected due to
failure excessive output voltage of controller solenoid above standard value.
Action of • None in particular (Since no current flows, solenoid does not operate.)
controller • If cause of failure disappears, machine becomes normal by itself.
Problem on • Swing motor relief pressure remains Lo.
machine
• Command (ON/OFF) to swing cut-off solenoid by controller can be checked with
monitoring function. (Even if solenoid is not ON due to open circuit, if controller command
Related is ON, monitoring display is ON.)
information (Code: 02301 solenoid 2)
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective swing 1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
cut-off solenoid 2. Disconnect connector V06, and connect T-adapter to male side.
1
(internal open
circuit) Resistance Between V06 (male) (1) and (2) 20 to 60 z
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Open circuit or
2. Disconnect connector CP02 and connect T-adapter to female side.
2 ground fault of
wiring harness Between CP02 (female) (94) and each
Resistance of CP02 (female) (115), (117) and (120) 20 to 60 z
PC210LC-10 40-515
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-516 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Failure code [DWK8KB] Swing Press C/O Sol Short Circuit (PC220_10-DWK8KB-400-A-
00-A)
Action Short circuit of swing cut-off solenoid system
Failure code
level Failure
(Pump controller system)
L01 DWK8KB
Details of • When output to swing cut-off solenoid is ON, short circuit is detected due to abnormal
failure current in circuit.
• Output to swing cut-off solenoid is turned to OFF position.
Action of • Even if cause of failure disappears, machine does not become normal until starting switch
controller is turned to OFF position.
Problem on • Swing motor relief pressure remains Lo.
machine
• Command (ON/OFF) to swing cut-off solenoid by controller can be checked with
monitoring function.
Related (Code: 02301 solenoid 2)
information • Method of reproducing failure code: Engine start + Hoist swing only operation (Do not
operate arm.)
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective swing 1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
cut-off solenoid 2. Disconnect connector V06, and connect T-adapter to male side.
1 (internal short Between V06 (male) (1) and (2) 20 to 60z
circuit or ground Resistance
fault) Between V06 (male) (1) and ground Min. 1 Mz
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector CP02 and connect T-adapter to female side.
Short circuit or
Between CP02 (female) (94) and each
2 ground fault in 20 to 60 z
of CP02 (female) (115), (117) and (120)
harness Resistance
Between CP02 (female) (113) and
ground Min. 1 Mz
PC210LC-10 40-517
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-518 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-519
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-520 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Action
Failure code PC-EPC (Front) Solenoid Short Circuit
level Failure
(Pump controller system)
L03 DXA8KB
Detail of • Abnormal current flows when pump controller drives F-PC-EPC solenoid, so pump
failure controller determines that short circuit exists in F-PC-EPC solenoid circuit.
• Stops driving F-PC-EPC solenoid.
Action of • Even if cause of failure disappears, machine does not become normal until starting switch
controller is turned to OFF position.
Problem on • If pump load increases, engine speed decreases largely and engine may stall.
machine
• When solenoid and wiring harness are normal, engine can be prevented from stalling by
setting emergency pump drive switch to ON position.
Related • Drive current to F-PC-EPC solenoid can be checked with monitoring function.
information (Code: 01300 PC-EPC solenoid current (F))
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Short circuit or ground fault in a Check that emergency pump drive switch is at normal position (lower
3 wiring harness side).
Between CP02 (female) (96) and each of (115),
Resis- (117), (120) 3 to 14 z
tance
Between CP02 (female) (96) and ground Min. 1 Mz
a If no failure is found by check on cause 3, this check is not required.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connectors CP02, S25 and V11, and connect T-adapters
Ground fault in wiring harness to any female side.
4
(contact with ground circuit) Between ground and CP02 (female) (96) or
Min. 1 Mz
Resis- S25 (female) (3)
tance Between ground and S25 (female) (5) or V11
(female) (2) Min. 1 Mz
If no failure is found by above checks, pump controller is defective.
5 Defective pump controller
(Since this is an internal defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
PC210LC-10 40-521
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-522 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Action
Failure code PC-EPC (Rear) Solenoid Open circuit
level Failure
(Pump controller system)
L03 DXA9KA
Detail of • No current flows when pump controller drives R-PC-EPC solenoid, so pump controller
failure determines that open circuit exists in R-PC-EPC solenoid circuit.
Action of • None in particular (Since no current flows, solenoid is not energized.)
controller • If cause of failure disappears, machine becomes normal by itself.
Problem on • If pump load increases, engine speed decreases largely and engine may stall.
machine
• When solenoid and wiring harness are normal, engine can be prevented from stalling by
setting emergency pump drive switch to ON position.
Related • Drive current to R-PC-EPC solenoid can be checked with monitoring function.
information (Code: 01302 PC-EPC solenoid current (R))
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Incorrect operation of
1 Set emergency pump drive switch at its normal position (lower side).
emergency pump drive switch
Defective R-PC-EPC 1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
solenoid 2. Disconnect connector V12, and connect T-adapters to male side.
2
(internal open circuit) Resis- Between V12 (male) (1) and (2)
3 to 14 z
tance
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector S25 and connect T-adapters to male side.
Switch position:
Max. 1 z
Defective emergency pump Between S25 (male) Normal
drive (3) and (2) Switch position:
3 Min. 1 Mz
Resis- Emergency
switch (internal open circuit)
tance Switch position:
Max. 1 z
Between S25 (male) Normal
(6) and (5) Switch position:
Emergency Min. 1 Mz
PC210LC-10 40-523
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-524 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Action
Failure code PC-EPC (Rear) Solenoid Short Circuit
level Failure
(Pump controller system)
L03 DXA9KB
Detail of • Abnormal current flows when pump controller drives R-PC-EPC solenoid, so pump
failure controller determines that short circuit exists in R-PC-EPC solenoid circuit.
• Stops driving R-PC-EPC solenoid.
Action of • Even if cause of failure disappears, machine does not become normal until starting switch
controller is turned to OFF position.
Problem on • If pump load increases, engine speed decreases largely and engine may stall.
machine
• When solenoid and wiring harness are normal, engine can be prevented from stalling by
setting emergency pump drive switch to ON position.
Related • Drive current to R-PC-EPC solenoid can be checked with monitoring function.
information (Code: 01302 PC-EPC solenoid current (R))
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective R-PC-EPC 1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
solenoid 2. Disconnect connector V12, and connect T-adapters to male side.
1
(internal short circuit or Resis- Between V12 (male) (1) and (2) 3 to 14 z
ground fault) tance Between V12 (male) (1) and ground Min. 1 Mz
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector S25 and connect T-adapters to male side.
Defective emergency pump
drive switch (internal short Between S25 (male) (5) and each
2 Switch Min. 1 Mz
circuit or ground fault) Resis- of (2) and (3)
position:
tance Between ground and each of S25
Normal Min. 1 Mz
(male) (2) and (3)
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector CP02 and connect T-adapters to female side.
Short circuit or ground fault in a Check that emergency pump drive switch is at normal position (lower
3 wiring harness side).
Between CP02 (female) (104) and each of
Resis- (115), (117), (120) 3 to 14 z
tance
Between CP02 (female) (104) and ground Min. 1 Mz
a If no failure is found by check on cause 3, this check is not required.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connectors CP02, S25 and V12, and connect T-adapters
Ground fault in wiring harness to either female side.
4
(contact with ground circuit) Between ground and CP02 (female) (104) or
Min. 1 Mz
Resis- S25 (female) (3)
tance Between ground and S25 (female) (5) or V12
(female) (2) Min. 1 Mz
If no failure is found by above checks, pump controller is defective.
5 Defective pump controller
(Since this is an internal defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
PC210LC-10 40-525
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-526 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Action
Failure code LS-EPC Solenoid Open Circuit
level Failure
(Pump controller system)
L01 DXE0KA
Detail of • No current flows when pump controller drives LS-EPC solenoid, so pump controller
failure determines that open circuit exists in LS-EPC solenoid circuit.
Action of • None in particular (Since no current flows, solenoid is not energized.)
controller • If cause of failure disappears, machine becomes normal by itself.
Problem on • Travel speed is high with speed setting at Lo and Mi.
machine • Work equipment speed and swing speed are high in fine control mode (L).
• Drive current to LS-EPC solenoid can be checked with monitoring function.
Related (Code: 01500 LS-EPC solenoid current)
information • Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Defective LS-EPC solenoid 2. Disconnect connector V19, and connect T-adapters to male side.
1
Resis- Between V19 (male) (1) and (2)
3 to 14 z
tance
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Open or short circuit in wiring 2. Disconnect connector CP02 and connect T-adapters to female side.
2
harness Resis- Between CP02 (female) (88) and each of (115),
(117), (120) 3 to 14 z
tance
a If no failure is found by check on cause 2, this check is not required.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Open circuit in wiring harness 2. Disconnect connectors CP02 and V19, and connect T-adapters to
3 (wire breakage or defective each female side.
contact of connector) Resis- Between CP02 (female) (88) and V19 (female)
(1) Max. 1 z
tance
Resis- Between V19 (female) (2) and each of CP02
(female) (115), (117), (120) Max. 1 z
tance
If no failure is found by above checks, pump controller is defective.
4 Defective pump controller
(Since this is an internal defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
PC210LC-10 40-527
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-528 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
Action
Failure code LS-EPC Solenoid Short Circuit
level Failure
(Pump controller system)
L01 DXE0KB
Detail of • Abnormal current flows when pump controller drives LS-EPC solenoid, so pump controller
failure determines that short circuit exists in LS-EPC solenoid circuit.
• Stops driving LS-EPC solenoid.
Action of • Even if cause of failure disappears, machine does not become normal until starting switch
controller is turned to OFF position.
Problem on • Travel speed is high with speed setting at Lo and Mi.
machine • Work equipment speed and swing speed are high in fine control mode (L).
• Drive current to LS-EPC solenoid can be checked with monitoring function.
Related (Code: 01500 LS-EPC solenoid current)
information • Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
PC210LC-10 40-529
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-530 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-531
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-532 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-533
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-534 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-535
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-536 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-537
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-538 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-539
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-540 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-541
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-542 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-543
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-544 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-545
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-546 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-547
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-548 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-549
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-550 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
PC210LC-10 40-551
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting by failure code (Display of code)
40-552 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
E-1 Engine does not start (Engine does not crank) (PC200LC_10-A21-400-A-Z0-A)
PC210LC-10 40-553
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
40-554 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-555
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
40-556 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-557
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
40-558 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-559
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
40-560 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-561
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
40-562 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-563
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
40-564 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-565
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
40-566 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-567
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
40-568 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-569
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
40-570 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-571
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
40-572 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-573
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
E-11 Fuel level monitor lights up in red while engine is running (PC220_10-FEQ-
400-A-00-A)
40-574 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-575
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
40-576 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-577
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
40-578 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-579
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
E-17 Fuel gauge indicates either full or empty and does not move (PC220_10-
FGE-400-A-00-A)
• While fuel is added, fuel level gauge does not rise from red range (E).
Failure • While fuel level is low, fuel level gauge does not lower from top green range (F).
Related • Signal voltage of fuel level sensor can be checked with monitoring function.
information (Code: 04200 Fuel sensor voltage)
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective fuel level 1. Starting switch: OFF
sensor 2. Disconnect connector P21 and connect T-adapters to male side.
1 Between P21 Fuel level: FULL Approximately 12 z
(internal open or
short circuit) Resistance (male) (1) and
ground Fuel level: EMPTY 85 to 110 z
1. Starting switch: OFF
Open circuit or 2. Disconnect connector CM01 and connect T-adapter to female side.
2 short circuit in Between CM01 Fuel level: FULL Approximately 12 z
wiring harness Resistance (female) (15) and
ground Fuel level: EMPTY 85 to 110 z
Open circuit in a if no failure is found by check on cause 2, this check is not required.
wiring harness 1. Starting switch: OFF
3 (wire breakage or 2. Disconnect connectors CM01 and P21, and connect T-adapters to each female
defective contact of side.
connector) Between CM01 (female) (15) and P21
Resistance (female) (1) Max. 1 z
40-580 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
E-18 Fuel gauge indicates incorrect amount (indicates neither full nor
empty) (PC220_10-FGF-400-A-00-A)
• Indication of fuel level gauge is different from actual fuel level.
Failure • Indication of fuel level gauge is different from display of fuel level monitor.
Related • Signal voltage of fuel level sensor can be checked with monitoring function.
information (Code: 04200 Fuel sensor voltage)
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective fuel level 1. Starting switch: OFF
sensor 2. Disconnect connector P21 and connect T-adapters to male side.
1 Between P21 Fuel level: FULL Approximately 12 z
(internal open or
short circuit) Resistance (male) (1) and
ground Fuel level: EMPTY 85 to 110 z
PC210LC-10 40-581
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
E-19 Coolant temperature gauge indicates either Min. or Max. and does
not move (PC220_10-FGG-400-A-00-A)
• While engine coolant temperature is rising properly, temperature gauge indicator does not
rise above white range (C).
Failure • Although engine coolant temperature is stabilized at the proper level, temperature gauge
rises to red range (H).
• Signal of engine coolant temperature sensor is input to engine controller and then data is
Related transmitted to machine monitor through CAN communication system.
information • Engine coolant temperature can be checked with monitoring function
(Code: 04107 Coolant temperature)
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective engine The engine coolant temperature sensor system may be defective. Carry out
coolant troubleshooting for failure codes [CA144] and [CA145].
1 temperature sensor
system
Defective machine If no failure is found by above checks, machine monitor is defective. (Since this is
2 an internal defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
monitor
40-582 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-583
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
E-21 Hydraulic oil temperature gauge indicates either Min. or Max. and
does not move (PC220_10-FGJ-400-A-00-A)
• While hydraulic oil temperature is rising normally, indication of temperature gauge does
not rise from white range (C).
Failure • While hydraulic oil temperature is stabilized normally, indication of temperature gauge
rises to red range (H).
• Signal of hydraulic oil temperature sensor is input to pump controller and then data is
Related transmitted to machine monitor through CAN communication system.
information • Hydraulic oil temperature can be checked by using monitoring function.
(Code: 04401 Hydraulic oil temperature)
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. Starting switch: OFF
2. Disconnect connector P22 and connect T-adapter to male side.
Defective hydraulic 10°C Approx. 90 kz
oil temperature Between P22 30°C Approx. 35 kz
1 sensor (male) (1) and (2) Approx. 6.5 kz
80°C
(internal open or Resistance 100°C Approx. 3.5 kz
short circuit)
Between P22
(male) (2) and Whole range Min. 1 Mz
ground
1. Starting switch: OFF
2. Disconnect connector CP01 and connect T-adapter to female side.
Open circuit or Between CP01 (female) (28) and (46)
2 short circuit in
a Resistance accords with value on 3.5 to 90 kz
wiring harness Resistance temperature characteristics table in
cause 1.
Between CP01 (female) (28) and ground Min. 1 Mz
a If no failure is found by check on cause 2, this check is not required.
Open circuit in 1. Starting switch: OFF
wiring harness 2. Disconnect connectors CP01 and P22, and connect T-adapter to either female
3 (Open circuit or side.
defective contact in Between CP01 (female) (28) and P22
(female) (2) Max. 1 z
connector) Resistance
Between CP01 (female) (46) and P22
(female) (1) Max. 1 z
40-584 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-585
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
40-586 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-587
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
40-588 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-589
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
E-26 Automatic preheating system does not work (In cold season) (PC220_10-
FEN-400-A-00-A)
Failure • Automatic warm-up system does not operate (in cold weather).
• Automatic warm-up function increases engine speed to 1,200 rpm when engine coolant
temperature is below 30°C.
• With starting switch at ON position or after engine is started, if fuel control dial is kept at
70% throttle position or higher for 3 seconds, automatic warm-up operation is canceled.
Related • If machine is equipped with air conditioner, when blower is turned on, ambient
information temperature is below 5°C and engine coolant temperature is below 55°C, automatic
warm-up function increases engine speed to 1,300 rpm. If engine coolant temperature
reaches 60°C, automatic warm-up function is canceled.
• If engine oil pressure is below 50 kPa {0.51 kg/cm2}, turbocharger protection function
works to keep engine speed below 1,050 rpm for up to 20 seconds after engine is started.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
a Turn starting switch to ON position or start engine and perform troubleshooting.
Engine coolant
temperature 6 (a: Red)
105°C
Engine coolant
temperature 5 (a: Red)
102°C
Engine coolant
temperature 4 (a: Blue)
Coolant Monitoring code
100°C
temperature gange 04107 Coolant
Defective engine Engine coolant
level temperature
coolant temperature 3 (a: Blue)
1 temperature signal 85°C
system Engine coolant
temperature 2 (a: Blue)
60°C
Engine coolant
temperature 1 (a: White)
30°C
If engine coolant temperature does not match with coolant temperature gauge
level, perform the following troubleshooting procedures.
• E-19 Coolant temperature gauge indicates either Min. or Max. and does not
move(PAGE 40-582)
• E-20 Coolant temperature gauge indicates incorrect temperature (indicates
neither Min. nor Max.)(PAGE 40-583)
Defective engine If no problem is found by above checks, engine controller is defective. (Since this
2 is an internal defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
controller
40-590 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-591
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
40-592 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
E-29 Working mode selection screen is not diplayed when working mode
switch is operated (PC220_10-FFE-400-A-00-A)
Failure • When working mode switch is operated, working mode selection screen is not displayed.
Related • Condition of signal of working mode switch can be checked by using monitoring function.
information (Code: 04504 Monitor 1st & 2nd row switches)
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective machine Machine monitor may be defective. (Since this is an internal defect,
1 troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
monitor
PC210LC-10 40-593
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
E-30 Engine or hydraulic pump setting does not change when working
mode is changed (PC220_10-FP9-400-A-00-A)
Failure • When working mode is changed, setting of engine and hydraulic pump is not changed.
Related
information
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective machine Machine monitor may be defective. (Since this is an internal defect,
1 troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
monitor
Defective pump Pump controller may be defective. (Since this is an internal defect, troubleshooting
2 cannot be performed.)
controller
40-594 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
E-31 Travel speed monitor does not change when travel speed switch is
operated (PC220_10-FFF-400-A-00-A)
Failure • When travel speed switch is operated, travel speed monitor does not change.
Related • Condition of signal of travel speed switch can be checked by using monitoring function.
information (Code: 04504 Monitor 1st & 2nd row switches)
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective machine Machine monitor may be defective. (Since this is an internal defect,
1 troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
monitor
PC210LC-10 40-595
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
E-32 Travel speed does not change while travel speed selection is
changed (PC200LC_10-BQ3-400-A-Z0-A)
Failure When selection of travel speed is changed, actual travel speed does not change.
• When failure due to cause 1 occurs, actual travel speed does not decrease when
travel speed setting is changed to "Lo".
Related information • As T-adapter for pump controller connector is "socket-type box", operating voltage
cannot be measured at pump controller connector.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Hot short circuit in wiring 1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
harness 2. Disconnect connector V04 and connect T-adapters to female side.
1 3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
circuit)
Voltage Between V04 (female) (1) and ground Max. 4.5 V
If no failure is found by check on cause 1, machine monitor may be
2 Defective machine monitor defective.
(Since this is an internal defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
If no failure is found by checks for causes 1 and 2, pump controller may
3 Defective pump controller be defective.
(Since this is an internal defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
40-596 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-597
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
E-34 When starting switch is turned to OFF position, service meter is not
displayed (PC220_10-FFL-400-A-00-A)
Failure • When starting switch is in OFF position, service meter is not displayed.
• While starting switch is in OFF position, if following switches are operated, service meter
Related is displayed at top center of screen.
information Switch operation: [4] + [1] (Press simultaneously)
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
If machine monitor displays nothing when the starting switch is turned ON, the
Defective backup backup power supply system is supposed to be defective. Carry out the following
1 power supply troubleshooting procedures.
system • E-5 When starting switch is turned to ON position, machine monitor displays
nothing
Defective machine If no failure is found by above checks, machine monitor is defective. (Since this is
2 an internal defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
monitor
40-598 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-599
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
E-36 Any of work equipment, swing and travel does not work (PC220_10-FT5-400-A-
00-A)
Failure • All work equipment, swing, and travel system do not operate.
Related
information
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective fuse F01- If fuse is broken, circuit probably has grounding fault. (See troubleshooting for
1 cause 7.)
3
Defective lock lever 1. Starting switch: OFF
switch 2. Disconnect connector S14 and connect T-adapter to female side.
2
(internal open Between S14 Lock lever: Lock Min. 1 Mz
circuit) Resistance (female) (1) and (2) Lock lever: Free Max. 1 z
Defective PPC lock 1. Starting switch: OFF
solenoid 2. Disconnect connector V01 and connect T-adapter to male side.
3
(internal open or Between V01 (male) (1) and (2) 20 to 60 z
short circuit) Resistance
Between V01 (male) (1) and ground Min. 1 Mz
1. Starting switch: OFF
Defective diode 2. Remove diode array D01 and connect T-adapter to male side.
array D01
4 a Check using multimeter in diode range.
(internal short
circuit) Between D01 (male) (8) (+) and (4) (-) Continuity
Continuity
Between D01 (male) (4) (+) and (8) (-) No continuity
Open circuit in 1. Starting switch: OFF
wiring harness 2. Set lock lever to FREE position.
5 (wire breakage or 3. Remove fuse F01-3.
defective contact of Between F01-3 and ground (coil
connector) Resistance resistance of PPC lock solenoid) 20 to 60 z
40-600 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-601
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
E-37 Any of work equipment, swing and travel cannot be locked (PC200LC_10-
FT7-400-A-Z0-A)
Failure All of work equipment, swing, and travel mechanism do not lock
Related information
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Defective lock lever switch 2. Disconnect connector S14 and connect T-adapters to female side.
1
(internal short circuit) Resis- Between S14 (male) Lock lever: LOCK Min. 1 Mz
tance (1) and (2) Lock lever: FREE Max. 1 z
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Hot short circuit in wiring 2. Disconnect connector V01 and connect T-adapter to female side.
2 harness 3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
circuit) 4. Turn lock lever to LOCK position.
Voltage Between V01 (female) (2) and (1) Max. 1 V
40-602 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
Defective No. 1 in fuse box If fuse is blown out, circuit probably has ground fault. In this case,
1 perform troubleshooting for cause 5 first.
F01
PC210LC-10 40-603
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
40-604 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
E-39 Swing brake does not operate while swing brake cancel switch is
locked (PC200LC_10-FGN-400-A-Z0-A)
Failure Swing brake does not operate while swing brake cancel switch is locked.
Related information
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector S25 and connect T-adapters to female side.
Defective swing brake cancel swing brake cancel
1 switch (internal short circuit) Min. 1 Mz
Resis- Between S25 (male) switch: Normal
tance (13) and (14) swing brake cancel
Max. 1 z
switch: FREE
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector V03 and connect T-adapter to female side.
Hot short circuit in wiring 3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
2 harness 4. Set swing lock switch to ON position.
circuit)
a Measure voltage again under swing lock switch OFF position.
Voltage Between V03 (female) (1) and ground Max. 1 V
PC210LC-10 40-605
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
40-606 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-607
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
40-608 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
Failure When L.H. knob switch is released, work equipment power is not returned to normal.
• Signal of L.H. knob switch can be checked with monitoring function.
Related information (Code: 02200 Switch input 1)
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Hot short circuit in wiring 1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
harness 2. Disconnect connector V08 and connect T-adapter to female side.
1 3. Turn starting switch to ON position.
circuit)
Voltage Between V08 (female) (1) and (2) Max. 4.5 V
If no failure is found by checks on cause 1, pump controller is defective.
2 Defective pump controller
(Since this is an internal defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
PC210LC-10 40-609
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
E-42 Travel alarm does not sound when machine travels (PC220_10-KA4-400-A-00-A)
Failure • When the machine is traveling, the travel alarm does not sound.
Related • Output to travel alarm can be checked with monitoring function.
information (Code: 03701 Controller output 2)
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective travel 1. Starting switch: OFF
1 alarm 2. Disconnect connector M14 and connect T-adapter to male side.
(internal defect) Continuity Between M14 (male) (1) and (2) Continuity
1. Starting switch: OFF
Open circuit in 2. Disconnect connectors M14 and CP02 and connect T-adapters to each female
wiring harness side.
2 (wire breakage or Between CP02 (female) (107) and M14
(female) (1) Max. 1 z
defective contact of
connector) Resistance
Between CP02 (female) (115) and M14
(female) (2) Max. 1 z
40-610 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
E-43 Alarm does not stop sounding while machine is stopped (PC200LC_10-KB5-
400-A-Z0-A)
PC210LC-10 40-611
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
40-612 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-613
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
40-614 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
E-46 Wiper monitor does not light up or go out when wiper switch is
operated (PC220_10-FG4-400-A-00-A)
Failure • When wiper switch is operated, wiper monitor does not light up or go off.
Related • Condition of wiper switch signal can be checked by using monitoring function.
information (Code: 04504 Monitor 1st & 2nd row switches)
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective machine Machine monitor may be defective. (Since this is an internal defect,
1 troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
monitor
PC210LC-10 40-615
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
E-47 Wiper does not operate when wiper switch is operated (PC220_10-FG0-400-A-00-
A)
Failure • When wiper switch is operated, windshield wiper does not operate.
• Condition of window rear limit switch signal can be checked by using monitoring function.
Related (Code: 02204 Switch input 5)
information • Wiper motor is troubleshooted for failure codes [DY20KA], [DY20MA], [DY2DKB], and
[DY2EKB].
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. Starting switch: OFF
2. Disconnect connector W03.
Defective rear limit Front window:
switch for window When installed to Min. 1 Mz
1
(internal short Between W03 front
circuit) Resistance (male) (1) and (2) Front window:
When retracted to Max. 1 z
rear
Defective wiper 1. Starting switch: OFF
motor 2. Disconnect connector M05 and connect T-adapter to female side.
2
(internal open
circuit in harness) Continuity Between M05 (female) (1) and (3) Continuity
Open circuit in
a Wiper motor system
wiring harness
See troubleshooting for [DY20KA], [DY20MA], [DY2DKB], and [DY2EKB].
3 (wire breakage or
defective contact of
connector)
Open circuit in a Rear limit switch system
wiring harness 1. Starting switch: OFF
4 (wire breakage or 2. Disconnect connectors CP01 and connect T-adapters to each female side.
defective contact of 3. Pull up front window.
connector) Resistance Between CP01 (female) (76) and ground Max. 1 Mz
Ground fault in 1. Starting switch: OFF
wiring harness 2. Disconnect connector CP01 and connect T-adapter to female side.
5
(contact with 3. Front window installed to front
ground circuit) Resistance Between CP01 (female) (76) and ground Min. 1 Mz
Defective pump If no failure is found by above checks, pump controller is defective. (Since this is
6 an internal defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
controller
40-616 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-617
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
E-48 Window washer does not operate when window washer switch is
operated (PC220_10-FH0-400-A-00-A)
Failure • When window washer switch is operated, window washer does not operate.
• Condition of window washer switch signal can be checked with monitoring function.
Related (Code: 04504 Monitor 1st, 2nd line switches)
information • As for window washer, perform troubleshooting for failure code [DY2CKB].
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective machine Machine monitor may be defective. (Since this is an internal defect,
1 troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
monitor
40-618 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-619
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
40-620 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-621
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
40-622 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-623
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
40-624 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-625
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
40-626 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-627
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
40-628 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-629
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
40-630 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
a Select “Terminal Status” from “KOMTRAX settings” in service menu of machine monitor.
PC210LC-10 40-631
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of electrical system (E-mode)
a Select “GPS & Communication Status” from “KOMTRAX settings” in service menu of machine monitor.
40-632 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
(Rev. 2011/03)
a The following information is summarized in the troubleshooting table. Before performing troubleshooting,
understand that information fully.
Failure Failure symptom that appears on machine
Related Information on occurred failure or troubleshooting
information
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1
2 Probable cause of failure <Contents of description>
(Each number is serial
3 number, not priority • Criteria to determine probable causes
4 sequence.) • Remarks for determination of probable cause
5
PC210LC-10 40-633
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
a This is a system chart that is drawn up by simplifying the whole hydraulic circuit chart. Use it as a
reference material when troubleshooting the hydraulic and mechanical systems.
40-634 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
PC210LC-10 40-635
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
Diagnosis codes
Engine system
PC-EPC valve
LS-EPC valve
Damper
Servo piston
Piston pump
Hydraulic oil
PC valve
LS valve
stainer
Cap
Failure mode
Speed or power of all work equipment, swing and travel is low. q q q q q q q q q q H-1
All work equipment, travel, and swing systems do not work. q q q H-3
swing and travel
Boom H-10
Bucket H-12
H-17
RAISE speed is slow.
Swing and
H-18
lowers significantly.
Travel speed does not switch or travel speed is too low or high. q H-22
40-636 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
Failed parts
Tank Hydraulic pump
Diagnosis codes
Engine system
PC-EPC valve
LS-EPC valve
Damper
Piston pump
Servo piston
Hydraulic oil
PC valve
LS valve
stainer
Cap
Failure mode
Upper structure swings
H-24
neither to the right nor left
Machine does not swing
Upper structure does not
H-25
swing in only one direction
Poor or low for both of the
Swing acceleration is poor or swing speed is right and left H-26
Large unusual noise is heard when upper structure stops swinging. H-31
When swing holding brake
H-32
Swing drift on a slope is excessive applied
When swing holding brake
H-33
released
Attachment circuit is not switched to desired one. H-34
Attachment
PC210LC-10 40-637
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
Failed parts
Control valve
Diagnosis codes
Swing LS select valve
Travel junction valve
Back pressure valve
Boom lock valve
Main relief valve
LS shuttle valve
LS line throttle
Suction valve
Unload valve
Safety valve
Spool
Failure mode
Speed or power of all work equipment, swing and travel is low. q q q H-1
All work equipment, travel, and swing systems do not work. q H-3
swing and travel
Boom q q q q H-10
Bucket q q q q H-12
q H-17
boom RAISE speed is slow.
Swing and
q q H-18
speed lowers significantly.
40-638 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
Failed parts
Control valve
Diagnosis codes
Swing LS select valve
Travel junction valve
Back pressure valve
Boom lock valve
Main relief valve
LS shuttle valve
LS line throttle
Suction valve
Unload valve
Safety valve
Failure mode Spool
Machine deviates during travel q q q q q H-19
Travel speed does not switch or travel speed is too low or high. H-22
Large unusual noise is heard when upper structure stops swinging. q H-31
When swing holding
H-32
Swing drift on a slope is excessive brake applied
When swing holding
q q H-33
brake released
Attachment circuit is not switched to desired one. q H-34
Attachment
PC210LC-10 40-639
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
Failed parts
Solenoid valve Swing motor
Diagnosis codes
2-stage relief solenoid
Shockless valve
Parking brake
Suction valve
Check valve
Piston motor
Safety valve
Failure mode
Speed or power of all work equipment, swing and travel is low. H-1
All work equipment, travel, and swing systems do not work. H-3
swing and travel
Boom H-10
Bucket H-12
H-17
RAISE speed is slow.
Swing and
H-18
lowers significantly.
40-640 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
Failed parts
Solenoid valve Swing motor
Diagnosis codes
2-stage relief solenoid
Shockless valve
Parking brake
Suction valve
Check valve
Piston motor
Safety valve
Failure mode
Machine deviates during travel q q H-19
Travel speed does not switch or travel speed is too low or high. q H-22
Large unusual noise is heard when upper structure stops swinging. q q H-31
When swing holding brake
q q H-32
Swing drift on a slope is excessive applied
When swing holding brake
q q q q H-33
released
Attachment circuit is not switched to desired one. q H-34
Attachment
PC210LC-10 40-641
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
Failed parts
Travel motor
Hydraulic cylinder
Swing machinery
Diagnosis codes
Counterbalance valve
Parking brake
Check valve
Piston motor
Safety valve
Final drive
Failure mode
Speed or power of all work equipment, swing and travel is low. H-1
All work equipment, travel, and swing systems do not work. H-3
swing and travel
Boom q H-10
Bucket q H-12
H-17
RAISE speed is slow.
Swing and
H-18
lowers significantly.
40-642 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
Failed parts
Travel motor
Hydraulic cylinder
Swing machinery
Diagnosis codes
Counterbalance valve
Parking brake
Check valve
Piston motor
Safety valve
Final drive
Failure mode
Machine deviates during travel q q q q q H-19
Travel speed does not switch or travel speed is too low or high. q H-22
Large unusual noise is heard when upper structure stops swinging. q H-31
When swing holding brake
H-32
Swing drift on a slope is excessive applied
When swing holding brake
H-33
released
Attachment circuit is not switched to desired one. H-34
Attachment
PC210LC-10 40-643
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
H-1 All of work equipment, swing and travel operation lacks speed or
power (PC200LC_10-A8A-400-A-Z0-A)
Failure • All of work equipment, swing and travel operation lacks speed or power.
• Perform all troubleshooting with working mode set in P mode.
• If failure codes are displayed, perform troubleshooting for them first. (DKR0MA, DKR1MA,
DXA8KA, DXA8KB, DXA9KA, DXA9KB, DXE0KA, DXE0KB)
• As for speed other than swing speed, check whether normal speed is obtained with swing
Related lock switch turned ON.
information If normal speed is obtained, perform troubleshooting on causes (1) and (2) to check pump
swash plate sensor for malfunction.
If normal speed is not obtained, perform troubleshooting on cause (3) and after.
• F pump pressure and R pump can be checked with monitoring function. (Code: F pump
pressure 01100, R pump pressure 01101)
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
a Be ready with engine stopped, then perform troubleshooting with engine
running at full speed.
Malfunction of pump swash All levers in NEUTRAL 1.35 ± 0.63 V
1 plate sensor (front)
Sensor output L.H. track only: Running idle off
voltage ground 3.35 ± 0.63 V
Swing lock switch: ON
a Be ready with engine stopped, then perform troubleshooting with engine
running at full speed.
Malfunction of pump swash All levers in NEUTRAL 1.35 ± 0.63 V
2 plate sensor (rear)
Sensor output R.H. track only: Running idle off
voltage ground 3.35 ± 0.63 V
Swing lock switch: ON
a Be ready with engine stopped, then perform troubleshooting with engine
Malfunction of unload valve running at full speed.
3 (front)
3.5 ± 1.0 MPa
Unload pressure All levers in NEUTRAL
{36 ± 10 kg/cm2}
a Be ready with engine stopped, then perform troubleshooting with engine
Malfunction of unload valve running at full speed.
4 (rear)
3.5 ± 1.0 MPa
Unload pressure All levers in NEUTRAL
{36 ± 10 kg/cm2}
a Be ready with engine stopped, then perform troubleshooting with engine
running at full speed.
Malfunction of main relief
5 valve (front) 33.1 to 37.2 MPa
Main relief
Boom RAISE hydraulic relief {338 to 380 kg/
pressure
cm2}
a Be ready with engine stopped, then perform troubleshooting with engine
running at full speed.
Malfunction of main relief
6 valve (rear) 33.1 to 37.2 MPa
Main relief
Arm IN hydraulic relief {338 to 380 kg/
pressure
cm2}
If normal oil pressure is not obtained after adjustment, check main relief
Malfunction of main relief
7 valve (front) valve for malfunction (setting of spring) and internal failure (defective valve
seat).
If normal oil pressure is not obtained after adjustment, check main relief
Malfunction of main relief valve for malfunction (setting of spring) and internal failure (defective valve
8 valve (rear)
seat).
40-644 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
PC210LC-10 40-645
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
40-646 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
PC210LC-10 40-647
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
40-648 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
PC210LC-10 40-649
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
H-3 All work equipment, swing and travel does not work (PC200LC_10-FT5-400-A-Z0-A)
Failure • All work equipment, travel, and swing systems do not work.
Related information • Perform all troubleshooting with working mode in power mode (P).
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
a Be ready with engine stopped, then troubleshoot with engine at full
speed.
Measurement Solenoid output
Malfunction of PPC lock Lock lever pressure
1 conditions
solenoid valve
• Hydraulic oil at LOCK position 0 MPa {0 kg/cm2 }
temperature: Within 2.9 MPa
operation range at FREE position
{30 kg/cm2 }
a Be ready with engine stopped, then troubleshoot with engine at full
speed.
Measurement Control circuit source
Control lever pressure
conditions
Malfunction of self-pressure
2 reducing valve • Hydraulic oil When all control levers 2.84 to 3.43 MPa
temperature: Within are in NEUTRAL
operation range position {29 to 35 kg/cm2 }
40-650 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
PC210LC-10 40-651
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
40-652 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
PC210LC-10 40-653
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
40-654 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
PC210LC-10 40-655
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
40-656 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
PC210LC-10 40-657
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
40-658 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
PC210LC-10 40-659
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
40-660 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
PC210LC-10 40-661
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
40-662 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
PC210LC-10 40-663
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
40-664 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
PC210LC-10 40-665
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
40-666 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
PC210LC-10 40-667
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
40-668 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
PC210LC-10 40-669
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
40-670 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
Malfunction of bucket
control valve (pressure a Check whether bucket cylinder moves slowly to bucket DUMP side
12 compensation valve) when performing hydraulic relief of other work equipment. (If bucket
(bucket DUMP side) cylinder moves, control valve is defective.)
PC210LC-10 40-671
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
H-14 When part of work equipment is relieved singly, other parts of work
equipment move (PC300-FT4-400-A-Z0-A)
Failure • Other wok equipment moves when one of work equipment is relieved.
Related • Perform all troubleshooting with working mode set in P mode.
information
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
When work equipment other than boom is hydraulically relieved singly, if
boom moves to RAISE side arbitrarily, pressure compensation valve on
Malfunction of boom boom RAISE side may malfunction.
control valve (pressure
1 compensation valve) a Pressure compensation valve is equipped with outer seal, inner seal,
(boom RAISE side) and LS check valve (ball).
Since slipper seal is installed to inner seal, damage on O-ring inside
inner seal cannot be checked visually.
Malfunction of arm control
When work equipment other than arm is hydraulically relieved singly, if arm
valve (pressure
2 compensation valve) (arm moves to IN side arbitrarily, pressure compensation valve on arm IN side
may malfunction.
IN side)
Malfunction of bucket
When work equipment other than bucket is hydraulically relieved singly, if
control valve (pressure
3 compensation valve) bucket moves to CURL side arbitrarily, pressure compensation valve on
bucket CURL side may malfunction.
(bucket CURL side)
Malfunction of bucket
When work equipment other than bucket is hydraulically relieved singly, if
control valve (pressure
4 compensation valve) bucket moves to DUMP side arbitrarily, pressure compensation valve on
bucket DUMP side may malfunction.
(bucket DUMP side)
40-672 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
PC210LC-10 40-673
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
a Pressure compensation valve is equipped with outer seal, inner seal, and LS check valve (ball).
Since slipper seal is installed to inner seal, damage on O-ring inside inner seal cannot be checked visually.
40-674 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
PC210LC-10 40-675
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
40-676 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
PC210LC-10 40-677
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
40-678 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
18 Defective final drive a Check for unusual noise, unusual heat, and metallic powders in drained
oil to make judgment.
PC210LC-10 40-679
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
40-680 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
13 Defective final drive a Check for unusual noise, unusual heat, and metallic powders in drained
oil to make judgment.
PC210LC-10 40-681
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
40-682 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
PC210LC-10 40-683
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
40-684 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
H-22 Travel speed does not change, or travel speed is too slow or
fast (PC200LC_10-BQ4-400-A-Z0-A)
Failure • Travel speed does not change or travel speed is too low or high.
• Perform all troubleshooting with working mode set in P mode.
• If failure codes are displayed, perform troubleshooting for them first.(DW43KA, DW43KB)
Related • Current to LS-EPC solenoid can be checked with monitoring function. (Code: 01500)
information • Signal (ON/OFF) of travel speed selector solenoid can be checked with monitoring
function. (Code: 02300)
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
a Be ready with engine stopped, then perform troubleshooting with engine
running at full speed.
Travel control 600 mA
lever: Finely Travel speed: Lo
moved (* Reference)
Travel control
LS-EPC current Travel speed: Mi
lever: Finely 644 mA
value
moved
Travel control
Malfunction of LS-EPC lever: Finely Travel speed: Hi 0 mA
1
valve moved
a Be ready with engine stopped, then perform troubleshooting with engine
running at full speed.
Approx. 2.9 MPa
Travel control Travel speed: Lo {Approx. 30 kg/
LS-EPC output lever: NEUTRAL cm2}
pressure Travel control
lever: Finely Travel speed: Hi 0 MPa {0 kg/cm2}
moved
a Be ready with engine stopped, then perform troubleshooting with engine
running at full speed.
Malfunction of travel speed Travel control Travel speed: Lo 0 MPa {0 kg/cm2}
2 lever: NEUTRAL
selector solenoid valve Solenoid valve
Travel control Approx. 2.9 MPa
outlet pressure
lever: Finely Travel speed: Hi {Approx. 30 kg/
moved cm2}
Malfunction of travel motor If no failure is found by checks on causes (1) and (2), speed switching
3 (speed switching portion) portion of travel motor may malfunction.
* : Travel speed of Lo setting can be adjusted by using adjustment function of machine monitor. If it is
changed from default value, LS-EPC current value changes slightly.
PC210LC-10 40-685
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
40-686 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
15 Defective final drive a Check for unusual noise, unusual heat, and metallic powders in drained
oil to make judgment.
PC210LC-10 40-687
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
H-24 Upper structure does not swing to the right or left (PC200LC_10-L41-400-A-Z0-A)
Failure • Upper structure does not swing in both right and left directions.
• Perform all troubleshooting with working mode set in P mode.
Related • If failure codes are displayed, perform troubleshooting for them first. (DW45KA, DW45KB)
information • Pump pressure can be checked with monitoring function. (Code: F pump pressure 01100,
R pump pressure 01101)
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
a Be ready with engine stopped, then perform troubleshooting with engine
running at full speed.
Malfunction of swing PPC Swing control
1 NEUTRAL 0 MPa {0 kg/cm2}
valve Swing PPC valve lever
output pressure Swing control Left swing and 2.84 to 3.43 MPa
lever Right swing {29 to 35 kg/cm2}
a Be ready with engine stopped, then perform troubleshooting with engine
running at full speed.
Malfunction of swing
2 holding brake solenoid Swing control 0 MPa {0 kg/cm2}
Swing holding NEUTRAL
valve lever
brake solenoid 2.9 MPa
Swing control Left swing and
output pressure
lever Right swing {30 kg/cm2}
When no failure is found by check on cause (1), if upper structure does not
Malfunction of swing motor swing with swing circuit pressure reaching relief pressure, swing holding
3 (swing holding brake) brake may malfunction.
(Check pump pressure by using monitoring function to make judgment.)
If no failure is found by checks on causes (1) and (2) and upper structure
Malfunction of swing
4 control valve (spool) does not swing when swing control lever is operated with pump pressure at
approx. 4 MPa, check whether spool is locked near NEUTRAL position.
a Be ready with engine stopped, then perform troubleshooting with engine
running at full speed.
27.4 to 31.3 MPa
Swing relief Swing lock Swing hydraulic
Defective swing motor {280 to 320 kg/
5 (safety valve) pressure switch: ON. relief cm2}
If relief pressures of left swing and right swing are same and below
standard value, sealing of safety valve may be defective.
Safety valve has 2-stage relief function, however, set pressures for Hi and
Lo settings are same (relief flow rate differs).
a Be ready with engine stopped, then perform troubleshooting with engine
6 Defective swing motor running at full speed.
Leakage from Swing lock Swing hydraulic
swing motor Max. 10l /min
switch: ON. relief
Swing machinery may have internal failure.
7 Defective swing machinery a Check for unusual noise, unusual heat, and metallic powders in drained
oil to make judgment.
40-688 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
PC210LC-10 40-689
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
40-690 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
PC210LC-10 40-691
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
40-692 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
PC210LC-10 40-693
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
40-694 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
PC210LC-10 40-695
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
40-696 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
Malfunction of swing Pressure compensation valve on right swing side of swing control valve
control valve (pressure may malfunction.
2 compensation valve on
Interchange pressure compensation valves on left and right swing sides
right swing side) and check whether failure symptom changes to make judgment.
Malfunction of swing Pressure compensation valve on left swing side of swing control valve may
control valve (pressure malfunction.
3 compensation valve on left
Interchange pressure compensation valves on left and right swing sides
swing side) and check whether failure symptom changes to make judgment.
a Be ready with engine stopped, then perform troubleshooting with engine
running at full speed.
27.4 to 31.3 MPa
Swing relief Swing lock Swing hydraulic
Defective swing motor pressure {280 to 320 kg/
4 switch: ON. relief
(safety valve) cm2}
If normal pressure is not obtained after adjustment, sealing of safety valve
may be defective.
Safety valve has 2-stage relief function, however, set pressures for Hi and
Lo settings are same (relief flow rate differs).
Interchange suction valves on left and right swing sides of swing motor,
Defective sealing of swing and check whether failure symptom changes to make judgment.
5 motor (suction valve)
When removing valve, check it for lock valve and defects.
Interchange check valves on left and right swing sides of swing motor, and
Defective seating of swing check whether failure symptom changes to make judgment.
6 motor (check valve)
When removing valve, check it for lock and defects.
Malfunction of swing motor Reverse prevention valve of swing motor may malfunction.
7 (reverse prevention valve) Check for locked or almost trapped spool and setting of spring.
PC210LC-10 40-697
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
40-698 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of hydraulic and mechanical system (H-
mode)
PC210LC-10 40-699
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of engine (S-mode)
(Rev. 2011/01)
a Troubleshooting Table collectively carries the following information. Carry out troubleshooting work after
fully grasping its contents.
Failure Problem on engine
Related Information related to the detected failure or troubleshooting
information
Probable cause Contents of check and remarks Remedy
1 <Contents of description>
2 Probable causes for
trouble (Each number is • Contents of check to judge • Actions to eliminate probable
3 serial number, not priority probable causes causes of trouble
4 sequence.) • Remarks required for
5 judgment
40-700 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of engine (S-mode)
S-1 When starting switch is turned to START position, engine does not
crank (PC220_10-A26-400-A-00-A)
Failure When starting switch is turned to "START" position, engine does not crank.
Related • For troubleshooting of electrical system, see E-1 in E mode troubleshooting.
information • If a failure code is displayed, perform troubleshooting for it first.
No. Cause Check item and remarks Remedy
Defective starting • When starting switch is turned to START, starter Perform troubleshooting
1 circuit wiring pinion does not plunge. for E-1 and repair failure.
• Rasping sound is heard around starting motor Perform troubleshooting
pinion. for E-1 and repair failure.
(When starting switch is turned to START, starting
motor pinion plunges.)
• Starting motor pinion returns halfway.
Defective starting
(When starting switch is turned to START, starting
2 motor (safety relay
motor pinion plunges.)
section)
• Brattle is heard and starting motor does not rotate.
(When starting switch is turned to START, starting
motor pinion plunges.)
(Reference: Brattle is made by starting motor pinion
when it repeats plunging and returning.)
• If rasping sound is heard from starting motor pinion Replace if broken.
Broken flywheel
3 and starting motor does not rotate, visually check
ring gear
flywheel ring gear.
Cracked EGR • Remove gas piping from EGR inlet and outlet, and Replace EGR cooler, and
cooler check if water containing coolant flows out of them. then remove water in
4 (Reference: engine cylinders.
a Moisture in exhaust gas may condense into water.
Coolant in exhaust So, check whether water contains coolant.
pipe)
PC210LC-10 40-701
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of engine (S-mode)
Foreign material in fuel • Rust and water are found in fuel drained Replace fuel.
4
from fuel tank.
• Air is bled during air bleeding of fuel system. Perform air bleeding.
5 Air in fuel piping system (Reference: See Testing and adjusting, Repair or replace fuel
"Bleeding air from fuel system".) piping.
• Fuel leaks from fuel piping.
Leakage from fuel piping Repair or replace fuel
6 (Reference: See Testing and adjusting,
system piping related parts.
"Checking fuel circuit for leakage".)
• Injector return rate is excessive.
Fuel leakage from injector (Reference: See Testing and adjusting, Tighten or replace inlet
7 "Measuring fuel delivery, return and
and inlet connector connector.
leakage".)
• See Testing and adjusting, "Measuring fuel Replace supply pump
8 Defective supply pump
delivery, return and leakage". or pressure limiter.
• No resistance is felt or large effort is
9 Defective priming pump Replace priming pump.
required when operating priming pump.
• Monitored common rail pressure does not Loosen injection piping
Improper air bleeding of lower even after engine is stopped. (Code: and high-pressure pipe
10 common rail or injection 36400 Common rail pressure) mounting nuts on
piping (Pressure may not decrease if air still common rail and bleed
remains.) air.
40-702 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of engine (S-mode)
S-3 Fuel is being injected but engine does not start (misfiring: engine
cranks but does not start) (WA380_7-A28-400-A-Z0-A)
Fuel is being injected but engine does not start (incomplete combustion: engine cranks but
Failure does not start).
Related • If any failure code is displayed, perform troubleshooting for that code first.
information
No. Cause Point to check, remarks Remedy
• Specific gravity of electrolyte and voltage of Add battery electrolyte
1 Defective battery
battery are low. and charge battery.
2 Insufficient fuel in tank • Fuel tank is empty. Add fuel.
Flush air breather hole
Clogged air breather hole in
3 • Air breather hole in fuel tank cap is clogged. in fuel tank cap and
fuel tank cap clean surrounding
area.
• Check used hours of fuel filter. If used
Clogged fuel filter element beyond specified hours, fuel filter element Replace fuel filter
4
may be clogged. element.
Foreign material in fuel • Rust and water are found in fuel drained Replace fuel.
5
from fuel tank.
• Air is bled during air bleeding of fuel system. Perform air bleeding.
6 Air in fuel piping system (Reference: See Testing and adjusting, Repair or replace fuel
"Bleeding air from fuel system".) piping.
• Fuel leaks from fuel piping.
Leakage from fuel piping Repair or replace fuel
7 (Reference: See Testing and adjusting,
system piping related parts.
"Checking fuel circuit for leakage".)
• Injector return rate is excessive.
Fuel leakage from injector (Reference: See Testing and adjusting, Tighten or replace inlet
8 "Measuring fuel delivery, return and connector.
and inlet connector
leakage".)
• No resistance is felt or large effort is
9 Defective priming pump Replace priming pump.
required when operating priming pump.
10 Clogged air cleaner element • Air cleaner dust indicator indicates that dust Check and clean air
is at caution level. cleaner element.
• When preheating works, intake air heater
mounting area does not become hot.
• When preheating works or when Replace intake air
11 Defective intake air heater
temperature is low, preheating monitor does heater.
not indicate properly.
• Check valve clearance.
(Reference: See Testing and adjusting,
Worn valve or rocker arm, "Testing and adjusting valve clearance".) Replace valve or
12
etc. • When engine is cranked, unusual noise is rocker arm.
heard from around cylinder head.
• Measuring compression pressure
Replace piston ring or
13 Defective piston ring (Reference: See Testing and adjusting,
piston.
"Testing compression pressure".)
• When engine is run in cylinder cutout mode
Defective injector with some cylinder cut out, engine speed
14 (clogged injector or defective does not change. Replace injector.
fuel spray) (Reference: See Testing and adjusting,
"Handling cylinder cutout mode operation".)
Since this is an internal defect, troubleshooting Replace engine
15 Defective engine controller
cannot be performed. controller.
PC210LC-10 40-703
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of engine (S-mode)
Foreign material in fuel • Rust and water are found in fuel drained Replace fuel.
6
from fuel tank.
• Air is bled during air bleeding of fuel system. Perform air bleeding.
7 Air in fuel piping system (Reference: See Testing and adjusting, Repair or replace fuel
"Bleeding air from fuel system".) piping.
• Fuel leaks from fuel piping.
Leakage from fuel piping Repair or replace fuel
8 (Reference: See Testing and adjusting,
system piping related parts.
"Checking fuel circuit for leakage".)
• See Testing and adjusting, "Measuring fuel Replace supply pump
9 Defective supply pump
delivery, return and leakage". or pressure limiter.
• Air cleaner dust indicator indicates that dust Check and clean air
10 Clogged air cleaner element
is at caution level. cleaner element.
• When preheating works, intake air heater
mounting area does not become hot.
• When preheating works or when Replace intake air
11 Defective intake air heater
temperature is low, preheating monitor does heater.
not indicate properly.
• Remove exhaust gas piping from EGR
cooler outlet and inlet, and check whether
Cracked EGR cooler Replace EGR cooler
coolant containing COOLANT flows out.
12 (Reference: Coolant enters and drain water from
exhaust gas piping.) a Water in exhaust gas can be normally engine cylinders
condensed, so check that condensate is
coolant or not.
• Some cylinder is found to be cool when
exhaust manifolds are touched by hand
immediately after engine is started.
• When engine is run in cylinder cutout mode
13 Defective injector Replace injector.
with some cylinder cut out, engine speed
does not change.
(Reference: See Testing and adjusting,
"Handling cylinder cutout mode operation".)
Since this is an internal defect, troubleshooting Replace engine
14 Defective engine controller cannot be performed. controller.
40-704 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of engine (S-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-705
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of engine (S-mode)
Foreign material in fuel • Rust and water are found in fuel drained Replace fuel.
4
from fuel tank.
• Air is bled during air bleeding of fuel system. Perform air bleeding.
5 Air in fuel piping system (Reference: See Testing and adjusting, Repair or replace fuel
"Bleeding air from fuel system".) piping.
• Fuel leaks from fuel piping.
Leakage from fuel piping Repair or replace fuel
6 (Reference: See Testing and adjusting,
system piping related parts.
"Checking fuel circuit for leakage".)
• See Testing and adjusting, "Measuring fuel Replace supply pump
7 Defective supply pump
delivery, return and leakage". or pressure limiter.
• When crankcase pressure high error (failure
code: CA555) is still displayed even after
Abnormally high crankcase KCCV filter is replaced, blowby pressure is Perform following
8 pressure probably high (see Testing and adjusting, checks on causes 10
"Measuring blowby pressure"). In this case, and after.
KVGT may be seized or damaged.
• Some cylinder is found to be cool when
exhaust manifolds are touched by hand
immediately after engine is started.
• When engine is run in cylinder cutout mode
9 Defective injector Replace injector.
with some cylinder cut out, engine speed
does not change.
(Reference: See Testing and adjusting,
"Handling cylinder cutout mode operation".)
• Unusual noise is heard from KVGT.
• Check whether KVGT shaft rotates.
10 Seized or broken KVGT Replace KVGT.
(Move KVGT vanes with hand in axial and
radial directions to make judgement.)
• When engine is cranked, unusual noise is
heard from around cylinder head.
11 Incorrect valve clearance • Check valve clearance. Adjust valve clearance.
(Reference: See Testing and adjusting,
"Testing and adjusting valve clearance".)
Since this is an internal defect, troubleshooting Replace engine
12 Defective engine controller cannot be performed. controller.
40-706 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of engine (S-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-707
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of engine (S-mode)
40-708 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of engine (S-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-709
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of engine (S-mode)
40-710 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of engine (S-mode)
Foreign material in fuel • Rust and water are found in fuel drained Replace fuel.
4
from fuel tank.
• Air is bled during air bleeding of fuel system. Perform air bleeding.
5 Air in fuel piping system (Reference: See Testing and adjusting, Repair or replace fuel
"Bleeding air from fuel system".) piping.
• Fuel leaks from fuel piping.
Leakage from fuel piping Repair or replace fuel
6 (Reference: See Testing and adjusting,
system piping related parts.
"Checking fuel circuit for leakage".)
• See Testing and adjusting, "Measuring fuel Replace supply pump
7 Defective supply pump
delivery, return and leakage". or pressure limiter.
Clogged air cleaner element • Air cleaner dust indicator indicates that dust Check and clean air
8
is at caution level. cleaner element.
• Check air cleaner and rectifying wire net for Correct or replace air
9 Defective air cleaner
deformation. cleaner.
Defective air intake hose
10 (Between air cleaner and • Visually check air intake hose for breakage. Replace air intake
hose.
KVGT inlet)
• Check air intake manifold for internal Replace air intake
11 Defective air intake manifold breakage. manifold.
Defective boost piping and
connections Repair or replace
12 • Air leaks from boost piping.
(Between KVGT outlet and air boost piping.
intake manifold)
Defective installation of boost • Air leaks from mounting part of boost Correct installation of
13 pressure sensor pressure sensor. boost pressure sensor.
Defective exhaust gas piping • Check exhaust gas piping for damage and
exhaust gas leakage. Replace exhaust gas
14 (Between exhaust manifold (Check soot on heat insulation cover and piping.
and KDPF inlet) heat insulation plate.)
Exhaust gas leakage from
15 EGR piping • Exhaust gas leaks from EGR piping. Replace EGR piping.
Defective intake and exhaust
system • Measure boost pressure.
Repair or replace
16 (Between KVGT outlet and air (Reference: See Testing and adjusting,
defective part.
intake manifold, air intake "Measuring boost pressure".)
manifold and KDPF inlet)
• Unusual noise is heard from KVGT.
• Check whether KVGT shaft rotates.
17 Seized or broken KVGT Replace KVGT.
(Move KVGT vanes with hand in axial and
radial directions to make judgement.)
• Open exhaust color inspection hole being
just upstream of KDPF, and check exhaust
gas (see Standard value table). Clean or replace
18 Excessive soot load in KDPF
(Reference: See Testing and adjusting, KDPF.
"Testing exhaust color".)
PC210LC-10 40-711
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of engine (S-mode)
40-712 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of engine (S-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-713
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of engine (S-mode)
40-714 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of engine (S-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-715
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of engine (S-mode)
40-716 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of engine (S-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-717
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of engine (S-mode)
S-13 Oil is in coolant (or coolant spurts or coolant level goes down) (PC400-
B40-400-A-Z0-A)
Failure Oil is in coolant (or coolant spurts or coolant level goes down)
Related information • If any failure code is displayed, carry out troubleshooting for it first.
No. Cause Detail of work, remarks Remedy
Perform
troubleshooting for "S-
1 Milky engine oil • Engine oil level rises and oil is milky
16 Water mixes into
engine oil (milky)".
Damaged oil cooler element Replace oil cooler
2 • Check oil cooler element
element
• Coolant in radiator has excessive air
bubbles and blows back.
3 Damaged cylinder head • Overhaul engine and perform a pressure Replace cylinder head
tightness test on cylinder head to check for
abnormalities
• Coolant in radiator has excessive air
Damaged cylinder head bubbles and blows back. Replace cylinder head
4 gasket • Overhaul engine and check cylinder head gasket
gasket for abnormalities
• Engine oil level rises and oil is milky
Cracks or pitting in cylinder • Disassemble engine and check for cracks Replace cylinder block
5
block or pitting in cylinder block
40-718 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of engine (S-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-719
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of engine (S-mode)
Failure Fuel mixes with engine oil (engine oil smells of diluted diesel fuel).
Related • If a failure code is displayed, perform troubleshooting for it first.
information
No. Cause Check item and remarks Remedy
• If exhaust manifold is touched immediately after Replace injector.
starting engine, temperature of some cylinders is
low.
1 Defective injector • Even if a cylinder is cut out, engine speed does not
change.
(Reference: See "Handling cylinder cutout mode
operation" in Testing and adjusting.)
Fuel leakage from • Check injector and O-ring. Replace injector and O-
2 injector and O-ring ring.
(spill circuit)
Defective sealing • Check sealing between injector and injection pipe, Repair or replace.
between injector and injection pipe.
3 and injection pipe,
and cracked
injection pipe
Defective supply • Replace supply pump and see if fuel stops Replace supply pump.
4 pump entering.
40-720 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of engine (S-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-721
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of engine (S-mode)
40-722 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of engine (S-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-723
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of engine (S-mode)
40-724 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of engine (S-mode)
PC210LC-10 40-725
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of engine (S-mode)
40-726 PC210LC-10
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of engine (S-mode)
• If any failure code is displayed, perform troubleshooting for that code first.
Related • Since the time required for manual stationary regeneration depends on the accumulated
information soot level, see failure code CA2639.
PC210LC-10 40-727
40 Troubleshooting
Troubleshooting of engine (S-mode)
40-728 PC210LC-10
SHOP MANUAL
HYDRAULIC EXCAVATOR
PC210LC-10
Model Serial Number
PC210LC-10 50-1
50 Disassembly and assembly
Table of contents
50-2 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Table of contents
PC210LC-10 50-3
50 Disassembly and assembly
General information on disassembly and assembly
Removal and installation of TTTT assembly • Common tools that are necessary for installation
Special tools are described as [1], [2] ... etc. and their part
• Special tools which are necessary for removal or numbers, part names and quantities are not
installation of assemblies are described as described.
A1•••X1 etc. and their part numbers, part names, • Marks shown in the installation section are
necessities, and quantities are described in the explained below.
special tool list. k: This mark indicates safety-related
• Marks used in the column of necessity are precautions which must be followed when
explained below. performing the work.
t: Tools are not substituted, must always be
equipped (used). a : This marks gives guidance or precautions
q: Tools extremely useful if available or tools when performing the work.
that can be substituted with commercially
available tool. 4 : This mark shows the weight of a part or
• For details and the sketches of the special tools, the assembled parts for a device.
see "special tool list" and "sketches of special
tools". 2 : This mark indicates a specific coating
Removal agent to be used.
• In the removal section, the work procedures, 3 : This mark indicates the specified
precautions and know-how to do the work and tightening torque.
the amount of oil and coolant to be drained are
described. 5 : This mark indicates the amount of oil or
• Common tools that are necessary for the coolant to be added.
removal work are indicated as [1], [2] ... etc. and
their part numbers, part names and quantities Disassembly and assembly of TTTT assembly
are not described. Special tools
• Marks used in the removal section are explained • Special tools which are necessary for
below. disassembly and assembly of assemblies are
described as A1•••X1 etc. and their part
k: This mark indicates safety-related numbers, part names, necessities, and
precautions which must be followed when quantities are described in the special tool list.
performing the work. • Marks used in the column of necessity are
explained below.
a : This mark gives guidance or precautions when t: Tools are not substituted, must always be
performing the work. equipped (used).
[*1]: This mark indicates that instructions or q: Tools extremely useful if available or tools
precautions for the assembly installation work are that can be substituted with commercially
given in the installation section. available tool.
• For details and the sketches of the special tools,
6 : This mark shows the amount of oil or see "special tool list" and "sketches of special
coolant to be drained. tools".
Disassembly
4 : This mark shows the weight of a part or • In the disassembly section, the work
the assembled parts for a device. procedures, precautions and know-how to do
Installation the work, and the amount of oil and coolant to be
• Unless otherwise instructed the installation of drained are described.
assemblies is to be made in the reverse order to • Common tools that are necessary for the
removal. disassembly work are indicated as [1], [2] ... etc.
• Instructions and precautions for assembly and their part numbers, part names, and
installation are shown with [*1] mark in the quantities are not described.
removal section, identifying which step the • Marks used in the disassembly section are
instructions are intended for. explained below.
50-4 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
General information on disassembly and assembly
PC210LC-10 50-5
50 Disassembly and assembly
General information on disassembly and assembly
a The recommended coating materials such as adhesives, gasket sealants, and greases used for
disassembly and assembly are listed below.
a For coating materials not listed below, use the equivalent of products shown in this manual.
Adhesive
Komatsu code Part No. Capacity Container Main features and applications
• Use to prevent rubber gaskets, rubber
LT-1A 790-129-9030 150 g Tube cushions, and cork plugs from coming
out.
• Use for plastic (except polyethylene,
20g polypropylene, tetrafluoroethylene, and
Polyethylene vinyl chloride), rubber, metal, and non-
LT-1B 790-129-9050 (2 pcs. container metal parts which require immediate
contained)
and strong adhesion.
• Features: Resistance to heat and
50 g Polyethylene chemicals
LT-2 790-129-9180
container • Use to fix and seal bolts and plugs.
Adhesive:
790-129-9060 1 kg • Use to bond and seal metal, glass and
LT-3 (Set of adhesive Can
Hardener: plastics.
and hardener)
500 g
250 g Polyethylene • Use to seal plugs for blank holes.
LT-4 790-129-9040
container
• Heat-resistant seal used to repair
Holtz MH705 790-129-9120 75 g Tube engines
• Instantaneous adhesive
50 g Polyethylene • Curing time: From 5 sec. to 3 min.
ThreeBond 1735 790-129-9140 • Use mainly to bond metals, rubbers,
container
plastics, and woods.
• Instantaneous adhesive
• Quick-curing type (max. strength is
Aron Alpha 201 2g Polyethylene
790-129-9130 obtained after 30 minutes)
container
• Use mainly to bond rubbers, plastics,
and metals.
• General-purpose instantaneous
adhesive with excellent resistance to
Loctite 499 428-99-80070 20 g Tube heat and impact
• Use on the bushing mounting faces of
axle supports.
• Features: Resistance to heat and
Polyethylene chemicals
Loctite 648-50 79A-129-9110 50 cc • Use for fitted portions used at high
container
temperatures.
50-6 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
General information on disassembly and assembly
Liquid gasket
Komatsu code Part No. Capacity Container Main features and applications
• Use to seal various thread portions,
Polyethylene pipe joints, and flanges.
LG-5 790-129-9080 1 kg
container • Use to seal taper plugs, elbows, and
nipples for hydraulic piping.
• Features: Silicon-based heat and
cold-resistant sealant
200 g • Use to seal thread portions and flange
LG-6 790-129-9160 Tube
surface.
• Use to seal oil pan, final drive case,
etc.
• Features: Silicon-based quick-curing
sealant
LG-7 790-129-9170 1 kg Tube • Use to seal flywheel housing, intake
manifold, oil pan, thermostat housing,
etc.
LG-8 • Features: Silicon-based, heat and
cold-resistant, vibration-resistant,
ThreeBond 419-15-18131 100 g Tube impact-resistant sealant
1207B • Use to seal transfer case, etc.
• Use for rough surfaces such as the
LG-9 circle gear top seal which is not
ThreeBond 790-129-9310 200 g Tube clamped by bolts, gaps in the weld
1206D which must be caulked, etc.
• Can be coated with paint.
LG-10 • Use as lubricant or sealant when the
ThreeBond 790-129-9320 200 g Tube radiator hoses are put on.
1206E • Can be coated with paint.
• Feature: Can be used together with
LG-11 solid gaskets.
790-129-9330 200 g Tube
ThreeBond 1121 • Use for covers of the transmission
case and steering case etc.
ThreeBond 1211 790-129-9090 100 g Tube • Liquid gasket used to repair engine
PC210LC-10 50-7
50 Disassembly and assembly
General information on disassembly and assembly
Grease
Komatsu code Part No. Capacity Container Main features and applications
SYG2-400LI-A
G2-LI SYG2-16LI • Lithium grease with extreme pressure
G0-LI (*) SYGA-16CNLI Various Various lubrication performance, general
*: For cold regions SYG0-400LI-A(*) purpose type
SYG0-16CNLI(*)
• Use for parts under heavy load.
Caution:
• Do not use this grease for rolling
Molybdenum SYG2-400M 400 g x 10 Bellows-type bearings like swing circle bearings,
disulfide grease SYG2-400M-A 400 g x 20 container etc. and splines.
LM-G (G2-M) SYGA-16CNM 16 kg Can • Use this grease for work
equipment pins only when
installing them, but do not use it
afterward.
Hyper White
SYG2-400T • Higher seizure resistant, heat
Grease Bellows-type
SYG2-16CNT 400 g resistant and water resistant than
G2-T container molybdenum disulfide grease.
SYG0-400T(*) 16 kg • Not conspicuous on machine since
G0-T (*) Can
SYG0-16CNT(*) color is white.
*: For cold regions
Bio grease
G2-B SYG2-400B
SYGA-16CNB 400 g Bellows-type • Since this grease is biodegradable in
G2-BT (*) container short period, it has less impact on
*: For use at high SYG2-400BT(*) 16 kg microorganisms, animals, and plants.
Can
temperature and SYGA-16CNBT(*)
under high load
• Silicone grease with wide usable
temperature range, high resistance to
G2-S thermal-oxidative degradation and
— 200 g Tube performance to prevent deterioration
ThreeBond 1855 of rubber and plastic parts
• Use for oil seals of the transmission,
etc.
• Urea (organic system) grease with
heat resistance and long life.
Enclosed type.
G2-U-SENS
427-12-11871 2 kg Can • Use for rubber, bearing and oil seal in
grease
damper.
Caution: Do not mix it with lithium
grease.
50-8 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
General information on disassembly and assembly
Primer
Komatsu code Part No. Capacity Container Main features and applications
Glass • Use to accelerate hardening of
Loctite 712 428-99-80080 100 ml
container instantaneous adhesive.
• Use as primer for painted cab
Sunstar Paint Glass sheet metal surface.
Primer 580 Super 20 ml (Effective period: 4 months after
container
manufacture)
417-926-3910
• Use as primer for cab glass
Sunstar Glass Glass surface.
20 ml
Adhesive
Komatsu code Part No. Capacity Container Main features and applications
• Use "S" in high temperature
season and "W" in low
Sunstar Penguin
For adhering cab glass
Caulking material
Komatsu code Part No. Capacity Container Main features and applications
• Use to seal joints of glass parts.
Sunstar Penguin Polyethylene
For adhering cab glass
PC210LC-10 50-9
50 Disassembly and assembly
General information on disassembly and assembly
a Tools with part number 79*T-***-**** are not supplied (to be locally manufactured).
a Necessity
t:Tools are not substituted, must always be equipped (used).
q: Tools extremely useful if available or tools that can be substituted with commercially available tool.
a New/Redesign
N: Tools with new part numbers, newly developed for this model.
R: Tools, with advanced part numbers, developed by improving existing tools for other models.
Blank: Tools already available for other models that can be used without any modification
a Tools marked with Q in the sketch column have the sketches. ((See “Sketches of special tools“.)
New/Redesign
Necessity
Sketch
Sym- Detail of work,
Q'ty
Work item Part No. Part Name
bol remarks
50-10 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
General information on disassembly and assembly
New/Redesign
Necessity
Sketch
Sym- Detail of work,
Q'ty
Work item Part No. Part Name
bol remarks
Removal and
1 796-427-1400 Wrench assembly t 1 installation of ring
nut
Installation of
2 796-427-1520 Installer t 1
floating seal
796T-427-1510 Push tool t 1 Q
790-101-2510 Block t 1
790-101-3310 Plate t 1
Disassembly and 790-101-2610 Leg t 2
assembly of final drive F 790-101-2730 Adapter t 2
Installation of hub
3 01580-11613 Nut t 2 assembly
790-101-2570 Plate t 2
01643-31645 Washer t 2
Puller (294 kN {30
790-101-2102 ton}) t 1
790-101-1102 Pump t 1
Tightening of cover
4 790-331-1110 Wrench t 1
mounting bolt
Press fit of main
1 796T-426-1410 Push tool t 1 Q bearing
Disassembly and Press fit of sub
2 796-426-1120 Push tool t 1
assembly of swing G bearing
machinery 796T-426-1130 Plate t 1 Q
3 790-101-5421 Grip t 1 Press fit of oil seal
01010-81240 Bolt t 1
Disassembly and Installation of
assembly of idler J 791-530-1510 Installer t 1
floating seal
Disassembly and Installation of
K 796-670-1020 Installer t 1
assembly of track roller floating seal
Disassembly and Installation of
L 790-434-1660 Installer t 1
assembly of carrier roller floating seal
791-600-2001 Compressor (A) t 1
or
Compressor (B) t 1
791-685-8006
790-201-2780 Spacer t 1 Disassembly and
1 791-635-3160 Extension t 1 assembly of idler
Cylinder (686 kN {70 cushion
790-101-1600 t 1
ton})
790-101-1102 Pump t 1
Disassembly and
assembly of idler M 790-640-2180 Guide bolt t 1
cushion 790-101-5201 Push tool kit (B) q 1
790-101-5241 • Plate 1
2 Press fit of bushing
790-101-5221 • Grip 1
01010-51225 • Bolt 2
790-201-1500 Push tool KIT q 1
790-201-1620 • Plate 1 Press fit of dust
3
790-101-5021 • Grip 1 seal
01010-50816 • Bolt 2
PC210LC-10 50-11
50 Disassembly and assembly
General information on disassembly and assembly
New/Redesign
Necessity
Sketch
Sym- Detail of work,
Q'ty
Work item Part No. Part Name
bol remarks
50-12 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
General information on disassembly and assembly
New/Redesign
Necessity
Sketch
Sym- Detail of work,
Q'ty
Work item Part No. Part Name
bol remarks
796-946-1330 Sleeve
t 1
(for 723-46-40100)
796-946-1630 Sleeve
t 1
(for 723-46-41100)
796-946-1830 Sleeve Replacement of
Disassembly and t 1
(for 723-46-43100 and 723-46-43400) pressure
assembly of control T 3
796-946-1930 Sleeve compensation
valve t 1
(for 723-46-46101 and 723-46-46300) valve seal
796-946-2230 Sleeve
t 1
(for 723-46-45100)
796-946-1430 Sleeve
t 1
(for 723-46-42700)
790–502–1003 Cylinder repair stand q 1 Disassembly and
1 assembly of work
790–101–1102 Pump q 1 equipment cylinder
790–102–4300 Wrench assembly t 1 Removal and
2 installation of
790–102–4310 Pin t 1 piston ring
3 790–720–1000 Expander q 1
Rubber band (for
796–720–1670 boom and bucket) q 1
Installation of
4 07281–01279 Clamp q 1 piston ring
796–720–1680 Rubber band (for arm) q 1
Disassembly and 07281–01589 Clamp q 1
assembly of work U 790–201–1702 Push tool KIT t 1
equipment cylinder
• Push tool (for boom
790-201–1841 and bucket) 1
5 Press fit of bushing
790–201–1851 • Push tool (for arm) 1
790–101–5021 Grip 1
01010–50816 Bolt 2
790–201–1500 Push tool KIT t 1
• Plate (for boom
790–201–1650 and bucket) 1
Press fit of dust
6
790–201–1660 • Plate (for arm) 1 seal
790–101–5021 • Grip 1
01010–50816 • Bolt 2
796-900-1200 Remover t 1
796-900-1210 • Sleeve 1
792-900-1520 • Plate 1
799-900-1230 • Screw 1
Removal and installation 796-900-1240 • Adapter 1 Removal of boom
of work equipment V 01643-33080 • Washer 1 foot pin
assembly 01803-13034 • Nut 1
Puller (490 kN {50 ton}
790-101-4000 long) t 1
Pump (294 kN {30
790-101-1102 ton}) t 1
PC210LC-10 50-13
50 Disassembly and assembly
General information on disassembly and assembly
New/Redesign
Necessity
Sketch
Sym- Detail of work,
Q'ty
Work item Part No. Part Name
bol remarks
50-14 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
General information on disassembly and assembly
Note: Komatsu does not take any responsibility for special tools manufactured according to these sketches.
A9: Plate
PC210LC-10 50-15
50 Disassembly and assembly
General information on disassembly and assembly
Note: Komatsu does not take any responsibility for special tools manufactured according to these sketches.
G1: Push tool
G3: Plate
50-16 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
General information on disassembly and assembly
PC210LC-10 50-17
50 Disassembly and assembly
General information on disassembly and assembly
50-18 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
a Special tools
Necessity
Symbol
Q'ty
Part No. Part Name
A 1 795-799-6130 Support t 1
Removal (PC200_10-AD70-520-K-00-A)
5. Disconnect fuel filter hoses (7) and (8) from
1. Close the cock of fuel stop valve (1). supply pump assembly (20). [*1]
a While pressing locks (L) on both sides, pull
the hose in the direction of (a).
PC210LC-10 50-19
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
50-20 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
PC210LC-10 50-21
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
[*7]
Install gear (22) according to the following
[*5] procedure.
3 Spill tube (16) mounting bolt: a Clean and dry the mating surfaces on shaft (24)
24 ± 4 Nm {2.45 ± 0.41 kgm} and gear (22) so that the surfaces are free of dirt
and foreign material.
3 Tube clamp (15) mounting bolt: 1. Install gear (22) to shaft (24).
24 ± 4 Nm {2.45 ± 0.41 kgm} 2. Install lock washer (23) and nut (21) and finger-
[*6] tighten the nut.
Install supply pump assembly (20).
a If too much grease is applied to O-ring (18), it will
ooze out. Accordingly, do not apply grease so
much. (Apply grease to the O-ring groove area
of part B.)
a When installing new supply pump mounting stud
bolts (25) to replace the existing ones, apply
LOCTITE to them.
3 Stud bolt:
12 ± 2 Nm {1.2 ± 0.2 kgm}
50-22 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
• Bleeding air
Bleed air from the fuel system. For details, see
Testing and adjusting,“Bleeding air from fuel
system“ .
PC210LC-10 50-23
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
a Special tools
Necessity
Symbol
Q'ty
Part No. Part Name
2 795-799-6700 Puller t 1
A 3 795-799-1131 Gear t 1
4 795-799-8150 Remover q 1
50-24 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
PC210LC-10 50-25
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
50-26 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
PC210LC-10 50-27
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
4] There is a worn part or an uneven seat 9) Tighten mounting bolts (53) of holder (54)
contact mark on seating face (e) at the alternately.
top end of the inlet connector. 3 Holder mounting bolt:
a If high-pressure fuel leaks through the 8 ± 0.8 Nm {0.82 ± 0.08 kgm}
inlet connector, the seal face has fine 10)Tighten retaining nut (51) of inlet connector
streaks or cracks. (52).
3 Retaining nut (51) (tightening to
the specified torque):
50 ± 5 Nm {5.1 ± 0.5 kgm}
50-28 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
a When reusing the crosshead, install the a If injector wiring harness connector (60) is
same intake and exhaust valves in the removed, apply liquid gasket LG-7 to O-
same direction because the shapes of its ring (61) and flange (62) of the connector.
holes (a) and (b) are different, Apply a bead of liquid gasket, f3 mm in
diameter to the O-ring so that the ring
groove is completely covered.
If the O-ring is damaged, replace it and
the wiring harness assembly as a unit.
2 O-ring and flange face of
connector:
Liquid gasket (LG-7)
3 Connector flange mounting bolt
(63):
10 ± 2 Nm {1 ± 0.2 kgm}
PC210LC-10 50-29
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
50-30 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
PC210LC-10 50-31
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
[*4]
3 Mounting bolt:
34 ± 5 Nm {3.5 ± 0.5 kgm}
[*5]
Radiator hose fitting length: 50 mm
3 Hose clamp:
10.8 to 11.8 Nm {1.1 to 1.2 kgm}
Perform the following installation in the reverse • Refilling of coolant
order to removal. Supply coolant through the coolant filler to the
specified level. Run the engine to circulate the
[*1]
coolant through the system. Then, check the
3 Hose clamp: coolant level again.
10.5 ± 0.5 Nm {1.1 ± 0.05 kgm}
5 Coolant: (Engine coolant)
[*2]
30.7 l
a Use an open-head type torque wrench when
installing EGR piping flange (11). It is difficult to
tighten by using a common type torque wrench.
3 Mounting bolt (10):
24 ± 4 Nm {2.45 ± 0.41 kgm}
[*3]
• Hose (15): KVGT control pressure circuit
50-32 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
a Special tools
Necessity
Symbol
Q'ty
Part No. Part Name
2
795-799-6700 Puller t 1
3
795-799-1131 Gear t 1
4
795-799-8150 Remover q 1
A 5
790-331-1120 Wrench (Angle) q 1
6
795-790-4510 Gauge q 1
Commercially Long socket (7/16 4. Remove mounting bolts (118) (10 pieces) and
12 in) q 1 (119) (5 pieces) from frame (6) and cover (117).
available
Removal (PC200_10-A100-520-K-00-A)
6 Coolant:
30.7 l
PC210LC-10 50-33
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
50-34 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
16.Disconnect dipstick pipe (21). 24.Disconnect wiring harness connectors (30), (31),
17.Disconnect tubes (22) and (23). and (32).
18.Remove bottom bracket (24) of the EGR valve.
a After the disconnection, move wiring harness
19.Remove EGR valve (25).
(33) toward the counterweight.
PC210LC-10 50-35
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
4 KVGT:
25 kg
50-36 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
PC210LC-10 50-37
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
50-38 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
68.By using tool A2, remove fuel injector assembly Installation (PC200_10-A100-720-K-00-A)
(96). 1. Cylinder head assembly
a Take care that dirt and foreign matter do not 1) Measure nominal length (a) of all the cylinder
enter the mounting portion of the injector head mounting bolts to check that each falls
assembly. within the using limit.
• Using limit length of bolt: less than 132.1
mm
PC210LC-10 50-39
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
50-40 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
1) Install O-ring (106) and gasket (107) to a If high-pressure fuel leaks through the
injector (105). inlet connector, the seal face has fine
streaks or cracks.
a Replace the O-ring and gasket with new
ones.
2) Apply engine oil to O-ring (106) of injector
(105) and the cylinder head side surface.
2 O-ring (106) of injector (105) and
the head side:
Engine oil (EO15W-40)
3) Engage the male and female parts at (A) to
install holder (95) to injector (105).
PC210LC-10 50-41
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
50-42 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
6. Head cover
1) Install the gasket and then install head cover
(85) with mounting nuts (84).
1) Tighten common rail (125) and high pressure
3 Mounting nut: pipes (34) to (39) lightly.
24 ± 4 Nm {2.45 ± 0.41 kgm}
PC210LC-10 50-43
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
50-44 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
PC210LC-10 50-45
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
5) Install fan belt (64). 6) Install air conditioner compressor belt (111).
a Insert a wrench to the portion (A) (width a See Testing and adjusting, “Checking and
across flats T 12.7 mm) of the tensioner adjusting air conditioner compressor belt
assembly (65), and rotate it to the tension“.
counter-direction (R) to the winding-up
direction to decrease fan belt (64) tension,
then install.
50-46 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
3 Sleeve nut:
24 ± 4 Nm {2.45 ± 0.41 kgm}
4 KVGT:
25 kg
3 Mounting nut:
43 ± 6 Nm {4.4 ± 0.6 kgm}
6) Fit a new gasket and install KVGT return
tube (58).
3 Hose clamp:
5 ± 1 Nm {0.5 ± 0.1 kgm}
3 Mounting bolt:
24 ± 4 Nm {2.45 ± 0.41 kgm}
PC210LC-10 50-47
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
4 Base bracket:
25 kg
50-48 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
2) Install hose clamp (44), wiring harness clamp 3 Mounting nut for intake air heater
(45), and tube clamp (46) to base bracket connector:
(42). 3.4 to 4.6 Nm {0.34 to 0.47 kgm}
3) Lightly tighten tube support bracket (43). 4) Install wiring harness connector and harness
clamp (27).
3 Mounting bolt (at intake assembly
side face):
24 ± 4 Nm {2.45 ± 0.41 kgm}
3 Mounting bolt (at intake assembly
top):
43 ± 6 Nm {4.4 ± 0.6 kgm}
5) Install air hose (26).
• MIKALOR clamps
a Use a new clamp.
1] Set the hose to the original (marked)
position.
13.EGR valve a Reference
1) Install gasket (64). Air hose fitting length: 80 mm (both
a Note the orientation of the part number upper and lower sides)
tag when installing the gasket. 2] Set the bridge (BR) under the clamp
bolt and lap it over band (BD) by at
least 5 mm (b).
Dimension (b) : Min. 5 mm
PC210LC-10 50-49
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
[*4]
• Hose (15): KVGT control pressure circuit
3 Sleeve nut:
25 ± 1.5 Nm {2.6 ± 0.15 kgm}
• Hose (16): KVGT actuator drive pressure circuit
3 Sleeve nut:
15 ± 1 Nm {1.5 ± 0.1 kgm}
50-50 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
• Refilling of coolant
PC210LC-10 50-51
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
5 Coolant(Engine coolant):
30.7 l (For details,see “Table of fuel,
coolant and lubricants“.)
50-52 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
Removal (PC200_10-B220-520-K-00-A)
6 Coolant:
30.7 l
4. Disconnect radiator hose (3). [*1]
a In order to indicate the original position of the
hose, put a mark of the hose-end on the
radiator.
5. Open engine hood (6) and disconnect reservoir
tank hose (7). 14.Lift and remove radiator assembly (20). [*3]
6. Disconnect hose clamp (8). a Carefully lift the radiator assembly so that its
7. Disconnect radiator hose (10) and aeration hose lower part is not caught.
(11). [*2]
8. Remove cover (12). 4 Radiator assembly:
9. Remove cover (13).
23 kg
PC210LC-10 50-53
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
5 Coolant(Engine coolant):
30.7 l (For details,see “Table of fuel,
coolant and lubricants“.)
Installation (PC200_10-B220-720-K-00-A)
• Refilling of coolant
Supply coolant through the coolant filler to the
specified level. Run the engine to circulate the
coolant through the system. Then, check the
coolant level again.
50-54 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
Necessity
Symbol
R1 and R2.
Q'ty
Part No. Part Name
Removal (PC200_10-B8P0-520-K-00-A)
6 Hydraulic tank:
132 l
PC210LC-10 50-55
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
9. Open engine hood (9) and disconnect reservoir 17.Disconnect inlet tube (21) of the hydraulic oil
tank hose (10). cooler and move it aside so that it does not
10.Remove covers (11) and (12). interfere with the hydraulic oil cooler.
11.Remove brackets (13) and (14).
50-56 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
• Refilling of oil
a Before supplying oil, check that the oil cooler
drain plug is securely tightened.
a Supply hydraulic oil through the oil filler port to
the specified level. Run the engine to circulate
the oil through the piping. Then, check the oil
level again.
5 Hydraulic tank:
132 l
PC210LC-10 50-57
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
Removal (PC200_10-A9A0-520-K-00-A)
4 Aftercooler assembly:
1. Open engine hood (1) and remove cover (2). 10 kg
50-58 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
PC210LC-10 50-59
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
a Special tools
Necessity
Symbol
Q'ty
Part No. Part Name
9 796T-401-1110 Plate q 1
10 795-799-9300 Lifting tool q 1
A
Commercially Long socket (7/16
12 in) q 1
available
1 796-460-1210 Oil stopper q 1
R
2 796-770-1320 Adapter q 1
k Park the machine on a level ground, lower 3. Drain the coolant through drain valve. (Drain
the work equipment to the ground stably, and hose: inside diameter f7 mm)
stop the engine.
6 Coolant:
k Set the lock lever in the LOCK position.
30.7 l
k Release the remaining pressure in the 4. Open the R.H. side cover of the machine and
hydraulic circuit. For details, see Testing and remove rubber-lined cover (4).
adjusting, referring to "Releasing remaining
pressure from hydraulic circuit".
Removal (PC200_10-R400-520-K-00-A)
6 Hydraulic tank:
132 l
50-60 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
4 Frame:
11 kg
4 Base bracket:
25 kg
PC210LC-10 50-61
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
50-62 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
PC210LC-10 50-63
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
50-64 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
PC210LC-10 50-65
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
48.Disconnect connector E10 (87). 53.Sling and remove the engine and main pump
49.Disconnect connectors E08 (88) and P44 (89). assembly (94).
50.Disconnect clamp (90).
a Attach the sling to two points on the engine
and to one point on the main pump when
removing the assembly.
a Before removing the assembly, check that all
wiring and piping are disconnected.
6 Damper case:
0.65 l
50-66 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
2) Remove fuel filter bracket (96) and a V-clamp can be reused, however, replace it with
disconnect fuel filter (97) a new one in the following conditions.
3) Set slings to main pump assembly (95), • Deformation of V-clamp
remove housing mounting bolts (98), and • Damage on T-bolt thread portion
then remove main pump assembly (95). • Crack at V groove
• Peeling at V groove
4 Main pump:
190 kg
[*3]
Install the hoses and tubes to the KVGT according
to the following procedures.
[*2] 1. Install tube (56).
Install tube (15) with V-clamp by using tool A12 3 V-clamp:
(long socket).
7 ± 1.1 Nm {0.7 ± 0.11 kgm}
• MIKALOR clamps
a Use a new clamp.
1) Set the hose to the original position
(marked position).
a Reference
Air hose fitting length: 50 mm
(aftercooler end)
Air hose fitting length: 40 mm (KVGT
end)
PC210LC-10 50-67
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
2) Set the bridge (BR) under the clamp bolt When installing a connector of quick coupler type,
and lap it over band (BD) by at least 5 observe the following points.
mm (b).
a The internal parts of the fitting may be damaged
Dimension (b): Min. 5 mm
when the hose or tube is removed. Accordingly,
2 Clamp bolt thread portion (BC): do not reuse the hose or tube.
Lubricant (THREEBOND When installing, replace it with a new one.
PANDO 18B)
a Ensure that mud or dirt is not sticking to the hose
a Impact wrench is not allowed to use. joint portions in advance.
• If hoses are to be reused
Install the clamp to the clamp mark put on a Push the connector straight (in the direction of
the hose. (b)). Do not pry it in or shake it.
If it is difficult to insert the connector, do not push
3 Clamp bolt:
it in forcibly but pull it out. Then, check the male
Min. 6 Nm {0.6 kgm} and female couplings for damage and sticking
• When using a new hose mud.
Tighten the clamp so that BDG dimension is
as follows.
BDG: 7 to 10 mm
[*5]
3 Fuel return hose mounting bolt:
2. Install hose (57). 19.6 to 29.4 Nm {2.0 to 3.0 kgm}
3 Hose clamp: [*6]
10.0 to 11.0 Nm {1.02 to 1.12 kgm} 3 Fuel supply hose mounting bolt:
3. Install hose (58).
25.4 to 34.3 Nm {2.6 to 3.5 kgm}
3 Hose clamp: [*7]
4.4 ± 0.49 Nm {0.45 ± 0.05 kgm}
3 Mounting nut for intake air heater
4. Install hose (54).
connector:
3 Hose clamp: 3.4 to 4.6 Nm {0.34 to 0.47 kgm}
3.3 ± 0.49 Nm {0.34 ± 0.05 kgm} [*8]
5. Install hose (53).
Install fan belt (64).
a Insert a wrench to the portion (A) (width across
flats: 12.7 mm) of the tensioner assembly (65),
and rotate it to the counter-direction (R) to the
winding-up direction to decrease fan belt (64)
tension, then install.
k Firmly set the wrench on tensioner assembly
(65) at portion (A) before applying turning
force to the wrench. (The spring of tensioner
assembly (65) is strong. If the wrench is
loosely inserted, the wrench can accidentally
come off and this is extremely dangerous.)
[*4]
50-68 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
[*9]
After fan (71) is installed, check the clearance (d)
between the fan blade tips and shroud (100). If the
clearance is out of the standard value range, loosen
six mounting bolts (101) and adjust the position of
the shroud.
• Blade tip clearance (at top/bottom/left/right of [*12]
shroud) 1. Install hose (76).
d: Min. 13 mm
a Note that the hose mounting clips are hard to
remove and install.
2. Install hose (75).
3 Hose clamp:
10.8 to 11.8 Nm {1.1 to 1.2 kgm}
[*10][*11]
Install alternator (66) according to the following
procedure.
PC210LC-10 50-69
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
[*13]
Install terminal B (85) and terminal C (86) to the
starting motor.
3 Terminal B (85):
[*15]
17.7 to 24.5 Nm {1.8 to 2.5 kgm}
2 Main pump involute splines:
3 Terminal C (86):
Molybdenum disulfide grease (LM-G)
2.6 to 4.6 Nm {0.27 to 0.47 kgm}
2 Mating face on main pump case:
Liquid gasket (LG-6)
a Take care not to torque the bolts excessively
since the flywheel housing is made of aluminum.
a Impact wrench is not allowed to use.
a Reference
3 Engine mounting bracket bolts (four
places) (99):
122.5 to 147 Nm {12.5 to 15 kgm}
[*14]
a The bolt length to be used on the engine front
side is shorter than that on the rear side.
a The size of the engine mounting rubber to be
used on the engine front side is smaller than that
on rear side.
a Reference
Overview of the fitting depths of the air hoses
and radiator hoses.
50-70 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
5 Damper case:
0.65 l
3 Damper case drain plug:
45 ± 5 Nm {4.6 ± 0.5 kgm}
• Refilling of oil (hydraulic tank)
Supply hydraulic oil through the oil filler port to
the specified level. Run the engine to circulate
the oil through the piping. Then, check the oil
level again.
5 Hydraulic tank:
132 l
3 Hydraulic tank drain plug:
68.6 ± 9.8 Nm {7.0 ± 1.0 kgm}
• Refilling of coolant
Supply coolant through the coolant filler port to
the specified level. Run the engine to circulate
the coolant through the system. Then, check the
coolant level again.
PC210LC-10 50-71
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
a Special tools
Necessity
Symbol
Q'ty
Part No. Part Name
Removal (PC200_10-A350-520-K-00-A)
50-72 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
PC210LC-10 50-73
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
50-74 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
[*2]
a See Testing and adjusting, “Checking and
adjusting air conditioner compressor belt
tension“.
[*3]
Install fan belt (18).
a Insert a wrench to the portion (A) (width across
flats: 12.7 mm) of the tensioner assembly (19),
and rotate it to the counter-direction (R) to the
winding-up direction to decrease fan belt (18)
tension, then install.
k Firmly set the wrench on tensioner assembly
(19) at portion (A) before applying turning
force to the wrench. (The spring of tensioner
assembly (19) is strong. If the wrench is
loosely inserted, the wrench can accidentally
come off and this is extremely dangerous.)
PC210LC-10 50-75
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
a Special tools
Necessity
Symbol
Q'ty
Part No. Part Name
Removal (PC220-A510-520-K-00-A)
Installation (PC220-A510-720-K-00-A)
6. Sling and remove flywheel assembly (4). [*2]
4 Flywheel assembly: 1. Install the engine rear oil seal (5) according to
the following procedure.
35 kg
a Do not remove pilot [4] which is attached to
engine rear oil seal (5) until engine rear oil
seal (5) is installed to the crankshaft.
50-76 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
4. Use tool A8 to install engine rear oil seal (5) to a Use plate [5] to prevent the flywheel assembly
the proper depth in flywheel housing (7). from rotating when tightening the bolts.
a Push in engine rear oil seal (5) with care not
to bend it.
a Extrusion of engine rear oil seal (5) from
flywheel housing (7)
X: Max. 0.38 mm
[*2]
• Measuring radial runout
a Radial runout: Max. 0.13 mm
1. Install dial gauge [6] on the stand, and set
the stand on flywheel housing (7).
PC210LC-10 50-77
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
50-78 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
Installation (PC200_10-B7W0-720-K-00-A)
PC210LC-10 50-79
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
Removal (PC200_10-AD10-520-K-00-A)
1. Remove undercovers (1) and (2). a The lower mounting end of handrail (6) is
fixed to the inside of tool case (7).
50-80 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
10.Remove grease gun (14) and grease gun 15.Remove four mounting bolts (19), then remove
mounting bracket (15). cover (27).
11.Disconnect connector L02 (16) for the R.H. 16.Remove four mounting bolts (28), then remove
headlamp wiring. cover (29).
12.Remove R.H. headlamp cover (17). [*1]
13.Remove four tool case mounting bolts (18).
4 Tool case:
35 kg
PC210LC-10 50-81
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
• Bleeding air
Bleed air from the fuel system. For details, see
Testing and adjusting, "Bleeding air from fuel
system".
Installation (PC220-AD10-720-K-00-A)
50-82 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
Removal (PC200_10-H540-520-K-00-A)
4 Engine hood:
48 kg
PC210LC-10 50-83
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
a Lightly tighten the bolts to the degree that the • As seen through hole (B), clearance (b)
engine hood does not move to the right and between bracket (13) and the engine hood
left, and back and forth when it is opened must be large enough to avoid interference.
and closed.
a Keep the engine hood slung after installation
to perform adjustments.
50-84 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
PC210LC-10 50-85
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
a Special tools
Necessity
Symbol
Q'ty
Part number Part name
50-86 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
6. Remove three mounting bolts (20) and one 10.Remove the double nuts and washers, then
mounting bolt (21). remove U-bolts (13).
7. Sling and remove KDPF bracket assembly (8).
a Loosen nuts alternately to prevent U-bolt
a When slinging, hook it to sling plate (29). thread galling.
a Pay attention to the gasket at the tube
connection that may fall away during the
removal.
PC210LC-10 50-87
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
Installation (PC200_10-A9H0-720-K-00-A)
50-88 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
PC210LC-10 50-89
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
50-90 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
PC210LC-10 50-91
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
3) Tighten first nut (27) of the double-nuts on U- a When tightening nuts (27) and (28) at
bolts (13) evenly (4 places). (A) part and (B) part, install spanner-
shaped head to torque wrench (head
3 U-bolt tightening nut (first):
exchangeable) and perform the work.
7.6 to 13.3 Nm {0.78 to 1.36 kgm}
4) Tighten second nut (28) of the double-nuts
on U-bolts (13) evenly (4 places).
a When nut (28) is chamfered only one side,
install it with its chamfered side
downward.
3 U-bolt tightening nut (second):
19.6 to 29.4 Nm {2.0 to 3.0 kgm}
50-92 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
3) Insert eye-joint (15) into KDPF water drain 7) Insert connectors E25 (1) and E26 (2) into
tube (18) and install it to the KDPF assembly. their mating sensor connectors, and push in
the red lever to lock them.
a Tighten bolt by holding the eye-joint so as
not to make any deformation on the tube.
• Tube insertion length (b) : 32 mm
3 eye-joint mounting bolt:
24.5 to 34.3 Nm {2.5 to 3.5 kgm}
PC210LC-10 50-93
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
a Special tools
Necessity
Symbol
Q'ty
Part No. Part Name
Disassembly (PC220-A9H0-530-K-00-A)
• Outlet side
50-94 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
3. Disconnect connectors of KDOC inlet 4. Remove KDOC outlet temperature sensor (2),
temperature sensor (1), KDOC outlet and KDPF outlet temperature sensor (3).
temperature sensor (2), and KDPF outlet • Width across flats of the nut for temperature
temperature sensor (3) from sensor table (13). sensor: 14 mm
a Close the sensor mounting portions with
plugs [2].
Plug [2] screw size: M12 x 1.25
PC210LC-10 50-95
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
3) Remove differential pressure sensor pipes 8. When replacing KDPF filter (16), remove sensor
(5) and (6). table (13) and hanger (15) according to the
following procedure.
a Since the tube is inserted inside of CSF,
pull out pipe (5) upright. 1) Remove band (12) by using tool A12 (long
socket) to remove sensor table (13).
2) Remove band (14) by using tool A12 (long
socket) to remove hanger (15).
• Width across flats of band (12), (14)
tightening nut: 7/16 in (11.1 mm)
3) Remove the plug from KDPF filter assembly
(11), if so attached.
50-96 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
PC210LC-10 50-97
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
3) Tighten V-clamp (7) lightly according to the a When assembling outlet body (10) and
marking put before removal and the angle KDPF filter assembly (11), take care that
shown below. gasket (18) does not come out.
• Width across flats of V-clamp fastening 6) Tighten V-clamp (8) lightly according to the
nut: 1/2 in (12.7 mm) marking put before removal and the angle
• Mounting angle of V-clamp T-bolt: 35 ± 5° shown below.
• Mounting angle of V-clamps (7) and (8) • Width across flats of V-clamp fastening
nut: 1/2 in (12.7 mm)
• Mounting angle of V-clamp T-bolt: 35 ± 5°
• Mounting angle of V-clamps (7) and (8)
50-98 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
PC210LC-10 50-99
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
• Width across flats of band (12) fastening 3 Thread portion of temperature sensor:
nut: 7/16 in (11.1 mm) Seizure prevention compound (LC-G)
3 Band (12) fastening nut: • Width across flats of the nut for temperature
6.3 to 8.3 Nm {0.6 to 0.8 kgm} sensor: 14 mm
2) Install connectors of differential pressure 3 Temperature sensor mounting nut:
sensor pipes (5) and (6) to differential
24 to 36 Nm {2.5 to 3.7 kgm}
pressure sensor (19).
a Push in fitting of connectors until locking
sound is heard.
3) Install differential pressure sensor pipes (5)
and (6).
• Width across flats of the nut for Hi side
pipe (5): 11/16 in (17.46 mm)
3 Hi side pipe (5) mounting nut:
24.5 to 36.5 Nm {2.5 to 3.7 kgm}
• Width across flats of the nut for Lo side
pipe (6): 5/8 in (15.88 mm)
3 Lo side pipe (6) mounting nut: 6. Install connectors of KDOC inlet temperature
13.6 to 19 Nm {1.39 to 1.9 kgm} sensor (1), KDOC outlet temperature sensor (2),
and KDPF outlet temperature sensor (3) to
sensor table (13).
a Do not install connectors at wrong positions.
50-100 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
PC210LC-10 50-101
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
Removal (PC200_10-A180-520-K-00-A)
50-102 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
Installation (PC200_10-A180-720-K-00-A)
PC210LC-10 50-103
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
• Dimensions of blowby gas inlet hose (5) and • Dimension of oil drain hse (6) (KCCV ventilator
(19) (junction block side), and blowby gas outlet side) is as follows.
hose (7) (tube side) are as follows. (Figure Hose fitting length (b): 25 mm
shows blowby gas outlet hose (7) as an Between hose end and clamp (c): 5 mm
example.)
Hose fitting length (b): 30 mm
Between hose end and clamp (c): 5 mm
50-104 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
a Reference
When removing, installing or replacing check
valve (17) from oil drain hose (6), install check
valve (17) with its gray part to the KCCV side as
shown on the L.H. side of the figure.
3 Hose clamp:
3.3 ± 0.49 Nm {0.34 ± 0.05 kgm}
PC210LC-10 50-105
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
Removal (PC200_10-A910-520-K-00-A)
50-106 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
Installation (PC220-A910-720-K-00-A)
a Plug the opening of the air cleaner with vinyl till a Installation of air cleaner assembly
just before installing air cleaner to prevent the If rubber ring (16) is detached, install it to tube
dust from entering. (13) beforehand.
Perform the rest of installation in the reverse order 3 Band fastening nut (10):
to removal. 10.0 to 11.0 Nm {1.02 to 1.12 kgm}
[*1]
3 Band fastening nut (11):
a Installation of cover 8.8 to 10.8 Nm {0.9 to 1.1 kgm}
Insert covers (15) and (5) to fit mating surface of
sponge (7) and install.
PC210LC-10 50-107
50 Disassembly and assembly
Engine and cooling system
50-108 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Power train
Removal and installation of travel motor and final drive assembly (PC220-DF10-
924-K-00-A)
Removal (PC200_10-DF10-520-K-00-A)
PC210LC-10 50-109
50 Disassembly and assembly
Power train
Necessity
Symbol
Q'ty
Part No. Part Name
4 Cover:
25 kg
a If ring gear (12) is slung together with the
cover, gently tap the ring gear off the cover
by using a plastic hammer.
3. Washer
Remove washer (2).
4. No. 1 planetary carrier assembly
6. Ring gear
Remove ring gear (12).
50-110 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Power train
4 Ring gear:
45 kg
7. Thrust washer
Remove thrust washer (13).
8. No. 2 sun gear
Remove No. 2 sun gear (14).
11.Ring nut
1) Remove lock plate (24).
2) By using tool F1, remove ring nut (25).
9. Thrust washer
Remove thrust washer (15).
10.No. 2 planetary carrier assembly
1) Remove No. 2 planetary carrier assembly
(16).
12.Hub assembly
1) Using eyebolts [2], sling and remove hub
assembly (26) from the travel motor.
4 Hub assembly:
80 kg
PC210LC-10 50-111
50 Disassembly and assembly
Power train
50-112 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Power train
PC210LC-10 50-113
50 Disassembly and assembly
Power train
6. Ring nut
1) Install the ring nut according to the following
procedure.
1] Rotate the hub two to three times.
2] Use tool F3 and push tool [5] to press the
inner race of bearing (27).
a Pressing force:
29.4 to 38.2 kN {3.0 to 3.9 ton}
3] Rotate the hub to the both directions at
least five times in total with the bearing
inner race pressed.
4] Release the pressing force.
5] Press the bearing again. 2) Measure the tangential force of the hub
against the motor case in the rotation
a Pressing force: direction using the push scale [6].
17.7 to 21.6 kN {1.8 to 2.2 ton} a Tangential force:
6] Rotate the hub two to three times.
Max. 490 N {50 kg}
a The tangential force denotes the
maximum force at start of the rotation.
50-114 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Power train
PC210LC-10 50-115
50 Disassembly and assembly
Power train
12.Ring gear 2] Align the pin holes in shaft (5) and the No.
1) Install the O-ring to the hub. 1 planetary carrier, and install the shaft
2) Install ring gear (12) on the hub. (5) by tapping it lightly with a plastic
hammer.
4 Ring gear: a Install the shaft, while rotating No. 1
45 kg planetary gear (8) with care not to
damage the thrust washer.
a Degrease the mating faces of the ring gear
3] Insert pin (4).
and hub. Do not apply liquid gasket on the
mating faces. a When inserting the pin, take care that
the three claws (parts (f)) on the
a Align the bolt holes of the ring gear with
periphery of the pin will not be placed
those of the hub.
on the thin-wall parts of No. 1
planetary carrier (parts (g)). The thin-
wall part may be on the opposite side
depending on carriers. Check each
carrier and avoid setting any claw of
the pin to the thin-wall part. If there is
a groove, avoid the groove.
a After assembling the carrier, check
that No. 1 planetary gear (8) rotates
smoothly.
a After the pin is inserted, punch the
pins (C) on the carrier at 2 locations.
50-116 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Power train
16.Refilling of oil
Tighten drain plug and supply power train oil
(TO30) from the oil filler port.
15.Cover
1) Using eyebolts [1], install cover (1).
4 Cover:
25 kg
PC210LC-10 50-117
50 Disassembly and assembly
Power train
50-118 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Power train
PC210LC-10 50-119
50 Disassembly and assembly
Power train
Installation (PC220-J120-720-K-00-A)
50-120 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Power train
a Special tools
Necessity
Symbol
Q'ty
Part No. Part Name
4 Swing motor:
55 kg
a Put match marks on swing motor (4) and
swing machinery assembly (5) for correct
matching during reassembly.
PC210LC-10 50-121
50 Disassembly and assembly
Power train
50-122 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Power train
Assembly (PC200_10-J120-710-K-00-A)
PC210LC-10 50-123
50 Disassembly and assembly
Power train
3 Cover assembly (6) mounting bolt: a Just before oil seal (14) enters shaft (B),
59 to 74 Nm {6.0 to 7.5 kgm} hold case assembly (13) horizontally so
that it is aligned with the center of shaft
a Take care that gasket sealant (LG-6) does (9), thereby the oil seal lip is prevented
not stick to drain port (DP). from being damaged.
a Match the drain portion of the cover with
drain port (DP).
50-124 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Power train
PC210LC-10 50-125
50 Disassembly and assembly
Power train
50-126 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Power train
12.Assembly of swing motor 13.Check the mounting angle and tightening torque
Install swing motor assembly (43) to ring gear of the drain elbow (44).
(28).
3 Elbow:
4 Swing motor: 128 to 186 Nm {13.0 to 19.0 kgm}
55 kg a Elbow mounting angle: 15°
a Degrease the mating faces of swing motor
assembly(43) and ring gear (28).
a Do not deposit liquid gasket on the mating
faces of swing motor assembly (43) and ring
gear (28).
a During installation, match the match marks
put during disassembly.
3 Swing motor mounting bolt:
59 to 74 Nm {6.0 to 7.5 kgm}
PC210LC-10 50-127
50 Disassembly and assembly
Power train
Installation (PC220-J110-720-K-00-A)
Removal (PC220-J110-520-K-00-A)
Perform installation in the reverse order to removal.
1. Remove the revolving frame assembly referring [*1]
to the section “Removal and installation of
revolving frame assembly“. a Position the soft zone position S mark of an
2. Remove swing circle assembly mounting bolts inner race: (a) and the soft zone position S mark
(2) and sling swing circle assembly (1). [*1] of an outer race: (b) in the R.H. side of the
machine as shown below and install it on the
a Leaving one mounting bolt each in the front track frame.
and rear, sling swing circle assembly (1) by
3-point lifting method. 2 Amount of grease filled in grease bath:
3. Remove the remaining mounting bolts to remove Grease (G2-LI) 15.8 l
swing circle assembly (1).
2 Swing circle mounting bolt threaded
4 Swing circle assembly (1): portion:
295 kg Adhesive (LT-2)
• In case of angle tightening:
3 Swing circle mounting bolt:
1. Initial torque: 294.2 ± 29.4 Nm {30 ±
3 kgm}
2. Then tighten the bolt by 60 ± 6 deg.
• In case of torque tightening:
3 Swing circle mounting bolt:
716 to 814 Nm {73 to 83 kgm}
50-128 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Undercarriage and frame
a Special tools
Necessity
Symbol
Q'ty
Part No. Part Name
Remover and
1 791-630-3000 t 1
installer
N 2 790-101-1300 Cylinder (980 kN t 1
{100 ton})
3 790-101-1102 Hydraulic pump t 1
1. Turn the upper structure by 90 deg. 4. By using tool N, remove master pin (2). [*2]
2. Loosen lubricator (1), and then slacken the a With guide pin (GP), push out master pin (2).
tension of the track. [*1]
PC210LC-10 50-129
50 Disassembly and assembly
Undercarriage and frame
50-130 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Undercarriage and frame
[*3]
1. Using bar [2], roll up track (3) while the machine
moves forward slowly.
PC210LC-10 50-131
50 Disassembly and assembly
Undercarriage and frame
Removal (PC220-DT60-520-K-00-A)
Installation (PC220-DT60-720-K-00-A)
1. Separate the track shoe assembly. For details,
Perform installation in the reverse order to removal.
see “Separation and connection of track shoe
assembly“. [*1]
2. Swing the work equipment 90 deg., push up the 2 Threads of sprocket mounting bolt:
chassis with the work equipment and place
Adhesive (LT-2)
blocks [1] between the track frame and the track.
3. Remove sprocket (2), by slinging according to 3 Sprocket mounting bolt:
the following procedure. 441 to 490 Nm {45 to 50 kgm}
1) Remove mounting bolts (1). [*1]
4 Sprocket:
40 kg
50-132 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Undercarriage and frame
Removal (PC200_10-DTA0-520-K-00-A)
Installation (PC220-DTA0-720-K-00-A)
4 Idler assembly:
105 kg
PC210LC-10 50-133
50 Disassembly and assembly
Undercarriage and frame
a Special tools
Necessity
Symbol
Q'ty
Part No. Part Name
J 791-530-1510 Installer t 1
Figure of structure
Assembly (PC200_10-DT90-710-K-00-A)
Disassembly (PC200_10-DT90-530-K-00-A)
50-134 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Undercarriage and frame
3. By using tool J, install floating seals (3) to idler 5. Turn it over, and supply oil between shaft (5) and
(4) and the assembly of shaft (5) and support idler (4).
(2).
5 Amount of oil to be sealed (EO-30DH):
a Completely clean, degrease, and dry the
contact surfaces (hatched area shown in the 245 to 255 cc
figure) of the floating seal and the O-ring.
a Apply oil to the sliding surface of the floating
seal, and take care not to have any dirt stuck
on it.
a After inserting the floating seals, check that
the inclination is less than 1 mm and the
protrusion (a) is within the range of 7 to 11
mm.
PC210LC-10 50-135
50 Disassembly and assembly
Undercarriage and frame
50-136 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Undercarriage and frame
a Special tools
Necessity
Symbol
Q'ty
Part No. Part Name
PC210LC-10 50-137
50 Disassembly and assembly
Undercarriage and frame
50-138 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Undercarriage and frame
a Special tools
Necessity
Symbol
Q'ty
Part No. Part Name
K 796-670-1020 Installer t 1
a Figure of structure
Assembly (PC200_10-DTD0-710-K-00-A)
PC210LC-10 50-139
50 Disassembly and assembly
Undercarriage and frame
50-140 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Undercarriage and frame
a Special tools
Necessity
Symbol
Q'ty
Part No. Part Name
L 790-434-1660 Installer t 1
a Figure of structure
Disassembly (ALL-DTJ0-530-K-00-A)
6 Amount of oil:
75 to 85 cc
5. Remove floating seal (7) from roller (4).
a Take care not to damage the sealing surface.
PC210LC-10 50-141
50 Disassembly and assembly
Undercarriage and frame
Assembly (ALL-DTJ0-710-K-00-A)
2. Floating seal
1) By using tool L, install floating seal (7) to
roller (4).
2) By using tool L, install floating seal (6) to ring
(5).
a Completely clean, degrease, and dry the
contact surfaces (hatched area shown in
the figure) of the floating seal and the O-
ring.
Take care that dirt or other foreign matter
does not stick to the contact face of the
floating seal.
a When installing floating seals, use tool L
and make sure to press the O-ring.
a After inserting the floating seals, check
that the inclination is less than 1 mm and
the protrusion (a) is within the range of 7
to 11 mm.
50-142 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Undercarriage and frame
PC210LC-10 50-143
50 Disassembly and assembly
Undercarriage and frame
50-144 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Undercarriage and frame
swivel joint assembly (5). Perform installation in the reverse order to removal.
[*1]
4 Revolving frame assembly (14):
Hoses are connected to the following places.
6,500 kg
• Hose (6): Swing motor port (T)
• Hose (7): Travel speed increase solenoid valve
• Hose (8): Control valve port (B2)
• Hose (9): Control valve port (B5)
• Hose (10): Control valve port (A2)
• Hose (11): Control valve port (A5)
[*2]
2 Swivel circle mating surface:
Liquid gasket (LG-6)
2 Threads of revolving frame mounting
bolt:
Adhesive (LT-2)
• In case of torque tightening
3 Revolving frame assembly mounting
bolt:
716 to 814 Nm {73 to 83 kgm}
• In case of angle tightening
3 1st time:
294.2 ± 29.4 Nm {30 ± 3 kgm}
3 2nd time:
60 ± 6 deg.
• Refilling of oil (hydraulic tank)
Supply oil through the oil filler port to the
specified level. Run the engine to circulate the
oil through the system. Then, check the oil level
again.
• Bleeding air
Bleed air from the hydraulic pump circuit. For
details, see Testing and adjusting, "Bleeding air
from hydraulic circuit".
PC210LC-10 50-145
50 Disassembly and assembly
Undercarriage and frame
a Special tools
Necessity
Symbol
Q'ty
Part No. Part Name
Removal (PC220-H700-520-K-00-A)
50-146 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Undercarriage and frame
PC210LC-10 50-147
50 Disassembly and assembly
Undercarriage and frame
[*3]
Installation and adjustment of rear view camera
cover
a Using shims (7), adjust the vertical clearance
between the counterweight and cover (6) to 2
mm or less.
a Hook shim (7) to cover (6) or insert it from
outside after inserting the bolt temporarily.
50-148 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Hydraulic system
6 Hydraulic tank:
132 l
PC210LC-10 50-149
50 Disassembly and assembly
Hydraulic system
5 Hydraulic tank:
132 l
3 Drain plug (2):
68.6 ± 9.8 Nm {7.0 ± 1.0 kgm}
[*2]
Hoses are connected to the following places.
• Hose (3): L.H. travel motor port (T)
• Hose (4): R.H. travel motor port (T)
• Hose (5): L.H. travel motor port (PA)
• Hose (6): R.H. travel motor port (PB)
8. Remove four mounting bolts (21) of center • Hose (7): L.H. travel motor port (PB)
swivel joint (20).[*3] • Hose (8): R.H. travel motor port (PA)
• Hose (9): L.H. travel motor port (P)
• Hose (10): R.H. travel motor port (P)
• Hose (14): Swing motor port (T)
• Hose (15): Travel speed increase solenoid valve
• Hose (16): Control valve port (B2)
• Hose (17): Control valve port (B5)
• Hose (18): Control valve port (A2)
• Hose (19): Control valve port (A5)
[*3]
If center swivel joint base (22) was removed, install
it, four bolts (23), eight washers (24), and four nuts
(25) to the dimensions shown in the figure to set
center of swing (C).
9. Sling and remove center swivel joint (20).
50-150 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Hydraulic system
• Bleeding air
Bleed air from the hydraulic pump circuit. For
details, see Testing and adjusting, “Bleeding air
from hydraulic circuit“.
PC210LC-10 50-151
50 Disassembly and assembly
Hydraulic system
a Special tools
Necessity
Symbol
Q'ty
Part No. Part Name
790-101-2501 Push-puller q 1
790-101-2510 • Block 1
790-101-2520 • Screw 1
791-112-1180 • Nut 1
S 790-101-2540 • Washer 1
790-101-2630 • Leg 2
790-101-2570 • Plate 4
790-101-2560 • Nut 2 5. Remove slipper seals (10) and O-rings (11) from
rotor (8).
790-101-2680 • Adapter 2
6. Remove dust seal (12) from cover (13).
a Figure of structure Assembly (PC220-J8E0-710-K-00-A)
50-152 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Hydraulic system
6 Hydraulic tank:
132 l
PC210LC-10 50-153
50 Disassembly and assembly
Hydraulic system
5. Remove three mounting bolts (10) of cover (9) 7. Remove cover (13) (four bolts).
and four mounting bolts (12) of cover (11).
a Each of covers (9) and (11) can be removed
as it is without separating it into the upper
and lower halves.
a Remove covers (9) and (11) after removing
frame (14).
6. Remove nine mounting bolts (14a) for frame
(14).
4 Frame (14):
11 kg
50-154 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Hydraulic system
10.Remove clamps (15) (one bolt each) and move 13.Remove four mounting bolts (31) of the suction
them away from hydraulic tank (16). tube and six mounting bolts (32) of the hydraulic
tank. [*3]
a Be sure to place a container to collect the
hydraulic oil that remains undrained and
flows out when the suction tube is
disconnected.
Installation (PC200_10-PM30-720-K-00-A)
PC210LC-10 50-155
50 Disassembly and assembly
Hydraulic system
5 Hydraulic tank:
132 l
3 Drain plug (2):
68.6 ± 9.8 Nm {7.0 ± 1.0 kgm}
[*2]
When installing covers (9) and (11), engage each
cover with clips (1) (four places) shown in the figure,
and then tighten the mounting bolts.
• As seen from the engine.
[*3]
3 Suction tube mounting bolt (31):
29.4 to 49.0 Nm {3 to 5 kgm}
3 Hydraulic tank mounting bolt (32):
235 to 285 Nm {23.5 to 29.5 kgm}
• Bleeding air
Bleed air from the hydraulic pump circuit. For
details, see Testing and adjusting, "Bleeding air
from hydraulic circuit".
50-156 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Hydraulic system
a Special tools
Necessity
Symbol
Q'ty
Part No. Part Name
Removal (PC200_10-C200-520-K-00-A)
1. Remove undercover (1). 3. Remove drain plug (3) and drain the damper oil.
6 Damper case:
0.65 l
6 Hydraulic tank:
132 l 4. Remove the KCCV ventilator assembly and
bracket, referring to “Removal and installation of
KCCV assembly“.
5. Remove the KDPF assembly, referring to
“Removal and installation of KDPF assembly“.
6. Removal of base brackets
1) Remove tube support bracket (4).
2) Disconnect hose clamp (6), harness clamp
(7), and tube clamp (8) from base bracket
(5).
PC210LC-10 50-157
50 Disassembly and assembly
Hydraulic system
4 Base bracket:
25 kg
50-158 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Hydraulic system
[*2]
2 Main pump involute splines:
Molybdenum disulfide grease (LM-G)
2 Mating face on main pump case:
Liquid gasket (LG-6)
a Take care not to torque the bolts excessively
since the flywheel housing is made of aluminum.
a Impact wrench is not allowed to use.
22.Sling main pump assembly (47) and remove • Filling of oil (damper case)
mounting bolts (48). Supply oil through the oil filler port to the
23.Sling and remove main pump assembly (47). specified level.
[*2]
5 Damper case:
4 Main pump assembly:
0.65 l
190 kg
3 Damper case drain plug:
45 ± 5 Nm {4.6 ± 0.5 kgm}
• Refilling of oil (hydraulic tank)
Supply oil through the oil filler port to the
specified level. Run the engine to circulate the
PC210LC-10 50-159
50 Disassembly and assembly
Hydraulic system
5 Hydraulic tank:
132 l
3 Hydraulic tank drain plug:
68.6 ± 9.8 Nm {7.0 ± 1.0 kgm}
• Bleeding air
See Testing and adjusting, "Bleeding air from
hydraulic circuit".
50-160 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Hydraulic system
PC210LC-10 50-161
50 Disassembly and assembly
Hydraulic system
50-162 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Hydraulic system
PC210LC-10 50-163
50 Disassembly and assembly
Hydraulic system
17.Disconnect hoses (35) to (41) on the right of the a The hose bands are colored as follows:
control valve. [*3] • Hose (43): Without band (port (PX1))
a The bands are colored as follows: • Hose (44): Without band (port (P-1))
• Hose (45): Without band (port (BP5)) (for
• Hose (35): Without band (port (P-2)) (for
machines equipped with attachment)
machines equipped with attachment)
• Hose (46): Without band (port (BP5)) (for
• Hose (36): White (port (P2))
machines equipped with attachment)
• Hose (37): Red (port (P4))
• Hose (47): Black (port (P1))
• Hose (38): Brown (port (P6))
• Hose (48): Without band (port (P3))
• Hose (39): Without band (port (P8))
• Hose (49): Green (port (P5))
• Hose (40): Green (port (P10))
• Hose (50): Red (port (P7))
• Hose (41): Blue (port (P12))
• Hose (51): Blue (port (P9))
• Hose (52): Yellow (port (P11))
• Hose (53): Without band (port (BP1))
• Hose (54): Without band (port (PX2))
a Disconnect hose (53) from the front of the
control valve.
20.Disconnect hose (55). [*3]
• Hose (55): Port (TSW)
a Disconnect hose (55) from the swing
motor, because the hose is difficult to
disconnect from the control valve.
50-164 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Hydraulic system
PC210LC-10 50-165
50 Disassembly and assembly
Hydraulic system
30.Disconnect hoses (72) to (83) and tubes (84) 32.Sling and remove control valve assembly (87).
and (85) on the front of the control valve. [*3]
• Hose (72): Port (A-1) (for machines equipped 4 Control valve assembly (87):
with attachment) 265 kg
• Hose (73): Port (A1)
a Using eyebolts, lift and remove control valve
• Hose (74): Port (A2)
assembly (87), keeping it horizontal.
• Hose (75): Port (A4)
• Hose (76): Port (A5) • Eyebolt: M12 x 1.75
• Hose (77): Port (A6)
• Hose (78): Port (B-1) (for machines equpped
with attachment)
• Hose (79): Port (B1)
• Hose (80): Port (B2)
• Hose (81): Port (B4)
• Hose (82): Port (B5)
• Hose (83): Port (B6)
• Tube (84): Port (A3)
• Tube (85): Port (B3)
Installation (PC200_10-C030-720-K-00-A)
50-166 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Hydraulic system
PC210LC-10 50-167
50 Disassembly and assembly
Hydraulic system
Necessity
Symbol
Q'ty
Part No. Part Name
50-168 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Hydraulic system
PC210LC-10 50-169
50 Disassembly and assembly
Hydraulic system
50-170 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Hydraulic system
PC210LC-10 50-171
50 Disassembly and assembly
Hydraulic system
• Upper and lower control valve covers 3 Mounting bolt of arm quick return
valve:
2 Mating face of upper and lower
control valve cover blocks (11): 58.8 – 73.6 Nm {6 – 7.5 kgm}
• Arm drift prevention valve
Loctite 222 or equivalent
a Tighten the mounting bolts of the arm
a Tighten the mounting bolts of the control
hydraulic drift prevention valve in the same
valve upper and bottom cover blocks in the
order as that for the control valve cover
following order. (A o D o C o B)
block.
3 Mounting bolts for control valve upper
3 Mounting bolt of arm hydraulic drift
and lower cover blocks:
prevention valve:
156.9 – 176.5 Nm {16 – 18 kgm}
58.8 – 73.6 Nm {6 – 7.5 kgm}
a After assembling, put stoppers to prevent
cleaning solvent from entering through f12
holes (13).
• Pressure compensation valve
a Install each pressure compensation valve
paying attention to the matchmark that was
put when removing it.
3 Pressure compensation valve:
372.7 – 411.9 Nm {38 – 42 kgm}
• Main relief valve assembly
50-172 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Hydraulic system
a Figure of structure
Disassembly (ALL-PL28-530-K-00-A)
a Only precautions for assembling the work a When installing plug (3) to valve body (1), check
equipment PPC valve assembly are described the insertion depth so that the tip of the plug
below. does not protrude into the f20 hole in the valve
body.
a Before assembly, thoroughly clean the parts and
check them for any dirt, rust or damage to 3 Plug (3):
prevent failures. 4 to 9 Nm {0.4 to 0.9 kgm}
a The head of plug (2) must not be projected from a Install spring (5) with its small diameter end
the surface of valve body (1). facing shim (4).
3 Plug (2): • Diameter of spring end tum (inside diameter)
6 to 11 Nm {0.6 to 1.1 kgm} Small diameter end: f 4.9 mm
Large diameter end: f 5.55 mm
PC210LC-10 50-173
50 Disassembly and assembly
Hydraulic system
a When installing springs (6) and (7), note that 3 Nut (14):
their installed positions are determined by the 69 to 88 Nm {7 to 9 kgm}
hydraulic ports.
• Installed height is 31.9 mm for all springs.
• Load at installed length
Spring (6) (P1, P2): 35.3 N {3.6 kg}
Spring (7) (P1, P2): 21.6 N {2.2 kg}
a Before installing piston (8), apply grease (G2-LI)
to the periphery of the piston and the bore in the
valve body.
3 Bolt (11):
11.8 to 14.7 Nm {1.2 to 1.5 kgm}
a When installing joint (12) to valve body (1), apply
Loctite according to the following procedure.
1. When installing the joint, apply a drop (approx.
0.02 g) of Loctite (No. 262) to each female
thread portion (A) (2 places) of the valve body.
Before installing the joint, degrease its male
threads and the female threads of the valve
body with Drysol and dry them.
2. Drop Loctite to the following positions.
2 Female thread (A) of valve body:
Loctite No. 262
3 Joint (12):
39 to 49 Nm {4 to 5 kgm}
50-174 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Hydraulic system
a Special tools
Necessity
Sym-
Q'ty
Part No. Part Name
bol
a Figure of structure
Disassembly (PC220-C6V0-530-K-00-A)
1. Remove screws (22) and remove damper a Note the installed position, quantity and
assemblies (21). thickness of shims (3) and keep them.
2. Remove mounting bolt (19) and remove case 8. Remove valves (2) from valve body (1).
(18), shafts (16) and levers (13) as a unit.
3. Remove pins (17).
4. Remove levers (13), bushings (14) and (14a),
and shafts (16) from case (18).
5. Remove mounting bolts (11) to remove plate
(10).
a Note the thickness and installed position of
washer (12).
a Remove pin (24) from valve body (1).
6. Remove seals (9) and collars (8).
7. Remove pistons (7), and then to remove
retainers (6), springs (5) and (4), and shims (3).
PC210LC-10 50-175
50 Disassembly and assembly
Hydraulic system
Assembly (PC220-C6V0-710-K-00-A)
a Only precautions for assembly are described. a Do not drive the pin directly with a hammer,
etc.
a Before assembly, thoroughly clean the parts and
check them for dirt, rust, or damage to prevent
failure. Assemble the parts with utmost care.
a When installing piston (7), apply grease (G2-LI)
to its periphery and the inside of the valve body
hole.
a Install spring (4) with its small diameter end
facing shim (3).
• Diameter of spring (inside diameter)
Small diameter end: f 4.9 mm
Large diameter end: f 5.55 mm
a Install shaft (16) according to the following
procedure. 3. Install lever (13).
1. Using tool Q1, install bushing (14) to the case. 4. Install shaft (16).
5. Using tool Q3, install pin (17).
a Install the bushing with its 10 deg. chamfered
side ahead. a Installed dimension (C) of pin (17) should be
as follows.
a Install the bushing so that dimension (A) is
• Dimension (C): 0 to 0.5 mm
as follows.
• Dimension (A): 20.4 ± 0.3 mm a Do not drive the pin directly with a hammer,
etc.
a Do not drive the pin directly with a hammer,
etc.
50-176 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Hydraulic system
PC210LC-10 50-177
50 Disassembly and assembly
Work equipment
Necessity
Symbol
Q'ty
Part No. Part Name
the grease nipple at the cylinder bottom.
a Remove the boom cylinder on the other side
796-900-1200 Remover t 1 in the same manner.
796-900-1210 • Sleeve 1
792-900-1520 • Plate 1 a If bumping of the lifting hook against the
working lamp is anticipated in lifting the work
799-900-1230 • Screw 1
equipment, the lamp must be removed.
796-900-1240 • Adapter 1
6. Stop the engine, and release the pressure
V 01643-33080 • Washer 1 remaining in the circuit. For details, see Testing
01803-13034 • Nut 1 and adjusting, “Releasing remaining pressure
Puller (490 kN {50 from hydraulic circuit“.
790-101-4000 ton} long) t 1
7. Disconnect two bucket cylinder hoses (6) and
Pump (294 kN {30 two arm cylinder hoses (7).
790-101-1102 ton}) t 1
a Plug the hose and then fix it to the valve side
k Fully extend the arm and bucket and with rope.
completely lower the work equipment to the 8. Disconnect working lamp intermediate
ground. connector A13 (8).
Removal (PC200_10-L410-520-K-00-A)
50-178 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Work equipment
PC210LC-10 50-179
50 Disassembly and assembly
Work equipment
50-180 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Work equipment
Necessity
Symbol
Q'ty
Part No. Part Name
PC210LC-10 50-181
50 Disassembly and assembly
Work equipment
6. Remove cap (8) to remove 12 balls (9), and Disassembling cylinder (arm cylinder only)
remove plunger (10). 1. Remove plug (21).
a Arm cylinder only 2. Remove spring (22) and valve (23).
Disassembling piston
1. Remove two rings (11).
2. Remove two wear rings (12).
3. Remove piston ring (13).
4. Remove the O-ring and two backup rings (14).
50-182 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Work equipment
Assembly (PC200_10-PPZ0-710-K-00-A)
PC210LC-10 50-183
50 Disassembly and assembly
Work equipment
50-184 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Work equipment
3 Piston assembly (4): a After installing screw (3), caulk the screw
at four peripheral places (a).
294 ± 29.4 Nm {30 ± 3.0 kgm}
2 Screw (3) thread portion:
a For a cylinder with a head cushion,
ensure that there is a little play in plunger Adhesive (Loctite #262)
(5) with piston assembly (4) installed. 3 Screw (3):
• Only the boom and arm cylinders 58.9 – 73.6 Nm {6 – 7.5 kgm}
PC210LC-10 50-185
50 Disassembly and assembly
Work equipment
50-186 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
Removal (PC220-K000-520-K-00-A)
PC210LC-10 50-187
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
50-188 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
PC210LC-10 50-189
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
24.Remove ducts (45) to (47). 28.Remove bolt (53) from under the operator's cab
and remove lock plate (54). [*1]
29.Remove cab tipping stopper (55). (width across
flats : 46 mm) [*2]
50-190 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
Installation (PC220-K000-720-K-00-A)
PC210LC-10 50-191
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
a Special tools
Necessity
Sym-
Q'ty
Part No. Part Name
bol
50-192 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
PC210LC-10 50-193
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
Removal (PC220-K183-520-K-00-A)
50-194 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
Installation (PC220-K183-720-K-00-A)
1. Using a knife and scraper [5], remove the a Use the primer within two hours after opening
remaining adhesive and dam rubber from the container.
sheet metal (adhesion surfaces) of the
a Even if the container of the primer is capped
operator's cab.
again just after it is opened, use it out within
a Remove the adhesive and dam rubber to a 24 hours after it is opened for the first time.
degree that they will not affect adhesion of (Discard the primer which is left unused 24
the new adhesive. Take care not to scratch hours after it is opened.)
the painted surfaces. (If the painted surfaces 1) Stir the primers for painted surface and glass
are damaged, adhesion will be lowered.) sufficiently before using them.
(The figure shows the operator's cab of a wheel
loader.) a If the primer is stored in a refrigerator,
leave it at the room temperature for at
least half a day before stirring it. (If the
primer is opened just after taken out of
the refrigerator, water will be condensed.
Accordingly, leave the primer at the room
temperature for a sufficient time.)
2) When reusing primer brush (11), wash it in
white gasoline.
a After washing the brush, check it again
for dirt and contaminants.
a Prepare respective brushes for the
painted surface primer and glass primer.
2. Remove oil, dust, dirt, etc. from the adhesion
surfaces on cab (8) and window glass (9) with
white gasoline.
a If the adhesion surfaces are not cleaned well,
the window glass may not be bonded
perfectly.
a Clean all the black part on the back of the
window glass.
a After cleaning the adhesion surfaces, leave
them for at least 5 minutes to dry.
(The figure shows the operator's cab of a wheel
loader.) 3) Evenly apply the painted surface primer to
the surfaces on operator's cab (8); the
surface where dam rubber (6) is bonded on
and its outside surfaces where the adhesive
is applied to.
2 Primer for painted surface:
Sunstar Primer 580 Super for
painted surfaces
a Do not apply the primer more than two
times. (Applying primer more than twice
will degrade the performance.)
PC210LC-10 50-195
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
a Places to apply: Apply over the entire a Never apply wrong primer. If the paint
circumference with dimension (a). primer is applied by mistake, wipe it off
• Primer applying dimension (a): 30 mm with white gasoline. If glass primer, etc. is
applied by mistake, wipe it off with white
gasoline.
4) Evenly apply the glass primer to the
adhesion surfaces of glass (9).
2 Primer for glass:
Sunstar Primer 453-41 for glass
a Do not apply the primer more than two
times. (Applying primer more than twice
will degrade the performance.)
50-196 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
PC210LC-10 50-197
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
50-198 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
6. Apply adhesive.
a Use either of the two types of adhesives
according to the season.
2 Adhesive (summer):
Sunstar penguine seal 580 super "S"
or equivalent
2 Adhesive (winter):
Sunstar penguine seal 580 super "W"
or equivalent
a The using limit of the adhesive is four months
after the date of manufacture. Do not use the 4) Remove the release tape from dam rubber
adhesive after the period. (6) on the glass sticking side.
5) Apply adhesive (15) to the outside of dam
a Keep the adhesive in a dark place where the
rubber (6) on the operator's cab.
temperature is below 25°C.
a Never heat the adhesive higher than 30°C.
a When reusing the adhesive, remove all the
hardened part from the nozzle tip.
1) Remove aluminum seal (13) of the outlet of
adhesive cartridge (12) and install the
nozzle.
PC210LC-10 50-199
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
50-200 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
PC210LC-10 50-201
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
50-202 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
Installation (PC220-K181-720-K-00-A)
PC210LC-10 50-203
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
50-204 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
PC210LC-10 50-205
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
• When adjustment is needed after 6) Adjustment of right and left rubber stoppers
performing check in step 8; (24)
3) Close front window assembly (1). • Bring right and left rubber stoppers (24)
4) Loosen locknuts (26) of right and left rubber into contact with front window assembly
stoppers (24) and move the stoppers (1) (locked in "open" position).
backward so that front window assembly (1)
does not touch the stoppers when it is locked
in its "open" position.
50-206 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
[*2]
3 Pin (9):
27 to 34 Nm {2.8 to 3.5 kgm}
2 Thread portion of pin (9):
Adhesive (LT-2)
PC210LC-10 50-207
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
50-208 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
PC210LC-10 50-209
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
50-210 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
PC210LC-10 50-211
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
Installation (PC200_10-H1H0-720-K-00-A)
50-212 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
PC210LC-10 50-213
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
a Never release the refrigerant (R134a) to the 6. Remove box (8) (five bolts).
atmosphere. a Disconnect the hose located under box (8).
a Ask a qualified person for collecting, adding, and 7. Remove box (9) (three bolts).
filling operations of the refrigerant (R134a). a Be careful about connectors (10) and (11)
a Note connector numbers and installed positions located behind box (9) (for machines
before disconnecting wiring and hoses. equipped with 12 V power socket).
• Connector (10): 12 V power socket
a Positions of the controllers are shown below. intermediate harness (M13A)
• A: Pump controller assembly • Connector (11): 12 V power socket
• B: Air conditioner controller assembly intermediate harness (M13B)
• C: KOMTRAX terminal controller assembly 8. Pull up cover (12) (three bolts) to remove.
a The connectors and harnesses at the rear
must not be caught.
Removal (PC200_10-K500-520-K-00-A)
50-214 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
10.Remove duct (15) (two bolts). a Cut the cable ties holding the ducts.
11.Remove cover (16) (three bolts) and bracket
(41) (two bolts).
a Disconnect connectors (17) and (18) located
behind cover (16) .
• Connector (17): R.H. console intermediate
harness (H14)
• Connector (18): R.H. console intermediate
harness (H15)
PC210LC-10 50-215
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
16.Remove cable tie (40) of the floor wiring 19.Disconnect connectors (42) to (45).
harness. • Connector (42): Communication antenna
(GPS)
• Connector (43): Machine main harness
(CK01).
• Connector (44): Machine main harness
(CK02).
• Connector (45): Communication antenna
20.Remove KOMTRAX terminal (C) (four bolts).
50-216 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
PC210LC-10 50-217
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
50-218 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
PC210LC-10 50-219
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
1. Pull lever (1) and move operator's seat (2) 4 Operator's seat (2):
backward. 21 kg
7. Remove mounting bolt (6) of seat belt (7) (one
on each side) to remove seat belt (7). [*2]
from the seat rails. [*1] • Perform installation in the reverse order to
5. Disconnect connector (5). removal.
• Connector (5): Seat belt caution switch (S19) [*1]
3 Mounting bolts (hexagonal socket head)
(3) and (4) of operator's seat (2):
25.5 Nm {2.6 kgm}
[*2]
50-220 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
PC210LC-10 50-221
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
Removal (PC220-K710-520-K-00-A)
50-222 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
PC210LC-10 50-223
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
Installation (PC220-K710-720-K-00-A)
50-224 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
PC210LC-10 50-225
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
3) Pull lever (3) down to release the lock while 5) When the bottom of front window touches the
holding handle (2) at right and left of front top of lower window, push the upper portion
window stowed in the ceiling. of front window against lock catcher (36) at
the front of the cab to lock.
50-226 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
PC210LC-10 50-227
50 Disassembly and assembly
Cab and its attachments
50-228 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Electrical system
PC210LC-10 50-229
50 Disassembly and assembly
Electrical system
[*3]
a When installing air conditioner hoses and tubes,
Installation (PC200_10-K590-720-K-00-A) take care so that dust, dirt or water does not
enter them.
Perform installation in the reverse order to removal. a When connecting the air conditioner hoses and
tubes, check that O-rings are fitted to their joints.
[*1]
• Filling air conditioner circuit with refrigerant a Do not reuse an O-ring since it is deformed and
(R134a) deteriorated once it is used.
Fill the air conditioner circuit with refrigerant a When removing O-rings, use a soft tool to avoid
(R134a). damaging hoses and tubes.
a Filling quantity: a Check that there is no defect or deterioration on
930 ± 50 g the O-ring.
• Refilling of air compressor oil a Apply compressor oil (Denso: ND-OIL8) for
For details, see Others, " Filling compressor oil". R134a refrigerant to O-rings.
[*2]
Reconnect the disconnected air tubes according to 3 Hose clamp (M6 bolt):
the following procedure. 8 to 12 Nm {0.8 to 1.2 kgm}
a Use new MIKALOR clamps.
1. Set the hose to the original (marked) position.
a Reference
Air hose fitting length:
80 mm (both R.H. and L.H. sides)
2. With bridge (BR) set under the clamp bolt,
tighten the bolt so that bridge (BR) laps over
with the band by dimension (b) indicated below.
Dimension (b): Min. 5 mm
50-230 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Electrical system
[*4]
a See Testing and adjusting, " Checking and
adjusting air conditioner compressor belt
tension".
3 Lock nut (9):
108 to 132 Nm {11 to 13.5 kgm}
3 Mounting bolt (8):
59 to 74 Nm {6.0 to 7.5 kgm}
[*5]
3 Air conditioner compressor assembly
mounting bolt :
24.5 to 29.4 Nm {2.5 to 3.0 kgm}
PC210LC-10 50-231
50 Disassembly and assembly
Electrical system
filling operations of the refrigerant (R134a). Perform installation in the reverse order to removal.
[*1]
Removal (PC220-K580-520-K-00-A) • Filling air conditioner circuit with refrigerant
(R134a)
Fill the air conditioner circuit with refrigerant
1. Collect the refrigerant (R134a) from the air
(R134a).
conditioner circuit. [*1]
a Filling quantity:
a Refrigerant to be collected:
930 ± 50 g
930 ± 50 g
• Addition of air compressor oil
2. Open the left rear cover and disconnect hoses
For details, see Others, "Filling compressor oil".
(1) and (2) from air conditioner condenser
[*2]
assembly (4). [*2]
3. Remove mounting bolts (3) and open air a When installing air conditioner hoses, take care
conditioner condenser (4). so that dust, dirt or water does not enter the
hose.
a Make sure before the installation that there is an
O-ring in the piping connector of the air
conditioner hose.
a Do not reuse an O-ring since it is deformed and
deteriorated after the first time it was used.
a When removing O-rings, use a soft tool to avoid
damaging hoses.
a Check that there is no defect or deterioration on
the O-ring.
a Apply compressor oil (Denso: ND-OIL8) for
4. Remove 4 mounting bolts (5) for the air
R134a refrigerant to O-rings.
conditioner condenser and then remove air
conditioner condenser (4). [*3] 3 Hose clamp (M6 bolt):
a In this removal operation, take care not to 8 to 12 Nm {0.8 to 1.2 kgm}
damage the core part.
50-232 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Electrical system
[*3]
a Mount the air conditioner condenser assembly
by inserting cushions in place.
2 Air conditioner condenser assembly
mounting bolt threads:
Adhesive (LT-2)
3 Air conditioner condenser assembly
mounting bolt:
10 to 15 Nm {1.2 to 1.5 kgm}
PC210LC-10 50-233
50 Disassembly and assembly
Electrical system
50-234 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Electrical system
Installation (PC220-AP70-720-K-00-A)
[*2]
3 Hexagon socket head bolt (11):
3 ± 1 Nm {0.31 ± 0.1 kgm}
[*3]
When installing mounting bolt (12), tighten ground
cable (14) together.
3 Engine controller mounting bolt:
24 ± 4 Nm {2.4 ± 0.4 kgm}
PC210LC-10 50-235
50 Disassembly and assembly
Electrical system
Removal (PC220-C3V1-520-K-00-A)
Installation (PC220-C3V1-720-K-00-A)
50-236 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Electrical system
PC210LC-10 50-237
50 Disassembly and assembly
Electrical system
50-238 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Electrical system
Removal (PC220-Q170-520-K-00-A)
1. Pull up front window assembly (1) to the ceiling 5. Remove connector (6) and then remove cover
and lock it. (4).
• Connector (6): Sunlight sensor (P31)
a Check that the front window is securely
locked.
2. Remove front lower window (2).
PC210LC-10 50-239
50 Disassembly and assembly
Electrical system
Installation (PC220-Q170-720-K-00-A)
50-240 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Electrical system
PC210LC-10 50-241
50 Disassembly and assembly
Electrical system
Removal and installation of mass air flow and temperature sensor (PC220-
A96H-924-K-00-A)
Removal (PC200_10-A96H-520-K-00-A)
Installation (PC220-A96H-720-K-00-A)
50-242 PC210LC-10
50 Disassembly and assembly
Electrical system
Removal (PC220-Q210-520-K-00-A)
PC210LC-10 50-243
50 Disassembly and assembly
Electrical system
Installation (PC220-Q210-720-K-00-A)
50-244 PC210LC-10
SHOP MANUAL
HYDRAULIC EXCAVATOR
PC210LC-10
Model Serial Number
60 Maintenance standard
8 60 Maintenance standard
PC210LC-10 60-1
60 Maintenance standard
Table of contents
60-2 PC210LC-10
60 Maintenance standard
Engine mount
PC210LC-10 60-3
60 Maintenance standard
Cooling system
60-4 PC210LC-10
60 Maintenance standard
Swing circle
Unit mm
No. Item Criteria Remedy
Axial clearance of Standard clearance Allowable clearance
1 bearing (when mounted Replace
on machine) 0.5 to 1.6 3.2
PC210LC-10 60-5
60 Maintenance standard
Swing machinery
60-6 PC210LC-10
60 Maintenance standard
Swing machinery
Unit mm
No. Item Criteria Remedy
Backlash between Standard clearance Allowable clearance
1 swing motor shaft and
No.1 sun gear 0.18 to 0.28 —
Backlash between No.
2 1 sun gear and No. 1 0.16 to 0.50 1.00
planetary gear
Backlash between No.1
3 planetary gear and ring 0.18 to 0.59 1.10
gear
Backlash between No.1
4 planetary carrier and 0.39 to 0.71 1.40
No. 2 sun gear
Backlash between No.
5 2 sun gear and No. 2 0.16 to 0.50 1.00
planetary gear
Replace
Backlash between No.
6 2 planetary gear and 0.18 to 0.59 1.20
ring gear
Backlash between No.
7 2 planetary carrier and 0.07 to 0.23 —
swing pinion
Backlash between
8 swing pinion and swing 0.22 to 1.32 2.00
circle
Clearance between
9 plate and No. 2 0.9 ± 0.24 —
planetary carrier
Clearance between
10 plate and No. 2 sun 2.3 ± 0.64 —
gear
Standard Repair by
Outside diameter of oil Tolerance Allowable dimension
dimension hard chrome-
11 seal contact surface of
0 plating or
spacer 125 —
-0.100 replace
PC210LC-10 60-7
60 Maintenance standard
Final drive
60-8 PC210LC-10
60 Maintenance standard
Final drive
Unit:mm
No. Item Criteria Remedy
Backlash between Standard clearance Allowable clearance
1 travel motor and No. 2
planetary carrier 0.06 to 0.25 —
Backlash between No.
2 2 planetary gear and 0.16 to 0.56 1.10
ring gear
Backlash between No.
3 2 planetary gear and 0.13 to 0.47 1.00
No. 2 sun gear
Replace
Backlash between No.1
4 planetary gear and ring 0.16 to 0.56 1.10
gear
Backlash between No.
5 1 planetary gear and 0.13 to 0.45 1.00
No. 1 sun gear shaft
Backlash between No.1
6 planetary carrier and 0.38 to 0.68 1.00
No. 2 sun gear
Amount of wear on Build-up
7 Repair limit 6
sprocket tooth welding for
Standard dimension Repair limit rebuilding or
8 Width of sprocket tooth replace
71 68
PC210LC-10 60-9
60 Maintenance standard
Sprocket
Sprocket (PC-DT60-034-K-00-A)
Unit mm
No. Item Criteria Remedy
Standard dimension Repair limit
1 Wear of tooth tip
294.5 282.5 Build-up
2 Thickness of tooth root 17 11 welding for
3 Width of tooth 71 68 rebuilding or
Repair limit 6 replace
4 Wear of tooth shape
(use a full-scale drawing of sprocket tooth shape to judge)
60-10 PC210LC-10
60 Maintenance standard
Sprocket
PC210LC-10 60-11
60 Maintenance standard
Track frame and idler cushion
60-12 PC210LC-10
60 Maintenance standard
Track frame and idler cushion
Unit:mm
No. Item Criteria Remedy
Standard dimension Tolerance Repair limit
+3
Height of idler Track 107 111
1 guide frame -1
Build-up
Idler
105 ±0.5 103 welding for
support
rebuilding or
Track +4 replace
250 255
Width of idler frame -1
2 guide Idler
247.4 — 245.4
support
Standard dimension Repair limit
Free length Load at Load at
Installed
x Outside installed Free length installed
3 Recoil spring length Replace
diameter length length
126.5 kN 101 kN
561.4 x 237 433 534
{12,900 kg} {10,300 kg}
PC210LC-10 60-13
60 Maintenance standard
Idler
Idler (PC220-DT90-034-K-00-A)
60-14 PC210LC-10
60 Maintenance standard
Idler
Unit:mm
No. Item Criteria Remedy
Outside diameter of Standard dimension Repair limit
1 protrusion 538 —
Outside diameter of Build-up
2 500 488
tread welding for
3 Thickness of tread 26 20 rebuilding or
4 Depth of tread 19 25 replace
5 Ovevall width 159 —
6 Width of tread 37.5 —
Standard Tolerance Standard Allowable
Clearance between dimension Shaft Hole clearance clearance
7 shaft and bushing -0.250 + 0.164 0.176 to
65 —
-0.350 - 0.074 0.514
Tolerance Standard Allowable
Standard
interfer- interfer- Replace
Interference between dimension Shaft Hole
8 ence ence bushing
idler and bushing
+ 0.108 - 0.032 0.040 to
72 —
+ 0.008 - 0.062 0.170
Clearance between Standard dimension Repair limit
9 bushing and support
0.5 to 1.0 —
(Total of both sides)
PC210LC-10 60-15
60 Maintenance standard
Track roller
Unit:mm
No. Item Criteria Remedy
Outside diameter of Standard dimension Repair limit
1 flange 188 —
Outside diameter of Build-up
2 156 144
tread welding for
3 Thickness of tread 44.5 38.5 rebuilding or
4 Ovevall width 225 — replace
5 Width of tread 44.5 —
6 Width of flange 25.5 —
Standard Tolerance Standard Allowable
Clearance between dimension Shaft Hole clearance clearance
7 shaft and bushing –0.215 +0.195 0.215 to
60 —
–0.315 0 0.510 Replace
Tolerance Standard Allowable bushing
Standard
interfer- interfer-
Interference between dimension Shaft Hole
8 ence ence
roller and bushing
+0.153 +0.030 0.023 to
67 —
+0.053 0 0.153
Clearance between Standard dimension Repair limit
9 bushing and collar Replace
0.5 to 1.0 —
(Total of both sides)
60-16 PC210LC-10
60 Maintenance standard
Carrier roller
Unit mm
No. Item Criteria Remedy
Outside diameter of Standard dimension Repair limit
1 flange 143 —
Outside diameter of
2 120 106
tread
3 Width of tread 43 —
4 Thickness of tread 23 16
5 Width of flange 14 —
Standard Tolerance Standard Allowable
Clearance between dimension Shaft Hole clearance clearance Replace
6 shaft and bushing -0.170 +0.301 0.338 to
40 —
-0.190 +0.168 0.491
Tolerance Standard Allowable
Standard
interfer- interfer-
Interference between dimension Shaft Hole
7 ence ence
roller and bushing
+0.061 0 0.016 to
47 —
+0.016 -0.040 0.101
End play of roller (play Standard clearance Allowable clearance
8 of shaft end) 0.44 to 0.76 —
PC210LC-10 60-17
60 Maintenance standard
Track shoe
a Portion P shows the link on the side where the bushing is press-fitted.
*1: Triple grouser shoe
*2: Road liner
*3: Swamp shoe
*4: Flat shoe
60-18 PC210LC-10
60 Maintenance standard
Track shoe
Unit:mm
No. Item Criteria Remedy
Standard dimension Repair limit
1 Link pitch
190.3 193.3 Turn 180
Outside diameter of Standard dimension Repair limit deg. or
2 bushing replace
59.4 54.4
3 Thickness of bushing 10.4 5.4
Standard dimension Repair limit
4 Link height
105 97 Repair or
Thickness of link replace
5 (bushing press fit part) 28.5 20.5
6 160.4
7 Shoe bolt pitch 124.4
8 62
Inside
9 84.8
width
Overall
10 Link 45.4
width
Tread
11 39.6
width
Adjust or
Protrusion of Regular 2.5
12 pin replace
Master 2.5
Protrusion of Regular 4.85
13 bushing
Master 0.0
Overall length Regular 212
14 of pin
Master 212
Overall length Regular 138.5
15 of bushing
Master 128.7
16 Thickness of spacer —
17 Bushing 88.2 to 245 kN {9 to 25 ton}
Regular
18 Press-fitting 127.4 to 274.4 kN {13 to 28 ton}
pin —
force
(*1) Master
78.4 to 147 kN {8 to 15 ton}
19 pin
Tightening torque Retightening angle
(Nm {kgm}) (deg.)
a. 490 ± 49
Regular Triple grouser
120 ± 10
link shoe {50 ± 5}
20 Shoe bolt 549 ± 59 Retighten
Road liner —
{56 ± 6}
Tightening torque Retightening angle Lower limit torque
b.
Master (Nm {kgm}) (deg.) (Nm {kgm})
link —
— —
PC210LC-10 60-19
60 Maintenance standard
Track shoe
Unit:mm
No. Item Criteria Remedy
Standard Tolerance Standard
Interference between dimension Shaft Hole interference
21 bushing and link +0.434 +0.074
59 0.320 to 0.434
+0.394 0
Interference between +0.222 –0.138
22 regular pin and link 38 0.300 to 0.422
+0.162 –0.200
Standard Tolerance Standard
Clearance between dimension Shaft Hole clearance
23 regular pin and bushing +0.222 +0.902 Adjust or
38 0.180 to 0.740 replace
+0.162 +0.402
Standard Tolerance Standard
(*1) Interference between dimension Shaft Hole interference
24 master pin and link +0.280 +0.062
37.8 0.188 to 0.280
+0.250 0
Standard Tolerance Standard
(*1) Clearance between dimension Shaft Hole clearance
25 master pin and bushing –0.150 +0.902
38 0.552 to 1.252
–0.350 +0.402
*1: For the dry type track
60-20 PC210LC-10
60 Maintenance standard
Track shoe
Unit:mm
No. Item Criteria Remedy
Standard dimension Repair limit
1 Grouser overall height
26 16
Shoe overall 36 26
2 height (*) 34.5 26
10 Build-up
Plate
3 welding for
thickness (*) 8.5 rebuilding or
4 26 replace
Grouser base length
5 19
6 20
7 Grouser tip length 14
8 19
*: 600 mm width shoe.
PC210LC-10 60-21
60 Maintenance standard
Track shoe
Unit: mm
No. Item Criteria Remedy
Standard dimension Repair limit Build-up
1 Shoe height welding for
102.5 90.5
rebuilding or
2 Shoe thickness 17 5 replace
60-22 PC210LC-10
60 Maintenance standard
Track shoe
Unit: mm
No. Item Criteria Remedy
1 Height 70 Replace
PC210LC-10 60-23
60 Maintenance standard
Hydraulic tank
60-24 PC210LC-10
60 Maintenance standard
Main pump
PC210LC-10 60-25
60 Maintenance standard
Control valve
60-26 PC210LC-10
60 Maintenance standard
Control valve
PC210LC-10 60-27
60 Maintenance standard
Control valve
Unit: mm
No. Item Criteria Remedy
Standard dimension Repair limit
Free length Installed Load at Load at
x Outside installed Free length installed
1 Spool return spring length
diameter length length
407 N 326 N
55.2 x 34.4 51.2 — If damaged
{41.5 kg} {33.2 kg} or deformed,
393 N 315 N replace
2 Spool return spring 54.5 x 34.8 51.2 —
{40.1 kg} {32.1 kg} spring
375 N 300 N
3 Spool return spring 54.4 x 34.8 51.2 —
{38.2 kg} {30.6 kg}
421 N 336 N
4 Spool return spring 54.6 x 34.8 51.2 —
{42.9 kg} {34.3 kg}
60-28 PC210LC-10
60 Maintenance standard
Control valve
PC210LC-10 60-29
60 Maintenance standard
Control valve
Unit: mm
No. Item Criteria Remedy
Standard dimension Repair limit
Free length Installed Load at Load at
x Outside installed Free length installed If damaged
1 Suction valve spring length
diameter length length or deformed,
5.5 N 4.4 N replace
46.8 x 7.5 40.6 —
{0.56 kg} {0.45 kg} spring
1.5 N 1.2 N
2 Check valve spring 11.5 x 4.6 8.5 —
{0.15 kg} {0.12 kg}
60-30 PC210LC-10
60 Maintenance standard
Control valve
PC210LC-10 60-31
60 Maintenance standard
Control valve
Unit: mm
No. Item Criteria Remedy
Standard dimension Repair limit
Free length Installed Load at Load at
Variable back pressure x Outside installed Free length installed
1 length
valve return spring diameter length length
14.7 N 11.8 N
59.3 x 14.4 43 —
{1.5 kg} {1.2 kg}
13.7 N 11 N
2 Check valve spring 33.8 x 6 29 — If damaged
{1.4 kg} {1.12 kg} or deformed,
Quick return valve 170 N 135 N replace
3 60.2 x 20 36 —
spring {17.3 kg} {13.8 kg} spring
Regeneration circuit 5.9 N 4.71 N
4 31.5 x 10.3 19.5 —
check valve spring {0.6 kg} {0.48 kg}
Cooler check valve 157 N 126 N
5 88.2 x 28.4 65 —
spring {16 kg} {12.8 kg}
52.7 N 42.2 N
6 Pilot piston spring 22.35 x 9.3 13.4 —
{5.37 kg} {4.30 kg}
60-32 PC210LC-10
60 Maintenance standard
Control valve
PC210LC-10 60-33
60 Maintenance standard
Control valve
Unit: mm
No. Item Criteria Remedy
Standard dimension Repair limit
Free length Installed Load at Load at
Merge-divider valve x Outside installed Free length installed
1 length
spring (for LS) diameter length length
121 N 96.5 N
36.4 x 21.8 33.0 —
{12.3 kg} {9.84 kg}
250 N 200 N
2 Sequence valve spring 70.9 x 18.0 56.0 —
{25.5 kg} {20.4 kg}
Merge-divider valve 178 N 142 N If damaged
3 64.5 x 32.3 63.0 — or deformed,
spring (main) {18.1 kg} {14.5 kg}
replace
Hydraulic drift 35.3 N 28.2 N spring
4 prevention valve check 33.0 x 12.0 26.0 —
valve spring {3.6 kg} {2.88 kg}
13.7 N 11.0 N
5 Check valve spring 33.8 x 6.0 29.0 —
{1.4 kg} {1.12 kg}
Regeneration circuit 5.9 N 4.71 N
6 31.5 x 10.3 19.5 —
check valve spring {0.6 kg} {0.48 kg}
Travel junction valve 50.0 N 40.0 N
7 30.7 x 20.5 23 —
spring {5.1 kg} {4.08 kg}
60-34 PC210LC-10
60 Maintenance standard
Control valve
PC210LC-10 60-35
60 Maintenance standard
Swing motor
60-36 PC210LC-10
60 Maintenance standard
Swing motor
Unit: mm
No. Item Criteria Remedy
Standard dimension Repair limit
Free length Installed Load at Load at
x Outside installed Free length installed If damaged
1 Check valve spring length
diameter length length or deformed,
3.43 N 2.75 N replace
57.2 x 20 30.9 —
{0.35 kg} {0.28 kg} spring
13.7 N 11.0 N
2 Shuttle valve spring 16.4 x 8.9 11.5 —
{1.4 kg} {1.12 kg}
PC210LC-10 60-37
60 Maintenance standard
Travel motor
60-38 PC210LC-10
60 Maintenance standard
Travel motor
PC210LC-10 60-39
60 Maintenance standard
Travel motor
Unit: mm
No. Item Criteria Remedy
Standard dimension Repair limit
Free length Installed Load at Load at
x Outside installed Free length installed
1 Regulator piston spring length
diameter length length
223 N 179 N
46.9 x 20.3 37.1 —
{22.8 kg} {18.2 kg}
69.6 N 55.7 N
2 Regulator piston spring 51.1 x 13.5 39.1 — If damaged
{7.1 kg} {5.7 kg} or deformed,
54.9 N 43.9 N replace
3 Regulator valve spring 21.5 x 11.1 17.1 —
{5.6 kg} {4.48 kg} spring
2.55 N 2.04 N
4 Check valve spring 13.0 x 6.5 8.5 —
{0.26 kg} {0.21 kg}
Suction safety valve 7.16 N 5.96 N
5 32.5 x 6.5 24.2 —
spring {0.73 kg} {0.58 kg}
Counterbalance valve 410 N 328 N
6 58.4 x 30.0 42.6 —
spring {41.9 kg} {33.5 kg}
60-40 PC210LC-10
60 Maintenance standard
Work equipment and swing PPC valve
PC210LC-10 60-41
60 Maintenance standard
Work equipment and swing PPC valve
60-42 PC210LC-10
60 Maintenance standard
Work equipment and swing PPC valve
Unit:mm
No. Item Criteria Remedy
Standard dimension Repair limit
Free length Installed Load at Load at
Centering spring x Outside installed Free length installed
1 length
(for ports P3 and P4) diameter length length
If damaged
17.7 N 14.1 N or deformed,
42.5 x 15.5 34.0 —
{1.80 kg} {1.44 kg} replace
Centering spring 29.4 N 23.5 N spring
2 44.5 x 15.5 34.0 —
(for ports P1 and P2) {3.0 kg} {2.40 kg}
16.7 N 13.3 N
3 Metering spring 26.5 x 8.15 24.9 —
{1.70 kg} {1.36 kg}
PC210LC-10 60-43
60 Maintenance standard
Travel PPC valve
60-44 PC210LC-10
60 Maintenance standard
Travel PPC valve
PC210LC-10 60-45
60 Maintenance standard
Travel PPC valve
Unit:mm
No. Item Criteria Remedy
Standard dimension Repair limit
Free length Installed Load at Load at
x Outside installed Free length installed If damaged
1 Centering spring length
diameter length length or deformed,
48.57 x 108 N 86.3 N replace
32.5 —
15.5 {11 kg} {8.8 kg} spring
26.53 x 16.7 N 13.3 N
2 Metering spring 24.9 —
8.15 {1.7 kg} {1.36 kg}
60-46 PC210LC-10
60 Maintenance standard
1st-line attachment PPC valve (with EPC valve)
(if equipped)
PPC: Abbreviation for Proportional Pressure Control
EPC: Abbreviation for Electromagnetic Proportional Control
PC210LC-10 60-47
60 Maintenance standard
1st-line attachment PPC valve (with EPC valve)
Unit:mm
No. Item Criteria Remedy
Standard dimension Repair limit
Free length Installed Load at Load at
x Outside installed Free length installed If damaged
1 Centering spring length
diameter length length or deformed,
125 N 100 N replace
33.9 x 15.3 28.4 —
{12.7 kg} {10.2 kg} spring
16.7 N 13.3 N
2 Metering spring 22.7 x 8.10 22.0 —
{1.70 kg} {1.36 kg}
60-48 PC210LC-10
60 Maintenance standard
1st-line attachment PPC valve (with EPC valve)
(if equipped)
EPC: Abbreviation for Electromagnetic Proportional Control
Unit:mm
No. Item Criteria Remedy
Standard dimension Repair limit
Load at Load at If damaged
Installed or deformed,
Free length installed Free length installed
1 Metering spring length replace the
length length
PPC valve
3.1 N 2.5 N assembly
9.5 8.4 —
{0.32 kg} {0.26 kg}
PC210LC-10 60-49
60 Maintenance standard
2nd-line attachment PPC valve
(if equipped)
PPC: Abbreviation for Proportional Pressure Control
Unit:mm
No. Item Criteria Remedy
Standard dimension Repair limit If damaged
Free length Installed Load at Load at or deformed,
1 Centering spring
x Outside installed Free length installed replace
length spring
diameter length length
60-50 PC210LC-10
60 Maintenance standard
2nd-line attachment PPC valve
Unit:mm
No. Item Criteria Remedy
125 N 100 N
33.9 x 15.3 28.4 —
{12.7 kg} {10.2 kg}
16.7 N 13.3 N
2 Metering spring 22.7 x 8.10 22.0 —
{1.70 kg} {1.36 kg}
PC210LC-10 60-51
60 Maintenance standard
Solenoid valve
a The figure shows the type for a machine ready for installing attachments.
60-52 PC210LC-10
60 Maintenance standard
Attachment circuit selector valve (for high-pressure
circuit)
(if equipped)
Unit mm
No. Item Criteria Remedy
Standard dimension Repair limit
Free length Installed Load at Load at If damaged
x Outside installed Free length installed or deformed,
1 Spool return spring length
diameter length length replace
28.7 N 22.9 N spring
33.4 x 11.2 27.3 —
{2.93 kg} {2.34 kg}
PC210LC-10 60-53
60 Maintenance standard
Attachment circuit selector valve (for low-pressure
circuit)
(if equipped)
Unit mm
No. Item Criteria Remedy
Standard dimension Repair limit
Free length Installed Load at Load at If damaged
x Outside installed Free length installed or deformed,
1 Spool return spring length
diameter length length replace
834 N 667 N spring
132 x 29 114.5 —
{85.0 kg} {68.0 kg}
60-54 PC210LC-10
60 Maintenance standard
Center swivel joint
Unit: mm
No. Item Criteria Remedy
Allowable
Clearance between Standard dimension Standard clearance
1 clearance Replace
rotor and shaft
80 0.056 to 0.105 0.111
PC210LC-10 60-55
60 Maintenance standard
Work equipment
60-56 PC210LC-10
60 Maintenance standard
Work equipment
PC210LC-10 60-57
60 Maintenance standard
Work equipment
Unit:mm
Criteria
No. Item Standard Tolerance Standard Allowable Remedy
dimension Shaft Hole clearance clearance
Clearance between pin
and bushing connecting -0.036 +0.135 0.110 to
1 90 1.0
revolving frame and -0.071 +0.074 0.206
boom
Clearance between pin -0.036 +0.137 0.113 to
2 and bushing connecting 90 1.0
-0.071 +0.077 0.208
boom and arm
Clearance between pin -0.030 +0.158 0.108 to
3 and bushing connecting 70 1.0 Replace pin
-0.076 +0.078 0.232
arm and link and bushing
Clearance between pin -0.030 +0.137 0.104 to
4 and bushing connecting 80 1.0
-0.076 +0.074 0.213
arm and bucket
Clearance between pin -0.030 +0.166 0.116 to
5 and bushing connecting 80 1.0
-0.076 +0.086 0.242
link and bucket
Clearance between pin -0.030 +0.166 0.104 to
6 and bushing connecting 80 1.0
-0.076 +0.086 0.230
links
60-58 PC210LC-10
60 Maintenance standard
Work equipment
Unit:mm
Criteria
Greasing Width of boss Width of hinge Remedy
No. Item Standard
interval Standard Standard
Tolerance Tolerance clearance
dimension dimension
Connecting 0 +1 Adjust shim
625.5 632 4.5 to 8.0
part of -0.5 -2 so that
7 revolving L7: Adjust with the combination of shim thickness 2.0 mm (2), clearance will
(*2) 2.5 mm (1), 3.0 mm (1), and 3.5 mm (1).
frame and be 1.0 mm or
boom 500 hours R7: Insert 2.0 mm thickness shim (1). less
(*1) +1.5
96 ±1.2 99.3 2.1 to 6.0
Connecting 0 Adjust shim
part of so that
8 revolving L8: Adjust with the combination of shim thickness 1.0 mm (1) clearance will
(*2) and 2.0 mm (2).
frame and be 1.5 mm or
boom 500 hours R8: Insert 1.0 mm thickness shim (1). less
cylinder
+3
695 ±2.4 701 2.6 to 11.4
Connecting -1 Adjust shim
part of L9-1: Adjust with the combination of shim thickness 1.0 mm (1) so that
9 boom and and 2.0 mm (2). clearance will
boom (*2) L9-2: Insert 1.0 mm thickness shim (1). be 1.5 mm or
cylinder 500 hours R9-1: Insert 1.0 mm thickness shim (1). less
R9-2: Insert 1.0 mm thickness shim (1).
+1.5 Adjust shim
Connecting 96 ±1.2 99.3 2.1 to 6.0
0 so that
part of
10 L10: Insert 1.0 mm thickness shim (1). clearance will
boom and (*2)
arm cylinder 500 hours R10: Adjust with the combination of shim thickness 1.0 mm (1) be 1.5 mm or
and 2.0 mm (2). less
0 +0.5 Adjust shim
Connecting 305.5 310 4.5 to 6.5
-0.5 0 so that
part of L11: Insert 2.0 mm thickness shim (1).
11 clearance will
boom and (*2)
R11: Adjust with either shim thickness 2.0 mm (1) or 2.5 mm be 1.0 mm or
arm 500 hours (1) or 3.0 mm (1). less
Connecting +1.5
106 ±1.2 109.3 2.1 to 6.0
part of arm 0 Replacement
12 L12: Insert 1.0 mm thickness shim (1).
cylinder and (*2) of shim
arm 500 hours R12: Insert 1.0 mm thickness shim (1).
+1.5 Adjust shim
Connecting 96 ±1.2 99.3 2.1 to 6.0
0 so that
part of arm
13 L13: Insert 1.0 mm thickness shim (1). clearance will
and bucket (*2)
cylinder R13: Adjust with the combination of shim thickness 1.0 mm (1) be 1.5 mm or
500 hours and 2.0 mm (2). less
Connecting 325 ±0.5 326.5 ±1 0 to 3.0
14 part of link (*2) L14: — —
and bucket 500 hours R14: —
Connecting 96 ±1.2 100.2 +0.5 2.5 to 5.9
part of
15a bucket (*2) L15a: Insert 1.0 mm thickness shim (1). —
cylinder and 500 hours R15a: Insert 1.0 mm thickness shim (1).
link
0 Adjust shim
280 — — —
Connecting -0.5 so that
15b part of link L15b: Insert 1.0 mm thickness shim (1). clearance will
(*2)
and link R15b: Adjust with the combination of shim thickness 1.0 mm be 1.5 mm or
500 hours (1) and 2.0 mm (1). less
PC210LC-10 60-59
60 Maintenance standard
Work equipment
Unit:mm
Criteria
Greasing Width of boss Width of hinge Remedy
No. Item Standard
interval Standard Standard
Tolerance Tolerance clearance
dimension dimension
0 Adjust shim
280 — — —
Connecting - 0.5 so that
16 part of arm L16: Adjust with the combination of shim thickness 1.0 mm (1) clearance will
(*2) and 2.0 mm (1).
and link be 1.5 mm or
500 hours R16: Insert 1.0 mm thickness shim (1). less
0 +2.2 Adjust shim
325 327.5 2.3 to 5.2
Connecting -0.5 -0.2 so that
17 part of arm L17: — clearance will
(*3)
and bucket R17: Adjust with the combination of shim thickness 0.5 mm (4) be 0.5 to 1.0
500 hours and 1.0 mm (12). mm
*1: The criteria indicates the L.H. boom cylinder. The position for shim adjustment of R.H. boom cylinder
becomes opposite to that of L.H. boom cylinder.
*2: Use plastic shims (with flange).
*3: Use separated iron shims.
a The number in ( ) next to the shim thickness shows the quantity of shims to be prepared.
60-60 PC210LC-10
60 Maintenance standard
Work equipment
PC210LC-10 60-61
60 Maintenance standard
Work equipment
Unit: mm
PC210LC–10
No. Tolerance
Measurement point Standard dimension
Shaft Hole
-0.030 +0.100
1 — 80
-0.076 0
+1.5
Arm side 109.3
2 0
Cylinder head side 106 ±1.2
+0.5
Boom side 310
0
3
0
Arm side 305.5
-0.5
-0.036 +0.054
4 — 90
-0.071 0
5 — 402.1 ±1.0
6 — 187.2 ±0.5
7 — 829.1 ±1.0
8 — 2,919 —
9 — 2,630.5 ±1.0
10 — 410 ±1.0
11 — 640 ±0.2
12 — 600 ±0.5
13 — 458.1 —
14 — 1,486 —
-0.030 +0.100
15 — 80
-0.076 0
Link side 325 ±0.5
16
Bucket side 326.5 ±1.0
-0.030 +0.100
17 — 80
-0.076 0
0
(without bushing) 311
-0.5
18
(with bushing press-
325 —
fitted)
(Min.) 1,680 —
19
(Max.) 2,800 —
60-62 PC210LC-10
60 Maintenance standard
Work equipment
PC210LC-10 60-63
60 Maintenance standard
Work equipment
Unit: mm
PC210LC–10
No.
Measurement point Standard dimension Tolerance
1 — 457.6 ±0.5
2 — 22 ±0.5
3 — 92°45′ —
4 — 458.1 —
5 — 1,477.3 —
6 — 158.6 —
7 — — —
8 — 15°54′ —
+0.1
9 — 80
0
10 — 326.5 ±1.0
11 — 56 —
12 — 106 —
13 — 470 —
14 — 23.5 —
15 — 140 —
16 — 190 —
17 — 133.2 —
18 — 131.6 —
19 — 107 —
20 — 85 —
+2.0
21 — 348.5
0
22 — 38 —
60-64 PC210LC-10
60 Maintenance standard
Boom cylinder (large diameter piston)
Unit:mm
No. Item Criteria Remedy
Standard Tolerance Standard Allowable
Clearance between dimension Shaft Hole clearance clearance Replace
1 piston rod and bushing bushing
-0.036 +0.257 0.084 to
90 0.437
-0.090 +0.048 0.347
Clearance between -0.030 +0.190
piston rod support shaft 0.100 to
2 80 1.0
and bushing -0.060 +0.070 0.250
Replace pin
Clearance between and bushing
-0.030 +0.165 0.075 to
3 cylinder bottom support 70 1.0
shaft and bushing -0.060 +0.045 0.225
Tightening torque of
4 373 ± 54.0 Nm {38.0 ± 5.5 kgm}
cylinder head
Tightening torque of
5 294 ± 29.4 Nm {30.0 ± 3.0 kgm} Retighten
cylinder piston
Tightening torque of
6 cylinder piston fix 58.9 to 73.6 Nm {6.0 to 7.5 kgm}
screw
PC210LC-10 60-65
60 Maintenance standard
Arm cylinder
Unit:mm
No. Item Criteria Remedy
Standard Tolerance Standard Allowable
Clearance between dimension Shaft Hole clearance clearance Replace
1 piston rod and bushing bushing
– 0.036 + 0.222 0.083 to
95 0.412
– 0.090 + 0.047 0.312
Clearance between – 0.030 + 0.190
piston rod support shaft 0.100 to
2 80 1.0
and bushing – 0.076 + 0.070 0.266
Replace pin
Clearance between and bushing
– 0.030 + 0.190 0.100 to
3 cylinder bottom support 80 1.0
shaft and bushing – 0.076 + 0.070 0.266
Tightening torque of
4 373 ± 54.0 Nm {38.0 ± 5.5 kgm}
cylinder head
Tightening torque of
5 294 ± 29.4 Nm {30.0 ± 3.0 kgm} Retighten
cylinder piston
Tightening torque of
6 cylinder piston fix 58.9 to 73.6 Nm {6.0 to 7.5 kgm}
screw
60-66 PC210LC-10
60 Maintenance standard
Bucket cylinder
Unit:mm
No. Item Criteria Remedy
Standard Tolerance Standard Allowable
Clearance between dimension Shaft Hole clearance clearance Replace
1 piston rod and bushing bushing
-0.030 +0.258 0.078 to
80 0.434
-0.076 +0.048 0.334
Clearance between -0.030 +0.170
piston rod support shaft 0.100 to
2 70 1.0
and bushing -0.060 +0.070 0.230
Replace pin
Clearance between and bushing
-0.030 +0.165 0.075 to
3 cylinder bottom support 70 1.0
shaft and bushing -0.060 +0.045 0.225
Tightening torque of
4 270 ± 39 Nm {27.5 ± 4.0kgm}
cylinder head
Tightening torque of
5 294 ± 29.4 Nm {30.0 ± 3.0 kgm} Retighten
cylinder piston
Tightening torque of
6 cylinder piston fix 58.9 to 73.6 Nm {6.0 to 7.5 kgm}
screw
PC210LC-10 60-67
60 Maintenance standard
Bucket cylinder
60-68 PC210LC-10
SHOP MANUAL
HYDRAULIC EXCAVATOR
PC210LC-10
Model Serial Number
80 Appendix
9 80 Appendix
PC210LC-10 80-1
80 Appendix
Table of contents
80-2 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Precautions for refrigerant
k Collect the refrigerant (air conditioner gas: R134a) from the air conditioner circuit before
disconnecting the air conditioner hoses to replace the air conditioner unit or condenser, the air
conditioner compressor, receiver drier, etc.
a Ask a qualified person for collecting, adding and filling operations of the refrigerant (air conditioner gas:
R134a). (Only registered person can work.)
a Never release the refrigerant (R134a) to the atmosphere.
k If refrigerant gas (R134a) gets in your eyes, you may lose your sight. And if it touches your skin,
you may suffer from frostbite. Put on protective eyeglasses, gloves and working clothes with long
sleeves while collecting the refrigerant or filling the air conditioner circuit with the refrigerant.
PC210LC-10 80-3
80 Appendix
Air conditioner component
80-4 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Air conditioner component
1. Compressor
2. Condenser
3. Modulator (with desiccant)
4. Hot water piping
5. Hot water return piping
6. Refrigerant piping
7. Dual pressure switch
8. Sight glass
9. Air conditioner controller
10. Air conditioner unit
11. Recirculation air filter
12. Fresh air filter
13. Machine monitor
14. Sunlight sensor
A. Front vent
B. Rear vent
C. Foot vent
D. Defroster vent
E. Recirculation air inlet
PC210LC-10 80-5
80 Appendix
Air conditioner component
Refrigerant R134a
Refrigerant refilling level (g) 930 ± 50
80-6 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Configuration and function of refrigeration cycle
PC210LC-10 80-7
80 Appendix
Outline of refrigeration cycle
• The refrigerating cycle performs the following four processes. The refrigerant is liquefied and gasified
repeatedly while it is circulated in the cycle.
Compression (Compressor)
• The compressor sucks in the refrigerant that has been vaporized in the evaporator and compresses it into
a state where it can be easily liquefied at the ambient temperature.
• The gaseous refrigerant sucked into the compressor cylinder is compressed to a temperature and
pressure at which it can be easily liquefied when cooled to the ambient temperature.
Condensation (Condenser)
• The condenser cools and liquefies the high pressure and high-temperature gaseous refrigerant sent from
the compressor.
• The heat released to the outside from the condenser is called condensation heat.
• The amount of condensation heat is the sum total of the heat absorbed by the evaporator from the air in
the cab and the quantity of the work applied (the value converted into a heat quantity) by compression of
the compressor.
• The refrigerant liquefied in the condenser is dehydrated in the modulator and cooled further in the sub-cool
section to increase the cooling efficiency.
• In the compression cycle, the gaseous refrigerant and liquid refrigerant coexist.
• The temperature (condensation temperature) and the pressure (condensation pressure) at which the
gaseous refrigerant is liquefied are proportional to each other.
(The condensation pressure varies depending on the condensation temperature of the refrigerant)
Evaporation (Evaporator)
• The evaporator evaporates the liquid refrigerant (superheated vapor).
• The refrigerant evaporates, while absorbing an amount of heat necessary for evaporation (evaporation
heat) from the air around the cooling fins (air in the cab).
• After the heat has been removed, the cooled air is sent into the cab by the blower fan, reducing the
temperature inside the cab.
• The mist refrigerant that has been sent from the expansion valve coexists with the evaporated refrigerant
in the evaporator
• The temperature (evaporation temperature) and the pressure (evaporation pressure) at which the liquid
refrigerant is evaporated are proportional to each other.
• The compressor sucks in the evaporated refrigerant in order to keep the pressure level in the evaporator
as low as possible so that the liquid refrigerant can be evaporated at a much lower temperature.
80-8 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Outline of refrigeration cycle
• If there is an insufficient quantity of refrigerant, all of it will be evaporated while it is passing through the
evaporator. This causes evaporator efficiency to deteriorate, which will result in defective air conditioning.
• If there is excessive refrigerant, not all of it will be evaporated and part of it will be sucked into the
compressor in liquid form, which will cause the compressor to compress the liquid and may damage the
components.
• If water gets into the refrigeration circuit, it will freeze at a small hole in the expansion valve, lower the
refrigerant flow, and may result in defective air conditioning.
PC210LC-10 80-9
80 Appendix
Air conditioner unit
80-10 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Air conditioner unit
• The air conditioner unit consists of evaporator (1) and heater core (2), and is used to cool down or warm
up the air in the cab.
Temperature control
• When the temperature control switch on the machine monitor is operated, the set temperature data is sent
to the air conditioner controller that is located at the rear of the operator's seat.
• The air conditioner controller controls air mix servomotor (5) to change the angle of air mix door (6) so that
the set temperature is reached
PC210LC-10 80-11
80 Appendix
Air conditioner unit
80-12 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Air conditioner unit
a For details of the numbers in the following sentence, see “Air conditioner unit”.
Evaporator (ALL-K549-042-K-00-A)
• Evaporator (1) is cooled by the low-pressure, low-temperature refrigerant gas being sent from expansion
valve (3).
• Air from blower motor (4) is cooled and dehumidified when passing through the evaporator fins.
PC210LC-10 80-13
80 Appendix
Air conditioner unit
Servomotor (ALL-K5D2-042-K-00-A)
a Servomotors are used to adjust the temperature (air mix) and to perform vent (mode) changeover.
• When a switch on the machine monitor is operated, the air conditioner controller applies 24V power
between servomotor terminal B (6) and servomotor terminal A (7). (Rotation direction switches according
to the polarity of supply voltage.) )
• The servomotor contains a variable resistor, and its resistance value changes as the motor rotates.
• The air conditioner controller applies a voltage of 5 V to the variable resistor and determines the motor
rotation angle from the potential difference.
• When the door (damper) reaches the position specified by each switch, the air conditioner controller stops
the supply of current to the servomotor, then the corresponding door stops.
• When the air conditioner controller cannot recognize the potential difference that corresponds to the
command to the servomotor, it generates a air conditioner failure code to inform the machine monitor of
failure in air conditioner system. Failure code [879EMC] or [879FMC] is displayed on the electrical system
failure record screen of the machine monitor.
a FRESH/RECIRC air changeover servo motor does not feature a variable resistance, and therefore,
does not have a self-diagnosis function.
a Do not try to drive a servomotor by supplying power directly between servomotor terminals (6) and (7)
during inspection.
80-14 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Air conditioner unit
Outline
• The expansion valve(1) converts high-pressure and high-temperature liquid refrigerant from the receiver
drier to low-pressure, low-temperature misty refrigerant through the throttle action.
• It controls the flow rate of refrigerant by changing the level of throttling depending on the temperature in
the cab.
• The temperature of the air blown out of the air vent is adjusted depending on the flow rate of refrigerant
circulating in the evaporator (3).
Structure (ALL-K548-042-K-00-A)
• Box-type expansion valve (1) consists of needle valve (1a), spring (1b), etc.
• Refrigerant gas (2) is sealed in the diaphragm chamber (hatched area) outside diaphragm (1a-1) of
needle valve (1a).
• The opening level of needle valve (1a) is determined based on the balance between the reaction force
exerted by spring (1b) in a rightward direction, and force (Fg) of refrigerant gas (2) pushing needle valve
(1a) through diaphragm (1a-1) in a leftward direction.
PC210LC-10 80-15
80 Appendix
Air conditioner unit
• The refrigerant flow rate flowing from the receiver drier to evaporator (3) is determined based on the
opening level of needle valve (1a).
Operation (ALL-K548-044-K-00-A)
• Thermoprobe (1a-2) senses the refrigerant temperature after it passes through the evaporator (3).
• After the refrigerant passes through evaporator (3), its temperature is transferred to the refrigerant gas (2)
in the diaphragm chamber (hatched area) through the thermoprobe (1a-2).
• The pressure of the refrigerant gas (2) sealed in the diaphragm chamber (hatched area) changes in
response to the temperature change of the thermoprobe (1a-2), which therefore changes the force (Fg)
pushing the needle valve (1a).
• The opening level of the needle valve (1a) is determined based on the balance between the reaction force
exerted by the spring (1b) in a rightward direction, and the force (Fg) of the refrigerant gas (2) pushing the
needle valve (1a) through the diaphragm (1a-1) in a leftward direction.
When evaporator (3) outlet temperature is high: [When not cooled yet: Condition (A) in the figure]
• The pressure of the refrigerant gas (2) in the diaphragm chamber is high and the volume is increased.
• The force (Fg) of the refrigerant gas (2) pushing the needle valve (1a) is increased, and the needle valve
(1a) moves leftward.
• As a result, the opening level of the needle valve (1a) is increased and the refrigerant flow rate to the
evaporator (3) is increased to improve cooling capacity. (Condition (A) in previous figure)
When evaporator (3) outlet temperature is low: [When cooled already: Condition (B) in the figure]
• The pressure of the refrigerant gas (2) in the diaphragm chamber is low and the volume is decreased.
• The force (Fg) of the refrigerant gas (2) pushing the needle valve (1a) is reduced, and the needle valve
(1a) is moved rightward by the reaction force of spring (1b).
• The opening level of the needle valve (1a) is reduced and the refrigerant flow rate to the evaporator (3) is
reduced to lower the cooling capacity. (Condition (B) in previous figure)
80-16 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Dual pressure switch
a The dual pressure switch is mounted on the air conditioner hose under the floor.
• The dual pressure switch turns “OFF“ when the refrigerant circuit pressure becomes abnormally low or
abnormally high.
• When the dual pressure switch turns "OFF", the air conditioner controller turns the compressor clutch
relay “OFF“. As a result, the compressor's magnet clutch is released and air conditioner components are
protected.
Function (ALL-K5FG-042-K-00-A)
PC210LC-10 80-17
80 Appendix
Air conditioner controller
80-18 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Compressor
Compressor (ALL-K590-041-K-00-A)
• The compressor circulates the refrigerant and compresses the gaseous refrigerant from the evaporator
into a misty refrigerant at high pressure and high temperature so that it will be easily regenerated
(liquefied) at the normal temperature.
• Calling into account of the evaporator temperature and refrigerant pressure, the air conditioner controller
activates magnetic clutch (2) built in the compressor.
• When magnetic clutch (2) is engaged, the power of the engine rotates the compressor shaft along with
pulley (1) to drive the compressor.
PC210LC-10 80-19
80 Appendix
Air conditioner condenser
• The condenser cools and liquefies the high pressure and high temperature misty refrigerant sent from the
compressor.
• The sub-cool section of condenser (1) further cools liquefied refrigerator, which came to this section after
passing through modulator (2), to increase the cooling efficiency.
• Modulator (2) stores the high-pressure and high-temperature liquefied refrigerant from the condenser. It is
capable of completely liquefying the refrigerant even when bubbles are contained in the refrigerant due to
the condenser condition in heat dissipation.
• Filter (4) and desiccating agent (3) contained in modulator (2) eliminate foreign substances in the
circulation circuit and water in the refrigerant.
80-20 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Air conditioner condenser
a If the fin is crushed or is clogged with dust, heat exchange efficiency is reduced and complete liquefaction
of refrigerant becomes impossible. Since increase of pressure in the refrigerant circulation circuit applies
extra load to the engine and reduces the cooling effect, you must take care not to crush or damage the fins
when handling them or during daily inspection.
a For the replacement procedure of desiccating agent (3) in modulator (2), see "Desiccant replacement".
PC210LC-10 80-21
80 Appendix
Sunlight sensor
1. Connector
2. Sensor
Function (ALL-K5FH-042-K-00-A)
Output characteristics
80-22 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Outer temperature sensor (outside air temperature
sensor)
1. Connector
2. Sensor
Function (ALL-K55C-042-K-00-A)
PC210LC-10 80-23
80 Appendix
Procedure for testing and troubleshooting
The air conditioner is provided with self-diagnosis functionality in order to provide for inspection of its main
components. Specifically, the operation of sensors and servomotors can be examined.
If a troubled section is detected, every part of that section must be inspected.
1. After basic check, find the troubled section according to the detected trouble of the air conditioner.
2. Narrow down the sections with the self-diagnosis function (See “Check with self-diagnosis”).
If, however, the entire air conditioner unit fails to operate, inspect for problems with the supply of power to
the air conditioner controller and with CAN communication between the machine monitor and the air
conditioner controller.
If any part of the air conditioner unit can operate, it will indicate that the air conditioner controller is
receiving power normally and that CAN communication between the machine monitor and the air
conditioner controller is normal.
3. After finding out the troubled section, inspect the component parts in that section and repair the troubled
part.
*1: By error display or abnormal display on "Electrical Systems" screen on the machine monitor.
*2: Simple checking of refrigerant volume through sight glass.
Start up the engine, set the air conditioner switch to ON, and then wait for five minutes before proceeding with
the inspection.
A) If the continuous stream of bubbles can be seen, the system contains insufficient refrigerant.
B) If the bubbles can be seen intermittently, the refrigerant volume is sufficient.
80-24 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Procedure for testing and troubleshooting
C) If no bubbles can be seen (i.e., the liquid is perfectly clear), the system contains too much refrigerant or no
refrigerant at all.
The above should be treated as general guidelines as certain exceptions do exist.
See "Troubleshooting with gauge pressure" and use gauge pressure to determine whether or not the
condition is normal.
S: Sight glass condition
R: Receiver drier internal condition
LR: Liquid refrigerant
*3: If any leakage of refrigerant is occurring, the compressor oil circulating within the air conditioner circuit will
definitely be leaking from the same point.
In such a case, retighten in accordance with the table of retightening torques from "Precautions for
disconnecting and connecting air conditioner piping."
*4: Start the engine and perform the check with the air conditioner switch set to ON.
PC210LC-10 80-25
80 Appendix
Circuit diagram and arrangement of connector pins
80-26 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Circuit diagram and arrangement of connector pins
PC210LC-10 80-27
80 Appendix
System diagram
80-28 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Input and output signals of the air conditioner controller
AMP025 - 32PF
Input/Output
Pin No. Symbol Signal name
signal
1 +Bback Backup power supply Input
2 – (*1) –
3 SS Sunlight sensor Input
4 THOUT Outside air temperature sensor Input
5 THF Evaporator temperature sensor Input
6 THI Inside air temperature sensor Input
7 POT5 V Servomotor potentiometer power supply (5 V) Output
8 BWFB Blower feedback signal Input
9 PTRB Power transistor control signal Output
10 CAN_H CAN communication signal (H) Input/output
11 CAN_L CAN communication signal (L) Input/output
12 – (*1) –
13 MRFA Fresh/recirculated air servomotor terminal A Output
14 MRFB Fresh/recirculated air servomotor terminal B Output
15 MAMA Air mix servomotor terminal A Output
16 MAMB Air mix servomotor terminal B Output
17 +24 V 24 V power supply Input
18 – (*1) –
19 SAM Air mix servomotor potentiometer signal Input
20 SVI Vent (mode) changeover servomotor potentiometer signal Input
21 PRESS SW Dual pressure switch Input
22 – (*1) –
23 – (*1) –
24 – (*1) –
25 GNDS Sensor GND Input
26 GND GND Input
27 – (*1) –
28 – (*1) –
29 RLCC Compressor clutch relay Output
30 – (*1) –
31 MV1A Vent (mode) changeover servomotor terminal A Output
32 MV1B Vent (mode) changeover servomotor terminal B Output
*1: Never connect these pins. Malfunctions or failures may occur.
Function (ALL-K5G4-042-K-00-A)
PC210LC-10 80-29
80 Appendix
Input and output signals of the air conditioner controller
5. The air conditioner controller detects the evaporator temperature using the evaporator temperature
sensor.
6. In order to prevent freezing of the evaporator, the air conditioner controller controls the compressor by
turning the compressor clutch relay ON and OFF.
a When the dual pressure switch detects a pressure abnormality (i.e., turns OFF), the air conditioner
controller turns the compressor clutch relay OFF, and therefore, the compressor stops operating.
7. When performing automatic air conditioning, the air conditioner controller controls the inside (air)
temperature to the set temperature and adjust the air flow according to the data from the sunlight sensor,
the outside air temperature sensor, and the inside air temperature sensor.
8. The air conditioner controller has the self-diagnosis function. If any abnormality is detected, the controller
notifies it to the machine monitor by the CAN communication. Then, failure code [879***] is displayed on
the "Electrical Systems" screen of the electrical system on the machine monitor.
80-30 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Parts and connectors layout
• Three fuses related to the air conditioner are in the fuse box at the right rear of the operator's seat.
• The air conditioner unit is mounted inside the rear cover of the operator's seat.
k Park the machine on a level surface, swing the upper structure by 90 degrees, lower the work
equipment to the ground so that it is stable, and stop the engine.
k Turn the battery disconnect switch to the "OFF" position and pull out the key.
a Note the connector numbers and installed positions before disconnecting wiring and hoses.
Connector Reference
Remarks Location
No. item
AC01 Intermediate connector Right rear of cab 2.
AC02 Intermediate connector Right rear of cab 2.
AC03 Air conditioner compressor Engine 7.
ACECU Air conditioner controller Rear of cab 2.
CM01* Machine monitor Front of cab 5.
CM02 Machine monitor Front of cab 5.
CM03* Machine monitor Front of cab 5.
CM04* Machine monitor Front of cab 5.
F01 Fuse box Right rear of cab 1.
Dual pressure switch
P17 Under cab 6.
a Swing upper structure 90 deg.
P18 Outside air temperature sensor Cooling unit 8.
P31 Sunlight sensor Machine monitor 4.
R21 Relay Rear of cab 2.
[2] Power transistor Air conditioner unit 3.
[5]* FRESH/RECIRC air changeover
Air conditioner unit 3.
servomotor
[6]* Inside air temperature sensor Air conditioner unit 3.
Evaporator temperature sensor
[7]* Air conditioner unit 3.
(Frost sensor)
*: Connector that does not appear during troubleshooting
Details (PC200LC_10-K500-04D-K-01-A)
PC210LC-10 80-31
80 Appendix
Parts and connectors layout
80-32 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Parts and connectors layout
4. Sunlight sensor
P31: Sunlight sensor connector
5. Machine monitor
• CM01 to CM04: Machine monitor connector
a Connector CM03: (Not used)
a Connector CM04: (For camera connection)
PC210LC-10 80-33
80 Appendix
Parts and connectors layout
80-34 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Testing air leakage (duct)
k Place the machine on a level ground, lower the work equipment to the ground and stop the engine.
k Turn the battery disconnect switch to the OFF position and remove the key.
a Note the connector numbers and installed positions before disconnecting wiring harnesses and hoses.
Check (ALL-K5D0-360-K-00-A)
1. Lift front window assembly (1) to the ceiling and lock it.
a Check that the front window is securely locked.
2. Remove front lower window (2).
3. Remove floor mat (3).
4. Remove cover (4) first, and then remove cover (5).
5. Remove cover (6).
PC210LC-10 80-35
80 Appendix
Testing air leakage (duct)
80-36 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Testing air leakage (duct)
PC210LC-10 80-37
80 Appendix
Testing with self-diagnosis function
Outline (ALL-Q19Y-360-K-00-A)
On the air conditioner operation screen of the machine monitor, the system performs self-diagnosis to the
communication with the air conditioner controller, FRESH/RECIRC air temperature sensor, outside (air)
temperature sensor, evaporator temperature sensor, temperature control, vent (mode) changeover, and
refrigerant pressure with the pressure switch, and if a problem is detected, the "Air conditioner system
condition monitor" is displayed.
a Even if the cause of a detected problem is restored to normal, the self-diagnosis failure condition will not
automatically be reset. To reset the failure condition, the starter switch must be set to OFF.
a On the "Electrical System" screen in the service mode of the machine monitor, the system performs self-
diagnosis for various sensors. If a problem is detected, failure information is displayed.
a FRESH/RECIRC air changeover servomotor is not checked with self-diagnosis function.
How to open the electrical system abnormality record screen in service mode
of the machine monitor (PC220-Q19Y-100-K-00-A)
• Overview of machine monitor operating procedure
Normal screen
O While pressing [4], press [1], [2], and [3] in this order.
Service menu (Mode)
O Press [F3] twice. Press [F6].
03 Abnormality record
O Press [F3] once. Press [F6].
02 Electrical Systems screen
• Detailed description of machine monitor operating procedure
1. On the normal operation screen, while pressing number key [4], press [1], [2], and [3] in this order.
2. On the service menu screen, press [F3] twice, and then select "03 Abnormality Record".
3. Press [F6] to confirm.
80-38 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Testing with self-diagnosis function
4. On the Abnormality Record screen, press [F3] once, and then select "02 Electrical Systems".
5. Press [F6] to confirm.
a For details, see the failure code list related to air conditioner
Failure code Failure (Displayed on screen) Remarks
879AKA A/C Inner Sensor Open Circuit
*
879AKB A/C Inner Sensor Short Circuit
879BKA A/C Outer Sensor Open Circuit
879BKB A/C Outer Sensor Short Circuit
879CKA Ventilating Sensor Open Circuit
*
879CKB Ventilating Sensor Short Circuit
879DKZ Sunlight Sensor Open or Short Circuit
879EMC Ventilation Damper Abnormality *
879FMC Air Mix Damper Abnormality *
879GKX Refrigerant Abnormality
DAZ9KQ A/C Model Selection Abnormality See Chapter 40, "Troubleshooting by
failure code"
DAZQKR CAN2 Discon (Aircon ECU)
**
*: Troubleshooting cannot be performed while the controller is mounted on the machine since the connector
cannot be checked.
**: Troubleshooting is not performed by the air conditioner unit but by the machine monitor.
a The air conditioner inner sensor means the inside (air) temperature sensor.
a The air conditioner outer sensor means the outside (air) temperature sensor.
a The ventilating sensor means the evaporator temperature sensor (frost sensor).
a The vent damper means the vent (mode) changeover damper (door).
a The air mix damper means the temperature adjustment (air mix) damper (door).
PC210LC-10 80-39
80 Appendix
Testing vent (mode) changeover
k Place the machine on a level ground, lower the work equipment to the ground and stop the engine.
a Note the connector numbers and installed positions before disconnecting wiring harnesses and hoses.
Testing (ALL-K5FR-360-K-00-A)
80-40 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Testing vent (mode) changeover
10.After finishing the inspection, turn the starting switch to the OFF position.
PC210LC-10 80-41
80 Appendix
Testing FRESH/RECIRC air changeover
k Place the machine on a level ground, lower the work equipment to the ground and stop the engine.
Testing (ALL-K5D2-360-K-00-A)
1. Open outside air filter cover (1) and remove outside air filter (2).
2. Start the engine and turn the air conditioner power "ON".
3. Operate the FRESH/RECIRC air selector switch on the machine monitor.
4. Check the opening/closing operation of FRESH/RECIRC air changeover rear door (3) through the fresh
air inlet on the left side of the cab.
5. After finishing the inspection, turn the starting switch to the OFF position.
80-42 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Testing sunlight sensor
k Place the machine on a level ground, lower the work equipment to the ground and stop the engine.
k Turn the battery disconnect switch to the OFF position and remove the key.
a Note the connector numbers and installed positions before disconnecting wiring harnesses and hoses.
Testing (PC220-K5FH-360-K-01-A)
1. Remove the machine monitor cover. For details, see "Testing air leakage (duct)", Steps 6 and 7.
2. Check connector P31 at the rear of the sunlight sensor. (Check whether the connector is coming off.)
3. Disconnect connector P31, remove the sunlight sensor, and measure the voltage between the terminals
on the sensor side using a circuit tester in voltage range.
• Approximate voltage of sunlight sensor unit
0.55 V: Direct sunlight
0.45 V: Cloudy
0.4 V: Indoors
PC210LC-10 80-43
80 Appendix
Testing (dual) pressure switch for refrigerant
k Place the machine on a level ground, lower the work equipment to the ground and stop the engine.
k Turn the battery disconnect switch to the OFF position and remove the key.
a Note the connector numbers and installed positions before disconnecting wiring harnesses and hoses.
Testing (PC220-K5FG-360-K-01-A)
1. Swing by 90 ° .
2. Remove the cab undercover.
3. Disconnect the dual pressure switch connector P17.
4. Ensure that the resistance between the switch-side terminals from connector P17 is shorted (ON). (If not
shorted (OFF), the dual pressure switch will detect a refrigerant pressure abnormality.)
a When the dual pressure switch is OFF, connect a pressure gauge to the high-pressure side of the air
conditioner compressor and check the refrigerant pressure. See "Connection of service tool" and
"Troubleshooting with gauge pressure."
a If the refrigerant pressure is normal, the dual pressure switch is defective.
• (Dual) pressure switch
a If resistance between the switch-side terminals from connector P17 is shorted (ON), perform
"Troubleshooting for compressor and refrigerant system".
80-44 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Testing relays
k Place the machine on a level ground, lower the work equipment to the ground and stop the engine.
k Turn the battery disconnect switch to the OFF position and remove the key.
a Note the connector numbers and installed positions before disconnecting wiring harnesses and hoses.
Testing (PC220-K5FE-360-K-03-A)
PC210LC-10 80-45
80 Appendix
Troubleshooting chart 1
Numbers in T represent the item numbers in the troubleshooting quick reference table.
1. Lowered cooling performance
80-46 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Troubleshooting chart 2
1. During cooling, the blower fan motor does not operate or the rotation speed does not match the air flow
setting.
Probable cause Check method Remedy
Check the connector for disconnection. Repair broken parts
Wire breakage or defective and connect
connection See "Parts and connectors layout". correctly
Operate the fan switches in order and check the fan
Defective blower fan motor speed. Replace
See "Air conditioner unit".
Defective power transistor Operate the fan switches in order and check the fan
Replace
(PTR) speed.
2. During cooling, the blower fan motor is normal but the flow of air is very light.
Probable cause Check method Remedy
Large duct resistance Check the filter for clogging and the duct for crushing. Repair
Air leakage through duct Check duct joints.
Repair
joints See "Testing air leakage (duct)".
Obstruction at evaporator Check evaporator for stain and obstruction Remove obstruction
inlet and clean
Defective evaporator Evaporator is frozen.
temperature sensor, Sensor fixing clip inspection, sensor contaminated
defective contact of Repair or replace
evaporator temperature Inspect the air conditioner hose around the pressure
switch for frost.
sensor, defective expansion
valve* (when freezing has advanced even further)
*: The evaporator temperature sensor and expansion valve are located inside the air conditioner unit.
3. Pressure abnormality (high-pressure/low-pressure) during cooling.
Probable cause Check method Remedy
Repair leaking part,
then charge with
Insufficient refrigerant
proper quantity of
Check the refrigerant volume through sight glass. refrigerant again
Specifically, perform checking with the gauge manifold Collect refrigerant,
connected. then fill up with
Overcharge with refrigerant
proper quantity of
refrigerant again
Normal pressure range
Low-pressure: Approx. 0.13 to 0.2 MPa {1.3 to 2.0 kg/
cm2 }
Judgment by pressure at See Troubleshooting
inlet/outlet of compressor High pressure: Approx. 1.5 to 1.7 MPa {15 to 17 kg/cm2 with gauge pressure
}
Temperature in operator's cab: 30 to 35 °C , Engine
speed: Approx. 1,500 rpm
PC210LC-10 80-47
80 Appendix
Troubleshooting chart 2
80-48 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Troubleshooting chart 2
8. Other abnormalities
Probable cause Check method Remarks
Temperature cannot be Select manual mode and change temperature setting.
controlled
Vent (mode) changeover is Common to cooling
See "Testing vent (mode) changeover".
not possible. and heating
FRESH/RECIRC air cannot
See "Testing FRESH/RECIRC air changeover".
be changed over
Excessive compressor oil See "Handling of compressor oil".
Cooling only
Water leakage into the cab Clogging of drain hole
PC210LC-10 80-49
80 Appendix
Information in troubleshooting table
80-50 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Failure code list related to air conditioner
a The air conditioner inner sensor means the inside (air) temperature sensor.
a The air conditioner outer sensor means the outside (air) temperature sensor.
a The ventilating sensor means the evaporator temperature sensor (frost sensor).
a The vent damper means the vent (mode) changeover damper (door).
a The Air Mix Damper means the temperature adjustment (air mix) damper (door).
a Troubleshooting for the troubles which do not display failure codes is explained after failure code
[879GKX].
• Troubleshooting for power supply system (Air conditioner does not operate)
• Troubleshooting for compressor and refrigerant system (Air is not cooled)
• Troubleshooting for blower motor system (No air comes out or air flow is abnormal)
• Troubleshooting for FRESH/RECIRC air changeover
PC210LC-10 80-51
80 Appendix
Failure code [879AKA] A/C Inner Sensor Open Circuit
Action level Failure code Open circuit in air conditioner inside air temperature sensor
Failure
- 879AKA (Machine monitor system)
Detail of • Air conditioner controller detected open circuit in inside (air) temperature sensor.
failure
• The air conditioner controller sends information about the inside (air) temperature sensor
Action of open circuit to the machine monitor via CAN communication.
controller • Stops the air conditioner if it is in automatic mode.
• The air conditioner does not operate in automatic mode because of a short circuit in the
Problem on air conditioner inside air temperature sensor.
machine (The air conditioner can be operated in manual mode)
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
• Check whether this failure code is displayed on the "Electrical Systems" screen in service
Related mode of the machine monitor.
information • Troubleshooting cannot be performed since the connector portion of the air conditioner
inside (air) temperature sensor cannot be checked while the controller is installed on the
machine.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective air conditioner Air conditioner controller may be defective. (Since this is an internal
1 defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
controller
Air conditioner unit may be defective. (Since this is an internal defect,
2 Defective air conditioner unit troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
80-52 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Failure code [879AKB] A/C Inner Sensor Short Circuit
Action level Failure code Short circuit in air conditioner inside air temperature sensor
Failure
- 879AKB (Machine monitor system)
Detail of • Air conditioner controller detected short circuit in inside (air) temperature sensor.
failure
• The air conditioner controller sends information about the inside (air) temperature sensor
Action of short circuit to the machine monitor via CAN communication.
controller • Stops the air conditioner if it is in automatic mode.
• The air conditioner does not operate in automatic mode because of a short circuit in the
Problem on air conditioner inside air temperature sensor.
machine (The air conditioner can be operated in manual mode)
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
• Check whether this failure code is displayed on the electrical system abnormality record
Related screen in service mode of the machine monitor.
information • Troubleshooting cannot be performed since the connector portion of the air conditioner
inside (air) temperature sensor cannot be checked while the controller is installed on the
machine.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective air conditioner Air conditioner controller may be defective. (Since this is an internal
1 defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
controller
Air conditioner unit may be defective. (Since this is an internal defect,
2 Defective air conditioner unit troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
PC210LC-10 80-53
80 Appendix
Failure code [879BKA] A/C Outer sensor Open Circuit
Defective air If no failures are found by the above checks, the air conditioner controller may be
4 conditioner defective.
controller (Since this is an internal defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
If no failures are found by the above checks, the air conditioner unit may be
Defective air defective.
5
conditioner unit
(Since this is an internal defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
80-54 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Failure code [879BKA] A/C Outer sensor Open Circuit
PC210LC-10 80-55
80 Appendix
Failure code [879BKB] A/C Outer sensor Short Circuit
Defective air If no failures are found by the above checks, the air conditioner controller may be
5 conditioner defective.
controller (Since this is an internal defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
If no failures are found by the above checks, the air conditioner unit may be
Defective air defective.
6
conditioner unit
(Since this is an internal defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
80-56 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Failure code [879BKB] A/C Outer sensor Short Circuit
PC210LC-10 80-57
80 Appendix
Failure code [879CKA] Ventilating Sensor Open Circuit
Action level Failure code Open circuit in evaporator temperature (frost) sensor
Failure
- 879CKA (Machine monitor system)
Detail of • Air conditioner controller detected open circuit in evaporator temperature (frost) sensor.
failure
• The air conditioner controller sends information about the evaporator temperature (frost)
Action of sensor open circuit to the machine monitor via CAN communication.
controller • Stops the air conditioner.
Problem on • The air conditioner does not operate due to an open circuit in the evaporator temperature
machine (frost) sensor.
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
• Check whether this failure code is displayed on the electrical system abnormality record
Related screen in service mode of the machine monitor.
information • Troubleshooting cannot be performed since the connector portion of the evaporator
temperature (frost) sensor cannot be checked while the air conditioner unit is installed on
the machine.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective air conditioner Air conditioner controller may be defective. (Since this is an internal
1 defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
controller
Air conditioner unit may be defective. (Since this is an internal defect,
2 Defective air conditioner unit troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
80-58 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Failure code [879CKB] Ventilating Sensor Short Circuit
Action level Failure code Short circuit in evaporator temperature (frost) sensor
Failure
- 879CKB (Machine monitor system)
Detail of • Air conditioner controller detected short circuit in evaporator temperature (frost) sensor.
failure
• The air conditioner controller sends information about the evaporator temperature (frost)
Action of sensor short circuit to the machine monitor via CAN communication.
controller • Stops the air conditioner.
Problem on • The air conditioner does not operate due to a short circuit in the evaporator temperature
machine (frost) sensor.
• Method of reproducing failure code: Starting switch ON
• Check whether this failure code is displayed on the electrical system abnormality record
Related screen in service mode of the machine monitor.
information • Troubleshooting cannot be performed since the connector portion of the evaporator
temperature (frost) sensor cannot be checked while the air conditioner unit is installed on
the machine.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective air conditioner Air conditioner controller may be defective. (Since this is an internal
1 defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
controller
Air conditioner unit may be defective. (Since this is an internal defect,
2 Defective air conditioner unit troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
PC210LC-10 80-59
80 Appendix
Failure code [879DKZ] Sunlight sensor Open or Short
Circuit
Defective air If no failures are found by the above checks, the air conditioner controller may be
3 conditioner defective.
controller (Since this is an internal defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
If no failures are found by the above checks, the air conditioner unit may be
Defective air defective.
4
conditioner unit
(Since this is an internal defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
80-60 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Failure code [879DKZ] Sunlight sensor Open or Short
Circuit
PC210LC-10 80-61
80 Appendix
Failure code [879EMC] Ventilation Damper Abnormality
Action level Failure code Abnormality in vent (mode) changeover damper servomotor
Failure
L01 879EMC (Machine monitor system)
Detail of • Air conditioner controller judged from potentiometer voltage of servomotor that vent
failure (mode) changeover damper servomotor is not operating.
Action of • The air conditioner controller sends information about the abnormality in vent (mode)
controller changeover damper to the machine monitor via CAN communication.
Problem on • Vent (mode) cannot be changed but air conditioner can be operated.
machine
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
• Check whether this failure code is displayed on the electrical system abnormality record
Related screen in service mode of the machine monitor.
information • Troubleshooting cannot be performed since the connector portion of vent (mode)
changeover damper servomotor cannot be checked while the air conditioner unit is
installed on the machine.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective air conditioner Air conditioner controller may be defective. (Since this is an internal
1 defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
controller
Air conditioner unit may be defective. (Since this is an internal defect,
2 Defective air conditioner unit troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
80-62 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Failure code [879FMC] Air Mix Damper Abnormality
Action level Failure code Abnormality in air mix (temperature control) damper
Failure servomotor
L01 879FMC
(Machine monitor system)
Detail of • The air conditioner controller judged from the potentiometer voltage of the servomotor that
failure the air mix (temperature regulation) damper servomotor is not operating.
Action of • The air conditioner controller sends information about the air mix damper abnormality to
controller the machine monitor via CAN communication.
Problem on • The air conditioner does not operate since temperature cannot be regulated.
machine
• Method of reproducing failure code: Turn starting switch to ON position.
• Check whether this failure code is displayed on the electrical system abnormality record
Related
screen in service mode of the machine monitor.
information
• Troubleshooting cannot be performed since the connector portion of the air mix damper
servomotor cannot be checked while the air conditioner unit is installed on the machine.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective air conditioner Air conditioner controller may be defective. (Since this is an internal
1 defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
controller
Air conditioner unit may be defective. (Since this is an internal defect,
2 Defective air conditioner unit troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
PC210LC-10 80-63
80 Appendix
Failure code [879GKX] Refrigerant Abnormality
80-64 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
A-1 Troubleshooting for power supply system (Air
conditioner does not operate)
A-1 Troubleshooting for power supply system (Air conditioner does not
operate) (PC220_10-FJ0-400-A-00-A)
Failure • Trouble: Air conditioner does not operate due to power supply system failure.
• If failure code [DAZQKR] is displayed on machine monitor, perform this troubleshooting
first.
a The machine monitor, engine controller, pump controller, and air conditioner controller are
connected via CAN communication.
• "DAZQKR" is displayed on operation screen of machine monitor in the following cases. In
this section, 1) and 2) of the following are explained.
1) The air conditioner controller is receiving no power.
2) The air conditioner controller is malfunctioning.
3) No communication is possible between the air conditioner controller and the machine
monitor.
a For 3), see failure code [DAZQKR].
• Turn starting switch to ON position and check whether failure code [DAZQKR] is
displayed on machine monitor and whether CAN communication condition is abnormal.
Related This type of abnormal status indicates that CAN communication cannot be performed
information between the air conditioner controller above the air conditioner unit and the machine
monitor.
• Referring to “Parts and connectors layout“, check fuse No. 14 (5 A) in fuse box F01 for
breakage.
• Ground cable of air conditioner is connected in machine wiring harness together with
electrical equipment of machine.
• For connectors and other parts, see “Parts and connectors layout“.
• In cases where fuses are blown when the A/C switch is pressed, see "Troubleshooting for
compressor and refrigerant system."
• Since connector ACECU of the air conditioner controller has small pins and does not
have a T-adapter, carry out troubleshooting by using the intermediate connector
(Although the intermediate connector does not have a T-adapter either, it does have large
pins).
• If the air conditioner wiring harness between connector ACECU of the air conditioner
controller and the intermediate connector needs to be replaced, the air conditioner unit
must be replaced.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Defective wiring 2. Set battery disconnect switch to OFF position.
1 harness (ground) 3. Disconnect connector AC02.
Between (1) (black) on harness side of
Resistance connector AC02 and chassis ground Max. 1 z
PC210LC-10 80-65
80 Appendix
A-1 Troubleshooting for power supply system (Air
conditioner does not operate)
80-66 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
A-2 Troubleshooting of compressor system (Air is not
cooled)
Failure • Trouble: Air is not cooled due to compressor or refrigerant system failure.
• Referring to "Testing with self-diagnosis function", display "Electrical Systems" screen on
the machine monitor and check to see if the refrigerant pressure is abnormal by checking
whether failure code [879GKX] is displayed. If the refrigerant pressure is abnormal, the
compressor will not be turned ON and air will not subsequently be cooled.
a Abnormal refrigerant pressure indicates that "Signal ((21) of connector ACECU) from the
dual pressure switch is not grounded".
• In certain cases, the air conditioner will not turn on at 3°C or lower (normal).
• If no air comes out, see "Troubleshooting for blower motor system".
Related • For each connector and fuse, see “A-3 Troubleshooting for blower motor system (No air
information comes out or air flow is abnormal)“ and “Parts and connectors layout“.
a A T-adapter is provided only for the connector AC03.
• Since connector ACECU of the air conditioner controller has small pins and does not
have a T-adapter, carry out troubleshooting by using the intermediate connector
(Although the intermediate connector does not have a T-adapter either, it does have large
pins).
• If the air conditioner wiring harness between connector ACECU of the air conditioner
controller and the intermediate connector needs to be replaced, the air conditioner unit
must be replaced.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
a Perform this check when failure code [879GKX] is displayed on "Electrical
Systems" screen of machine monitor.
See failure code [879GKX].
Defective dual a In certain cases, the dual pressure switch may be operating normally and set to
1 pressure switch OFF, therefore, if abnormality is indicated (i.e., switch OFF), attach a pressure
system gauge to the air conditioner compressor and check the refrigerant pressure.
(See “Troubleshooting with gauge pressure“.)
k If the pressure switch is to be replaced, refrigerant must be collected in
advance.
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect the connector AC03 from the air conditioner compressor and
connect a T-adapter to the male side.
Defective air
2 conditioner a Ensure connection of air conditioner compressor ground cable (E).
compressor (See “Parts and connectors layout“.)
Between connector AC03 (male) (1) and
Resistance the chassis ground (i.e., air conditioner Approx. 15 z
compressor coil resistance)
• Referring to "Testing relays", check sound when compressor clutch relay is
turned ON.
Click is heard.: A
a When A above is abnormal and B below is abnormal and C is normal (if the
relay is normal), go to cause 4.
Defective 1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
compressor clutch 2. Disconnect connector R21.
3 relay(Does not turn 3. Use a wire to short-circuit (3) (white) and (5) (red on yellow) of connector R21
ON) (wiring harness side). (This forces the compressor to operate without using the
relay.)
4. Turn starting switch to ON position.
Air is cooled.: B
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
2. Disconnect connector R21 and troubleshoot in that condition.
PC210LC-10 80-67
80 Appendix
A-2 Troubleshooting of compressor system (Air is not
cooled)
80-68 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
A-2 Troubleshooting of compressor system (Air is not
cooled)
PC210LC-10 80-69
80 Appendix
A-3 Troubleshooting for blower motor system (No air
comes out or air flow is abnormal)
A-3 Troubleshooting for blower motor system (No air comes out or air
flow is abnormal) (PC220_10-FK3-400-A-00-A)
Failure No air comes out or air flow is abnormal due to blower motor system failure.
• This failure is not checked with self-diagnosis function.
• In cases where the blown-air volume begins to behave in an unpredictable manner after a
certain while during cooling, freezing of the evaporator is a likely cause.
This may be due to the followings.
1. Defective compressor clutch relay (i.e., stuck in ON position) (see item 3 A from
"Troubleshooting for compressor and refrigerant system")
2. Detachment of the evaporator temperature sensor's mounting holder (Replace the air
conditioner unit)
3. Incorrect adjustment of expansion valve (Replace air conditioner unit)
• If air comes out, fuse and motor are normal, and also wiring harness is normal.
• For connectors and power transistor, see “Parts and connectors layout“.
Related
information a The power transistor is on the rear side of the air conditioner unit.
• If air comes out but its flow is abnormal in heating mode, replace power transistor. (When
no air comes out, the power transistor may also be defective.)
a The blower motor cannot be replaced unless the air conditioner unit is removed once.
• Since connector ACECU of the air conditioner controller has small pins and does not
have a T-adapter, carry out troubleshooting by using the intermediate connector
(Although the intermediate connector does not have a T-adapter either, it does have large
pins).
• If the air conditioner wiring harness between connector ACECU of the air conditioner
controller and the intermediate connector needs to be replaced, the air conditioner unit
must be replaced.
No. Cause Procedure, measuring location, criteria and remarks
Defective fuse No. If fuse is blown, circuit probably has ground fault.
1
10 in fuse box F01
1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
Defective power 2. Replace power transistor.
2
transistor a If air comes out and air flow can be adjusted, the original power transistor is
defective.
Breaking of 1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
harness 2. Disconnect connector AC02.
3 (Wire breakage or 3. Remove fuse No. 10 of fuse box F01.
defective contact of
Resistance Between AC02 (female) (2) and F01-10 Max. 1 z
connectors)
Ground fault in 1. Turn starting switch to OFF position.
harness 2. Disconnect connectors AC02 and R21.
4 3. Remove fuse No. 10 of F01.
(Contact with GND
Between AC02 (female) (2) or F01-10
circuit) Resistance Max. 1 z
and ground
Defective air If no failures are found by the above checks, the air conditioner controller may be
5 conditioner defective. (Since this is an internal defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
controller
If no failures are found by the above checks, the air conditioner unit may be
Defective air defective.
6
conditioner unit
(Since this is an internal defect, troubleshooting cannot be performed.)
80-70 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
A-3 Troubleshooting for blower motor system (No air
comes out or air flow is abnormal)
PC210LC-10 80-71
80 Appendix
A-4 Troubleshooting for FRESH/RECIRC air changeover
80-72 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
A-4 Troubleshooting for FRESH/RECIRC air changeover
PC210LC-10 80-73
80 Appendix
Troubleshooting with gauge pressure
Perform troubleshooting according to the high and low gauge pressures of the cooling cycle. For details, see
"Connection of service tool".
a The gauge pressure varies largely with the weather condition and operating condition of the machine.
Check the gauge pressure under the pressure measurement conditions.
• Pressure of high-pressure line is too high: Approximately 2.5 MPa {25 kg/cm 2} minimum
• Pressure of high-pressure line is too low: Approximately 1 MPa {10 kg/cm 2} maximum
• Pressure of low-pressure line is too high: Approximately 0.3 MPa {3 kg/cm 2} minimum
• Pressure of low-pressure line is too low: Approximately 0.05 MPa {0.5 kg/cm 2} maximum
a Dual pressure switch turns "OFF" to protect the air conditioner circuit if the pressure of the high-pressure
or low-pressure line is abnormal.
[Measurement condition for pressure]
Item Condition value
Ambient temperature 25 to 50°C
Engine speed 1,500 rpm
Air conditioner switch ON
Fan switch HI
Set temperature Cool-Max
• Dual pressure switch
a The switch is normally "ON", and becomes "OFF" when it detects abnormal pressure for compressor
operation.
80-74 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Troubleshooting with gauge pressure
PC210LC-10 80-75
80 Appendix
Troubleshooting with gauge pressure
80-76 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Connection of service tool
k Place the machine on a level ground, lower the work equipment to the ground and stop the engine.
k Turn the battery disconnect switch to the OFF position and remove the key.
a Following service tool kit is used for work with refrigerant R134a.
Symbol Part No. Part name
X 799-703-1200 Service tool kit
PC210LC-10 80-77
80 Appendix
Connection of service tool
80-78 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Precautions for disconnecting and connecting air
conditioner piping
a Ask a qualified person for collecting, adding and filling operations of the refrigerant (air conditioner gas:
R134a). (Only registered person can work.)
a Never release the refrigerant (R134a) to the atmosphere.
k If refrigerant gas (R134a) gets in your eyes, you may lose your sight. And if it touches your skin,
you may suffer from frostbite. Put on protective eyeglasses, gloves and working clothes with long
sleeves while collecting the refrigerant or filling the air conditioner circuit with the refrigerant.
• When loosening the air conditioner hose nuts after collecting the refrigerant, be sure to use 2 wrenches.
Use one wrench to fix and use the other one to loosen the nuts.
• When disconnecting conditioner hoses and tubes, cover so that dust, dirt or water dose not enter them.
PC210LC-10 80-79
80 Appendix
Precautions for disconnecting and connecting air
conditioner piping
1. Engine
2. Compressor
3. Condenser
4. Modulator
5. Air conditioner unit
80-80 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Handling of compressor oil
a If oil for CFC-12 (R-12) is used, lubrication trouble will occur and the compressor may be broken or seized.
Be sure to use an oil suitable for R134a (DENSO: ND-OIL8).
a Oil for use with R134a is extremely hygroscopic, and therefore, the cap must be immediately closed after
use to limit contact with air.
Store the oil can in a dry and ventilated place.
a Precautions for using oil
Do not allow oil for use with R134a to come into contact with acrylic plastic or polystyrene surfaces (except
a baked finish) as it may dissolve these plastics.
Check compressor oil in the following cases, and then add new oil if necessary.
• When much refrigerant is discharged because of leakage.
• When the compressor is troubled and replaced.
(See 3 below)
• When a cycle parts such as air conditioner unit, condenser, modulator, refrigerant piping, etc. is replaced.
• Quantity of oil to be added when cycle part is replaced
Air conditioner part Quantity to be added (cc)
Air conditioner unit, evaporator Approx. 40
Condenser (including modulator) Approx. 60
Modulator (desiccant) Approx. 20
Hose (between compressor and cab) Approx. 35
Hose (between condenser and compressor) Approx. 30
Hose (between condenser and cab) Approx. 10
3. Replacement of compressor
• In case of compressor seizure or breakage.
Metal chips will circulate through the air conditioner circuit and contaminate the compressor oil extremely.
PC210LC-10 80-81
80 Appendix
Handling of compressor oil
In this case, flush the air conditioner circuit and replace the compressor and receiver drier.
The compressor oil is removed from the air conditioner circuit by flushing. Accordingly, install a new
compressor with the oil of the specified quantity (180 cc) filled in it.
• Other cases
a New compressor contains compressor oil of 180 cc in it.
1. Prepare an oil container and drain oil from the old compressor.
2. Measure the quantity of the drained oil with a measuring cylinder, and note the quantity or mark the level.
80-82 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Desiccant replacement
k When replacing the desiccating agent, be sure to collect the refrigerant from the air conditioning
cycle. If the desiccating agent is replaced without collecting the refrigerant, the refrigerant may
blind you or cap (C) may fly out and injure you because of the refrigerant pressure in the cycle.
1. Condenser
2. Modulator
a The desiccanting agent is in modulator (2).
PC210LC-10 80-83
80 Appendix
Desiccant replacement
80-84 PC210LC-10
80 Appendix
Desiccant replacement
PC210LC-10 80-85
80 Appendix
Desiccant replacement
80-86 PC210LC-10
SHOP MANUAL
HYDRAULIC EXCAVATOR
PC210LC-10
Model Serial Number
PC210LC-10 90-1
90 Diagrams and drawings
Table of contents
90-2 PC210LC-10
90 Diagrams and drawings
Symbols in hydraulic circuit diagram
(Rev. 2010/03)
PC210LC-10 90-3
90 Diagrams and drawings
Symbols in hydraulic circuit diagram
90-4 PC210LC-10
90 Diagrams and drawings
Symbols in hydraulic circuit diagram
PC210LC-10 90-5
90 Diagrams and drawings
Symbols in hydraulic circuit diagram
90-6 PC210LC-10
Hydraulic circuit diagram Hydraulic circuit diagram
PC210LC-10
PC210LC-10
a This figure covers the equipment and devices that are unavailable as optional items in some areas.
PC210LC-10 90-7
90 Diagrams and drawings
Symbols in electric circuit diagram
(Rev. 2010/03)
PC210LC-10 90-9
90 Diagrams and drawings
Symbols in electric circuit diagram
90-10 PC210LC-10
90 Diagrams and drawings
Symbols in electric circuit diagram
PC210LC-10 90-11
90 Diagrams and drawings
Symbols in electric circuit diagram
90-12 PC210LC-10
Electrical circuit diagram (1/6) Electrical circuit diagram (1/6)
PC210LC-10
PC210LC-10
a This figure covers the equipment and devices that are unavailable as optional items in some areas.
PC210LC-10 90-13
Electrical circuit diagram (2/6) Electrical circuit diagram (2/6)
PC210LC-10
PC210LC-10
a This figure covers the equipment and devices that are unavailable as optional items in some areas.
PC210LC-10 90-15
Electrical circuit diagram (3/6) Electrical circuit diagram (3/6)
PC210LC-10
PC210LC-10
a This figure covers the equipment and devices that are unavailable as optional items in some areas.
PC210LC-10 90-17
Electrical circuit diagram (4/6) Electrical circuit diagram (4/6)
PC210LC-10
PC210LC-10
a This figure covers the equipment and devices that are unavailable as optional items in some areas.
PC210LC-10 90-19
Electrical circuit diagram (5/6) Electrical circuit diagram (5/6)
PC210LC-10
PC210LC-10
a This figure covers the equipment and devices that are unavailable as optional items in some areas.
PC210LC-10 90-21
Electrical circuit diagram (6/6) Electrical circuit diagram (6/6)
PC210LC-10
PC210LC-10
a This figure covers the equipment and devices that are unavailable as optional items in some areas.
PC210LC-10 90-23
Electrical circuit diagram for air conditioner unit Electrical circuit diagram for air conditioner unit
PC210LC-10
PC210LC-10
a In the drawing, full line shows air conditioner wiring harness, and dashed line shows cab and chassis wiring harness. (For the detail of cab and chassis harness, see "Electrical circuit diagram")
a In the drawing, dot and dash line shows machine monitor wiring, and using twisted line (AVS 0.5 x 2, pitch 45 mm or less).
a This figure covers the equipment and devices that are unavailable as optional items in some areas.
PC210LC-10 90-25
INDEX
INDEX
B E
Bleeding air from fuel system ......................... 30-34 E-1 Engine does not start (Engine does not
Bleeding air from hydraulic circuit ................... 30-72 crank) ...................................................... 40-553
Bucket cylinder ............................................. 60-67 E-2 Manual preheating system does not work .....40-
Bucket play adjustment shim ....................... 10-191 559
E-3 Automatic preheating system does not
work......................................................... 40-562
C E-4 Preheating monitor does not light up when
Carrier roller ................................................. 60-17 preheater is operated ................................ 40-564
Center swivel joint............................. 10-186, 60-55 E-5 When starting switch is turned to ON
Checking and adjusting air conditioner position, machine monitor displays nothing.. 40-566
compressor belt tension............................... 30-39 E-6 When starting switch is turned to ON
Checking cab tipping stopper......................... 30-74 position (before starting engine), engine oil
Checking fuel circuit for leakage..................... 30-36 level monitor lights up in yellow .................. 40-569
Circuit diagram and arrangement of connector E-7 When starting switch is turned to ON
pins ........................................................... 80-26 position (before starting engine), radiator
Classification and procedure for coolant level monitor lights up in yellow ....... 40-570
troubleshooting ........................................... 40-38 E-8 Coolant temperature monitor lights up in
CLSS........................................................... 10-44 white while engine is running...................... 40-571
Coating materials list....................................... 50-6
PC210LC-10 1
INDEX
E-9 Hydraulic oil temperature monitor lights up E-38 When swing brake cancel switch is set to
in white while engine is running .................. 40-572 CANCEL position, machine cannot swing ... 40-603
E-10 Charge level monitor lights up while E-39 Swing brake does not operate while
engine is running....................................... 40-573 swing brake cancel switch is locked ............ 40-605
E-11 Fuel level monitor lights up in red while E-40 One-touch power maximizing function
engine is running....................................... 40-574 does not work or monitor is not displayed .... 40-607
E-12 Air cleaner clogging monitor lights up in E-41 One-touch power maximizing function is
yellow while engine is running .................... 40-575 not cancelled ............................................ 40-609
E-13 Water separator monitor lights up while E-42 Travel alarm does not sound when
engine is running....................................... 40-576 machine travels ........................................ 40-610
E-14 Coolant temperature monitor lights up in E-43 Alarm does not stop sounding while
red while engine is running......................... 40-577 machine is stopped ................................... 40-611
E-15 Hydraulic oil temperature monitor lights E-44 Horn does not sound ........................... 40-612
up in red while engine is running................. 40-578 E-45 Horn does not stop sounding ............... 40-614
E-16 Engine oil pressure monitor lights up in E-46 Wiper monitor does not light up or go out
red while engine is running......................... 40-579 when wiper switch is operated.................... 40-615
E-17 Fuel gauge indicates either full or empty E-47 Wiper does not operate when wiper
and does not move.................................... 40-580 switch is operated ..................................... 40-616
E-18 Fuel gauge indicates incorrect amount E-48 Window washer does not operate when
(indicates neither full nor empty) ................. 40-581 window washer switch is operated .............. 40-618
E-19 Coolant temperature gauge indicates E-49 BOOM LOWER indication is not
either Min. or Max. and does not move........ 40-582 displayed properly with monitoring function . 40-619
E-20 Coolant temperature gauge indicates E-50 ARM DUMP indication is not displayed
incorrect temperature (indicates neither Min. properly with monitoring function ................ 40-620
nor Max.).................................................. 40-583 E-51 ARM IN indication is not displayed
E-21 Hydraulic oil temperature gauge indicates properly with monitoring function ................ 40-621
either Min. or Max. and does not move........ 40-584 E-52 BOOM RAISE indication is not displayed
E-22 Hydraulic oil temperature gauge indicates properly with monitoring function ................ 40-622
incorrect temperature (indicates neither Min. E-53 BUCKET CURL indication is not
nor Max.).................................................. 40-586 displayed properly with monitoring function . 40-623
E-23 Content of display on machine monitor is E-54 BUCKET DUMP indication is not
different from that of actual machine ........... 40-587 displayed properly with monitoring function . 40-624
E-24 Machine monitor does not display some E-55 SWING indication is not displayed
items........................................................ 40-588 properly with monitoring function ................ 40-625
E-25 Function switch does not work ............. 40-589 E-56 TRAVEL indication is not displayed
E-26 Automatic preheating system does not properly with monitoring function ................ 40-626
work (In cold season) ................................ 40-590 E-57 Service is not displayed properly with
E-27 Auto-deceleration monitor does not light monitoring function.................................... 40-627
up or does not go out when auto-deceleration E-58 Attachment hydraulic circuit cannot be
switch is operated ..................................... 40-591 changed ................................................... 40-630
E-28 Auto-deceleration is not actuated or E-59 KOMTRAX system does not operate
canceled when lever is operated ................ 40-592 properly.................................................... 40-631
E-29 Working mode selection screen is not EGR cooler .................................................. 10-18
diplayed when working mode switch is EGR system circuit diagram .......................... 10-14
operated................................................... 40-593 EGR system piping drawing........................... 10-12
E-30 Engine or hydraulic pump setting does EGR valve ................................................... 10-16
not change when working mode is changed 40-594 Electric circuit diagram .................................. 90-13
E-31 Travel speed monitor does not change Electric circuit diagram for air conditioner unit .. 90-25
when travel speed switch is operated.......... 40-595 Engine mount ................................................. 60-3
E-32 When travel speed selection is changed, Engine related parts ........................................ 10-3
actual travel speed does not change........... 40-596 Explanation of terms for maintenance standard ...00-
E-33 Alarm buzzer does not stop sounding ... 40-597 23
E-34 When starting switch is turned to OFF
position, service meter is not displayed ....... 40-598
E-35 Service mode cannot be selected......... 40-599
F
E-36 Any of work equipment, swing and travel Fabrication of dummy temperature sensor (for
does not work ........................................... 40-600 KDOC and KDPF temperature sensors)...... 40-106
E-37 All of work equipment, swing, and travel Fabrication of short-circuit connector (for
mechanism do not lock .............................. 40-602 CA1883 and CA3135) ............................... 40-107
2 PC210LC-10
INDEX
Failure code [879FMC] Air Mix Damper Failure code [CA2288] Turbo Speed High Error
Abnormality .............................................. 40-125 1.............................................................. 40-281
Failure code [A1U0N3]: KDPF Dry Request Failure code [CA2349] EGR Valve Solenoid
(HC Release)............................................ 40-130 Open Error ............................................... 40-283
Failure code [A1U0N4] KDPF Dry Request Failure code [CA2353] EGR Valve Solenoid
(HC Release)............................................ 40-132 Short Error................................................ 40-285
Failure code [AA10NX] Air Cleaner Clogging. 40-134 Failure code [CA2357] EGR Valve Servo Error ....40-
Failure code [B@BAZK] Eng Oil Level Low ... 40-139 287
Failure code [CA1117] Persistent Data Lost Failure code [CA2373] Exhaust Manifold Press
Error ........................................................ 40-238 Sens High Error ........................................ 40-288
Failure code [CA122] Chg Air Press Sensor Failure code [CA2374] Exhaust Manifold Press
High Error................................................. 40-145 Sens Low Error ......................................... 40-290
Failure code [CA123] Chg Air Press Sensor Failure code [CA2375] EGR Orifice Temp Sens
Low Error ................................................. 40-147 High Error................................................. 40-292
Failure code [CA144] Coolant Temp Sens High Failure code [CA238] Ne Speed Sensor
Error ........................................................ 40-153 Supply Volt Error ....................................... 40-169
Failure code [CA145] Coolant Temp Sens Low Failure code [CA2381] KVGT Pos Sens High
Error ........................................................ 40-155 Error ........................................................ 40-296
Failure code [CA153] Chg Air Temp Sensor Failure code [CA2382] KVGT Pos Sens Low
High Error................................................. 40-157 Error ........................................................ 40-298
Failure code [CA154] Chg Air Temp Sensor Failure code [CA2383] KVGT Solenoid Open
Low Error ................................................. 40-159 Error ........................................................ 40-301
Failure code [CA1664] KDOC Malfunction .... 40-239 Failure code [CA2386] KVGT Solenoid Short
Failure code [CA1691] Regeneration Error ........................................................ 40-303
Ineffective................................................. 40-241 Failure code [CA2387] KVGT Servo Error ..... 40-305
Failure code [CA1843] Crankcase Press Sens Failure code [CA2554] Exh Manifold Press
High Error................................................. 40-248 Sens In Range Error.................................. 40-306
Failure code [CA1844] Crankcase Press Failure code [CA2555] Grid Htr Relay Volt Low
Sensor Low Error ...................................... 40-250 Error ........................................................ 40-307
Failure code [CA187] Sensor 2 Supply Volt Failure code [CA2556] Grid Htr Relay Volt High
Low Error ................................................. 40-161 Error ........................................................ 40-309
Failure code [CA1879] KDPF Delta Pressure Failure code [CA2637] KDOC Face Plugging 40-311
Sensor High Error ..................................... 40-252 Failure code [CA2639] Manual Stationary
Failure code [CA1881] KDPF Delta Pressure Regeneration Request............................... 40-313
Sensor Low Error ...................................... 40-254 Failure code [CA271] IMV/PCV1 Short Error . 40-171
Failure code [CA1883] KDPF Delta P Sens In Failure code [CA272] IMV/PCV1 Open Error . 40-173
Range Error.............................................. 40-256 Failure code [CA295] Ambient Press Sens In
Failure code [CA1921] KDPF Soot Load High Range Error.............................................. 40-175
Error 1...................................................... 40-259 Failure code [CA2973] Chg Air Press Sensor
Failure code [CA1922] KDPF Soot Load High In Range Error .......................................... 40-317
Error 2...................................................... 40-262 Failure code [CA3133] KDPF Outlet Press
Failure code [CA1993] KDPF Delta Pressure Sens High Error ........................................ 40-318
Low Error ................................................. 40-268 Failure code [CA3134] KDPF Outlet Press
Failure code [CA2185] Throt Sensor Sup Volt Sens Low Error ......................................... 40-320
High Error................................................. 40-271 Failure code [CA3135] KDPF Outlet Press
Failure code [CA2186] Throt Sensor Sup Volt Sens In Range Error.................................. 40-322
Low Error ................................................. 40-273 Failure code [CA322] Inj #1(L#1) Open/Short
Failure code [CA221] Ambient Press Sens Error ........................................................ 40-176
High Error................................................. 40-163 Failure code [CA323] Inj #5(L#5) Open/Short
Failure code [CA222] Ambient Press Sens Low Error ........................................................ 40-178
Error ........................................................ 40-165 Failure code [CA324] Inj #3(L#3) Open/Short
Failure code [CA2249] Rail Press Very Low Error ........................................................ 40-180
Error 2...................................................... 40-275 Failure code [CA325] Inj #6(L#6) Open/Short
Failure code [CA227] Sensor 2 Supply Volt Error ........................................................ 40-182
High Error................................................. 40-167 Failure code [CA3251] KDOC Inlet Temp High
Failure code [CA2271] EGR Valve Pos Sens Error ........................................................ 40-326
High Error................................................. 40-276 Failure code [CA3253] KDOC Temp Error -
Failure code [CA2272] EGR Valve Pos Sens Non Regeneration..................................... 40-329
Low Error ................................................. 40-278
PC210LC-10 3
INDEX
Failure code [CA3254] KDOC Outlet Temp Failure code [CA515] Rail Press Sens Sup Volt
High Error 1 .............................................. 40-332 High Error................................................. 40-211
Failure code [CA3255] KDPF Temp Error - Non Failure code [CA516] Rail Press Sens Sup Volt
Regeneration............................................ 40-335 Low Error ................................................. 40-213
Failure code [CA3256] KDPF Outlet Temp Failure code [CA553] Rail Press High Error... 40-215
High Error 1 .............................................. 40-338 Failure code [CA559] Rail Press Low Error ... 40-218
Failure code [CA331] Inj #2(L#2) Open/Short Failure code [CA687] Turbo Speed Low Error .....40-
Error ........................................................ 40-184 221
Failure code [CA3311] KDOC Outlet Temp Failure code [CA689] Eng Ne and Speed
High Error 2 .............................................. 40-341 Sensor Error ............................................. 40-223
Failure code [CA3312] KDPF Outlet Temp Failure code [CA691] Intake Air Temp Sens
High Error 2 .............................................. 40-344 High Error................................................. 40-225
Failure code [CA3313] KDOC Inlet Temp Failure code [CA692] Intake Air Temp Sens
Sensor Low Error ...................................... 40-347 Low Error ................................................. 40-227
Failure code [CA3314] KDOC Inlet Temp Failure code [CA731] Eng Bkup Speed Sens
Sensor High Error ..................................... 40-350 Phase Error .............................................. 40-231
Failure code [CA3315] KDOC Inlet Temp Sens Failure code [CA778] Eng Bkup Speed Sensor
In Range Error .......................................... 40-353 Error ........................................................ 40-233
Failure code [CA3316] KDOC Outlet Temp Failure code [D19JKZ] Personal Code Relay
Sens Low Error ......................................... 40-357 Abnormality .............................................. 40-386
Failure code [CA3317] KDOC Outlet Temp Failure code [D8ALKA] System Operating
Sens High Error ........................................ 40-360 Lamp Disconnection (KOMTRAX) .............. 40-391
Failure code [CA3318] KDOC Outlet Temp Failure code [D8ALKB] System Operating
Sens In Range Error.................................. 40-364 Lamp Short Circuit (KOMTRAX) ................. 40-393
Failure code [CA3319] KDPF Outlet Temp Failure code [DA25KP] 5V Sensor1 Power
Sens High Error ........................................ 40-368 Abnormality .............................................. 40-398
Failure code [CA332] Inj #4(L#4) Open/Short Failure code [DA29KQ] Model Selection
Error ........................................................ 40-186 Abnormality .............................................. 40-401
Failure code [CA3321] KDPF Outlet Temp Failure code [DA2LKA] System Operating
Sens Low Error ......................................... 40-372 Lamp Disconnection (Pump Con) ............... 40-403
Failure code [CA3322] KDPF Outlet Temp Failure code [DA2LKB] System Operating
Sens In Range Error Failure code [CA3322] Lamp Short Circuit (Pump Con).................. 40-405
KDPF Outlet Temp Sens In Range Error ..... 40-375 Failure code [DA2QKR] CAN2 Discon ( Pump
Failure code [CA3419] Mass Air Flow Sensor Con) ........................................................ 40-406
Sup Volt High Error.................................... 40-379 Failure code [DA2RKR] CAN1 Discon ( Pump
Failure code [CA3421] Mass Air Flow Sensor Con) ........................................................ 40-409
Sup Volt Low Error .................................... 40-381 Failure code [DAF9KQ] Model Selection
Failure code [CA352] Sensor 1 Supply Volt Abnormality .............................................. 40-414
Low Error ................................................. 40-190 Failure code [DAFLKA] Operating Lamp Open
Failure code [CA356] Mass Air Flow Sensor Circuit(Monitor) ......................................... 40-416
High Error................................................. 40-192 Failure code [DAFLKB] System Operating
Failure code [CA357] Mass Air Flow Sensor Lamp Short Circuit (Monitor) ...................... 40-418
Low Error ................................................. 40-194 Failure code [DAZ9KQ] AC Model Selection
Failure code [CA3741] Rail Press Valve Trip Abnormality .............................................. 40-420
Error ........................................................ 40-383 Failure code [DAZQKR] CAN2 Discon (AC) .. 40-421
Failure code [CA386] Sensor 1 Supply Volt Failure code [DB2QKR] CAN2 Discon (Engine
High Error................................................. 40-196 Con) ........................................................ 40-426
Failure code [CA428] Water in Fuel Sensor Failure code [DGH2KB] Hyd Oil Sensor Short .....40-
High Error................................................. 40-197 435
Failure code [CA429] Water in Fuel Sensor Failure code [DHS3MA] Arm IN PPC Sen.
Low Error ................................................. 40-199 Abnormality .............................................. 40-444
Failure code [CA449] Rail Press Very High Failure code [DHS9MA] Boom LOWER Press
Error ........................................................ 40-205 Sensor Abnormality................................... 40-452
Failure code [CA451] Rail Press Sensor High Failure code [DHSDMA] Bucket DUMP PPC
Error ........................................................ 40-206 Press Sensor Abnormality ......................... 40-464
Failure code [CA452] Rail Press Sensor Low Failure code [DKR0MA] F pump S/P sensor
Error ........................................................ 40-208 Abnormality .............................................. 40-479
Failure code [CA488] Chg Air Temp High Failure code [DKR1MA] R pump S/P sensor
Torque Derate........................................... 40-210 Abnormality .............................................. 40-481
4 PC210LC-10
INDEX
Failure code [DW43KA] Travel Speed Sol Failure code [B@BCZK] Radiator Coolant
Open Circuit ............................................. 40-489 Level Low................................................. 40-141
Failure code [DW45KA] swing holding brake Failure code [B@HANS] Hyd Oil Overheat.... 40-143
Sol Open Circuit........................................ 40-493 Failure code [CA115] Eng Ne and Bkup Speed
Failure code [DW45KB] Swing Brake Sol Short Sens Error ................................................ 40-144
Circuit ...................................................... 40-496 Failure code [CA131] Throttle Sensor High
Failure code [DXA8KA] PC-EPC (F) Sol Open Error ........................................................ 40-149
Circuit ...................................................... 40-519 Failure code [CA132] Throttle Sensor Low
Failure code [DXA8KB] PC-EPC (F) Sol Short Error ........................................................ 40-151
Circuit ...................................................... 40-521 Failure code [CA234] Eng Overspeed........... 40-168
Failure code [DXA9KA] PC-EPC (R) Sol Open Failure code [CA239] Ne Speed Sens Supply
Circuit ...................................................... 40-523 Volt High Error .......................................... 40-170
Failure code [DXA9KB] PC-EPC (R) Sol Short Failure code [CA343] ECM Critical Internal
Circuit ...................................................... 40-525 Failure ..................................................... 40-188
Failure code [DXE0KA] LS-EPC Sol Open Failure code [CA351] Injectors Drive Circuit
Circuit ...................................................... 40-527 Error ........................................................ 40-189
Failure code [DXE5KA] Merge-divider Main Sol Failure code [CA435] Eng Oil Press Sw Error......40-
Open Circuit ............................................. 40-535 201
Failure code [DXE5KB] Merge-divider Main Sol Failure code [CA441] Battery Voltage Low
Short Circuit ............................................. 40-537 Error ........................................................ 40-202
Failure code [DXE6KA] Merge-divider LS Sol Failure code [CA442] Battery Voltage High
Open Circuit ............................................. 40-539 Error ........................................................ 40-204
Failure code [879AKA] A/C Inner Sensor Open Failure code [CA555] Crankcase Press High
Circuit ............................................ 40-117, 80-52 Error 1...................................................... 40-216
Failure code [879AKB] A/C Inner Sensor Short Failure code [CA556] Crankcase Press High
Circuit ............................................ 40-118, 80-53 Error 2...................................................... 40-217
Failure code [879BKA] A/C Outer sensor Open Failure code [CA697] ECM Int Temp Sensor
Circuit ........................................................ 80-54 High Error................................................. 40-229
Failure code [879BKA] A/C Outer Sensor Failure code [CA698] ECM Int Temp Sensor
Open Circuit ............................................. 40-119 Low Error ................................................. 40-230
Failure code [879BKB] A/C Outer sensor Short Failure code [CA1695] Sensor 5 Supply Volt
Circuit ........................................................ 80-56 High Error................................................. 40-244
Failure code [879BKB] A/C Outer Sensor Short Failure code [CA1696] Sensor 5 Supply Volt
Circuit ...................................................... 40-120 Low Error ................................................. 40-246
Failure code [879CKA] Ventilating Sensor Failure code [CA1942] Crankcase Press Sens
Open Circuit ................................... 40-121, 80-58 In Range Error .......................................... 40-267
Failure code [879CKB] Ventilating Sensor Failure code [CA2311] IMV Solenoid Error .... 40-282
Short Circuit ................................... 40-122, 80-59 Failure code [CA2376] EGR Orifice Temp Sens
Failure code [879DKZ] Sunlight sensor Open Low Error ................................................. 40-294
or Short Circuit............................................ 80-60 Failure code [CA2961] EGR Orifice Temp High
Failure code [879DKZ] Sunlight Sensor Open Error 1...................................................... 40-316
or Short Circuit.......................................... 40-123 Failure code [CA595] Turbo Speed High Error
Failure code [879EMC] Ventilation Damper 2.............................................................. 40-220
Abnormality .................................... 40-124, 80-62 Failure code [D110KB] Battery Relay Output
Failure code [879FMC] Air Mix Damper Voltage..................................................... 40-384
Abnormality ................................................ 80-63 Failure code [D811MC] KOMTRAX Error ...... 40-389
Failure code [879GKX] Refrigerant Failure code [D862KA] GPS Antenna Open
Abnormality .................................... 40-126, 80-64 Circuit ...................................................... 40-390
Failure code [989L00] Engine Controller Lock Failure code [D8AQKR] CAN2 Discon
Caution1 .................................................. 40-127 (KOMTRAX) ............................................. 40-394
Failure code [989M00] Engine Controller Lock Failure code [DA20MC] Pump Controller ...... 40-395
Caution2 .................................................. 40-128 Failure code [DA22KK] Pump Solenoid Power
Failure code [989N00] Engine Controller Lock Low Error ................................................. 40-396
Caution3 .................................................. 40-129 Failure code [DAF0MB] Monitor ROM
Failure code [AB00KE] Charge Voltage Low . 40-136 Abnormality .............................................. 40-410
Failure code [B@BAZG] Engine Oil Pressure Failure code [DAF0MC] Monitor Error ........... 40-411
Low ......................................................... 40-138 Failure code [DAF8KB] Camera Power Supply
Failure code [B@BCNS] Engine Coolant Short Circuit ............................................. 40-412
Overheat .................................................. 40-140 Failure code [DAFGMC] GPS Module Error .. 40-415
PC210LC-10 5
INDEX
Failure code [DAFQKR] CAN2 Discon Failure code [DXE4KB] Attachment Flow EPC
(Monitor) .................................................. 40-419 Short Circuit ............................................. 40-533
Failure code [DB2RKR] CAN1 Discon (Engine Failure code [DXE6KB] Merge-divider LS Sol
Con) ........................................................ 40-431 Short Circuit ............................................. 40-541
Failure code [DHA4KA] Air Cleaner Clog Failure code [DY20KA] Wiper Working
Sensor Open Circuit .................................. 40-437 Abnormality .............................................. 40-543
Failure code [DHPAMA] F Pump Press Sensor Failure code [DY20MA] Wiper Parking
Abnormality .............................................. 40-438 Abnormality .............................................. 40-545
Failure code [DHPBMA] R Pump Press Sensor Failure code [DY2CKB] Washer Drive Short
Abnormality .............................................. 40-441 Circuit ...................................................... 40-547
Failure code [DHS4MA] Bucket Curl PPC Failure code [DY2DKB] Wiper Drive (Fwd)
Press Sensor Abnormality ......................... 40-446 Short Circuit ............................................. 40-549
Failure code [DHS8MA] Boom Raise PPC Failure code [DY2EKB] Wiper Drive (Rev)
Press Sensor Abnormality ......................... 40-449 Short Circuit ............................................. 40-551
Failure code [DHSAMA] Swing RH PPC Press Failure code list related to air conditioner ........ 80-51
Sensor Abnormality................................... 40-455 Failure mode and cause table ...................... 40-636
Failure code [DHSBMA] Swing LH PPC Press Final drive ............................................10-34, 60-8
Sensor Abnormality................................... 40-458 Fuse location table...................................... 40-101
Failure code [DHSCMA] Arm Dump PPC
Press Sensor Abnormality ......................... 40-461
Failure code [DHSFMA] Travel Fwd LH PPC
H
Press Sensor Abnormality ......................... 40-467 H-1 All of work equipment, swing and travel
Failure code [DHSGMA] Travel Fwd RH PPC operation lacks speed or power .................. 40-644
Press Sensor Abnormality ......................... 40-470 H-2 Engine speed lowers significantly or
Failure code [DHSHMA] Travel Rev LH PPC engine stalls ............................................. 40-647
Press Sensor Abnormality ......................... 40-473 H-3 All work equipment, swing and travel does
Failure code [DHSJMA] Travel Rev RH PPC not work ................................................... 40-650
Press Sensor Abnormality ......................... 40-476 H-4 Unusual sound is heard from around
Failure code [DR21KX] Camera 2 Picture Rev. hydraulic pump ......................................... 40-651
Drive Abnormality...................................... 40-483 H-5 Fine control performance or response is
Failure code [DR31KX] Camera 3 Picture Rev. poor ......................................................... 40-652
Drive Abnormality...................................... 40-485 H-6 Speed or power of boom is low .............. 40-654
Failure code [DV20KB] Travel Alarm Short H-7 Speed or power of arm is low................. 40-658
Circuit ...................................................... 40-487 H-8 Speed or power of bucket is low............. 40-663
Failure code [DW43KB] Travel Speed Sol H-9 Work equipment does not move in single
Short Circuit ............................................. 40-491 operation.................................................. 40-666
Failure code [DW91KA] Travel Junction Sol H-10 Hydraulic drift of boom is large ............. 40-667
Open Circuit ............................................. 40-499 H-11 Hydraulic drift of arm is large ................ 40-668
Failure code [DW91KB] Travel Junction Sol H-12 Hydraulic drift of bucket is large............ 40-669
Short Circuit ............................................. 40-501 H-14 When part of work equipment is relieved
Failure code [DWA2KA] Attachment Sol Open singly, other parts of work equipment move . 40-672
Circuit ...................................................... 40-503 H-15 One-touch power maximizing function
Failure code [DWA2KB] Attachment Sol Short does not operate ....................................... 40-673
Circuit ...................................................... 40-505 H-16 In combined operation of work
Failure code [DWK0KA] 2-Stage Relief Sol equipment, equipment having heavier load
Open Circuit ............................................. 40-507 moves slower ........................................... 40-674
Failure code [DWK0KB] 2-stage Relief Sol H-17 In combined operations of swing and
Short Circuit ............................................. 40-509 boom RAISE, boom rising speed is low....... 40-675
Failure code [DWK2KA] Variable Back Press H-18 In combined operations of swing and
Sol Open Circuit........................................ 40-511 travel, travel speed drops largely ................ 40-676
Failure code [DWK8KA] Swing Press C/O Sol H-19 Machine does not travel straight........... 40-677
Open Circuit ............................................. 40-515 H-20 Travel speed is slow............................ 40-680
Failure code [DWK8KB] Swing Press C/O Sol H-21 Machine is hard to steer or travel power
Short Circuit ............................................. 40-517 is low ....................................................... 40-682
Failure code [DXE0KB] LS-EPC Sol Short H-22 Travel speed does not change, or travel
Circuit ...................................................... 40-529 speed is too slow or fast ............................ 40-685
Failure code [DXE4KA] Attachment Flow EPC H-23 One of tracks does not run................... 40-686
Open Circuit ............................................. 40-531 H-24 Upper structure does not swing to the
right or left ................................................ 40-688
6 PC210LC-10
INDEX
H-25 Upper structure swing only to the right or KOMTRAX system ..................................... 10-267
left ........................................................... 40-689 KVGT ............................................................ 10-5
H-26 Swing acceleration or swing speed is low
in both directions (right and left).................. 40-690
H-27 Swing acceleration performance is poor
L
or swing speed is slow in only one direction. 40-691 List of abbreviation........................................ 00-52
H-28 Upper structure overruns excessively
when it stops swinging (both right and left) .. 40-692
H-29 Upper structure overruns excessively
M
when it stops swinging (either right or left) ... 40-693 Machine monitor system.................. 10-194, 10-245
H-30 Shock is large when upper structure Main pump ......................................... 10-49, 60-25
stops swinging .......................................... 40-694 Measuring and adjusting valve clearance........ 30-13
H-31 Large unusual noise is heard when upper Measuring fuel delivery, return and leakage..... 30-29
structure stops swinging ............................ 40-695 Measuring fuel pressure ................................ 30-23
H-32 Swing drift on a slope is large while swing Method of disconnecting and connecting of
holding brake is applied ............................. 40-696 push-pull type coupler ................................. 00-29
H-33 Swing drift on a slope is large while swing
holding brake is released ........................... 40-697
H-34 Attachment hydraulic circuit cannot be O
changed while attachment is installed ......... 40-698 Outer temperature sensor.............................. 80-23
H-35 Oil flow in attachment circuit cannot be Outline of refrigeration cycle ............................ 80-8
controlled ................................................. 40-699
Handling battery disconnect switch .............. 30-151
Handling cylinder cutout mode operation ........ 30-37 P
Handling equipment of fuel system devices..... 00-25 Parts and connectors layout .......................... 80-31
Handling no injection cranking operation......... 30-38 Pm clinic service......................................... 30-153
Handling of compressor oil ............................ 80-81 Power train system ....................................... 10-29
Handling of electrical equipment .................... 00-32 PPC valve.................................................. 10-156
Handling of hydraulic equipment .................... 00-27 Practical use of KOMTRAX............................ 00-47
Handling of intake system parts ..................... 00-26 Precautions for disconnecting and connecting
Handling voltage circuit of engine controller .. 30-150 air conditioner piping ................................... 80-79
How to open the electrical system abnormality Precautions for KDPF (KCSF and KDOC)
record screen in service mode of the machine Cleaning and Replacement........................ 40-103
monitor....................................................... 80-38 Precautions for refrigerant ............................... 80-3
How to read electric wire code ....................... 00-40 Precautions when performing operation.......... 00-43
How to read the shop manual ........................ 00-21 Preparation work for troubleshooting of
How to read this manual .................................. 50-4 electrical system ......................................... 40-34
Hydraulic circuit diagram ................................. 90-7 Procedure for testing and troubleshooting ....... 80-24
Hydraulic equipment layout drawing ............... 10-38
Hydraulic tank .................................... 10-42, 60-24
R
I Releasing remaining pressure from hydraulic
circuit ......................................................... 30-44
Idler ............................................................. 60-14 Removal and installation of air conditioner
Important safety precautions.......................... 00-14 compressor assembly ............................... 50-229
Information described in troubleshooting table Removal and installation of air conditioner
(H-mode).................................................. 40-633 condenser assembly ................................. 50-232
Information in troubleshooting table ...... 40-44, 80-50 Removal and installation of air conditioner unit
Information mentioned in troubleshooting table assembly.................................................. 50-214
(S mode) .................................................. 40-700 Removal and installation of center swivel joint
Inspection procedure before troubleshooting... 40-15 assembly.................................................. 50-149
Isolating the parts causing hydraulic drift in Removal and installation of control valve
work equipment .......................................... 30-68 assembly.................................................. 50-161
Removal and installation of counterweight
K assembly.................................................. 50-146
Removal and installation of cylinder head
KCCV layout drawing .................................... 10-19 assembly.................................................... 50-33
KCCV ventilator............................................ 10-21
KDPF .......................................................... 10-23
PC210LC-10 7
INDEX
Removal and installation of engine and main Removal and installation of work equipment
pump assembly .......................................... 50-60 assembly.................................................. 50-178
Removal and installation of engine controller Replacing fan belt ......................................... 30-41
assembly.................................................. 50-234 ROPS cab.................................................. 10-193
Removal and installation of engine front oil
seal ........................................................... 50-72
Removal and installation of engine hood
S
assembly.................................................... 50-83 S-1 When starting switch is turned to START
Removal and installation of engine rear oil seal ...50- position, engine does not crank .................. 40-701
76 S-2 Engine cranks but no exhaust smoke
Removal and installation of floor frame comes out ................................................ 40-702
assembly.................................................. 50-208 S-3 Fuel is being injected but engine does not
Removal and installation of front window start (misfiring: engine cranks but does not
assembly.................................................. 50-202 start) ........................................................ 40-703
Removal and installation of front wiper S-4 Engine startability is poor....................... 40-704
assembly.................................................. 50-222 S-5 Engine does not pick up smoothly .......... 40-706
Removal and installation of fuel cooler S-6 Engine stops during operation................ 40-708
assembly.................................................... 50-79 S-7 Engine runs rough or is unstable ............ 40-710
Removal and installation of fuel tank assembly....50- S-8 Engine lacks power............................... 40-711
80 S-9 Exhaust smoke is black (KDPF clogs up
Removal and installation of hydraulic oil cooler early) ....................................................... 40-713
assembly.................................................... 50-55 S-10 Engine oil consumption is excessive..... 40-715
Removal and installation of hydraulic tank S-11 Engine oil becomes contaminated early 40-716
assembly.................................................. 50-153 S-12 Fuel consumption is excessive............. 40-717
Removal and installation of idler and idler S-13 Oil is in coolant (or coolant spurts or
cushion assembly ..................................... 50-133 coolant level goes down) ........................... 40-718
Removal and installation of injector assembly . 50-24 S-14 Engine oil pressure drops .................... 40-719
Removal and installation of KCCV assembly . 50-102 S-15 Fuel is contaminated in engine oil......... 40-720
Removal and installation of KDPF assembly ... 50-86 S-16 Coolant is contaminated in engine oil (Oil
Removal and installation of KOMTRAX becomes cloudy white) .............................. 40-721
terminal assembly ..................................... 50-243 S-17 Coolant temperature rises too high
Removal and installation of machine monitor (overheating) ............................................ 40-722
assembly.................................................. 50-239 S-18 Unusual noise is heard ........................ 40-723
Removal and installation of main pump S-19 Vibration is excessive.......................... 40-724
assembly.................................................. 50-157 S-20 Air cannot be bled from fuel circuit ........ 40-725
Removal and installation of mass air flow and S-21 Active regeneration is executed
temperature sensor ................................... 50-242 frequently ................................................. 40-726
Removal and installation of operator cab glass S-22 Active regeneration takes time ............. 40-727
(adhered glass)......................................... 50-192 S-23 White smoke is exhausted during active
Removal and installation of operator's cab regeneration ............................................. 40-728
assembly.................................................. 50-187 Sensor....................................................... 10-270
Removal and installation of pump controller Separation and connection of track shoe
assembly.................................................. 50-236 assembly.................................................. 50-129
Removal and installation of pump swash plate Sequence of events in troubleshooting ........... 40-11
sensor...................................................... 50-241 Sketch of tools for testing and adjusting ............ 30-7
Removal and installation of radiator assembly . 50-53 Sketches of special tools ............................... 50-15
Removal and installation of revolving frame Solenoid valve.................................. 10-178, 60-52
assembly.................................................. 50-144 Special functions of machine monitor.............. 30-77
Removal and installation of seat belt............. 50-220 Specification drawing ...................................... 01-3
Removal and installation of sprocket ............ 50-132 Specifications .........................................01-3, 01-5
Removal and installation of supply pump Sprocket ...................................................... 60-10
assembly.................................................... 50-19 Standard tightening torque table .................... 00-48
Removal and installation of swing circle Standard value table for electrical system ....... 20-18
assembly.................................................. 50-128 Standard value table for engine........................ 20-3
Removal and installation of swing motor and Standard value table for machine ..................... 20-5
swing machinery assembly ........................ 50-118 Sunlight sensor............................................. 80-22
Removal and installation of travel motor and Swing circle..........................................10-31, 60-5
final drive assembly................................... 50-109 Swing machinery ..................................10-32, 60-6
Swing motor ..................................... 10-131, 60-36
8 PC210LC-10
INDEX
Symbols in electric circuit diagram.................... 90-9 Work equipment and swing PPC valve ........... 60-41
Symbols in hydraulic circuit diagram................. 90-3 Work equipment shim ................................. 10-190
Symptom of probable failure and Working range drawings.................................. 01-4
troubleshooting No. ..................................... 40-41
System chart for hydraulic system ................ 40-634
System diagram ........................................... 80-28
T
T-branch box and T-branch adapter table........ 40-95
Table of fuel, coolant and lubricants .................. 01-9
Testing air leakage (duct)............................... 80-35
Testing and adjusting oil pressure in pump LS
control circuit .............................................. 30-55
Testing and adjusting oil pressure in pump PC
control circuit .............................................. 30-52
Testing and adjusting oil pressure in work
equipment, swing, and travel circuits............. 30-45
Testing and adjusting track shoe tension......... 30-43
Testing before troubleshooting ....................... 40-13
Testing blowby pressure ................................ 30-20
Testing boost pressure .................................... 30-9
Testing compression pressure ....................... 30-16
Testing diodes ............................................ 30-152
Testing (dual) pressure switch for refrigerant ... 80-44
Testing EGR valve and KVGT oil pressures..... 30-22
Testing engine oil pressure ............................ 30-21
Testing engine speed ...................................... 30-8
Testing exhaust gas color .............................. 30-11
Testing FRESH/RECIRC air changeover ........ 80-42
Testing oil leakage ........................................ 30-69
Testing oil pressure of control circuit ............... 30-49
Testing output pressure of solenoid valve........ 30-60
Testing PPC valve output pressure................. 30-64
Testing pump swash plate sensor................... 30-67
Testing relays ............................................... 80-45
Testing sunlight sensor.................................. 80-43
Testing swing circle bearing clearance............ 30-42
Testing vent (mode) changeover .................... 80-40
Testing with self-diagnosis function................. 80-38
Tools for testing and adjusting.......................... 30-3
Track frame and idler cushion .............. 10-36, 60-12
Track roller ................................................... 60-16
Travel motor ..................................... 10-143, 60-38
Travel PPC valve .......................................... 60-44
Troubleshooting chart 1................................. 80-46
Troubleshooting chart 2................................. 80-47
Troubleshooting points .................................... 40-9
Troubleshooting with gauge pressure ............. 80-74
Truck shoe ................................................... 60-18
V
Valve control ................................................ 10-40
W
Weight table ................................................... 01-8
Work equipment ............................... 10-189, 60-56
PC210LC-10 9
PC210LC-10 HYDRAULIC EXCAVATOR
Form No. SEN05842-01
©2012 KOMATSU
All Rights Reserved
Printed in Japan 06–12